Human Resource Management Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd i 20/07/10 6:25 PM Human Resource Management THIRTEENTH EDITION R OBE RT L . M AT H I S University of Nebraska at Omaha JOHN H. JACKSON University of Wyoming Australia • Brazil • Japan • Korea • Mexico • Singapore • Spain • United Kingdom • United States Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd iii 20/07/10 6:25 PM This is an electronic version of the print textbook. Due to electronic rights restrictions, some third party content may be suppressed. Editorial review has deemed that any suppressed content does not materially affect the overall learning experience. The publisher reserves the right to remove content from this title at any time if subsequent rights restrictions require it. For valuable information on pricing, previous editions, changes to current editions, and alternate formats, please visit www.cengage.com/highered to search by ISBN#, author, title, or keyword for materials in your areas of interest. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. Human Resource Management, 13th Edition Robert L. Mathis John H. Jackson Vice President of Editorial, Business: Jack W. Calhoun Publisher: Joseph Sabatino Sr. Acquisitions Editor: Michele Rhoades Sr. Developmental Editor: Susanna C. Smart Sr. Editorial Assistant: Ruth Belanger Marketing Manager: Clint Kernen Content Project Manager: Corey Geissler Media Editor: Rob Ellington Sr. Frontlist Buyer, Manufacturing: Kevin Kluck © 2011, 2009 South-Western, Cengage Learning ALL RIGHTS RESERVED. No part of this work covered by the copyright herein may be reproduced, transmitted, stored or used in any form or by any means graphic, electronic, or mechanical, including but not limited to photocopying, recording, scanning, digitizing, taping, Web distribution, information networks, or information storage and retrieval systems, except as permitted under Section 107 or 108 of the 1976 United States Copyright Act, without the prior written permission of the publisher. For product information and technology assistance, contact us at Cengage Learning Customer & Sales Support, 1-800-354-9706 For permission to use material from this text or product, submit all requests online at www.cengage.com/permissions Further permissions questions can be emailed to permissionrequest@cengage.com Production Service: Integra Sr. Art Director: Tippy McIntosh Library of Congress Control Number: 2010930409 Internal and Cover Designer: c miller design Student Edition ISBN-13: 978-0-538-45315-8 Student Edition ISBN-10: 0-538-45315-X Cover Image: © John Foxx, Stockbyte, Getty Images Sr. Rights Acquisitions Specialist, Images: Deanna Ettinger Rights Acquisitions Specialist, Text: Mardell Glinski Schultz South-Western Cengage Learning 5191 Natorp Boulevard Mason, OH 45040 USA For your course and learning solutions, visit www.cengage.com Purchase any of our products at your local college store or at our preferred online store www.cengagebrain.com Printed in the United States of America 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 14 13 12 11 10 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd iv 20/07/10 6:25 PM Dedications TO Jo Ann Mathis for managing efforts on this book, and Julie Foster and Lee Skoda as key supporters. R. D. and M. M. Jackson, who were successful managers of people for many years Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd v 20/07/10 6:25 PM Contents in Brief Preface xxv SECTION 1 Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 SECTION 2 Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 4 5 6 7 SECTION 3 Chapter 8 Chapter 9 Chapter 10 SECTION 4 Chapter 11 Chapter 12 Chapter 13 SECTION 5 Chapter 14 Chapter 15 Chapter 16 Environment of Human Resource Management 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 36 Equal Employment Opportunity 72 Jobs and Labor 107 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 108 Human Resource Planning and Retention 144 Recruiting and Labor Markets 176 Selecting Human Resources 212 Training and Development 247 Training Human Resources 248 Talent Management 282 Performance Management and Appraisal 318 Compensation 357 Total Rewards and Compensation 358 Incentive Plans and Executive Compensation 394 Managing Employee Benefits 424 Employee Relations 465 Risk Management and Worker Protection 466 Employee Rights and Responsibilities 502 Union/Management Relations 538 Appendices 575 Appendix A Appendix B Appendix C Appendix D Human Resource Certification Institute: PHR and SPHR Test Specifications 575 HR Management Resources 581 Major Federal Equal Employment Opportunity Laws and Regulations 585 Uniform Guidelines on Employee Selection 587 vii Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd vii 20/07/10 6:25 PM viii CONTENTS IN BRIEF Appendix E Appendix F Appendix G EEO Enforcement 591 Preemployment Inquiries 595 Sample HR-Related Job Descriptions 599 Glossary 601 Author Index 609 Subject Index 615 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd viii 20/07/10 6:25 PM ix Contents Preface xxv S E C T I O N 1 Environment of Human Resource Management 1 CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 2 HR Headline: The Challenges and Crises Facing HR Management 3 Human Resources as Organizational Core Competency 4 Human Capital and HR 5 HR Functions 5 HR Management’s Contributing Role 7 Organizational Culture and HR 7 Organizational Productivity 9 Social Responsibilities and HR 10 HR Perspective: “Growing Green” in HR 11 Customer Service and Quality Linked to HR 11 Employee Engagement and HR Culture 12 Organizational Ethics and HR Management 12 Ethical Behavior and Organizational Culture 13 HR Best Practices: Cisco Makes Global Ethics Important and Fun 14 Ethics and Global Differences 14 HR’s Role in Organizational Ethics 15 Current and Future HR Management Challenges 16 Organizational Cost Pressures and Restructuring 16 Economics and Job Changes 16 Globalization of Organizations and HR 19 Workforce Demographics and Diversity 20 HR Technology 21 HR Online: Wikis, Blogs, Twitters, and HR 22 Measuring HR Impact through Metrics 23 Managing HR in Organizations 23 Smaller Organizations and HR Management 23 HR Cooperation with Operating and Line Managers 24 How HR Is Seen in Organizations 24 HR Management Roles 25 Administrative Role of HR 26 Operational and Employee Advocate Role for HR 27 Strategic Role for HR 27 HR Management Competencies and Careers 28 HR Competencies 28 HR Management as a Career Field 28 HR Professionalism and Certification 29 ix Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd ix 20/07/10 6:25 PM x CONTENTS Summary 31 Global Staffing 49 Critical Thinking Activities 32 HR Planning in Mergers and Acquisitions 50 HR Experiential Problem Solving 32 Case: HR, Culture, and Business Results Success at Google, Scripps, and UPS 33 Supplemental Cases: Phillips Furniture; Sysco 34 Notes 34 Before the Deal 50 During Integration 51 Post Integration 52 HR Perspective: Dow’s Formula for Successful Acquisitions 52 Strategic Challenges 53 CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 36 HR Headline: Strategic Utilization of Talent Benefits Health Care Organization 37 Managing a Talent Surplus 54 Legal Considerations for Workforce Reductions 55 Managing a Talent Shortage 56 Technology Challenges 57 Effects on Work and Organizations 57 Effects on Communication 58 Strategic Planning 38 Strategy Formulation 39 HR as Organizational Contributor 41 High-Performance Work Practices 42 HR Effectiveness and Financial Performance 43 Environmental Analysis 43 HR Perspective: Numbers Add Up for IBM 44 Internal Environmental Analysis 44 External Environmental Analysis 45 HR Perspective: Verizon Engages Employees via Web Portal 59 Effects on Work Processes 59 Effects on HR Activities 60 Measuring Effectiveness of HR Initiatives 61 HR Metrics 61 HR and Benchmarking 63 HR and the Balanced Scorecard 63 Human Capital Effectiveness Measures 64 HR Audit 66 HR Best Practices: NASA Launches Workforce Realignment 47 Summary 66 Global Competitiveness and Strategic HR 48 HR Experiential Problem Solving 67 Global Framework 48 Global Legal and Regulatory Factors 48 Offshoring 49 Case: Pioneers in HR Analytics 68 Critical Thinking Activities 67 Supplemental Cases: Where Do You Find the Bodies?; Xerox 69 Notes 69 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd x 20/07/10 6:25 PM xi CONTENTS CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 72 HR Headline: Sexual Harassment at the United Nations 73 Nature of Equal Employment Opportunity (EEO) 74 Disparate Treatment 75 Disparate Impact 75 Equal Employment Opportunity Concepts 76 Progressing Toward Equal Employment Opportunity 77 HR Perspective: “Officer Dirt” 78 Race/Ethnic/National Origin 78 Civil Rights Act 1964, Title VII 78 Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478 79 Civil Rights Act 1991 79 Managing Racial and National Origin Issues 79 Affirmative Action 80 Managing Affirmative Action Requirements 81 Sex/Gender Discrimination Laws and Regulations 82 Pregnancy Discrimination 82 Equal Pay and Pay Equity 83 Sexual Harassment 83 Managing Sex/Gender Issues 84 Individuals with Differing Sexual Orientations 86 Nepotism 86 Consensual Relationships and Romance at Work 86 Dealing with Sexual Harassment 87 Types of Sexual Harassment 88 Employer Responses to Sexual Harassment 88 Harassment Likelihood 89 Individuals with Disabilities 90 Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) 90 Who Is Disabled? 90 Genetic Bias Regulations 91 Managing Disabilities in the Workforce 92 HR On-the-Job: ADA and Employment Questions 93 Age and Equal Employment Opportunity 94 Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA) 95 Older Workers Benefit Protection Act (OWBPA) 95 Managing Age Discrimination 95 Religion and Spirituality in the Workplace 96 Managing Religious Diversity 96 Managing Other Discrimination Issues 97 Immigration Reform and Control Acts (IRCA) 97 Language Issues 98 Military Status and USERRA 98 Sexual Orientation 99 Appearance and Weight Discrimination 99 HR Perspective: Discrimination against “Caregivers” 100 Family Responsibility Discrimination (FRD) 100 Diversity Training 100 Components of Traditional Diversity Training 101 Mixed Results for Diversity Training 101 Backlash against Diversity Training Efforts 101 Summary 102 Critical Thinking Activities 102 HR Experiential Problem Solving 103 Case: Religious Accommodation? 103 Supplemental Cases: Keep on Trucking; Mitsubishi Believes in EEO—Now 104 Notes 104 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xi 20/07/10 6:25 PM xii CONTENTS S E C T I O N 2 Jobs and Labor 107 CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 108 HR Headline: Work-Life Balancing 109 Workforce Composition 110 Business Contribution of Diverse Workers 110 Race and Ethnicity 111 Preparing for and Introducing the Job Analysis 129 Conducting the Job Analysis 129 Developing Job Descriptions and Job Specifications 129 Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions and Job Specifications 129 Job Analysis Methods 129 HR Best Practices: Resolving Language Barriers Pays Off 112 Observation 130 Interviewing 130 Questionnaires 130 Computerized Job Analysis Systems 131 Combination Methods 131 Generational Differences 113 Gender Workforce Diversity 113 HR Online: O*Net Resources for Employers 132 Nature of Jobs and Work 114 Job Analysis and O*Net 132 Work Flow Analysis 114 Job Design 116 Behavioral and Legal Aspects of Job Analysis 133 Workers and Job Design 117 Common Approaches to Job Design 118 Characteristics of Jobs 118 Using Worker Teams in Jobs 119 Current Incumbent Emphasis 133 “Inflation” of Jobs and Job Titles 133 Employee and Managerial Anxieties 133 Legal Aspects of Job Analysis 134 Jobs and Work Scheduling 121 Job Descriptions and Job Specifications 135 Telework 121 Work Schedule Alternatives 122 HR On-The-Job: Writing Job Descriptions 136 HR Perspective: Global Work Schedule Differences 123 Job Descriptions 136 Job Specifications 136 Performance Standards 136 Job Description Components 137 Work Flexibility and Scheduling 124 Job Analysis 124 Purposes of Job Analysis 125 Job Analysis Responsibilities 126 Task-Based Job Analysis 126 Competency-Based Job Analysis 127 Summary 139 Critical Thinking Activities 139 HR Experiential Problem Solving 139 Case: ROWE and Flexible Work and Success at Best Buy 140 Implementing Job Analysis 128 Supplemental Cases: The Reluctant Receptionist; Jobs and Work at R.R. Donnelley 141 Planning the Job Analysis 128 Notes 141 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xii 20/07/10 6:25 PM xiii CONTENTS CHAPTER 5 Drivers of Retention 164 Human Resource Planning and Retention 144 HR Perspective: Global Retention 166 HR Headline: Need More Workers? 145 Retention Assessment and Metrics 168 Human Resource Planning 146 HR On-the-Job: Conducting Exit Interviews 170 Organizational Size and HR Planning 146 HR Best Practices: Effective HR Planning for Workforce Future 147 Managing Retention 168 Retention Evaluation and Follow-Up 170 Summary 171 HR Planning Process 147 Critical Thinking Activities 171 Assessing the External Workforce 148 HR Experiential Problem Solving 172 Economic and Governmental Factors 149 Competitive Evaluations 149 Changing Workforce Considerations 149 Case: Accenture—Retaining for Itself 172 Assessing the Internal Workforce 150 Notes 173 Current and Future Jobs Audit 150 Employee and Organizational Capabilities Inventory 150 CHAPTER 6 HR Online: Technology Expanding Employee Skills Database 151 Forecasting HR Supply and Demand 152 Forecasting Methods and Periods 152 Forecasting the Demand for Human Resources 153 Forecasting the Supply of Human Resources 153 Individual Workers and Organizational Relationships 155 Psychological Contract 155 Individual Employee Performance and Motivation 156 Nature of Job Satisfaction 158 Employee Turnover 159 Types of Employee Turnover 160 Measuring Employee Turnover 161 HR Metrics: Determining Turnover Costs 162 Retention of Human Resources 163 Myths and Realities about Retention 163 Supplemental Cases: The Clothing Store; Alegent Health 173 Recruiting and Labor Markets 176 HR Headline: Passive Recruiting Becomes Active 177 Recruiting 178 Strategic Recruiting and HR Planning 178 Training of Recruiters and Managers 179 Labor Markets 179 Labor Market Components 180 Different Labor Markets and Recruiting 181 Strategic Recruiting Decisions 183 Recruiting Presence and Image 183 HR Best Practices: Effective Recruitment at USDA 184 Organization-Based versus Outsourced Recruiting 184 Regular versus Flexible Staffing 185 Recruiting and EEO: Diversity Considerations 186 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xiii 20/07/10 6:25 PM xiv CONTENTS Realistic Job Previews 188 Recruiting Source Choices: Internal versus External 188 General Recruiting Process Metrics 205 Increasing Recruiting Effectiveness 207 Internet Recruiting 188 Critical Thinking Activities 208 E-Recruiting Means 188 Recruiting and Internet Social Networking 189 HR Experiential Problem Solving 208 HR On-the-Job: Effective Recruiting Using an Employer Website 190 Recruiting Using Special Technology Means 190 Legal Issues in Internet Recruiting 191 Advantages of Internet Recruiting 192 Disadvantages of Internet Recruiting 193 External Recruiting Sources 193 Media Sources 193 Competitive Recruiting Sources 195 Employment Agencies 195 Labor Unions 195 HR Perspective: Outplacement Firms as Recruiting Sources 196 Job Fairs and Creative Recruiting 196 Educational Institutions and Recruiting 197 Summary 208 Case: Recruiting at Kia 209 Supplemental Cases: Northwest State College; Enterprise Recruiting 210 Notes 210 CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 212 HR Headline: Using Virtual Worlds for Selection 213 Selection and Placement 214 Placement 214 Selection, Criteria, Predictors, and Job Performance 215 Validity 216 Combining Predictors 218 Selection Responsibilities 218 The Selection Process 219 HR On-the-Job: Internships as a Part of College Recruiting 198 Applicant Job Interest 220 Preemployment Screening 221 Internal Recruiting Methods 198 HR Perspective: Cheating on Electronic Assesments 222 Internal Recruiting Databases and InternetRelated Sources 199 Job Posting 200 HR Perspective: Enhancing Opportunities for Internal Promotion 201 Employee-Focused Recruiting 201 Recruiting Evaluation and Metrics 202 Evaluating Recruiting Quantity and Quality 203 Evaluating Recruiting Satisfaction 204 Evaluating the Time Required to Fill Openings 204 Evaluating the Cost of Recruiting 205 Application Forms 222 Immigration Verification 225 Selection Testing 225 Ability Tests 226 Personality Tests 227 Honesty/Integrity Tests 228 Controversies in Selection Testing 228 Selection Interviewing 229 Inter-Rater Reliability and Face Validity 229 Structured Interviews 230 Less-Structured Interviews 231 Who Conducts Interviews? 232 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xiv 20/07/10 6:25 PM xv CONTENTS Effective Interviewing 232 Problems in the Interview 234 Selection Process for Global Assignments 239 HR Perspective: Common Interview Mistakes 235 Defining Who Is an Applicant 240 Applicant Flow Documentation 241 Selecting for “Soft Skills” 241 Legal Concerns in the Selection Process 240 Background Investigations 235 Negligent Hiring and Retention 235 Legal Constraints on Background Investigations 236 Medical Examinations and Inquiries 237 References 237 Making the Job Offer 238 Summary 241 Critical Thinking Activities 242 HR Experiential Problem Solving 242 Case: Full Disclosure on Sex Offenders? 243 Global Staffing Issues 238 Supplemental Cases: Strategic Selection: A Review of Two Companies; Selecting a Programmer 243 Types of Global Employees 238 Notes 244 S E C T I O N 3 Training and Development 247 CHAPTER 8 Training Human Resources 248 HR On-the-Job: Planning for New Employee Orientation 258 Evaluating Orientation and Metrics 259 HR Headline: China’s Need for Training 249 Training and HR 250 Training Needs Assessment 260 Training Categories 250 Legal Issues and Training 251 Analysis of Training Needs 260 Establishing Training Objectives and Priorities 262 Organizational Strategy and Training 252 Training Design 263 Strategic Training 252 Organizational Competitiveness and Training 253 Learner Characteristics 263 Instructional Strategies 265 Transfer of Training 266 HR Perspective: Business Education at Work 255 Training Delivery 266 Training for Global Strategies 256 Global Assignment Training 256 Intercultural Competence Training 256 Planning for Training 257 Orientation: Planning for New Employees 258 Internal Training 267 HR Perspective: Cross Training “Universal Agents” 269 External Training 270 Combination Training Approaches 271 E-Learning: Online Training 272 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xv 20/07/10 6:26 PM xvi CONTENTS HR Perspective: Simulations and Games 273 Training Evaluation 274 Levels of Evaluation 275 Training Evaluation Metrics 276 Training Evaluation Designs 277 Summary 278 Critical Thinking Activities 279 HR Experiential Problem Solving 279 Case: 21st-Century Onboarding 279 Supplemental Cases: Training Crucial for Hotels; New Payroll Clerk 280 Notes 280 HR On-the-Job: Handling Global Dual-Career Situations 301 Global Career Concerns 302 Developing Human Resources 303 Possible Development Focuses 303 Development Needs Analyses 304 HR Development Approaches 305 Job-Site Development Approaches 306 Off-Site Development Approaches 307 Learning Organizations and Development 308 Management Development 309 CHAPTER 9 Supervisor Development 310 Leadership Development 311 Problems with Management Development Efforts 313 Talent Management 282 Summary 314 HR Headline: How Top Companies Develop Stars 283 Talent Management in Perspective 284 Talent Management “Systems” 285 Scope of Talent Management 286 Critical Thinking Activities 314 HR Experiential Problem Solving 314 Case: Leadership Leverage 315 Supplemental Cases: Equipping for the Future; Developed Today, Gone Tomorrow 316 Notes 316 HR Perspective: Groundbreaking Talent Management Programs 286 Succession Planning 288 Succession Planning Process 288 Succession Planning Decisions 290 Benefits of Formal Succession Planning 292 Careers and Career Planning 293 Changing Nature of Careers 293 Organization-Centered Career Planning 294 Individual-Centered Career Planning 295 Career Progression Considerations 296 Career Transitions 298 Common Individual Career Issues 299 Technical and Professional Workers 299 Women and Careers 300 Dual-Career Couples 300 CHAPTER 10 Performance Management and Appraisal 318 HR Headline: Performance Management Does Not Focus Enough on Ethics 319 The Nature of Performance Management 320 Global Cultural Differences in Performance Management 322 Performance-Focused Organizational Cultures 323 Identifying and Measuring Employee Performance 324 Types of Performance Information 325 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xvi 20/07/10 6:26 PM xvii CONTENTS HR Perspective: Behaviors or Results . . . Why Not Both? 326 Relevance of Performance Criteria 327 Performance Standards 327 Performance Metrics in Service Businesses 328 Graphic Rating Scales 339 Comparative Methods 343 Narrative Methods 345 Management by Objectives 345 Combinations of Methods 346 Training Managers and Employees in Performance Appraisal 346 Performance Appraisals 329 Uses of Performance Appraisals 329 Rater Errors 347 HR Online: Using Technology to Enhance Performance Appraisals 331 Decisions about the Performance Appraisal Process 332 Legal Concerns and Performance Appraisals 334 HR On-the-Job: Elements of a Legal Performance Appraisal System 334 Who Conducts Appraisals? 335 Supervisory Rating of Subordinates 335 Employee Rating of Managers 336 Team/Peer Rating 336 Self-Rating 337 Outsider Rating 337 Multisource/360-Degree Feedback 337 Tools for Appraising Performance 339 Category Scaling Methods 339 Appraisal Feedback 349 Appraisal Interview 349 Feedback as a System 350 Reactions of Managers 351 Reactions of Appraised Employees 351 Effective Performance Management 351 HR Best Practices: Calibration Is the Key to Better Employee Evaluations and Performance Management 352 Summary 352 Critical Thinking Activities 353 HR Experiential Problem Solving 353 Case: Building Performance Management through Employee Participation 354 Supplemental Cases: Performance Management Improvements for Bristol-Myers Squibb; Unequal/Equal Supervisors 354 Notes 355 S E C T I O N 4 Compensation 357 CHAPTER 11 Total Rewards and Compensation 358 HR Best Practices: Using Rewards to Effectively Develop Talent 364 HR Metrics for Compensation 365 Compensation Responsibilities 365 HR Headline: Rewarding Employees to Encourage Positive Behaviors 359 Compensation System Design Issues 366 Nature of Total Rewards and Compensation 360 Compensation Fairness and Equity 366 Types of Compensation 362 Compensation Philosophies 362 HR Perspective: Quantitative Techniques Facilitate Compensation Management 367 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xvii 20/07/10 6:26 PM xviii CONTENTS Market Competitiveness and Compensation 368 Competency-Based Pay 369 Individual versus Team Rewards 370 Global Compensation Issues 370 Compensating Expatriates 371 CHAPTER 12 Incentive Plans and Executive Compensation 394 HR Headline: Variable Pay at Cox Communications 395 Legal Constraints on Pay Systems 372 Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA) 372 Independent Contractor Regulations 375 Acts Affecting Government Contractors 375 Legislation on Equal Pay and Pay Equity 376 State and Local Laws 376 Garnishment Laws 376 Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act 376 Development of a Base Pay System 377 Variable Pay: Incentives for Performance 396 Developing Successful Pay-for-Performance Plans 396 HR Perspective: Awarding Points for Staff Efforts 398 Global Variable Pay 399 Metrics for Variable Pay Plans 399 Successes and Failures of Variable Pay Plans 400 Three Categories of Variable Pay 401 Valuing Jobs with Job Evaluation Methods 378 Valuing Jobs Using Market Pricing 379 Pay Surveys 380 Individual Incentives 402 HR Online: Responding to Internet Pay Survey Data Questions 381 Group/Team Incentives 404 Pay Structures 382 Pay Grades 383 Pay Ranges 383 Individual Pay 384 Determining Pay Increases 386 Performance-Based Increases 386 Standardized Pay Adjustments 388 Summary 389 Critical Thinking Activities 389 Piece-Rate Systems 402 Bonuses 402 Special Incentive Programs 403 Design of Group/Team Incentive Plans 405 Group/Team Incentive Challenges 406 Types of Group/Team Incentives 406 Group/Team Incentives and Information Sharing 408 Organizational Incentives 408 Profit Sharing 408 Employee Stock Plans 409 Sales Compensation 410 Types of Sales Compensation Plans 410 HR Experiential Problem Solving 390 HR Perspective: Ethical Concerns and Sales Compensation 411 Case: Pay for Performance Enhances Employee Management at Scripps Health 390 Sales Compensation Challenges 412 Supplemental Cases: Compensation Changes at JC Penney; Scientific Turmoil 391 Executive Compensation 413 Notes 391 Elements of Executive Compensation 414 Global Executive Compensation 416 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xviii 20/07/10 6:26 PM xix CONTENTS “Reasonableness” of Executive Compensation 416 Severance Pay 438 HR Perspective: CEO Executives Overpaid? 417 Increases in Health Benefits Costs 439 Controlling Health Care Benefits Costs 439 Summary 419 Critical Thinking Activities 419 HR Experiential Problem Solving 420 Case: Sodexo Incentives 420 Supplemental Cases: Cash Is Good, Card Is Bad; Incentive Plans for Fun and Travel 421 Notes 421 Health Care Benefits 438 HR Best Practices: Mini-Medical Plans on the Rise 441 Consumer-Driven Health Plans 441 Health Care Preventive and Wellness Efforts 443 Health Care Legislation 444 Retirement Benefits 446 CHAPTER 13 Managing Employee Benefits 424 HR Headline: Behavioral Economics Guides Benefits Administration 425 Benefits and HR Strategy 426 Benefits as Competitive Advantage 427 Role of Benefits for Workforce Attraction and Retention 429 Benefits Management and Communications 429 Benefits Design 429 HR and Benefits Administration 431 HR Technology and Benefits 432 Benefits Measurement 432 Benefits Cost Control 433 Benefits Communication 433 HR Online: Using Online Technology to Combat Presenteeism 434 Types of Benefits 434 Government-Mandated Benefits 435 Voluntary Benefits 436 Security Benefits 437 Workers’ Compensation 437 Unemployment Compensation 437 Social Security 446 Pension Plans 446 Pension Plan Concepts 448 Individual Retirement Options 448 Legal Requirements for Retirement Benefits 449 Employee Retirement Income Security Act 449 Retiree Benefits and Legal Requirements 450 Retirement Benefits and Age Discrimination 450 Financial Benefits 451 Insurance Benefits 451 Financial Services 452 Educational Assistance 452 Family-Oriented Benefits 453 Family and Medical Leave Act 453 Family-Care Benefits 454 Measuring the Effectiveness of Family Benefits 455 Benefits for Domestic Partners 455 Time-Off and Other Benefits 456 Holiday Pay 457 Vacation Pay 457 Leaves of Absence 457 Paid-Time-Off Plans 458 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xix 20/07/10 6:26 PM xx CONTENTS Case: Strategic Benefits at KPMG Canada 460 Miscellaneous Benefits 458 Summary 459 Critical Thinking Activities 459 Supplemental Cases: Delivering Benefits; Benefiting Connie 460 HR Experiential Problem Solving 459 Notes 461 S E C T I O N 5 Employee Relations 465 CHAPTER 14 Risk Management and Worker Protection 466 HR Headline: $1.6 Million Fine When Young Worker Suffocates 467 Current State of Health, Safety, and Security 468 Trends 469 Global Health, Safety, and Security 470 Legal Requirements for Safety and Health 471 Worker’s Compensation 471 American with Disabilities Act and Safety Issues 473 Child Labor Laws 473 Occupational Safety and Health Act 474 OSHA Enforcement Standards 475 HR On-the-Job: Hazard Communication 476 Ergonomics and OSHA 477 Work Assignments and OSHA 478 OSHA Recordkeeping Requirements 479 OSHA Inspections 479 Critique of OSHA 481 Safety Management 482 Organizational Commitment and a Safety Culture 482 Safety Policies, Discipline, and Recordkeeping 484 Safety Training and Communication 484 Safety Committees 485 Inspection, Investigation, and Evaluation 485 Measuring Safety Efforts 486 Employee Health 486 Substance Abuse 486 HR Perspective: The “Company Doctor” 487 Emotional/Mental Health 488 Health and Older Employees 489 Smoking at Work 489 Health Promotion 489 Security Concerns at Work 491 Workplace Violence 491 Security Management 493 Employee Screening and Selection 495 Security Personnel 495 Disaster Preparation and Recovery Planning 495 Disaster Planning 495 HR Perspective: Disaster Plan Put to the Test 496 Disaster Planning for Disease 497 Summary 498 Critical Thinking Activities 498 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xx 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxi CONTENTS HR Experiential Problem Solving 499 Case: Data Security 499 Supplemental Cases: What’s Happened to Bob?; Communicating Safety and Health Success 500 Notes 500 Workplace Monitoring 519 Employer Investigations 520 Substance Abuse and Drug Testing 521 HR Policies, Procedures, and Rules 523 Employee Handbooks 523 Communicating HR Information 525 Employee Absenteeism 525 CHAPTER 15 Employee Rights and Responsibilities 502 HR Headline: Technology Usage and HR Policy Issues 503 Employer and Employee Rights and Responsibilities 504 Contractual Rights 504 Implied Contracts 506 HR Perspective: Employment Practices Liability Insurance 507 Rights Affecting the Employment Relationship 507 Employment-at-Will (EAW) 508 Just Cause 510 Due Process 510 Work-Related Alternative Dispute Resolution (ADR) 511 Types of Absenteeism 525 HR Perspective: Effects of Tardiness on Work and Absenteeism 526 Controlling Absenteeism 526 HR Metrics: Measuring Absenteeism 528 Employee Discipline 528 Reasons Why Discipline Might Not Be Used 529 Effective Discipline 529 Approaches to Discipline 529 Discharge: The Final Disciplinary Step 531 HR On-the-Job: Termination Procedure 532 Summary 533 Critical Thinking Activities 533 HR Experiential Problem Solving 534 Case: Dealing with Workplace Bullying 534 Supplemental Cases: George Faces Challenges; Employer Liable for “Appearance Actions” 535 Managing Individual Employee and Employer Rights Issues 513 Notes 535 Privacy Rights and Employee Records 513 Employees’ Free Speech Rights 515 CHAPTER 16 HR Online: Ethical HR Issues on Blogs 516 Technology and Employer/ Employee Issues 517 Employee Rights and Personal Behavior Issues 518 Balancing Employer Security and Employee Rights 519 Union/Management Relations 538 HR Headline: Business versus Labor—Right to Work Laws 539 Unions: Employee and Management Perspectives 540 Why Employees Unionize 540 Why Employers Resist Unions 541 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxi 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxii CONTENTS Unions Globally 542 International Union Membership 542 Global Labor Organizations 542 HR Perspective: Unions in China 543 U.S. and Global Differences 543 Union Membership in the United States 544 Reasons for U.S. Union Membership Decline 544 Public-Sector Unionism 547 Union Targets for Membership Growth 547 Unions in the United States 548 Historical Evolution of U.S. Unions 548 Union Structure 549 U.S. Labor Laws 550 Early Labor Legislation 550 Wagner Act (National Labor Relations Act) 551 Taft-Hartley Act (Labor Management Relations Act) 552 Landrum-Griffin Act (Labor Management Reporting and Disclosure Act) 554 Civil Service Reform and Postal Reorganization Acts 554 Proposed Legislation 555 The Unionization Process 555 Organizing Campaign 555 HR Perspective: Good Times, Bad Times 557 Authorization Cards 558 Representation Election 558 HR On-the-Job: Unionization Do’s and Don’ts for Managers 559 Certification and Decertification 560 Contract Negotiation (Collective Bargaining) 560 Collective Bargaining Issues 561 Management Rights 561 Union Security 562 Classification of Bargaining Issues 562 Collective Bargaining Process 563 Preparation and Initial Demands 563 Continuing Negotiations 563 Settlement and Contract Agreement 564 Bargaining Impasse 564 Strikes and Lockouts 565 Union/Management Cooperation 566 HR Perspective: Union Helps Cut Costs at Ford 567 Employee Involvement Programs 567 Unions and Employee Ownership 568 Grievance Management 568 Grievance Responsibilities 569 Grievance Procedures 569 Steps in a Grievance Procedure 569 Summary 570 Critical Thinking Activities 571 HR Experiential Problem Solving 571 Case: Teamsters and the Fraternal Order of Police (FOP) 572 Supplemental Cases: Wal-Mart and Union Prevention; The Wilson County Hospital 572 Notes 573 APPENDIX A Human Resource Certification Institute: PHR and SPHR Test Specifications 575 APPENDIX B HR Management Resources 581 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxii 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxiii CONTENTS APPENDIX C APPENDIX G Major Federal Equal Employment Opportunity Laws and Regulations 585 Sample HR-Related Job Descriptions 599 APPENDIX D Uniform Guidelines on Employee Selection 587 Glossary 601 Author Index 609 Subject Index 615 APPENDIX E EEO Enforcement 591 APPENDIX F Preemployment Inquiries 595 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxiii 20/07/10 6:26 PM Preface To reach a thirteenth edition is an honor for a textbook and its authors. The authors of Human Resource Management are gratified that it has become the leader in both the academic market for human resource texts and in the market for human resource professionals. For academics, the book is a standard in HR classes. It is also used to provide HR knowledge as part of professional degree programs. For HR professionals, the book is extensively used in the pursuit of HR professional education and certifications, specifically the PHR and SPHR from the Human Resource Certification Institute (HRCI). In preparing the thirteenth edition of the book, we have extensively reviewed the academic, governmental, and practitioner literature published since the last revision. Further, we have asked academics and practitioners, both those who use this book and those who do not, to provide input on the previous edition and what coverage should be added, deleted, or changed. We have always been receptive to input from our adopters and reviewers and have made extensive use of their observations and ideas. Consequently, we have reorganized some chapters, incorporated relevant new topics, and updated references so that readers can be certain that they are getting the most current HR content possible. U.S. and Global Economics During the past few years, both in the United States and worldwide, economic shifts have created major organizational impacts. Some em-ployers have closed operations or reduced their workforces, while others have increased theirs. Many employers are expanding throughout the world and, as they do, different cultural considerations affect HR management. Rather than having a separate chapter on global HR management, the coverage of global issues has been integrated throughout the chapters and is indicated by a global icon. Strategic HR Management HR management in more and more companies is becoming a part of organizational strategy decisions. To address strategic HR management, Chapter 2 has been significantly revised and expanded to show why HR management is an important strategic contributor to the success of the organization. In most chapters the topical connection to strategy also is discussed. For example, the strategic natures of recruiting (Chapter 6), talent management (Chapter 9), compensation (Chapter 11), and benefits (Chapter 13) all consider the implications for strategy of decisions made in these areas. THE THIRTEENTH EDITION Measuring HR Effectiveness through Metrics Human resource management and the organizations in which it takes place are facing challenges from a changing environment. The thirteenth edition G L O B A L reflects those challenges and as always suggests ways to deal with them. For example, consider the following: Closely related to strategic HR management is the need to measure the value of HR management activities. The outM E A S U R E put of HR must be justified to executives in organizations by using financial and other data. The value of HR management activities is measured by xxv Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxv 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxvi P R E FAC E cost–benefit analysis, profit per employee, new hire success, and similar metrics. Thus, HR efforts can be justified financially and the value that HR management brings to the company’s goals can be documented. The thirteenth edition includes sections in most chapters called “HR Metrics” that identify how different activities can be measured. A special metrics icon is used to identify this content. Workforce Changes The demographics of workers in the United States and globally are shifting. Diversity of employees based on ethnicity, aging, gender, and other factors is changing legal requirements and HR efforts needed. Beginning in Chapter 1, workforce changes are identified as well as why they must be managed effectively. In Chapters 4 and 5, workforce composition differences and their HR implications are identified. Throughout other chapters workforce composition issues are discussed as part of the context for the relevant HR topics. Attracting, Retaining, and Managing Talent A key part of managing the workforce is having the right people with the right capabilities in the right jobs—and being able to retain them. These HR concerns exist in most organizations and are emphasized in information on recruiting, selection, job design, training, retention, talent management, and compensation. These topics emphasize HR’s role in ensuring that organizations have sufficient and productive workforces, both currently and in the future. HR, Technology, and the Internet The use of technology in HR has expanded dramatically and is continuing to change HR management activities with executives, managers, and employees. The Internet, Webbased resources, social media, and blogs all affect HR management. Throughout the chapters of this edition is a feature titled “HR Online” that highlights how technology is being used in HR. Also, many chapters cover HR technology topics in the specific content areas. The Internet continues to be a valuable tool for HR professionals and affects a number of HR activities. To provide immediate links for readers, numerous “Logging On” features have been incorporated throughout the text. This feature identifies websites that contain useful sources of HR information about topics being discussed and contains specific Web address links. Also, references from Web addresses are cited in the chapter notes as appropriate. ORGANIZATION OF THE THIRTEENTH EDITION The thirteenth edition reflects both the continuity and changes occurring in HR management. The following highlights some of the significant content throughout the book section by section. Section I: Environment of Human Resource Management The first three chapters of the book examine factors in the changing environment in which the HR function operates. The first chapter looks at human capital, HR as a core competency, HR ethics, and HR challenges. The necessary competencies for HR careers are also discussed. Chapter 2 addresses strategic HR management, environmental analyses, global competitiveness, HR technology, and metrics to evaluate the effectiveness of HR management. Equal employment opportunity (EEO) is a key HR concern, both legally and operationally. Chapter 3 addresses the laws, regulations, and court decisions that determine the legal framework of EEO. Furthermore, the chapter looks at implementing equal employment and dealing with affirmative action, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxvi 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxvii P R E FAC E sexual harassment, age discrimination, and other issues. Section 2: Jobs and Labor Chapter 4 discusses workforce composition and describes workflow, scheduling, and other job design issues that have an impact on organizations and the people working in them. The chapter concludes with coverage of job analysis and the approaches to job analysis. Chapter 5 contains content on HR planning, job satisfaction, and employee turnover and retention. Chapter 6 focuses on recruiting in different labor markets. It discusses the difficulties of recruiting employees with special skills— and new methods to attract those individuals. The chapter contains significant content on Internet recruiting and the evaluation of recruiting efforts. An expansion of the coverage on selection in Chapter 7 encompasses the selection strategy choices that management must make. The discussion of testing, interviewing approaches, and other selection techniques reflects the current research and practices in HR management. Section 3: Training and Development Because talent management is a growing concern for many employers, major content additions in this section have been made to emphasize the nature and importance of talent management. Chapter 8 discusses the strategic role training plays in organizations and how training can be linked to business strategies and organizational competitiveness. Specific content on adult learning and new training design and means of delivery is provided. As the text addresses the growing use of e-learning, it discusses both the contributions and problems associated with Web-based training. Chapter 9 on talent management and development looks at the methods organizations use to expand the capabilities of their human resources, the nature of talent management, and succession planning. Chapter 10 emphasizes performance management and the role of the performance appraisal process in enhancing the development of human resources in organizations. The chapter expands the material on identifying and measuring employee performance, including additional information on the numerous approaches used. Section 4: Compensation Compensation is viewed broadly as total rewards that include base pay, variable pay, and benefits. Employers are facing great pressure to control those expenditures while also being competitive to attract and retain employees. Chapter 11 discusses the strategic nature of total rewards and then looks at compensation. The coverage of legal requirements, base compensation, pay for performance, and variable pay programs has been revised and updated. Chapter 12 discusses variable pay, which can include incentives such as those for sales employees. It concludes with an overview of executive compensation and issues of current concern in that area. Chapter 13 highlights the growing changes and increasing costs of benefits that are facing HR professionals and their organizations. Specific expanded content discusses health care costs and issues, as well as retirement and other forms of benefits. Section 5: Employee Relations Employee relations include several evolving areas. One such area is risk management, which incorporates health, safety, and security. The coverage in Chapter 14 identifies the nature of risk management, current health and safety issues, OSHA compliance requirements, health promotion, prevention of workplace violence, and the importance of workplace security. Revised content identifies the need for HR to develop disaster and recovery plans for such situations as natural disasters, terrorist threats, or pandemics. The various issues associated with employee rights and discipline—such as employment-atwill, privacy rights, and substance abuse—have Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxvii 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxviii P R E FAC E been highlighted in Chapter 15. The chapter also looks at such emerging issues as electronic monitoring, privacy, e-mail, and other employee rights affected by technology. It concludes with a discussion on employee terminations. The changing role of unions in the U.S. economy and the reasons for the decline in the percentage of workers in unions are discussed in Chapter 16. In addition to covering the basic laws and regulations governing union/ management relations in the United States, the chapter includes coverage of collective bargaining and grievance management as key components of union/management relations. CHANGES TO THIS EDITION • • • • • • • • NEW: Each chapter contains a new endof-chapter exercise, called HR Experiential Problem Solving, which provides a problem, asks one to three brief questions about it, and suggests resources to resolve it. NEW: All end-of-chapter Cases are new. NEW: End-of-chapter Supplemental Cases have been increased from one to two per chapter. NEW: An expanded appendix section provides additional information on a variety of topics. NEW: Material on HR as an organizational contributor from Chapter 2 is now combined with new Chapter 1. NEW: Previous edition Chapters 4 and 5 are combined into a new Chapter 3 to put EEO laws and their management in one chapter. NEW: Chapter 4 on jobs and job analysis was formerly Chapter 6 and is significantly changed to reflect how HR addresses workers, and the contributions of various types of diverse workers. Chapter 5 on HR planning and retention has major changes, with material combined from several other chapters. Sections revised include HR planning components, individual workers in organizations, and turnover. Chapter 6 on recruiting and labor markets (formerly Chapter 7) has revised coverage of strategic recruiting as tied to HR planning, labor market components, and strategic decisions, as well as additional content on Internet recruiting methods. • Chapter 7 (formerly Chapter 8) expands the topic of placement to include common mismatch situations between people and jobs, immigration status verification to include E-Verify, and controversies in selection testing • Chapter 8 (formerly Chapter 9) expands strategy and training, planning for training and orientation, evaluation of orientation, and instructional strategies, and includes new research on the assessment of e-learning use in training. • Each chapter has been brought up-todate on any changes in HR research or the laws that have transpired since the twelfth edition. • CHAPTER FEATURES Each chapter begins with specific learning objectives. Next, the “HR Headline” feature contains a concise example of a contemporary HR problem, situation, or practice to illustrate topics covered. Throughout the text, most chapters also include an “HR Best Practices” feature that highlights effective HR management in real-world companies. Additionally, chapters contain “HR On-theJob,” a feature that presents suggestions on how to handle specific HR issues or situations. The “Logging On” feature provides links to additional materials beyond the text content. To highlight how information technology affects HR management, some chapters contain “HR Online” and “HR Perspective” features that address specific HR issues, ethical concerns, technology, or interesting employer HR efforts. Each chapter concludes with a point-bypoint “Summary” and a “Critical Thinking Activities” section that provides critical thinking queries. At the end of every chapter is an Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxviii 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxix P R E FAC E “HR Experiential Problem Solving” exercise, and a “Case” that presents a real-life HR problem or situation using real organizations as examples. Further, two additional “Supplemental Cases” are available in each chapter on the text website. They briefly describe typical HR problems faced in organizations. Finally, reference “Notes” cite sources used in the chapter, with particular attention given to the inclusion of the most current references and research. More than 80% of the references are new or updated from the previous edition. AACSB tags for general (NATIONAL) and topic-specific (LOCAL) designations. SUPPLEMENTS PowerPoint Slide Presentation Instructor’s Manual with Video Guide The instructor’s manual, revised by Dr. Fraya Wagner-Marsh, Eastern Michigan University, represents one of the most exciting and useful instructor’s aids available. Comprehensive teaching materials are provided for each chapter—including overviews, outlines, instructor’s notes, suggested answers to endof-chapter Review and Application Questions, suggested questions for the “HR Headline,” “HR Online,” “HR Best Practices,” and “HR On-the-Job” features, suggested answers to the end-of-chapter case questions, and suggested questions and comments on the supplemental cases for each chapter. In addition, a video guide section describes the video segments that are available on an Instructor’s DVD to help integrate chapter content through current, interesting examples. ExamView ExamView contains all of the questions in the printed test bank. Instructors can add or edit questions, instructions, and answers. Questions may be selected by previewing them on screen, selecting them randomly, or selecting them by number. Instructors can also create quizzes online whether over the Internet, a local area network, or a wide area network. Instructor PowerPoint slides, prepared by Charlie Cook of the University of West Alabama, are available on both the Instructor’s Resource CD and on the password-protected Instructor’s Resources Website. Approximately 400 slides are included. Handbook for Human Resource Faculty New to this edition, the Handbook for Human Resource Faculty, originally created by Corinne Livesay of Bryan College, has been revised by Laura L. Wolfe of Louisiana State University to provide additional teaching aids such as Generating Interest discussion topics, Dealing with Trouble Spots features that provide resources to address challenges, and Involving Students sections that suggest activities and resources. Test Bank Instructor’s Resource CD The test bank is significantly revised and upgraded from previous editions, and contains more than 1,800 test questions prepared by Janelle Dozier. Multiple-choice, true/ false, and essay questions are provided for every chapter. Answers are cross-referenced to pages within the text so that it is easy to pinpoint where relevant material is found. Questions are identified by type—definition, application, and analytical—and also include The Instructor’s Resource CD includes the instructor’s manual, test bank, ExamView, the Handbook for Human Resource Faculty, the Video Guide, and PowerPoint presentation slides for instructor convenience. On-The-Job Video Package A majority of the book’s video collection is new and features companies with innovative Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxix 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxx P R E FAC E HR practices, many of which have been recognized for their excellence in HR practices. Both small and large companies are featured in the videos, and all video content is closely tied to concepts within the text. These include interviews with Metropolitan Bakery, Yale Repertory Theater, Zappos, The Fruit Guys, and many others. The videos are available on DVD for the instructor. CengageNOW The HRCI 2009 Outline • The HRCI 2009 outline is featured in this edition to effectively prepare students with the latest body of knowledge of human resource management from which the certification exams are taken. • • • • Student Resource Guide Designed from a student’s perspective by Tonya Elliott, a certified HR professional, this useful study guide provides aids that students can use to maximize results in the classroom and on exams and, ultimately, in the practice of HR. Chapter objectives and chapter outlines aid students in reviewing for exams. Study questions include matching, true/false, idea completion, multiple-choice, and essay questions. Answer keys are provided for immediate feedback to reinforce learning. Product Support Website Please visit our product support website, http://www.cengage.com/management/mathis, which offers additional instructional and learning tools to complement our text. • NEW: The new CourseMate online learning system helps students manage their homework, make the most of every study minute, and immediately view their progress. Interactive study tools, homework assignments, and self-testing opportunities help students earn the grade they want within the course and assist as them in effectively preparing for professional examinations. This powerful and fully integrated online teaching and learning system provides instructors with flexibility and control, saves valuable time, and improves outcomes. Students benefit by having choices in the way they learn through a unique personalized learning path made possible by CengageNOW. • • • Homework, assignable and automatically graded Integrated e-book Personalized learning paths Interactive course assignments Assessment options, including AACSB learning standards achievement reporting Test delivery Course management tools, including Grade Book WebCT and Blackboard integration Speak with your South-Western sales representative about integrating CengageNOW into your courses. Visit www.cengage.com/now today to learn more! WebTutor™ for Blackboard® or WebCT® This dynamic learning and instructional resource harnesses the power of the Internet to deliver innovative learning aids that actively engage students. Multimedia resources include animated tutorials, quizzes with immediate feedback, online exercises to reinforce principles learned, and online discussion to encourage continuing communication between students and instructors. ACKNOWLEDGMENTS The success of each edition of Human Resource Management can largely be attributed to our reviewers, who have generously offered both suggestions for improvements and new ideas for the text. We sincerely thank the following reviewers: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxx 20/07/10 6:26 PM xxxi P R E FAC E Collette M. Arens Bates Western Illinois University Linsey C. Willis Florida Atlantic University Callie Burnley California State University, Fullerton Ryan D. Zimmerman Texas A&M Cathy Dubois Kent State University Andrea D. Ellinger University of Illinois at Champaign-Urbana Yezdi Godiwalla University of Wisconsin, Whitewater Mark A. Johnson Idaho State University Carlos Jon Keller Graduate School Thomas Kanick Southern New Hampshire University Stan Malos San Jose State University Patrick McHugh George Washington University Bob Meier Robert Morris College David Nye Athens University Kristin D. Scott Clemson University Larry Siefert Webster University Romilia Singh University of Wisconsin, Milwaukee Susan Stewart Western Illinois University K. J. Tullis University of Central Oklahoma Fraya Wagner-Marsh Eastern Michigan University Finally, some leading HR professionals provided ideas and assistance. Appreciation is specifically expressed to Sean Valentine, Patti Meglich, Sandra Washa, Steve Williams, Kathy McKee, and Frank Giancola. Those who assisted with many critical details of manuscript preparation include Jo Ann Mathis, Carolyn Foster, and our copyeditor, Linda Ireland. The authors thank Joe Sabatino, Publisher, Michele Rhoades, Senior Acquisitions Editor, and Susan Smart, Senior Developmental Editor, for their guidance and involvement. We also appreciate the support of our Content Project Manager, Corey Geissler, whose efforts contributed significantly to making the final product appealing. Thanks go also to our Media Editor, Rob Ellington, for pulling together the text website, and to our Marketing Manager, Clint Kernen, for getting the word out about the new edition. The authors feel confident that this edition will continue as the standard for the HR field. We believe it offers a relevant and current look at HR management, and we are optimistic that those who use the book will agree. Robert L. Mathis, SPHR John H. Jackson Omaha, Nebraska Laramie, Wyoming Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_00_fm_pi-xxxii.indd xxxi 20/07/10 6:26 PM S E C T I O N 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Chapter 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations Chapter 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning Chapter 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 1 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 1 21/07/10 8:42 PM C H A P T E R 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Define human capital and identify the seven categories of HR activities. • Discuss how organizational culture and HR are related and identify four areas that are part of these relationships. • Explain how organizational ethical issues affect HR management. • Provide an overview of six challenges facing HR today. • Describe how the major roles of HR management are being transformed. • Explain the key competencies needed by HR professionals and why certification is important. 2 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 2 26/06/10 3:22 PM HR Headline The Challenges and Crises Facing HR Management D (PhotoLink/Photodisc/Getty Image) uring the past few years, economic downturns, industry crises, bank failures, closings of plants and stores, changes in global operations, and other factors have significantly affected organizations, managers, and Human Resource (HR) management professionals. For HR and other executives, these changes have led to decisions about layoffs, reductions in work hours, and cuts or elimination of some employee benefits. HR is facing a different world because of these problems. Other issues have created different workforce strategies as well. A recent survey found that the highest-demand jobs include jobs like registered nurse, elementary and secondary school teacher, accountant and auditor, general and operations manager, network software engineer, and jobs that contain significant professional responsibilities. The increased demand for these jobs has been caused by economic shifts in staffing that have affected manufacturing, retail, and other industries. These examples illustrate why HR must change. Organizational and HR executives, managers, and employees are dealing in various ways with major issues. According to surveys, some of the biggest problems include: • • • • Adjusting benefits programs due to increasing costs Attracting and retaining key employees Planning for replacement of “baby boomers” when they retire Using talent management to train and develop capabilities of employees for future job needs 3 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 3 26/06/10 3:25 PM 4 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management • • Dealing with the expanded personal and organizational use of HR technology through blogs, wikis, twitters, text-messaging, and other formats Complying with revised and changing federal, state, and local legal requirements affecting discrimination, treatment errors, unionization, and other issues The manner in which all these conflicting issues are managed can influence how HR plans and contributes to organizational culture and performance.1 Human resource (HR) management Designing management systems to ensure that human talent is used effectively and efficiently to accomplish organizational goals. As the HR Headline indicates, managing people in changing organizations is part of what is currently being done by supervisors, managers, and executives. People as human assets are the “glue” that holds all the other assets, such as financial and physical ones, together and guides their use to better achieve results. Certainly, the cashiers, supervisors, and other employees at Wal-Mart or Walgreen’s or the doctors, nurses, receptionists, technical professionals, and other employees at a hospital allow all the other assets of their organization to be used to provide customer or patient services. How effectively people at all levels contribute to organizational results is part of the challenge. Managing people as human resources is essential in organizations of all sizes and types. As a field, human resource management is undergoing significant transformation. Human resource (HR) management is designing management systems to ensure that human talent is used effectively and efficiently to accomplish organizational goals. Whether employees are in a big company with thousands of jobs or a small nonprofit agency, managing people in an organization is about more than simply administering a pay program, designing training, or avoiding lawsuits. If human resources are to be an important part of successfully competing in the marketplace, a different level of thinking about HR management is necessary. Productive, creative people working in flexible, effective organizations that provide rewarding work for individuals is important for all managers, not just those in HR departments. People in organizations can be a core competency. HUMAN RESOURCES AS ORGANIZATIONAL CORE COMPETENCY Core competency A unique capability that creates high value and differentiates an organization from its competition. The development and implementation of specific organizational strategies must be based on the areas of strength in an organization. Referred to as core competencies, those strengths are the foundation for creating a competitive advantage for an organization. A core competency is a unique capability that creates high value and differentiates an organization from its competition. Figure 1-1 shows some possible areas where human resources may become part of core competencies. Certainly, many organizations have identified that having their human resources as core competencies differentiates them from their competitors and is a key determinant of competitive advantages.2 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 4 26/06/10 3:26 PM CHAPTER 1 5 Human Resource Management in Organizations Core Competencies in Possible HR Areas F I G U R E 1- 1 Productivity Quality/Service Human Resources as Successful Competencies Employee Skills Innovative Operations Human Capital and HR Human capital is not solely the people in organizations—it is what those people bring and contribute to organizational success. Human capital is the collective value of the capabilities, knowledge, skills, life experiences, and motivation of an organizational workforce. Sometimes human capital is called intellectual capital to reflect the thinking, knowledge, creativity, and decision making that people in organizations contribute. For example, firms with high intellectual capital may have technical and research employees who create new biomedical devices, formulate products that can be patented, or develop new software for specialized uses. All these organizational contributions illustrate the potential value of human capital. A few years ago, a Nobel prize-winning economist, Gary Becker, expanded the view of human capital by emphasizing that countries managing human capital better are more likely to have better economic results.3 The importance of human capital in organizations can be seen in various ways. One is sheer costs. In some industries, such as the restaurant industry, employee-related expenditures may exceed 60% of total operating costs. With such significant levels comes an increasing need to measure the value of human capital and how it is changing through HR metrics, discussed in Chapter 2. HR Functions Human capital The collective value of the capabilities, knowledge, skills, life experiences, and motivation of an organizational workforce. HR management can be thought of as seven interlinked functions taking place within organizations, as depicted in Figure 1-2. Additionally, external forces—legal, economic, technological, global, environmental, cultural/ geographic, political, and social—significantly affect how HR functions are designed, managed, and changed. The functions can be grouped as follows: • Strategic HR Management: As part of maintaining organizational competitiveness, strategic planning for HR effectiveness can be increased Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 5 26/06/10 3:26 PM SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management HR Management Functions F I G U R E 1- 2 Tec hn olo gic al a Glob Strategic HR Management HR effectiveness HR metrics HR technology HR planning HR retention en tal Equal Employment Opportunity Compliance Diversity Affirmative action ic ograph l/Ge tura ic om Econ Risk Management and Worker Protection Health and wellness Safety Security Disaster and recovery planning Env iro nm Cul Employee and Labor Relations Employee rights and privacy HR policies Union/management relations l HR FUNCTIONS Staffing Job analysis Recruiting Selection Total Rewards Compensation Incentives Benefits Talent Management Orientation Training HR development Career planning Performance management Po lit ica l 6 Le ga l Social External environment • • through the use of HR metrics and HR technology. These topics are covered in Chapter 2. Equal Employment Opportunity: Compliance with equal employment opportunity (EEO) laws and regulations affects all other HR activities. The nature of EEO is discussed in Chapter 3. Staffing: The aim of staffing is to provide a sufficient supply of qualified individuals to fill jobs in an organization. Workers, job design, and job analysis lay the foundation for staffing by identifying what diverse people do in their jobs and how they are affected by them. Through HR planning, managers anticipate the future supply of and demand for employees and the nature of workforce issues, including the retention of employees. These factors are used when recruiting applicants for job openings. The selection Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 6 26/06/10 3:26 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 7 process is concerned with choosing qualified individuals to fill those jobs. These staffing activities are discussed in Chapters 4, 5, 6, and 7. • Talent Management and Development: Beginning with the orientation of new employees, talent management and development includes different types of training. Also, HR development and succession planning of employees and managers is necessary to prepare for future challenges. Career planning identifies paths and activities for individual employees as they move within the organization. Assessing how well employees perform their jobs is the focus of performance management. Activities associated with talent management are examined in Chapters 8, 9, and 10. • Total Rewards: Compensation in the form of pay, incentives, and benefits rewards people for performing organizational work. To be competitive, employers develop and refine their basic compensation systems and may use variable pay programs such as incentive rewards. The rapid increase in the cost of benefits, especially health care benefits, will continue to be a major issue for most employers. Compensation, variable pay, and benefits activities are discussed in Chapters 11, 12, and 13. • Risk Management and Worker Protection: Employers must address various workplace risks to ensure protection of workers by meeting legal requirements and being more responsive to concerns for workplace health and safety. Also, workplace security has grown in importance along with disaster and recovery planning, and LOGGING ON these activities are examined in Chapter 14. International Association for • Employee and Labor Relations: The relationship Human Resource Information between managers and their employees must be Management (IHRIM) handled legally and effectively. Employer and employee The International Association for rights must be addressed. It is important to develop, Human Resource Information communicate, and update HR policies and procedures Management (IHRIM) is the world’s so that managers and employees alike know what is leading clearinghouse for the HRMS expected. In some organizations, union/management industry for information management, relations must be addressed as well. Activities systems issues, trends, and technology. associated with employee rights and labor/management Visit its website at www.ihrim.org. relations are discussed in Chapters 15 and 16. HR MANAGEMENT’S CONTRIBUTING ROLE Human Resources can create value and impact organizational results more in some organizations than others. Being the core competency mentioned earlier, HR may aid organizations in a number of ways. Given the changes in economic situations, workers, workforce challenges, and other factors, employers can face significant reputation problems. One survey of global senior managers in 20 countries found that more than 60% indicated they had less trust in their corporations than a year before.4 This study illustrates why HR must be at the heart of enhancing organizational culture. Organizational Culture and HR Organizational culture The shared values and beliefs in an organization. The ability of an organization to use its human capital as a core competency depends in part on the organizational culture that is operating. Organizational culture consists of the shared values and beliefs that give members of an organization meaning and provide them with rules for behavior. The culture of an Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 7 26/06/10 3:26 PM 8 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management organization is seen in the norms of expected behaviors, values, philosophies, rituals, and symbols used by its employees, and it evolves over a period of time. Only if an organization has a history in which people have shared experiences for years does a culture stabilize. A relatively new firm, such as a business existing for less than 2 years, may not have developed a stabilized culture. HR Values and Organizational Cultures Central to organizational culture are values that are inherent in the ways organizations and their members treat people both inside and outside the organization. Similar values are likely to exist with some executives, managers, and HR professionals, as well, which can affect the nature of the organizational culture. Values may be used to define opportunities, plan strategies, and view operational concerns, as highlighted in Chapter 2. Values in an organizational culture can become relatively constant and enduring over time. Newcomers learn the values and culture from the senior employees; hence, the rules of behavior are perpetuated. These rules may or may not be beneficial, so the values and culture can either facilitate or limit performance. They also affect employee morale and how conflicts are resolved.5 Competitive Advantage of Organizational Culture Organizational culture should be seen as the “climate” of the organization that employees, managers, customers, and others experience. This culture affects service and quality, organizational productivity, and financial results. One facet of the culture of the organization, as viewed by the people in it, is that culture may affect the attraction and retention of competent employees.6 Alignment of the organizational culture and HR helps organizational performance. One competitive aspect of an organizational culture is creativity and innovation. Efforts in this area can enhance the organizational culture by developing or revising current and new products and services, acquiring new businesses, and performing other activities with competitive advantages.7 G L O B A L Global Cultural Factors Cultural forces represent an important concern affecting international HR management. One only has to look at the conflicts caused by politics, religion, and ethnicity in Africa, the Middle East, and other parts of the world to see the importance of culture in international organizations. Convincing individuals from different religious, ethnic, or tribal backgrounds to work together in a global firm may be difficult in some areas. One widely used way to classify and compare cultures was developed by Geert Hofstede, a Dutch scholar and researcher. Hofstede conducted research on more than 100,000 IBM employees in 53 countries, and he defined five dimensions useful in identifying and comparing cultures:8 • • • • • Inequality in power Individualism/group orientation Masculinity/femininity Uncertainty avoidance Long-term/short-term orientation Differences in many other facets of culture could be discussed, but it is enough to note that international HR managers and professionals must recognize that cultural dimensions differ from country to country and even within countries. Therefore, the HR activities appropriate in one culture or country may have to be altered to fit appropriately into another culture, country, or geographic area. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 8 26/06/10 3:26 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 9 Organizational Productivity Productivity Measure of the quantity and quality of work done, considering the cost of the resources used. Unit labor cost Computed by dividing the average cost of workers by their average levels of output. F I G U R E 1- 3 HR management can play a significant role in organizations by helping to create a culture that emphasizes effectiveness and productivity. In its most basic sense, productivity is a measure of the quantity and quality of work done, considering the cost of the resources used. Productivity can be a competitive advantage because when the costs to produce goods and services are lowered by effective processes, lower prices can be charged or more revenue made. Better productivity does not necessarily mean more output; perhaps fewer people (or less money or time) are used to produce the same amount. One useful way of measuring the productivity of human resources is to consider unit labor cost, which is computed by dividing the average cost of workers by their average levels of output. Using unit labor costs, one can see that paying relatively high wages still can result in a firm being economically competitive if high productivity levels are achieved. Low unit labor costs can be a basis for a strategy focusing on human resources. Productivity and unit labor costs can be evaluated at the global, country, organizational, departmental, or individual level as part of various HR measurement metrics. Improving Organizational Productivity Productivity at the organizational level ultimately affects profitability and competitiveness in a for-profit organization and total costs in a not-for-profit organization. Perhaps of all the resources used for productivity in organizations, the ones often most closely scrutinized are the human resources. Examples as indicated in Figure 1-3 of Approaches to Improving Organizational Productivity Restructuring the Organization Revising organizational structure Reducing staff Aiding in mergers and acquisitions Re-Designing Work Changing workloads and combining jobs Reshaping jobs due to technology changes Goals Increase organizational productivity Reduce unit labor costs Aligning HR Activities Attracting and retaining employees Training, developing, and evaluating employees Compensating employees and other HR activities Outsourcing Using domestic vendors/ contractors instead of employees Outsourcing operations internationally Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 9 26/06/10 3:26 PM 10 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management HR management efforts designed to enhance organizational productivity are as follows: • • • • Organizational restructuring involves eliminating layers of management and changing reporting relationships, as well as cutting staff through downsizing, layoffs, and early retirement buyout programs. That has become a concern in a number of industries as economic factors have changed.9 Redesigning work often involves having fewer employees who work longer hours and perform multiple job tasks. It may also involve replacing workers with capital equipment or making them more efficient by use of technology or new processes. Aligning HR activities means making HR efforts consistent with organizational efforts to improve productivity. This alignment includes ensuring that HR functions are not working against productivity. Outsourcing analyses involve HR in conducting cost-benefit analyses to justify outsourcing. Additional factors may include negotiating with outsourcing vendors, ensuring that contractors domestically and internationally are operating legally and appropriately, and linking organizational employees to the employees of the outsourcing firm. Outsourcing is discussed further in Chapter 2. Social Responsibilities and HR Organizational influences have changed as individuals, employers, governmental agencies, and other entities have evolved. Social responsibility and networking have become more prevalent as organizational culture issues. Part of HR management is to ensure that social responsibility is integrated into the organizational culture. Both explicit and implicit requirements are needed.10 The explicit requirements include specific regulations, policies, and training. The implicit ones aid the organizational culture in encouraging appropriate organizational behavior when dealing with customers, suppliers, employees, and others. Sustainabilty Being able to continue to operate, survive, and adjust to significant changes. HR Advantages and Social Responsibilities Corporate social responsibility by HR has numerous advantages. One of the most important is the ability to attract and retain employees.11 Socially responsible jobs are increasingly popular, especially with college students, who will be future workers. One survey by Panetta Institute for Public Policy found that almost half of the college students had their greatest interest in working for a more socially responsible corporation, while others wanted to work for governmental or nonprofit organizations.12 These statistics indicate how attracting individuals with social responsibilities before hiring may lead to lower turnover and higher productivity when they become employees. Sustainability is a key part of social responsibility, as well as playing a key HR role in dealing with economic challenges. Sustainability is being able to continue to operate, survive, and adjust to significant changes. Balancing business needs and social factors, such as layoffs, job losses, business reputations, ethics, and other factors makes sustainability a part of HR in changing business environments.13 Another evolving area in which HR is playing a social responsibility role is in creating a “green” culture. Although that may seem unusual, participating in environmental improvement efforts can enhance employees’ views of the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 10 26/06/10 3:26 PM CHAPTER 1 11 Human Resource Management in Organizations “Growing Green” in HR Getting employees involved in green efforts is growing. Such efforts may affect the organizational corporate image with customers, employees, and throughout the business community in the area. Also, these programs can result in reduced operational costs linked to HR policies on recycling, creating less waste and pollution, reducing lighting and power usage, and many other means. According to a survey of 2,500 hiring managers, green programs also may create more jobs for employee environmental specialists. Firms that have emphasized green have found that the effects on attracting, retaining, and motivating workers of all types can be positive. For instance, General Electric highlights its “Ecomagination” on its recruiting website. In Chicago a number of firms in different industries offer green-job training HR perspective programs for environmental specialists, as well as other participants. A broader value of playing a key green role is that it can result in more organizational strategic emphasis. Organizations such as Mitsubishi International, Google, Emory University, and others have established sustainability officers to lead environmental efforts. For instance, Google switched a California facility to more solar power, guided by those officers. HR has a key role in green efforts. The need to communicate, train, and enforce the relevant green requirements with employees and managers throughout the organization is important. Also, safety and health issues may be affected by these efforts. In summary, HR management will have an increasingly green role in both large and small companies.14 social responsibility of a firm. Participation in different types of these efforts also can aid in recruiting employees, especially those who have higher views of such firms.15 As the HR Perspective discusses, the role of HR in green efforts is growing in importance. G L O B A L Global Social Responsibility and HR As organizations have more and more workers and businesses in various countries, social responsibility globally is becoming more of an HR issue. Global practices of social responsibility are often conducted through HR and may include collecting/donating money for local charities or national disasters and numerous other activities. Doing these activities results in higher organizational images globally, better employee morale and loyalty, and more competitive advantages with consumers.16 Customer Service and Quality Linked to HR Linking HR to social responsibility, customer service, and quality significantly affects organizational effectiveness. Having managers and employees focus on customers contributes significantly to achieving organizational goals and maintaining competitive advantages. In most organizations, service quality is greatly influenced by individual employees who interact with customers. Employee job satisfaction also can be influenced by positive customer satisfaction.17 Customers often consider continuity of customer service representatives as important when making marketing and sales decisions. Unfortunately, overall customer satisfaction with sales quality has declined in the United States and other countries. For example, the decline in customer Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 11 26/06/10 3:26 PM 12 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management satisfaction has affected many of the U.S. airlines. Even though some airlines have made efforts to improve services, customers continue to be rather skeptical of the improvements in the industry.18 Employee Engagement and HR Culture What is evident from the previous discussions is that the engagement of employees is a crucial goal and link to an effective organizational culture and HR’s role in it. Employee engagement is the extent to which individuals feel linked to organizational success and how the organization performs positively. Numerous studies have shown that engaged employees are less likely to quit, more likely to encourage other persons to become employees, and more likely to commit to activities positively outside of their organizations. One study found that highly engaged employees are almost 80% more likely to be top performers and miss fewer work days.19 The unfortunate lack of a positive culture can lead to more employee dissatisfaction, turnover, poor service, and other undesirable outcomes and behaviors. That is why employee engagement is such a crucial part of effective HR management and is linked to social networking. Social Networking and Engagement An integral part of employee engagement is social networking. This networking involves communicating to other employees, nonwork friends, community contacts, and others. Previously, social networking primarily was done through personal contacts as well as oral communications. However, networking has become a massive issue for employees and employers as technology has expanded through e-mailing, textmessaging, twitters, blogs, and many other formats. Some employees, especially younger ones, use such technology to communicate almost constantly with others. This expansive use of technological methods may create both good and bad images for employees and employers, as well as work-related legal issues. One survey by Deloitte found that 60% of executives believe they should know how workers use network profiles. Also, 75% of employers indicated that using social networks online makes creating a negative company image easier.20 However, some organizations have found that using social networks online can aid in recruiting new employees. Use of various types of technology can lead to recruiting more people, as well as reducing recruiting costs.21 The use of these technologies and issues in this area are discussed more in other chapters on specific HR resources and issues. ORGANIZATIONAL ETHICS AND HR MANAGEMENT Employee engagement The extent to which individuals feel linked to organizational success and how the organization performs positively. Closely linked with the strategic role of HR is the way managers and HR professionals influence the ethics of people in organizations. How those ethics affect work and lives for individuals may aid in producing more positive work outcomes.22 As Figure 1-4 indicates, establishing HR ethical areas can lead to organizational and individual consequences.23 The need for great attention to ethics has grown in the past few years, as evidenced by the corporate scandals at numerous financial and investment firms in the United States and globally. These scandals illustrate that ethical lapses are not just symbolic; they affect numerous firms and employees. The Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 12 26/06/10 3:27 PM CHAPTER 1 13 Human Resource Management in Organizations Business Ethics and HR Management Consequences F I G U R E 1- 4 BUSINESS ETHICS HR Management Ethical Areas Compensation Development Performance management HR policies Staffing Training Labor relations Legal compliance Consequences Job satisfaction Reduced turnover Decreased absenteeism LOGGING ON Ethics & Policy Integration Centre The Ethics & Policy Integration Centre is an online resource for ethical and policy issues. Visit the website at www.ethicaledge.com. Organizational commitment Higher job performance Ethical decision making expansion of the Internet has led to more publicity about ethical issues, including ethics electronic job boards and postings.24 An increase in ethics issues has been identified by the Ethics Resource Center. One survey of 3,000 U.S. workers found that within a year, 52% had seen one incident of misconduct and 36% had observed two or more ethical violations. The survey also reported that almost 70% of their employers had done ethics training.25 Ethical Behavior and Organizational Culture Numerous writers on business ethics consistently stress that the primary determinant of ethical behavior is organizational culture, which is the shared values and beliefs in an organization mentioned earlier. Every organization has a culture, and that culture influences how executives, managers, and employees act in making organizational decisions. For example, if meeting objectives and financial targets is stressed, then it should not be a surprise when executives and managers fudge numbers or falsify cost records. However, a positive ethical culture exists in many organizations. When the following four elements of ethics programs exist, ethical behavior is more likely to occur: • • • • A written code of ethics and standards of conduct Training on ethical behavior for all executives, managers, and employees Advice to employees on ethical situations they face, often made by HR Systems for confidential reporting of ethical misconduct or questionable behavior Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 13 26/06/10 3:27 PM 14 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Cisco Makes Global Ethics Important and Fun Cisco Systems, a technology firm with more than 60,000 employees worldwide, has emphasized ethics in interesting ways. Until a few years ago, Cisco did ethics training and enforcement like many other firms by using organization-required sessions and procedures. However, Cisco now uses a constantly available ethics program through its firm communications, Internet, and even television programs similar to American Idol. To conduct its ethics awareness, Cisco enables employees worldwide to view the Ethics Idol via television on its intranet. Cartoon individuals present different ethical situations and then have “judges” give decisions. Employees vote on the best answer to each situation. More than 10,000 Cisco employees participate voluntarily in these network analyses. Many employees look at the Ethics Idol after work rather than during business hours. After the employees vote, Cisco’s ethics office professionals then give the best answer HR best practices linked to Cisco company standards and compliance requirements. Using these creative and entertaining means has enhanced awareness of ethical issues throughout the firm. A new ethics document has been updated regularly, and more than 90% of Cisco employees have become certified in reviewing the code of the firm. Merging ethics issues, technology, and regular interactive training has led to ethical understanding and behavior by Cisco employees. Other firms have similar programs, but Cisco’s efforts are a model of ethical training and engagement. This creative ethics program is an expansion of Cisco’s corporate responsibility efforts. For years Cisco has been a leader in the “Corporate Citizens” listing on business ethics, and one of only three firms that have been recognized every year. Although other firms have ethics programs, Cisco’s broad efforts illustrate how expanding ethical training and engagement of employees can be effective.26 An ethical business culture is based first on organizational mission and values. Other related factors can include shareholders, long-term perspectives, process integrity, and leadership effectiveness.27 The roles of boards, CEOs, other executives, and HR leaders are vital in setting the culture for ethics globally as well as locally. Training of employees is crucial, and how they respond to situations may be linked to their expectations, motivations, and other factors.28 As the HR Best Practices indicates, Cisco has emphasized ethics using creative and effective means throughout its global business world. Ethics and Global Differences G L O B A L Differences in legal, political, and cultural values and practices in different countries often raise ethical issues for global employers who must comply with both their home-country laws and the laws of other countries. With the changes in the global economy in the past few years, a France-based entity, the Organization for Economic Cooperation (OECD), has emphasized the effects of ethics. The OECD has recommended that global multinational firms establish and implement stricter ethical standards to aid business development.29 The different legal, political, and cultural factors in other countries can lead to ethical and legal conflicts for global managers. Some global firms have established guidelines and policies to reduce the payments of bribes, but even Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 14 26/06/10 3:27 PM CHAPTER 1 15 Human Resource Management in Organizations those efforts do not provide detailed guidance on handling the situations that can arise. HR’s Role in Organizational Ethics Organizations that are seen as ethical in the way they operate have longerterm success. Because people in organizations are making ethical decisions on a daily basis, HR management plays a key role as the “keeper and voice” of organizational ethics. All managers, including HR managers, must deal with ethical issues and be sensitive to how they interplay with HR activities. Instead of relying just on HR policies or laws, people must be guided by values and personal behavior “codes,” including these two questions: • • Does the behavior or result meet all applicable laws, regulations, and government codes? Does the behavior or result meet both organizational standards and professional standards of ethical behavior? There are a number of different views about the importance of HR in ensuring that ethical practices, justice, and fairness are present throughout HR practices. Figure 1-5 identifies some of the most frequent areas of ethical misconduct involving HR activities. Ethical issues pose fundamental questions about fairness, justice, truthfulness, and social responsibility. Just complying with a wider range of requirements, laws, and regulations cannot cover every ethical situation that executives, managers, HR professionals, and employees will face. Yet, having all the elements of an ethics program may not prevent individual managers or executives from engaging in or failing to report unethical behavior. Even HR staff members may be reluctant to report ethics concerns, primarily because of fears that doing so may affect their current and future employment. Critical for guiding ethical decisions and behavior is training. Firms such as Best Buy, Caterpillar, and others have training for all employees via the Internet or in person. How to address difficult and conflicting situations is part F I G U R E 1- 5 Examples of HR-Related Ethical Misconduct Activities Compensation Misrepresenting hours and time worked Falsifying work expense reports Personal bias in performance appraisals and pay increases Deliberate inappropriate overtime classifications Accepting personal gains/gifts from vendors Employee Relations Employees lying to supervisors and coworkers Executives/managers e-mailing false public information to customers and vendors Misusing/stealing organizational assets and supplies Intentionally violating safety/health regulations Staffing and Equal Employment Discriminatory favoritism in hiring and promotion Sexual harassment of other employees EEO discrimination in recruiting and interviewing Conducting inappropriate background investigations Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 15 26/06/10 3:27 PM 16 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management of effective HR management training efforts.30 To help HR professionals deal with ethical issues, the Society for Human Resource Management has developed a code of ethics for its members and provides information on handling ethical issues and policies.31 HR Ethics and Sarbanes-Oxley The Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) was passed by Congress to make certain that publicly traded companies follow accounting controls that could reduce the likelihood of illegal and unethical behaviors. A number of HR facets must be managed in line with SOX. The biggest issues are linked to executive compensation and benefits, but SOX sections 404, 406, 802, and 806 require companies to establish ethics codes, develop employee complaint systems, and have antiretaliation policies for employees who act as whistle blowers to identify wrongful actions. HR has been involved in routing people through the massive compliance verification effort that has occurred. Numerous other local, state, and federal laws may relate to organizational and employee ethical issues. Some additional federal laws include the False Claims Act, Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, and others. Given all these laws, regulations, and issues, a broad study of ethics is philosophical, complex, and beyond the scope of this book. The intent here is to concisely identify ethical aspects of HR management. Various ethical issues in HR management are also highlighted throughout the text as appropriate. CURRENT AND FUTURE HR MANAGEMENT CHALLENGES As the way HR is managed in organizations changes, some challenges are affecting all employers. Responding effectively requires a competent HR presence to deal with the challenges. A wide range of factors are putting more planning, administrative, and cost pressures on organizations both in the United States and globally. Some of these new challenges and increased pressures are discussed next. Organizational Cost Pressures and Restructuring An overriding theme facing managers and organizations is to operate in a “costless” mode, which means continually looking for ways to reduce costs of all types—financial, operations, equipment, and labor. Pressures from global competitors have forced many U.S. firms to close facilities, use international outsourcing, adapt their management practices, increase productivity, and decrease labor costs in order to become more competitive. The growth of information technology, particularly that linked to the Internet, has influenced HR management as it handles the number, location, and required activities of employees. These shifts have caused some organizations to reduce the number of employees, while at the same time scrambling to attract and retain employees with different capabilities than were previously needed. Responding to organizational cost pressures and restructurings, as well as the other HR challenges, has resulted in the transformation of HR management in organizations. Economics and Job Changes The shifts in the U.S. and global economy in the past years have changed the number and types of jobs present in the United States. The recession in Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 16 26/06/10 3:27 PM CHAPTER 1 17 Human Resource Management in Organizations 2007–2009 affected many industries such as automotive and financial firms. In general, the United States has continued to have private- and public-sector jobs that are service economy in nature, and many of the additional jobs to be filled in the next several years will be in the service industry rather than manufacturing firms. Occupational Shifts Projections of growth in some jobs and decline in others illustrate the shifts occurring in the U.S. economy. Figure 1-6 lists occupations that are expected to experience the greatest growth in percentage and numbers for the period ending in 2016. Most of the fastest-growing occupations percentage-wise are related to information technology and health care. However, when the growth in the number of jobs is compared to the percentage growth, an interesting factor is evident. The highest growth of jobs by percentage is in occupations that generally require more education and expertise training, whereas the numerical growth of several jobs is in occupations requiring less education and jobs that are lower-skilled. Another aspect of the shifting economy is revealed in the types of jobs that have the greatest decline in numbers. They include stock clerks, cashiers, packers, file clerks, and farmers/ranchers.32 These declines reflect shifts in economic factors and how those jobs are being combined with others or eliminated due to business changes. Workforce Availability and Quality Concerns Various parts of the United States face significant workforce shortages that exist due to an inadequate supply of workers with the skills needed to perform the jobs being added. It may not be that there are too few people—only that there are too few with many F I G U R E 1- 6 Fastest Growth in Job Changes to 2016 Percentage Increase in Jobs Increase in Job Numbers Network systems/data communications analysts 53% Registered nurses 587,000 Personal/home care aides 51% Retail salespersons 557,000 Home health aides 49% Customer service reps 545,000 Computer software engineers 44% Food preparations workers 452,000 Veterinary technologists 41% Office clerks 404,000 Personal financial advisors 41% Personal/home care aides 389,000 Makeup artists 40% Home health aides 384,000 Medical assistants 35% Postsecondary teachers 382,000 Source: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 17 26/06/10 3:27 PM 18 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management of the skills being demanded. For instance, one survey of more than 2,000 employers found that the hardest jobs to fill are engineers, nurses, technicians, teachers, and sales representatives.33 Even though many Americans are graduating from high school and college, employers are concerned about the preparation and specific skills of new graduates. Comparisons of international test results show that students in the United States perform slightly above average in math and science, but well below students in some other directly competitive nations. Also, graduates with degrees in computers, engineering, and the health sciences remain in short supply relative to the demand for them. That is another reason why international outsourcing has grown. Unless major improvements are made to U.S. educational systems, U.S. employers will be unable to find enough qualified workers for the growing number of skilled jobs of all types. That is why talent management and development has become one of the most important issues emphasized by HR management. Talent Management and Development A broad focus of HR professionals is on talent management and development to address the workforce and job changes. Despite the economic pressures, the emphasis on talent management has appeared on the HR scene in organizations of all sizes and in all industries. Some forces behind the emphasis on talent management have included: • • • • The impending retirement of baby boomers worldwide Shortages of skilled workers of certain types and at certain levels Increasing global competition for human resource talent Growth in technology capable of automating talent management processes These and other factors have forced organizations to develop a more strategic, integrated, and automated approach to talent management. Whether it involves attracting, recruiting, and hiring qualified talented individuals, or training and developing employees for current and future jobs, talent management is crucial. A survey by McKinsey and Company of 200 companies found that better-performing firms hired more qualified people, established more specific performance expectations, and worked to link employees to corporate culture and strategies.34 Further discussion of talent management occurs in later chapters. Growth in Contingent Workforce Contingent workers (temporary workers, independent contractors, leased employees, and part-timers) represent about one-fourth of the U.S. workforce. Many employers operate with a core group of regular employees who have critical skills, and then expand and shrink the workforce by using contingent workers. The number of contingent workers has grown for many reasons. One reason is the economic factor. Temporary workers are used to replace full-time employees, and many contingent workers are paid less and/or receive fewer benefits than regular employees. For instance, omitting contingent workers from health care benefits saves some firms LOGGING ON 20% to 40% in labor costs. Development Dimensions Another reason for the increased use of contingent International workers is that it may reduce legal liability for some Development Dimensions International employers. As more and more employment-related lawsuits provides resources for globalization of have been filed, employers have become more wary about organizations and HR. Visit the website adding regular full-time employees. By using contract at www.ddiworld.com. workers, including those in other countries, employers may Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 18 26/06/10 3:27 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 19 reduce a number of legal issues regarding selection, discrimination, benefits, discipline, and termination. Globalization of Organizations and HR G L O B A L Expatriate A citizen of one country who is working in a second country and employed by an organization headquartered in the first country. Host-country national A citizen of one country who is working in that country and employed by an organization headquartered in a second country. Third-country national A citizen of one country who is working in a second country and employed by an organization headquartered in a third country. The internationalization of business has proceeded at a rapid pace. Many U.S. firms, both large and small, receive a substantial portion of their profits and sales from other countries. Firms such as Coca-Cola, Exxon, Mobil, Microsoft, and General Electric derive half or more of total sales and profits from outside the United States. The reverse is also true. For example, Toyota, based in Japan, has grown its market share and its number of jobs in the United States and North America. Also, Toyota, Honda, Nissan, and other Japanese automobile manufacturers, electronics firms, and suppliers have maintained operations in the United States, whereas Chrysler and General Motors have had to reduce major operations. The globalization of business has shifted from trade and investment to the integration of global operations, management, and strategic alliances, which has significantly affected the management of human resources. Individuals from other countries are employees. There are three types of global workers: expatriate, host-country national, and third-country national. An expatriate is a citizen of one country who is working in a second country and employed by an organization headquartered in the first country. Experienced expatriates can provide a pool of talent that can be tapped as the organization expands its operations more broadly into even more countries. A host-country national is a citizen of one country who is working in that country and employed by an organization headquartered in a second country. Host-country nationals often know the culture, politics, laws, and business customs better than an outsider would. A third-country national is a citizen of one country who is working in a second country and employed by an organization headquartered in a third country. For example, a U.S. citizen working for a British oil company as a manager in Norway is a third-county national. Staffing with third-country nationals shows a truly global approach. Attracting global talent has created political issues. For instance, U.S. employers are having a difficult time hiring enough engineers and educated tech workers, but U.S. federal legislation restricts the quota for high-skilled workers to be admitted from other countries in light of the large amount of illegal immigration and high numbers of unemployed U.S. workers that are occurring. Global Economic Factors Economic factors are linked to different political, legal, cultural, and economic systems. In many developed countries, especially in Europe, employment restrictions and wage levels are high. When labor costs in the United States are compared with those in Germany and Korea, the differences are significant, as Figure 1-7 shows. As a result of these differences, many U.S. and European firms are moving jobs to lower-wage countries and other continental locations. Critics of globalization cite the extremely low wage rates paid by the international firms and the substandard working conditions that exist in some underdeveloped countries. Various advocacy groups have accused global firms of being “sweatshop employers.” Thus, some global employers have made efforts to ensure that foreign factories adhere to more appropriate HR standards, while others have not. Global employers counter that even though the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 19 26/06/10 3:27 PM 20 Environment of Human Resource Management SECTION 1 Hourly Compensation Costs for Manufacturing Production Workers F I G U R E 1- 7 Germany $37.66 $30.17 Australia U.K. $29.43 Countries France $28.57 Canada $28.19 U.S. $24.59 Japan $19.75 $6.58 Korea Taiwan Phillipines $0.00 $2.92 $1.10 $5.00 $10.00 $15.00 $20.00 $25.00 $30.00 $35.00 $40.00 Hourly Costs (in U.S. Dollars) Source: U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov. wage rates in some countries are low, their employees often receive the highest wages and experience the best working conditions that exist in those local countries. Also, they argue, more people have jobs in the host countries, which allows them to improve their living standards. Global Legal and Political Factors Firms in the United States, Europe, and elsewhere are accustomed to relatively stable political and legal systems. However, many nations function under turbulent and varied legal and political systems. International firms in many industries have dramatically increased security for both operations and employees. Terrorist threats and incidents have significantly affected airlines, travel companies, construction firms, and even retailers such as McDonald’s. HR management must respond to such concerns as part of transnational operations and risk management efforts. Therefore, HR-related efforts vary in character and stability. Compliance with laws and company actions on wages, benefits, union relations, worker privacy, workplace safety, and other issues illustrate the importance of HR management when operating transnationally. As a result, it is crucial for HR professionals to conduct a comprehensive review of the political environment and employment laws before beginning operations in a country. The role and nature of labor unions should be a part of that review. Workforce Demographics and Diversity The U.S. workforce has been changing dramatically. It is more diverse racially and ethnically, more women are in it than ever before, and the average age of its members is increasing. As a result of these demographic shifts, HR management in organizations has had to adapt to a more varied labor force both externally and internally. In addition to the issues discussed in the following sections, this growing diversity and aging of the workforce has raised employer concerns and means that HR is having to devote more time and Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 20 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 21 effort to ensuring that nondiscriminatory policies and practices are followed. The effective management of diversity issues in organizations is getting more attention, as will be highlighted in later chapters. Racial/Ethnic Diversity Racial and ethnic minorities account for a growing percentage of the overall labor force, with the percentage of Hispanics equal to or greater than the percentage of African Americans. Immigrants will continue to expand that growth. An increasing number of individuals characterize themselves as multiracial, suggesting that the American “melting pot” is blurring racial and ethnic identities. Racial/ethnic differences have also created greater cultural diversity because of the accompanying differences in traditions, languages, religious practices, and so on. For example, global events have increased employers’ attention to individuals who are Muslim, and more awareness and accommodation for Islamic religious beliefs and practices have become a common concern. Workforce diversity is further discussed in Chapter 4. Women in the Workforce Women constitute about 50% of the U.S. workforce, but may be a majority in certain occupations. For instance, the membership of HR professionals in the Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM) is more than 75% female.35 Additionally, numerous women workers are single, separated, divorced, or widowed, and therefore are “primary” income earners. A growing number of U.S. households include “domestic partners,” who are committed to each other though not married and who may be of the same or the opposite sex. Many of the women in these partnerships, as well as many who are married, have partners or spouses who also are employed. For many workers in the United States, balancing the demands of family and work is a significant challenge. Although that balancing has always been a concern, the increased number of working women and dual-career couples has resulted in greater tensions for many workers, both male and female. Employers have had to respond to work/family concerns in order to retain employees. Responses have included greater use of job sharing, the establishment of child-care services, increased flexibility in hours, and varied work-life programs. Aging Workforce In many economically developed countries, the population is aging, resulting in a significantly aging workforce. In the United States, during the second decade of the twenty-first century, a significant number of experienced employees will be retiring, changing to part-time, or otherwise shifting their employment. Replacing the experience and talents of longerservice workers is a growing challenge facing employers in all industries. This loss of longer-service workers is frequently referred to as a “brain drain,” due to the capabilities and experience of these workers, and employers are having to develop programs to retain them, have them mentor and transfer knowledge to younger employees, and find ways for them to continue contributing by limited means. One study found that 65% of baby boomers want to continue working part-time and avoid full-time employment.36 HR Technology Greater use of technology has led to organizational use of a human resource management system (HRMS), which is an integrated system providing information used by HR management in decision making. This terminology Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 21 26/06/10 3:28 PM 22 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management emphasizes that making HR decisions, not just building databases and using technology, is the primary reason for compiling data in an information system. Purposes for Expanding HR Technology The rapid expansion of HR technology serves two major purposes in organizations. One relates to administrative and operational efficiency, and the other to effectiveness. The first purpose is to improve the efficiency with which data on employees and HR activities are compiled. The most basic example is the automation of payroll and benefits activities. Another common use of technology is tracking EEO/ affirmative action activities. Beyond those basic applications, the use of Webbased information systems has allowed the HR unit in organizations to become more administratively efficient and communicate more quickly to employees. The second purpose of the use of HR technology is related to strategic HR planning. Having accessible data enables HR planning and managerial decision making to be based to a greater degree on information rather than relying on managerial perceptions and intuition. Greater Uses of HR Technology The greater uses of technologies are affecting how HR activities are performed in many ways. To illustrate, numerous Wikis, Blogs, Twitters, and HR The explosive growth of the Internet has resulted in many employees and managers participating in wikis, blogs, twitters, text-messaging, and other techniques. Some of the HR aspects of the Internet are highlighted here. In a wiki, which is a widely available website for individuals to make comments, employees can communicate both positive and negative messages on many topics. Employers have used wikis, such as Wikipedia and other sources, to increase the exchange of ideas and information among a wide range of individuals. Wikis are one example of collaborative HR. This process of collaboration can lead to HR professionals from several different organizations jointly working to address shared business problems and interacting regularly with other professionals. Blogs are Web logs kept by individuals or groups to post and exchange information on a range of topics. People create and use more than one million blogs daily. The subjects of blogs vary. An example of company use would be CEOs or HR executives exchanging information with employees immediately on operational or other important occurrences. Many bloggers are young and college-educated. Often, HR HR online professionals are not as involved in blogs as some other employees, but they are having to ramp up their awareness and usage of this format. An even newer technology tool is twitter, which is a microblog that allows people to send and receive tweets. Basically, a tweet is a quick message of less than 140 characters through which individuals quickly send information to others. Whether such information is valid, positive or negative, or useful is a topic of continuing controversy. Some firms use twitters to send out policy changes, competitive services details, and many other organizational messages, but individuals can use twitters inappropriately and send critical, obscene, or even harassing details to other employees. These technology tools and others create significant HR issues, including ethical and disciplinary actions. Firms must establish policies and regulations on how all of this technology can and should be used. For example, IBM has established guidelines directing that the use of twitters must be responsible, protect privacy, and correct mistakes made by individual tweets. Throughout this text, the various HR technology means will be discussed as they apply to specific HR activities.37 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 22 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 23 firms provide a Web-based employee self-service program to their worldwide staffs. Employees can go online to access and change their personal data, enroll in or change benefits programs, and prepare for performance reviews. As discussed in the HR Online box, the explosive use of wikis, blogs, twitters, and other technology is affecting HR significantly. Additional examples of how various HR activities are being transformed by technology will be presented throughout the chapters of this text. Measuring HR Impact through Metrics Traditionally, much of HR has focused on administrative activities, and on counting them, such as the number of people hired, total benefits costs, and so on. However, as HR has grown in importance and changed, it has had to develop measurements of its results, including financial, in order to justify its activities. Whether it is measuring the cost of hiring someone, calculating the turnover costs when persons leave the firm, or doing a return-on-investment analysis of training results and expenses, HR has had to become more analytical and develop metrics that measure the HR efforts, much like financial officers measure their responsibilities. HR metrics are discussed as part of Chapter 2, as well as throughout the text. MANAGING HR IN ORGANIZATIONS In a real sense, every manager in an organization is an HR manager. Sales managers, head nurses, drafting supervisors, college deans, and accounting supervisors all engage in HR management, and their effectiveness depends in part on the success of organizational HR systems. However, it is unrealistic to expect a nursing supervisor or an engineering manager to know about the nuances of equal employment regulations or how to design and administer a compensation and benefits system. For that reason, many organizations have people in an HR department who specialize in these activities, but HR in smaller organizations may be somewhat different. Smaller Organizations and HR Management In the United States and worldwide, small businesses employ more than 50% of all private-sector employees and generate new jobs each year.38 In surveys over several years by the U.S. Small Business Association (SBA), the issues identified as significant concerns in small organizations were consistent: having sufficient numbers of qualified workers, the rapidly increasing costs of benefits, rising taxes, and compliance with government regulations. Notice these concerns have an HR focus, especially when governmental compliance with wage/hour, safety, equal employment, and other regulations are considered. HR efforts through recruiting, employee empowerment, and training have been found to contribute positively to sales growth in various small service industry firms.39 As a result, for many smaller organizations, HR issues are often significant. However, not every small organization is able to maintain an HR department. In a company with an owner and only three employees, the owner usually takes care of HR issues. As an organization grows, often a clerical employee is added to handle payroll, benefits, and required HR recordkeeping. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 23 26/06/10 3:28 PM 24 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management If new employees are hired, supervisors and managers usually do the recruiting, selecting, and training. These HR activities reduce the time that supervisors and managers have to focus on operations, sales and marketing, accounting, and other business areas. Thus, for both small and large employers, numerous HR activities are being outsourced to specialized vendors. Typically, at 80 to 100 employees, an organization will need to designate a person to specialize in HR management. Other HR jobs are added as the company gets larger and as HR technology increasingly becomes available for small- and medium-sized organizations. HR Cooperation with Operating and Line Managers In departments such as accounting, network technology, operations, customer service, and others, cooperation between line and operating managers, supervisors, executives, and HR staff is necessary for HR efforts to succeed. In many cases, the HR professionals and staff members design processes and systems that the operating managers must help implement. The exact division of labor between HR and other departments varies from organization to organization. Throughout this book, figures labeled “Typical Division of HR Responsibilities” illustrate how HR responsibilities in various areas may be divided in organizations having specialized HR departments. The first such example, Figure 1-8, shows how the responsibilities for a familiar activity— recruiting planning—might be divided between the HR department and the operating managers in an organization. How HR Is Seen in Organizations For a number of years, HR departments and individuals have been viewed in different ways, both positive and negative. HR management is necessary, especially due to the huge number of government regulations enacted over the past decades. However, the role of protecting corporate assets against the many legal issues often puts HR management in an enforcement role that may be seen as restrictive and administratively focused. F I G U R E 1- 8 Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Recruiting HR Unit Forecasts recruiting needs Prepares copy for recruiting ads, campaigns, and Internet resources Plans and conducts recruiting efforts Audits and evaluates all recruiting activities Managers Anticipate needs for employees to fill vacancies, including capabilities needed of applicants Relate with existing employees on possible applicant referrals Assist in recruiting efforts with information about job requirements Review success/failure of recruiting activities Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 24 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 25 Negative Views of HR The legal compliance role and other administrative aspects of HR staff can create conflicting views. The negative perception by some employees, managers, and executives is that HR departments and personnel are too bureaucratic, too administratively focused, too detail-oriented, too costly, and not effective change agents.40 Various authors have referred to HR departments as “dinosaurs” or “gatekeepers” who build silos and resist changes. These critics do not see HR as making significant organizational contributions. Unfortunately, these views are accurate in some HR departments. Those HR departments concern themselves with the “administrivia” of personnel policies and practices—which companies are increasingly outsourcing to contractors who can do these tasks more cheaply and efficiently. Frequently, HR managers are seen as being more concerned about activities than results, and HR efforts as too seldom linking to employee, managerial, and business performance organizational metrics. As would be expected, numerous HR professionals have criticized these views as being too negative and not what HR is actually doing in many organizations. Positive, Contributing Views of HR Despite many criticisms, HR can be respected if done well and truly brought into the realm of business strategy. HR can and should be a special part of any organization, which means viewing the people and their talents as an opportunity for creating greater organizational competitive advantages. That is why HR in many organizations has recognized the need to change even more to overcome the negative images. As previously indicated, economic, global, workforce, and other aspects are increasingly creating challenging practices for HR professionals.41 Key for a more positive view is for HR to expand as a business contributor, as will be highlighted in the following sections. One leader in creating this view, among others, has been Dave Ulrich. He and other advocates have emphasized that HR needs to become more of a change agent and shift positively how HR impacts organizatons.42 The different roles of HR and how they need to be changing and expanding are discussed next. HR MANAGEMENT ROLES Several roles can be fulfilled by HR management. The nature and extent of these roles depend on both what upper management wants HR management to do and what competencies the HR staff have demonstrated. Three roles are typically identified for HR. The focus of each of them, as shown in Figure 1-9, is as follows: • • • Administrative: Focusing on clerical administration and recordkeeping, including essential legal paperwork and policy implementation. Operational and employee advocate: Managing most HR activities in line with the strategies and operations that have been identified by management and serving as employee “champion” for employee issues and concerns. Strategic: Helping to define the strategy relative to human capital and its contribution to organizational results. The administrative role traditionally has been the dominant role for HR. However, as Figure 1-9 indicates, a broader transformation in HR is needed so that significantly less HR time and fewer HR staff are used just for clerical Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 25 26/06/10 3:28 PM 26 SECTION 1 F I G U R E 1- 9 Administrative Personnel practices and procedures Legal compliance forms and paperwork Environment of Human Resource Management Roles of HR Management Operational Actions Managing employee relationship issues Employee advocate Strategic HR Organizational/business strategies HR strategic planning Evaluation of HR effectiveness administration. The emphasis on the operational and employee advocate role is growing in most organizations. The greatest challenge is for more strategic HR management. The biggest barriers to HR becoming more strategic, according to one study, are transaction of administrative tasks (42%), lack of strategic HR involvement (31%), and insufficient HR budgets (22%).43 A closer look at each of the HR roles and how these roles are being transformed follows. Administrative Role of HR The administrative role of HR management has been heavily oriented to processing and recordkeeping. This role has given HR management in some organizations the reputation of being staffed by paper shufflers who primarily tell managers and employees what cannot be done. If limited to the administrative role, HR staff are seen primarily as clerical and lower-level administrative aides to the organization. Two major shifts driving the transformation of the administrative role are greater use of technology and outsourcing. Technology Transforming HR To improve the administrative efficiency of HR and the responsiveness of HR to employees and managers, more HR functions are becoming available electronically or are being done on the Internet using Web-based technology. Technology is being used in most HR activities, from employment applications and employee benefits enrollments to e-learning using Internet-based resources. Outsourcing of HR Increasingly, many HR administrative functions are being outsourced to vendors. This outsourcing of HR administrative activities has grown dramatically in HR areas such as employee assistance (counseling), retirement planning, benefits administration, payroll services, and outplacement services. The primary reasons why HR functions are outsourced are to save money on HR staffing, to take advantage of specialized vendor expertise and technology, and to be able to focus on more strategic HR activities. These activities are being outsourced to firms both in the United States and worldwide. Such contracting for HR services is an evolving practice that continues to change the administrative HR functions for many employers, as discussed further in Chapter 2. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 26 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 27 Operational and Employee Advocate Role for HR HR often has been viewed as the “employee advocate” in organizations. As the voice for employee concerns, HR professionals traditionally may serve as “company morale officers,” but they spend considerable time on HR “crisis management,” dealing with employee problems that are both work-related and not work-related. Employee advocacy helps ensure fair and equitable treatment for employees regardless of personal background or circumstances. Sometimes the HR advocate role may create conflict with operating managers. However, without the HR advocate role, employers could face even more lawsuits and regulatory complaints than they do now. The operational role requires HR professionals to cooperate with various departmental and operating managers and supervisors, to identify and implement needed programs and policies in the organization. Operational activities are tactical in nature. Compliance with equal employment opportunity and other laws is ensured, employment applications are processed, current openings are filled through interviews, supervisors are trained, safety problems are resolved, and wage and benefit questions are answered. These efforts require matching HR activities with the strategies of the organization. Strategic Role for HR Differences between the operational and strategic roles exist in a number of HR areas. The strategic HR role means that HR professionals are proactive in addressing business realities and focusing on future business needs, such as strategic planning, compensation strategies, the performance of HR, and measuring its results. However, HR often does not help formulate strategies for the organization as a whole; instead it merely carries them out through HR activities. Many executives, managers, and HR professionals are increasingly seeing the need for HR management to become a greater strategic contributor to the “business” success of organizations. Even not-for-profit organizations, such as governmental and social service entities, must manage their human resources in a business-oriented manner. In fact, it has been suggested that the HR function should be managed as its own business. Therefore, a large number of senior HR executives are selected from outside HR experience. Doing this means that these individuals have a business focus, not just HR experience.44 HR should be responsible for knowing what the true cost of human capital is for an employer. For example, it may cost two times key employees’ annual salaries to replace them if they leave. Turnover is something HR can help control, and if it is successful in saving the company money with good retention and talent management strategies, those may be important contributions to the bottom line of organizational performance. “Contributing at the Table” The role of HR as a strategic business partner is often described as “having a seat at the table,” and contributing to the strategic directions and success of the organization. That means HR is involved in devising strategy in addition to implementing strategy. Part of HR’s contribution is to have financial expertise and to produce financial results, not just employee morale or administrative efficiencies. Therefore, a significant concern for chief financial officers (CFOs) is whether HR executives are equipped to help plan and meet financial requirements.45 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 27 26/06/10 3:28 PM 28 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management However, even though this strategic role of HR is recognized, many organizations still need to make significant progress toward fulfilling it. Some examples of areas where strategic contributions can be made by HR are: • Evaluating mergers and acquisitions for organizational “compatibility,” structural changes, and staffing needs • Conducting workforce planning to anticipate the retirement of employees at all levels and identify workforce expansion in organizational strategic plans • Leading site selection efforts for new facilities or transferring operations to international outsourcing LOGGING ON locations based on workforce needs HRN Management Group • Instituting HR management systems to reduce Information on strategic issues for HR, administrative time, equipment, and staff by using HR including news and success stories for technology key HR decision makers, is available by • Working with executives to develop a revised sales linking to the HRN Management Group compensation and incentives plan as new products or website at www.hronline.com. services are rolled out to customers HR MANAGEMENT COMPETENCIES AND CAREERS As HR management becomes more complex, greater demands are placed on individuals who make HR their career specialty. Despite the HR criticism and concerns mentioned earlier, a significant number of individuals have made HR their career field. Even readers of this book who do not become HR managers and professionals will find it useful to know about the competencies required for effective HR management. HR Competencies The transformation of HR toward being more strategic has implications for the competencies needed by HR professionals. Views of HR have changed over the years as the needed competencies and the results have differed. Research has indicated that HR professionals at all levels need the following: 46 • • • Strategic knowledge and impact means Legal, administrative, and operational capabilities Technology knowledge and usage abilities Senior HR leaders may need additional capabilities and competencies. According to an overview from a SHRM study, senior HR leaders also need: (a) more business, strategic, HR, and organizational knowledge; (b) ability to lead changes due to credibility; and (c) ethical behavior and results orientation/ performance.47 For individuals with HR as their career, these competencies help establish their value as professional resources. The changes in organizations and the workforce mean that HR as a career field is being altered and will continue to require more efforts by HR professionals at all levels. HR Management as a Career Field A variety of jobs exists within the HR career field, ranging from executive to clerical. As an employer grows large enough to need someone to focus Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 28 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 29 primarily on HR activities, the role of the HR generalist emerges—that is, a person who has responsibility for performing a variety of HR activities. Further growth leads to the addition of HR specialists, or individuals who have in-depth knowledge and expertise in limited areas of HR. The most common areas of HR specialty, in order of frequency, are benefits, employment and recruitment, and compensation.48Appendix F contains examples of HR-related job descriptions of both a generalist and a specialist. HR jobs can be found in corporate headquarters as well as in field and subsidiary operations. A compensation analyst or HR director might be found at a corporate headquarters. An employment manLOGGING ON ager for a manufacturing plant and a European HR manager for a global food company are examples of field and HR Certification Institute subsidiary HR professionals. The two types of jobs have For information on the HRCI different career appeals and challenges, which may affect certification process, go to the recruiting, selection, promotions, and development of www.hrci.org. individuals. HR Professionalism and Certification Depending on the job, HR professionals may need considerable knowledge about employment regulations, finance, tax law, statistics, and information systems. In most cases, they also need extensive knowledge about specific HR activities. The broad range of issues faced by HR professionals has made involvement in professional associations and organizations important. For HR generalists, the largest organization is the Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM). Public-sector HR professionals tend to be concentrated in the International Personnel Management Association (IPMA). Two other prominent specialized HR organizations are the WorldatWork Association and the American Society for Training and Development (ASTD). One characteristic of a professional field is having a means to certify that members have the knowledge and competence needed in the profession. The CPA for accountants and the CLU for life insurance underwriters are examples. Certification can be valuable to individuals and useful to employers as they select and promote certified individuals.49 The most well-known certification programs for HR generalists are administered by the Human Resource Certification Institute (HRCI), which is affiliated with SHRM. More than 100,000 professionals have an HRCI certification. HR generalist A person who has responsibility for performing a variety of HR activities. HR specialist A person who has in-depth knowledge and expertise in a limited area of HR. HRCI Certification The most widely known HR certifications are the Professional in Human Resources (PHR) and the Senior Professional in Human Resources (SPHR), both sponsored by HRCI. Annually, thousands of individuals take the certification exams. HRCI also sponsors a Global Professional in Human Resources (GPHR) certification. Eligibility requirements for PHR, SPHR, and GPHR certifications have been updated. These requirements, effective 2011, are shown in Figure 1-10. Additionally, eligible individuals must pass the appropriate exam. Appendix A identifies test specifications and knowledge area covered by the PHR and SPHR. Readers of this book can identify specific competencies for the HRCI outline to aid them in getting a PHR or SPHR. Certification from HRCI also exists for global HR professionals in the GPHR. Global certification recognizes the growth in HR responsibilities in organizations throughout the world and covers appropriate global HR subject areas noted through SHRM. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 29 26/06/10 3:28 PM 30 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management HR Certifications at a Glance F I G U R E 1- 10 The certification exams test on experience-based knowledge; therefore, you must possess a minimum of two years of professional (exempt-level) HR experience. Exam Eligibility Requirements Profile of a Successful Candidate* Professional in Human Resources (PHR®) Senior Professional in Human Resources (SPHR®) Global Professional in Human Resources (GPHR®) Minimum of two years of professional (exempt-level) HR experience. Minimum of two years of professional (exempt-level) HR experience. Must hold a current PHR or SPHR certification. At least 51% of your daily work activities are within the HR function. At least 51% of your daily work activities are within the HR function. At least 51% of your daily work activities are within the HR function. Has two to four years of professional (exempt-level) generalist experience Has six to eight years of progressive professional (exempt-level) experience Has at least two years of professional (exempt-level) experience in international HR practices. Focuses on program implementation rather than creation. Designs and plans rather than implements. Has core knowledge of the organization’s international HR activities. Focuses within the HR function rather than organization-wide Makes decisions that have an impact within and outside the organization. Develops and implements international HR strategies that affect internation al HR assignments and operations. *In addition to meeting the exam eligibility requirements, successful exam candidates usually have the above work experience. WorldatWork Certifications The WorldatWork Association has certifications emphasizing compensation and benefits. The four certifications are as follows: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 30 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations • • • • 31 Certified Compensation Professional (CCP) Certified Benefits Professional (CBP) Certified Work-Life Professional (CWLP) Certified Global Remuneration (CGR) Other HR Certifications Increasingly, employers hiring or promoting HR professionals are requesting certifications as a “plus.” HR professionals feel that various HR certifications give them more credibility with corporate peers and senior managers. Additional certification programs for HR specialists and generalists are sponsored by various organizations, and the number of certifications is being expanded.50 For specialists, some well-known programs include the following: • Certified Recognition Professional (CRP) sponsored by the Recognition Professionals International • Certified Employee Benefits sponsored by the International Foundation of Employee Benefits Plans • Certified Professional in Learning and Performance sponsored by the American Society for Training and Development • Certified Safety Professional (CSP) and Occupational Health and Safety Technologist (OHST) sponsored by the American Society of Safety Engineers • Certified Professional Outsourcing (CSO) provided by the Human Resource Outsourcing Association • Certified Graphics Communications Manager (CGCM) and Certified Mail Manager (CMM) sponsored by the International Personnel Management Association Most individuals who want to succeed in the field must update their knowledge continually. One way of staying current on HR is to tap information in current HR literature and relevant associations, as listed in Appendix B of this book. Overall, certifying knowledge is a trend in numerous professions, and HR illustrates the importance of certification by making many different types available. Given that many people may enter HR jobs with limited formal HR training, certifications help both individuals and their employers to make HR management a better performing part of their organizations. S U M M A R Y • • • HR management ensures that human talent is used effectively and efficiently to accomplish organizational goals. As an organization core competency, human resources has a unique capability that creates high value and differentiates an organization from competitors in areas such as productivity, quality/ service, employee skills, and innovative changes. Human capital is the collective value of the capabilities, knowledge, skills, life experiences, and motivation of an organizational workforce. • HR management activities can be grouped as follows: strategic HR management; equal employment opportunity; staffing; talent management; compensation and benefits; health, safety, and security; and employee and labor relations. • As part of organizational culture, HR plays a significant role through affecting human values, competitive advantages, and global cultures. • Contributions by HR can include productivity improvement, meeting social responsibilities, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 31 26/06/10 3:28 PM 32 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management enhancing customer service and quality, and expanding employee engagement. • Ethical behavior is crucial in HR management, and HR professionals regularly face a number of ethical issues and consequences both domestically and globally. • Numerous HR challenges exist currently, including organizational cost pressures, economics and job changes, talent management and development, technology expansion, and measuring HR. • All organizations need HR management, but larger ones are more likely to have a specialized HR function. C R I T I C A L HR management must fulfill three roles: (1) administrative, (2) operational and employee advocate, and (3) strategic. • All levels of HR professionals need competencies in strategic knowledge and impacts; capabilities in legal, administrative, and operational areas; and technology knowledge abilities. Senior HR leaders need these areas plus others to be effective. • Current knowledge about HR management is required for professionals in the HR career field, and professional certification has grown in importance for HR generalists and specialists. T H I N K I N G 1. Discuss several areas in which HR can affect organizational culture positively or negatively. 2. Give some examples of ethical issues that you have experienced in jobs, and explain how HR did or did not help resolve them. 3. Why is it important for HR management to transform from being primarily administrative and operational to becoming a more strategic contributor? H R • E X P E R I E N T I A L Your company, a growing firm in the financial services industry, is extremely sensitive to the issues surrounding business ethics. The company wants to be proactive in developing a business ethics training program for all employees both to ensure the company’s reputation as an ethical company in the community and to help maintain the industry’s high standards. As the HR Director and someone who values the importance of having all employees trained in the area of business ethics, you are in charge of developing the ethics training program. A C T I V I T I E S 4. Assume you are an HR director with a staff of seven people. A departmental objective is for all staff members to become professionally certified within a year. Using Internet resources of HR associations such as www.shrm.org and www.WorldatWork.org, develop a table that identifies four to six certifications that could be obtained by your staff members, and show the important details for each certification. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G It needs to be a basic program that can be presented to all employees in the company. Resources for business ethics information can be found at www.business-ethics.org/primer1.html. 1. What legislative act prompted many U.S. companies to develop internal ethical policies and procedures? 2. What are key concepts related to business ethics that should be considered in the development of the ethics training program? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 32 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 Human Resource Management in Organizations 33 C A S E HR, Culture, and Business Results Success at Google, Scripps, and UPS Firms in a variety of industries have been recognized as being among the Most Admired Companies by Fortune magazine. Others have been highlighted as being the Best Companies to Work For by Fortune or as Optimas Award winners by Workforce Management. These recognitions contain some common elements because of how HR management has contributed to organizational success and is being positively viewed by employees. Three examples are highlighted here. One recognized firm is Google, which is well known by many individuals because of its Internet components. Google has an HR image as a creative contributor to business objectives through its work environment guided by HR. According to the head of HR at Google, Lazio Bock, the overriding key of HR at Google is its emphasis on organizational culture and business objectives. The focus of Google HR is on giving its employees flexibility to produce results, not just following core job requirements. Consequently, HR at Google has established innovative efforts for its people and has made the administrative part of HR efficient. Minimizing numerous HR administrative forms, data, and reports by using technology has occurred, which would be expected in a prominent technology firm. At Google, HR communicates to its employees extensively about business objectives, organizational results, and relevant current information. Because many of the Google employees are stock shareholders also, they have a personal interest in Google being a successful business. Thus they continuously want to know the operational results by seeing current reports, data, and information. Overall, Google’s HR approach is unique in comparison to the approaches at other companies recognized by Fortune, but its success illustrates that how HR is established and operates can be a key to organizational success. A different firm with a variety of organizations and a strong HR culture is Scripps Network, a prominent television and communications corporation. At Scripps, HR plays a core role in establishing strategic goals and efforts. Even when Scripps has merged separate media firms, HR has focused on getting the cultures of the two entities to integrate effectively. Several HR functions are used to support the culture and core values at Scripps. One is an active pay-for-performance system to reward employees at higher job levels with base pay increases, annual incentives, and long-term incentives. Another key part of HR efforts at Scripps is that HR emphasizes leadership development throughout the firm. Additionally, the firm has widely used work variability efforts such as worklife balance, telecommuting, and worker flexible schedules. These are done as part of a core value at Scripps of “compassion/support.” A different firm with an extended history of effectively integrating corporate culture and HR is UPS, the transportation and logistics delivery firm that operates worldwide. Its culture is different from the cultures of Google and Scripps; however, for more than a decade, UPS has been recognized for its corporate integrity, culture, and HR inclusion with employees. UPS has emphasized linking HR with business objectives and uses communication and intranet programs to ensure that employees are kept constantly informed on business objectives and workforce challenges. One well-recognized component at UPS is the established codes of conduct that are consistently reviewed with all employees. These reviews include specific examples of ethical situations that employees may face and how to respond to them. Annually, managers complete a “conduct code” report that asks specific questions about ethical problems that have arisen during the year. These three firms are in different industries, have different cultures, and use a variety of HR efforts. However, each of them has been recognized for implementing HR as core to their organizational cultures and successful business results.51 QUESTIONS 1. How does the integration of HR with the organizational culture contribute to the success of Google, Scripps, and UPS? To find ideas, go to the corporate website for each of these companies and search for additional insights. 2. Discuss how some of the cultural facets mentioned compare to those among employers you have worked for, and explain the difference in the views of these various employers. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 33 26/06/10 3:28 PM 34 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Phillips Furniture Sysco This case describes a small company that has grown large enough to need a full-time HR person. You have been selected to be the HR manager, and you have to decide what HR activities are needed and the role HR is to play. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) As a large food services and distribution firm, Sysco had to revise its HR management. Review this case and identify how the Sysco changes modified HR’s importance. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) N O T E S 1. Based on “Where the Jobs Are,” HR Magazine, March 2009, 18; Peter Coy, Help Wanted,” BusinessWeek, May 11, 2009, 40–45; “HR’s Insight into the Economy,” SHRM Workplace Visions, No. 4 (2008), www.shrm.org/research. 2. Alan Clardy, “Human Resource Development and the ResourceBased Model of Core Competencies,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 387–407. 3. “What Is Human Capital?” SHRM Knowledge Center, August 22, 2008, www.shrm.org/TemplatesTools. 4. Sheila Bonini, et al., “Rebuilding Corporate Reputations,” The McKinsey Quarterly, June 2009, www.mckinseyquarterly.com. 5. Scott Flander, “The HR Personality,” Human Resource Executive, February 2008, 1, 20–32. 6. Charles Rothrock and David Gregory, “How Corporate Culture Affects Organizational Value,” SHRM White Paper, April 1, 2006, www.shrm.org. 7. “Creativity and Innovation,” SHRM Workplace Visions, No. 1 (2007), 1–8. 8. Geert Hofstede, Culture’s Consequences: Comparing Values, Behaviors, Institutions, and Organizations Across Cultures, 2nd ed. (Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage, 2001); John W. Bing, “Hofstede’s Consequences: The Impact of His Work on Consulting and Business Practices,” Academy of Management Executive, February 2004, 80–87. 9. Michael Mandel, “Productivity’s Up and That’s a Worry,” BusinessWeek, May 25, 2009, 22–23. 10. Dirk Matten and Jeremy Moon, “‘Implicit and Explicit’ CSR: A Conceptual Framework for a 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. Comparative Understanding of Corporate Social Responsibility,” Academy of Management Review, 33 (2008), 404–424. Adrienne Fox, “Corporate Social Responsibility Pays Off,” HR Magazine, August 2007, 43–47. “Socially Responsible Jobs Most Popular,” USA Today, May 14, 2009, 6D. “Can Sustainability Initiatives Survive in a Tough Economy?” SHRM Workplace Visions, No. 2 (2009), 1–6. Based on “Green Jobs and Programs on the Rise,” WorldatWork Newsline, April 22, 2009; Don Sanford and Sara Duffy, “Going Green: A Means to Attract and Retain,” WorkSpan, May 2009, 100–106; Nancy H. Woodword, “New Breed of Human Resource Leader: Going Green . . .,” HR Magazine, June 2008, 52–61. Kjell A. Brekke and Karine Nyborg, “Attracting Responsible Employees: Green Productions as Labor Market Screening,” Resource & Energy Economics, 30 (2008), 509–526. “Social Responsibility and HR Strategy,” SHRM Workplace Visions, No. 2 (2007), 1–8. Rebecca M.J. Wells, “Outstanding Customer Satisfaction: The Key to a Talented Workforce?” Academy of Management Perspectives, August 2007, 87–89. Jenna McGregor, “When Service Means Survival,” BusinessWeek, March 2, 2009, 26–33. “Highly Engaged Workers More Productive, Less likely to Quit,” WorldatWork Newsline, April 2, 2009. Lydell C. Bridgeford, “Employers, Workers Clash over Social 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. Networks,” Employee Benefit News, June 9, 2009, http:ebn-benefitsnews .com. Lauren Leader-Chivee and Ellen Cowan, “Networking the Way to Success: On-line Social Networks for Workplace and Competitive Advantage,” People and Strategy, 30 (2008), 40–46. K. Koonmee, et al., “Ethics Institutionalized, Quality of Work Life, and Employee Related Outcomes,” Journal of Business Research, 63 (2010), 20–26. Sean Valentine, “Human Resource Management, Ethical Context, and Personnel Consequences,” forthcoming Journal of Business Research Online, 62 (2009). Theresa Minton Eversole, “JobBoard Industry Addresses Ethical Concerns,” 2008 HR Trendbook, 30. Ethics Resource Center, www.ethics .org. Based on Michael O’Brien, “‘Idol’izing Ethics,” Human Resource Executive Online, May 16, 2009. Alexandria Ardichvilli, et al., “Characteristics of Ethical Business Cultures,” Journal of Business Ethics, 85 (2009), 445–451. Scott Sonenshein, “The Role of Construction, Intuition, and Justification in Responding to Ethical Issues at Work,” Academy of Management Review, 32 (2007), 1022–1040. Frank Kilmo, “Stricter Ethical Standards Called Key to Global Recovery,” February 18, 2009, HR News, www.shrm.org. Jean Thilmany, “Supporting Ethical Employees,” HR Magazine, September 2007, 105–112. To view the code of ethics and its development, go to www.shrm.org. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 34 26/06/10 3:28 PM CHAPTER 1 35 Human Resource Management in Organizations 32. “Occupational Employment Projections to 2016,” Monthly Labor Review, November 2007, www.bls.gov. 33. “The Hardest Jobs to Fill in America,” Forbes, June 4, 2009, www.Forbes.com. 34. Mary Siegfried, “Skilled Talent, Not Technology, Drives Value,” Inside Supply Management, May 2009, 26–27; McKinsey and Company, The Talent Factor in Purchasing, 2007, www.McKinsey.com. 35. For composition of HR membership in SHRM, go to www.shrm.org. 36. Karen Colligan, “Is Your Company Ready for the Brain Drain?” Workspan, October 2008, 97–99. 37. Based on a variety of publications, including www.wikipedia.com; Frank Giancola, “Getting Up to Speed on the HR Blogosphere,” WorldatWork, March 31, 2009, www.worldatwork.org; and “Managing the Tweets,” BusinessWeek, June 1, 2009, 20–21. 38. Small Business by the Numbers and other reports from the U.S. Small Business Administration, www.sba.gov. 39. Levent Altinay, et al., “Exploring the Relationship Between the Human Resource Practices and Growth in Small Service Firms,” Service Industries Journal, 28 (2008), 919–937. 40. For example, see John Sullivan, “HR’s Dinosaurs,” Workforce Management, March 26, 2007, 58ff.; Keith Hammond, “Why We Hate HR,” Fast Company, August 2005, 40. 41. Leon Rubis, “HR Is Easier Said than Done, Says Jack Welch,” May 5, 2009, HR News, www.shrm.org. 42. Dave Ulrich, “Are You a Change Agent?” Workforce Management, June 9, 2008, 22–23. 43. “Examining Strategic Versus Transitional Approaches to HR,” Proven Results: Research Meets Real World (Norcross, GA: EmployEase, 2009), www .employease.com. 44. Jessica Marquez, “Not the Usual Suspects,” Workforce Management, November 5, 2007, 23–30. 45. David McCann, “Memo to CFOs: Don’t Trust HR,” March 10, 2009, www.CFO.com. 46. Dave Ulrich, et al., HR Competencies (Alexandria, VA: SHRM, 2008). 47. Amanda Benedict, et al., “Leading Now, Leading the Future: What Senior HR Leaders Need to Know,” SHRM Executive Summary, February 2009, 1–23. 48. HR Department Benchmarks and Analysis (Washington, DC: Bureau of National Affairs). For more details, go to www.bna.com. 49. Kris Dunn, “What Are HR Certifications Worth?” Workforce Management Online, December 2007, www.workforce.com. 50. “A New Seat at the Table,” Employee Benefit News, September 1, 2008, 28–32. 51. Fay Hansen, “Special Report: The HR Profession—HR at America’s Most Admired Companies,” Workforce Management, June 23, 2008, 1, 24–32; Bob King, “Packard: Creating a Great Culture Makes for Great TV,” Workspan, October 2008, 23–28; Richard Stolz, “What HR Will Stand For,” Human Resource Executive, January 2003, 20–28. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_01_ch01_p001-035.indd 35 26/06/10 3:28 PM C H A P T E R 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Summarize the strategic planning process and how it drives the organizational activities. • Outline how strategic HR management is linked to the organizational strategies. • Discuss how internal and external environmental factors affect HR strategies. • List HR strategic challenges faced by modern organizations. • Explain how technology is affecting HR management practices and employees. • Identify how organizations can measure and assess the effectiveness of HR management practices. 36 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 36 26/06/10 3:30 PM HR Headline Strategic Utilization of Talent Benefits Health Care Organization L Courtesy of Lee Memorial Health System. ee Memorial Health System tapped its workers’ heads and hearts to resuscitate the organization. In 2008, economic conditions put Ft. Myers’s largest employer on life support, and this key provider of health care turned to its employees to reduce costs and prevent layoffs. Because front-line workers are closer to the action than supervisors, they can more easily spot inefficiencies and waste. Lee Memorial’s HR staff encouraged middle managers to hold honest, frank discussions with their staff to explain the urgency of the situation. Getting the attention of employees was not especially difficult because many of them had been personally touched by the national economic crisis. Helping employees make the connection between organizational health and their job security led to outstanding results for both the hospital and its staff. Employees and physicians involved in a lean/Six Sigma project identified areas for cost reduction. Improved patient flow saved the hospital $5 million. Modifying the employee Paid Time Off (PTO) program to be consistent with other local employers saved $4 million. In total, Lee Memorial Health System reduced costs by $45 million and increased revenues by $25 million. A major success was that Lee Memorial saved 200 positions that had been slated for layoffs. The approach of Lee Memorial’s managers in actively soliciting and engaging employees demonstrates the value of sharing information about organizational business conditions with employees and giving them a stake in the outcomes. Putting the survival of the organization on every employee’s radar allowed Lee Memorial to gain a competitive advantage through effective utilization of its human resources.1 37 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 37 26/06/10 3:33 PM 38 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management The strategy an organization follows is its proposition for how to compete successfully and thereby survive and grow. Several different approaches to strategy formation exist. Most organizations have a relatively formal process for developing a written strategy encompassing a 5-year period with objectives and goals for each unit. Strategic decisions relate to using resources in such a way that the organization can outperform its competitors. Organizations seek to achieve and maintain a competitive advantage in the marketplace by delivering high-quality products and services to their customers in a way that competitors cannot duplicate. Strategies might include revising existing products, acquiring new businesses, or developing new products or services using existing capabilities. Other strategic approaches might be to maintain a secure position with a single stable product (like WD-40) or to emphasize a constant stream of new products (like Apple). These are all viable strategies for different businesses, but the strategies chosen will determine the number, nature, and capabilities of people needed in the organization. Further, the people already in the organization may limit the strategies that might be successful.2 Regardless of which specific strategies are adopted for guiding an organization, having the right people in the right place at the right time will be critical to make the overall strategies work. If a strategy requires worker skills that are currently not available in the company, it will require time to find and hire people with those skills. Strategic HR management entails providing input into organizational strategic planning and developing specific HR initiatives to help achieve the organizational goals. While it seems important to consider Strategy An organization’s HR in the overall organizational strategy, estimates are that only 30% of HR proposition for how to professionals are full strategic partners. Their primary role remains that of compete successfully and providing input to top management.3 thereby survive and grow. Although HR administrative and legally mandated tasks are important, strategic HR means adding value by improving the performance of the business. Some businesses are highly dependent on human capital for a competitive advantage; others are less so. For LOGGING ON example, the productivity of a steel mill depends more on People Trak—Strategic P gic HR the efficiency of furnaces and quality of raw materials than Software S on human resources. However, every business strategy must TThis firm provides strategic gic human be carried out by people, and therefore human capital is a resources management and planning vital element to business success. An important aspect of software for organizations. ns. Visit their strategic HR management covered in this chapter is the website at www.people-trak.com/ -trak.com/ measurement and determination of the value of human strategic_hr.asp. capital and HR practices.4 STRATEGIC PLANNING Strategic planning The process of defining organizational strategy and allocating resources toward its achievement. Strategic planning is the process of defining an organizational strategy, or direction, and making decisions on allocating the resources of the organization (capital and people) to pursue this strategy. Successful organizations engage in this core business process on an ongoing basis. The plan serves as the roadmap that gives the organization direction and aligns resources. The process involves several sequential steps that focus on the future of the organization.5 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 38 26/06/10 3:34 PM CHAPTER 2 39 Strategic HR Management and Planning FIGURE 2-1 Strategic Planning Process Organizational Mission SWOT Analysis Establish Goals and Objectives Formulate Organizational Strategy Formulate Supporting Functional Strategies Implement Evaluate and Reassess Strategy Formulation Organizational mission The core reason for the existence of the organization and what makes it unique. The strategic planning cycle typically covers a 5-year time frame, and management considers both internal and external forces when formulating the strategic plan. Figure 2-1 shows the strategic planning process for the organization.6 The guiding force behind the strategic planning process is the organizational mission, which is the core reason for the existence of the organization and what makes it unique. The mission statement is usually determined by the organizational founders or leaders and sets the general direction for the organization. The planning process begins with an assessment of the current state of the business and the environmental forces that may be important during the planning cycle. Analysis of the strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats (SWOT) is a typical starting point because it allows managers to consider both internal and external conditions, which are discussed in more detail later in the chapter. The analysis helps managers to formulate a strategic plan Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 39 26/06/10 3:34 PM 40 SECTION 1 Strategic HR management Refers to the use of employees to gain or maintain a competitive advantage. Environment of Human Resource Management that considers the organizational ability to deal with the situation at hand.7 The planning process is an ongoing cycle with managers continuously monitoring and responding to changes in the environment and competitive conditions. Managers then determine the objectives for the planning cycle and formulate organization-level strategies to accomplish those objectives. Each function within the organization then formulates strategies that will link to and support the organization-level strategies. The strategic plan is evaluated periodically because conditions may change and managers must react to the ever-changing environment. Strategic HR management refers to the use of human resource management (HRM) practices to gain or keep a competitive advantage. Talent acquisition, talent deployment, talent development, and rewarding talent are all strategic HRM approaches that can impact the organizational ability to achieve its strategic objectives.8 The focus of HR initiatives is evolving from a traditional emphasis to a strategic emphasis, as detailed in Figure 2-2. Because business strategies affect HR FIGURE 2-2 Traditional HR versus Strategic HR FOCUS TRADITIONAL HR STRATEGIC HR Micro Macro Narrow skill application Broad skill application Organization Administration Compliance Transactional Tactical Strategic Planning Diagnostic Analytical (metrics) Consultative Head count Cost-based Exploitable resource Contributors Asset-based Critical resource Planning outlook Short-term Low-risk Traditional: utilizes triedand-true approaches Long-term High-risk Experimental: tries novel approaches HR systems and practices Routine, traditional Reactive Responds to stated needs Adaptive, innovative Anticipatory, proactive Recognizes unstated needs Traditional HRM generalists and specialists Other specialties Business acumen Comprehensive HRM body of knowledge Organizational development View of organization Critical skills View of employees Education and training Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 40 26/06/10 3:34 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 41 plans and policies, consideration of human resource issues should be part of the strategy formulation process. Strategic HR deals with the contributions that HR strategies make to achieving organizational effectiveness and competitive advantage and how these HR contributions are accomplished. Therefore, HR should be involved in implementing strategies that affect and are influenced by people.9 An important element of strategic HRM is to develop processes in the organization that help align individual employee performance with the organizational strategic objectives. When employees understand the organizational priorities, they can better contribute by applying their skills to advance the organizational strategic goals. Employees who understand the “big picture” can make decisions that will contribute to the objectives of the firm. HRM practices that facilitate this include talent development and reward systems that channel employee efforts toward the organizational bottom line.10 Strategic Competencies for HR Professionals The HR professional wears many hats and must possess a wide variety of skills to successfully contribute at the strategic planning table. The following six primary strategic competencies are critical for HR professionals:11 • • • • • • Credible Activist: challenges assumptions and offers a point of view Culture and Change Steward: shapes the organizational culture, makes changes happen Talent Manager/Organization Designer: acquires and deploys talent, embeds capabilities into the organizational structure Strategy Architect: recognizes business trends, forecasts potential obstacles to business success, and builds overall strategy Operational Executor: efficiently and effectively carries out tactical HR activities Business Ally: understands the business value chain, and establishes internal partnerships with line managers Operationalizing HR Management Strategies Specific HR management strategies depend on the strategies and plans of the organization. Figure 2-3 highlights some common areas where HR should develop and implement appropriate strategies.12 To contribute in a meaningful way in the strategic planning process, HR professionals provide the perspective and expertise to managers by performing the following functions: • Understand the business: Knowing the financials and key drivers of business success are important to understanding the need for certain strategies. • Focus on the key business goals: Programs that have the greatest relevance to business objectives should get priority. • Know what to measure: Metrics are a vital part of assessing success, which means picking those measures that directly relate to the business goals. • Prepare for the future: Strategic thinking requires preparing for the future, not focusing on the past—except as a predictor of the future. HR AS ORGANIZATIONAL CONTRIBUTOR In organizations where there are identifiable core competencies related to people, HR practices play a significant strategic role in enhancing organizational effectiveness. Effective management of talent provides managers with Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 41 26/06/10 3:34 PM 42 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Strategic Human Resource Management FIGURE 2-3 Organization/Senior Management Mission statement Objectives/strategies Human Resources Mission statement Objectives/strategies Strategic Level Staffing Total rewards Employee/labor relations Training and development Performance management Operational Level Staffing Total rewards Employee/labor relations Training and development Performance management Measurement Effectiveness Efficiency Legal compliance high-quality human resources to carry out the organizational strategies. As discussed in Chapter 1, strategic HR management plays a significant role in the following strategies: • • • Organizational productivity Customer service and quality Financial contributions. High-Performance Work Practices A wide array of data from both academics and consulting firms shows that HR practices really do make a significant difference to business outcomes. Many HR “Best Practices” are identified in chapters throughout this book. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 42 26/06/10 3:34 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 43 The examples will illustrate how HR strategies that foster these practices pay off for both employers and employees. Some recognized HR best practices include:13 • • • • • Incentive compensation: Pay-for-performance systems that tie employee rewards directly to successful performance of job responsibilities Training: Talent development programs to ensure that all employees have the proper knowledge, skills, and abilities to perform their jobs and to grow with the organization Employee participation: Soliciting and using employee ideas and suggestions to give employees a sense of importance and value to the organization Selectivity: Setting stringent hiring standards to maintain a high level of quality when bringing employees into the organization Flexible work arrangements: Providing alternative work schedules to help employees balance their personal and professional lives Organizations that implement such practices have increased return on assets by 5% and reduced employment turnover by 20%. Research has also shown that market value, return on equity, and other operational performance measures are better in organizations that adopt high-performance work practices.14 HR Effectiveness and Financial Performance Effectiveness The ability to produce a specific desired effect or result that can be measured. Efficiency The degree to which operations are done in an economical manner. Effectiveness for organizations is a measure of the ability of a program, project, or task to produce a specific desired effect or result that can be measured. Efficiency is the degree to which operations are done in an economical manner. Efficiency can also be thought of as a short-term measure that compares inputs and costs directly against outputs and benefits. HR management and financial executives work together to make certain that HR practices contribute financially to organizational effectiveness. There are many different ways of measuring the financial contributions of HR and many challenges associated with doing so. Return on investment (ROI) is a common measure used by financial professionals to assess the value of an investment. For example, if a firm invests $20,000 for a supervisory training program, what does it gain in lower worker compensation costs, lower legal costs, higher employee productivity, and lower employee turnover? The benefits of HR programs are not always immediately visible which is what makes measuring HR’s impact such a challenge. However, efforts should be made to financially assess HR practices.15 Later in this chapter the discussion of HR metrics will highlight some specific HR measurement approaches. The HR Perspective discusses an interesting approach at IBM to harness the power of numbers in managing human resources. ENVIRONMENTAL ANALYSIS Environmental scanning The assessment of internal and external environmental conditions that affect the organization. Before the managers in an organization begin strategic planning, they study and assess the dynamics of the environment in which they operate to better understand how these conditions might affect their plans. The process of environmental scanning helps to pinpoint strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats that the organization will face during the planning horizon. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 43 26/06/10 3:35 PM 44 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management HR perspective Numbers Add Up for IBM Turning workers into numbers sounds not only difficult but also somewhat insensitive and heartless. However, mathematical models are helping IBM to harness human resources and allow its employees to thrive. IBM has long relied on detailed data and sophisticated algorithms to manage its supply chain and manufacturing processes, but the business has changed. IBM has shifted to a focus on services rather than building computer hardware. This increases the need to optimize the workforce so that the right individuals are available when customers need specific talents. Building a profile for each employee involves determining the specific knowledge and strengths of each worker. Résumés and project records are used to identify skills and experiences. Online calendars, cell phones, and PDAs show how employees use their time and who they interact with. Call records and emails define the social network each employee has developed. This inventory of talent can be used by managers to better schedule work and create project teams. Think of the manager who needs to deploy a team to work on assignment for a particular client. She could sit down and put the dates and skills needed into the talent inventory system. The results would come back telling her which workers are available with the right skill set, whether several proposed team members have worked together in the past, and how much they are paid. She would then be able to configure the ideal team within the budget limits. Talent development could be enhanced by reviewing the combination of skills and experiences that high performers possess. To build the strength of the talent pipeline, employees could be “cloned” to duplicate successful employees based upon their profiles. The social networks of employees could be tapped to identify prospective employees or customers. Scheduling of workers would be aided by defining their skills and matching them to the thousands of small tasks that need to be accomplished on each project. Although IBM has just begun mining the data and building the mathematical models to utilize human resources, the future will be based less on guesswork and more on proven formulas for success.16 The internal environment includes the quality and quantity of talent, the organizational culture, and the talent pipeline and leadership bench strength. The external environment includes many economic, political, and competitive forces that will shape the future. Figure 2-4 shows the HR elements of a SWOT analysis.17 Internal Environmental Analysis The strengths and weaknesses of the organization represent factors within the organization that either create or destroy value. When assessing the internal environment, managers evaluate the quantity and quality of human resources, HR practices, and the organizational culture. The organizational culture is discussed at greater length in Chapter 1. The strength of the talent pipeline is particularly important as the organization plans its future. Fulfilling strategic objectives is impossible without sufficient skills and talent. Leadership development and succession planning programs ensure that high-quality talent will be available to carry out the strategy. Effective development programs can reduce the high failure rate of people in leadership positions. Selecting individuals with the right talents Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 44 26/06/10 3:35 PM CHAPTER 2 45 Strategic HR Management and Planning FIGURE 2-4 HR Factors in the SWOT Analysis Strengths Intellectual capital Loyal, committed employees Innovative, adaptive employees High-performance practices Weaknesses Lack of skilled employees Lack of leadership pipeline Outdated talent management practices Opportunities Market position Unexplored markets Global expansion Technology advances Threats Legal mandates and restrictions Competitor power Economic uncertainty Talent shortage and teaching them leadership skills can improve the quality of leaders and promote strategic success. Succession planning is the process of identifying a plan for the orderly replacement of key employees. The succession plan is the blueprint for managing the internal talent pipeline. Managers identify individuals who can fulfill new roles in the future and include them in the succession plan. This internal pool of talent is the reserve needed to meet the objectives in the strategic plan.18 Succession planning is explained in greater detail in Chapter 9. External Environmental Analysis Opportunities and threats emerge from the external environment and can impact the outcomes for the organization. Many of these forces are not within the organizational control, but must be considered in the scanning process. Dealing with uncertainty in the external environment is becoming a critical skill for planners.19 The external environmental scan includes an assessment of economic conditions, legislative/political influences, demographic changes, and geographic and competitive issues, as shown in Figure 2-5. Succession planning The process of identifying a plan for the orderly replacement of key employees. Economic Conditions The prevailing business climate will affect strategic planning because the future is shaped by current conditions. Productivity levels, interest rates, economic growth, consumer prices, inflation, and unemployment rates affect the business outlook. Access to credit, capital, and labor affect the organizational ability to grow and to provide desired rewards to employees. During times of high economic growth, labor and material shortages are more likely. During economic downturns, resources are underutilized and organizations seek to increase productivity and to lower costs. When facing difficult economic conditions, firms may react by implementing severe workforce reductions, compensation cuts, and other drastic measures to remain viable.20 These actions have strategic implications for the organization because they may leave the organization vulnerable when the economy improves. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 45 26/06/10 3:35 PM 46 SECTION 1 FIGURE 2-5 Environment of Human Resource Management Areas of External Environmental Scan Economic Legislative & Political Demographic Geographic & Competitive Inflation rates can influence the revenue stream for the organization as well as employee expectations regarding compensation. As the unemployment rate rises, the number of qualified people looking for work increases. This poses challenges for the organizations because the sheer volume of applicants can overwhelm the selection process. Legislative/Political Influences An expanding and often bewildering collection of government regulations affects the labor market and organization practices. Consideration of current and pending legislation should be a part of the assessment process because new mandates might impact how the organization operates during the planning horizon. Legislation regarding taxes, labor unions, compensation, benefits, employment, and safety and health affect the HR practices in all organizations. Many aspects of the employment relationship are regulated, and strategic planning must be done with these restrictions in mind. The social and regulatory priorities of political parties also influence how business operates, with particular programs gaining or losing support. In summary, an organization considers a complex variety of government policies, regulations, and laws during the strategic planning process. Demographic Changes Significant demographic changes are occurring that will impact the composition of the future workforce. The U.S. Census Bureau projects that by 2042 non-Hispanic whites will no longer comprise the majority of the U.S. population.21 These population shifts and demographic changes can affect the organizational strategy in several ways. Consumer demographics influence the demand for products and services. For example, as the population ages, demand for medical services and assistive devices will increase. Workforce demographics will also affect the quality and quantity of labor available to the organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 46 26/06/10 3:35 PM CHAPTER 2 47 Strategic HR Management and Planning HR best practices NASA Launches Workforce Realignment In 2010 the space shuttle program will be discontinued and thousands of NASA engineers and scientists will be affected. The Constellation program, which will succeed the space shuttle program, will not launch for 5 years. If the skilled shuttle staffers decide to retire rather than wait for the replacement program, NASA will face a serious knowledge gap. NASA administrators must determine what people and skills will be needed to develop the Constellation program. Employees who do not have the critical skills may be allowed to leave or laid off. However, a congressional ban prohibits massive layoffs at the space agency. Also, a government panel is studying manned spaceflight programs to determine if the shuttle should truly be taken out of service. All of the uncertainty facing NASA and its employees creates a major challenge of keeping employees engaged and committed. Leaders have been making themselves more visible, holding “all-hands” meetings, and communicating more frequently. Websites provide news on the transition and help employees to find new jobs. HR staff is working with managers to map the skills for the next program and comparing them to the skills of the current workers. They have found that systems engineering and project management skills are lacking, and they are developing training to fill the skill shortages. Fortunately, training for the transition has not disrupted current operations. The remainder of transition period will be devoted to transferring those skills to the retained employees. In addition to the tangible transition issues, there are intangible issues such as dealing with fear of the unknown, breaking up of teams that have worked together for years, and grief for the end of a program that many individuals worked on their entire careers. Dealing with the stress and honoring the value of the shuttle program are helping employees to maintain morale and optimism while facing a new frontier.22 Among the factors influencing workforce diversity are age, gender, generational differences, race, and ethnicity. Managers assess changes in the workforce composition because the diverse needs and expectations of a heterogenous workforce require creative and flexible solutions. A one-size-fits-all approach to recruitment, compensation, training, and performance management will no longer be effective. The anticipated retirement of baby boomers in the near future will leave many organizations without sufficient skilled talent. NASA faces a serious workforce issue, and the HR Best Practices box describes their strategy for dealing with it. LOGGING ON Society for Human Resource Management The Society for Human Resource Management is the largest association devoted to Human Resource Management. Some of the most essential and comprehensive resources available for Human Resource professionals are contained within the SHRM website at www.shrm.org. Geographic and Competitive Concerns The local industrial base and economic conditions affect the strategic planning process. Where an organization locates its operations plays a role in how well it will perform. Being located in an industry hub (like Silicon Valley for IT firms) provides the infrastructure and supply base the organization needs to succeed. The local industry is centered on the particular industry, and resources, including skilled talent, are more readily available. If operations are located in a sparsely populated area, the organization will face staffing challenges if the strategy involves substantial growth. An understanding of geographic advantages and disadvantages can help managers develop appropriate plans. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 47 26/06/10 3:35 PM 48 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Competitors exist in both the product and labor markets. Competition in the product market determines the potential for the organization. If the organization is in a highly competitive industry (such as consumer electronics), strategies for growth rely heavily on innovation and driving down product costs. Competition in the labor market establishes the pricing for high-quality talent and determines the availability of workers. A detailed competitive analysis in both product and labor markets provides important information to managers regarding the possibility of meeting strategic objectives. GLOBAL COMPETITIVENESS AND STRATEGIC HR G L O B A L The globalization of business has meant that more organizations now operate across borders with ties to foreign operations, international suppliers, vendors, employees, and other business partners. A global presence can range from importing and exporting to operating as a multinational corporation (MNC). An MNC, sometimes called a “transnational corporation,” is a corporation that has facilities and other assets in at least one country other than its home country. Because human resources are considered assets, the definition of MNC covers a large number of companies. Global Framework Mastering the global complexities of managing human resources is important not only for HR results, but also for the overall success of the organization. Companies operating globally must deliver basic HR services while also overcoming various operational, cultural, and organizational obstacles.23 Even organizations that operate primarily in the domestic market face pressure from foreign competitors. The supply chain is increasingly internationally dispersed, and foreign business practices influence operations in the United States. Technology advances have eliminated many barriers to operating on a global scale. In addition, workers from numerous countries may seek employment in the United States, and managers and HR professionals must be prepared to deal with the needs of this labor force.24 Having a global HR mind-set means looking at HR issues from an international perspective, using ideas and resources throughout the world, and ensuring openness to other cultures and ideas. To effectively compete on an international scale, the organization needs expertise to administer all HR activities in a wide range of nations. Policies and practices should be established to address the unique demands for operating in a global context. Managers determine which policies should be standardized and which should be tailored for each locale.25 For example, the organization may decide to standardize talent development and succession planning but permit local managers to establish compensation and labor relations policies. An ideal international approach strikes a balance between home-country and host-country policies that utilizes the best practices within the organization. The following sections address specific issues that should be considered when formulating international strategies. Multinational corporation (MNC) A corporation that has facilities and other assets in at least one country other than its home country. Global Legal and Regulatory Factors Globally-operating organizations must be aware of widely varying legal and regulatory systems due to politics, economic differences, and other factors. Emerging economies, in particular, pose major challenges to smooth operations and reliable Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 48 26/06/10 3:35 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 49 conditions.26 Having to know about and comply with laws on many HR-related issues is crucial. Therefore, senior executives and HR professional must review each country’s legal and regulatory factors, both before and during ongoing operations. Also they must be trained in how to deal with the nuances of the requirements in each country. Offshoring Competitive pressure to lower costs has resulted in many jobs being moved overseas in recent years. Offshoring is the relocation by a company of a business process or operation from one country to another. Firms offshore the production of goods as well as the delivery of services to lower-wage countries. Call centers in India are an example of business service offshoring to countries with well-educated, English-speaking workers. Product and software development projects are increasingly being offshored due to the loss of science and engineering talent in the United States. Predictions are that offshoring will increase in the future, and few firms have plans to return offshored jobs to the home country.27 Decisions to offshore operations are made as part of a broader strategic assessment. Economic conditions in both the domestic and global marketplace, the loss of intellectual talent and institutional knowledge, and the potential for lower quality are all issues that managers face. To maximize the success of offshoring, organizations should utilize the following approaches:28 • • • Design work processes to allow workers to hand off the project from one to the next. Open the channels of communication by investing in technologies to support real-time interaction. Build common ground by sharing knowledge across locations. Global Staffing Offshoring The relocation by a company of a business process or operation from one country to another. Staffing for global operations includes a wide variety of alternatives. The optimal solution is to combine the expertise of local employees with the organization-specific knowledge of employees from the home country (headquarters). Some countries require that the organization employ a certain percentage of workers from the host country. Figure 2-6 shows four strategic approaches to international staffing. Each organization will use a staffing model that best fits its culture and strategic goals. An expatriate is an employee living and working in a different country from where he or she is a citizen. Moving an employee to an overseas assignment for an extended period requires careful selection, training, and planning to make the experience a success.29 The return of an expatriate (called repatriation) must be well planned and executed for the organization to gain the benefits of the overseas assignment. Leadership development is especially important for MNCs. It is becoming more important for individuals in top management positions to have international experience so that they understand the worldwide marketplace. Effective selection and development processes are needed to ensure that the right individuals are chosen for these roles. Leading across cultures requires specific skills, and organizations should provide formal training along with expatriate assignments to develop leaders who can achieve results in this demanding environment.30 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 49 26/06/10 3:35 PM 50 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Strategic Approaches to International Staffing FIGURE 2-6 Ethnocentric Policy Managers from headquaters staff key positions Ensures control over subsidiary location operations Eases transfer of policies from headquarters to subsidiary Polycentric Policy Host-country nationals staff key positions Reduces cultural mishaps and misunderstanding Coordination with headquarters may be problematic Geocentric Policy An international cadre of skilled managers are assigned to global subsidiaries regardless of nationality Leverages technical and managerial expertise Regiocentric Policy Key positions are filled by individuals in the region of the subsidary (i.e., European Union countries) Capitalizes on cultural and language similiarities within the region HR PLANNING IN MERGERS AND ACQUISITIONS The overall purpose of a merger or acquisition is to generate shareholder value by creating a more competitive, cost-efficient company by combining two existing companies. Strategic HRM can contribute to the success of mergers and acquisitions (M&As). Research has clearly shown that the majority of M&As fail to deliver on the expected financial, marketing, or product gains, with only about one-third of companies reporting that they achieved their goals.31 A significant number of failed ventures can trace their roots to HR issues that were not properly addressed such as loss of key staff, culture clashes, and poor communication. To maximize the chances of a successful integration, HR should be involved before, during, and after the deal is completed. Figure 2-7 shows the HR activities and focus during each stage of the merger process. Before the Deal Due diligence A comprehensive assessment of all aspects of the business being acquired. To determine whether or not the two organizations should combine, a rigorous process of due diligence is conducted. Due diligence is a comprehensive assessment of all aspects of the business being acquired. Financial, sales and marketing, operations, and human resource staffs are all involved before the final decision is made to merge or acquire the company. Each function determines the assets and liabilities of the target company to ascertain whether there are serious risks to the buyer. HR professionals review issues related to legal compliance, compensation and benefits programs, quality of talent, and labor contract obligations. Early identification of potential problems such as underfunded Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 50 26/06/10 3:35 PM CHAPTER 2 51 Strategic HR Management and Planning HR Activities during M&A FIGURE 2-7 Before the Deal During Integration Du Post Integration P Conduct due diligence Assess risks Identify possible conflicts Address key HR processes Retain key talent Recognize cultural differences Optimize workforce Identify and establish new culture pension liabilities or incompatible labor agreements helps management plan for an orderly transition. Due diligence is even more complex when the M&A involves companies in different countries. A thorough, objective analysis of the HR-related issues is critical to make good business decisions.32 During Integration After the deal has been closed, the focus of HR activity switches to the orderly transition of basic HR processes such as payroll and benefits migration. During the first 60 days after the acquisition, HR must deliver highquality administrative and operational support to employees and managers. The immediate concerns are often about basic services needed to run the operations. Frequent communication, employee hotlines, and guidance for managers all contribute to employee retention and loyalty during the chaotic early days of the transition. Early in the transition, managers focus on identifying key talent and establishing initiatives to retain these critical employees. Retention bonuses, special assignments, and enhanced severance can be used to keep key talent in place during the integration stage.33 Integrating HR information systems is important to provide managers with information about employee capabilities, performance, and potential. The acquiring organization cannot make optimum human resource assessments without access to historical information on all employees. An inventory of knowledge, skills, and expertise along with performance information provide the data for making suitable assignments for employees from both organizations. Gathering all relevant HR information in a single database helps managers to analyze and compare employee skills and to make informed decisions about which employees should be retained. As the businesses are merged, culture conflicts will emerge. For example, when HP and Compaq merged in 2001, cultural differences were recognized and addressed. HP had a culture that fostered innovation by giving employees autonomy and opportunities for professional development. Compaq, on the other hand, was a fast-paced company that made decisions quickly. The merger has been successful because of the blending of the best parts of the culture in each company.34 Changing the organizational culture depends upon changing behavior in the organization. Four important factors in changing culture are:35 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 51 26/06/10 3:35 PM 52 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management • • • • Define the desired behaviors: Provide behavioral examples of how people are expected to act and tie these behaviors to the performance management system. Deploy role models: Select leaders that exemplify the desired behaviors and make them visible throughout the organization. Provide meaningful incentives: Reward the role models with recognition to reinforce their behavior and to signal the rest of the organization. Provide clear and consistent messages: Align what you say with what you do and reward. Post Integration To realize the expected benefits of a merger, the months following the initial integration are critical. Culture changes started in the early days must be maintained. Practical issues regarding talent management and development along with combining compensation systems will solidify the new, united organization. Failure to effectively blend the workforces and move beyond the “us-and-them” mentality can lead to inferior business results, a loss of shareholder value, and the failure of the merger. Continued change efforts are needed to bring all employees to the “one organization” mentality. Breaking down the barriers between the previous practices at each organization and implementing the best from both organizations will give employees a sense of value and importance. Ultimately, the outcomes of the deal result from how HR issues are addressed.36 The HR Perspective details the strategies that Dow uses to ensure that acquisitions deliver as promised. Dow’s Formula for Successful Acquisitions Dow is a diversified chemical company with $49 billion in annual revenues and 43,000 employees worldwide. Since its founding in 1897, much of the company growth has come through mergers and acquisitions. Because Dow’s acquisition activities are central to its organizational growth strategy, top leaders formulated an approach to ensure success. Although significant emphasis was placed on pre-deal activities, little was done to ensure the post-deal success. Various employees in operating units might work on the acquisition as a temporary assignment, but would return to their regular jobs after the deal was done. The implementation of the M&A Technology Center provided a systematic approach to handle the complicated process of acquiring and integrating new companies into the Dow corporate structure. The M&A Technology Center is staffed with a fulltime group of experts in the M&A process. Members of the Center document the processes used, gather HR perspective data to assess results, capture and share “lessons learned,” and create templates and tools for future use. The Center oversees all acquisition activity at Dow by drawing on the experience and skills of its staff. Due to the success of the Center, Dow leaders took the idea one step further and instituted the HR Center for Mergers and Acquisitions to address the unique HR tasks associated with integrating acquired companies. Staffed with seasoned professionals who can assess and make recommendations on issues related to labor relations, compensation and benefits, training, change management, and other HR disciplines, the HR Center is involved from the very beginning of each potential acquisition through final integration. The HR Center surveys Dow business leaders each year to assess the effectiveness of the process. Results have been very positive and indicate that HR has added high value to the M&A process at Dow.37 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 52 26/06/10 3:35 PM CHAPTER 2 53 Strategic HR Management and Planning STRATEGIC CHALLENGES Because the objective of strategic planning is to anticipate future events and conditions, managers should evaluate and revise the plan on a periodic basis. Some have called into question the value of strategic planning in light of the economic volatility in the recent past.38 However, organizations would fare much worse with no plan in place. Recent events highlight the impact of environmental forces on organizations and emphasize the need to remain watchful and attentive to changing conditions. Attracting and retaining the right talent is an ongoing challenge as the needs of the business change over time. The United States has continued to move from a manufacturing economy to a service economy. This shifting economic base leads to structural mismatches between workers and jobs. Workers with outdated skills are unable to fill the technical and health service jobs employers need. Ongoing retraining can help overcome these problems if strategic planning has identified them.39 Organizations need to plan for both the quantity and quality of the workforce over the planning horizon. Having sufficient workers with the right qualifications is essential to achieve the strategic plan. If the firm employs too many people for its needs, a talent surplus exists; if too few, a talent shortage. Because of the rapidly changing conditions, the organization may face a surplus in some parts of the business while facing a shortage in others. Figure 2-8 shows the tactics organizations might use to deal with talent supply imbalances. FIGURE 2-8 Managing Talent Supply Imbalances MANAGING A TALENT SURPLUS MANAGING A TALENT SHORTAGE Reduce employee work hours or compensation Increase employee work hours through overtime Attrition Outsource to a third party Freeze hiring Implement alternative work arrangements Voluntary separation programs Use contingent workers (temporaries, independent contractors) Downsizing/reduction in force (RIF) Reduce employee turnover Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 53 26/06/10 3:35 PM 54 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Managing a Talent Surplus A talent surplus can be managed within a strategic HR plan in a number of ways. The reasons for the surplus will guide the ultimate steps taken by the organization. If the workforce has the right qualifications but the sales revenue has fallen, the primary strategies would involve retaining workers while cutting costs. However, if the workforce is not appropriately trained for the jobs needed, the organization may lay off those employees who cannot perform the work. Managers may use various strategies in a progressive fashion to defer workforce reductions until absolutely necessary.40 Reduction in Work Hours or Compensation In order to retain qualified employees, managers may institute reduced work hours on a temporary basis. Selected groups of employees may have their workweek reduced or all employees can be asked to take a day or week off without pay. For example, Zurn Plumbing Service, a small family-owned company, asked its 15 full-time workers to take a day off without pay each week in order to keep all of them on the payroll and avoid layoffs.41 When the economy improves, these skilled employees will be available to handle the increased workload. Across-the-board pay cuts can reduce labor costs while retaining skilled employees. It is important that pay cuts start at the very top of the organization so that employees do not bear all of the hardship. Uniform pay cuts can be felt as a shared sacrifice for the survival of the firm. Organizations may also reduce employee benefits, such as eliminating matching 401K contributions or raising employee health insurance premiums. HR should closely monitor the situation and reinstate pay and benefits levels when the economic outlook improves to maintain employee loyalty and a sense of fairness. Attrition and Hiring Freezes Attrition occurs when individuals quit, die, or retire and are not replaced. By use of attrition, no one is cut out of a job, but those who remain must handle the same workload with fewer people. Unless turnover is high, attrition will eliminate only a relatively small number of employees in the short run, but it can be a viable alternative over a longer period of time. Therefore, employers may combine attrition with a freeze on hiring. Employees usually understand this approach better than they do other downsizing methods. Voluntary Separation Programs Organizations can reduce the workforce while also minimizing legal risks if employees volunteer to leave. Often firms entice employees to volunteer by offering them additional severance, training, and benefits payments. Early retirement buyouts are widely used to encourage more senior workers to leave organizations early. As an incentive, employers may offer expanded health coverage and additional buyout payments to employees so that they will not be penalized economically until their pensions and Social Security benefits take effect. These programs are viewed as a way to accomplish workforce reductions without resorting to layoffs. Voluntary separation programs appeal to employers because they can reduce payroll costs significantly over time. Although the organization faces some up-front costs, it does not incur as many continuing payroll costs. Using such programs is also viewed as a more humane way to reduce staff than terminating long-service, loyal employees. In addition, as long as buyouts are truly Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 54 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 55 voluntary, the organization offering them is less exposed to age discrimination suits. One drawback is that some employees the company would like to retain might take advantage of a buyout. Workforce Downsizing It has been given many names, including downsizing, rightsizing, and reduction in force (RIF), but it almost always means cutting employees.42 Layoffs on a broad scale have occurred with frightening regularity in recent years. Trimming underperforming units or employees as part of a plan that is based on sound organizational strategies may make sense. After a decade of many examples and studies, it is clear that downsizing has worked for some firms. However, it does not increase revenues; it is a short-term cost-cutting measure that can result in a long-term lack of talent. When companies cannibalize the human resources needed to change, restructure, or innovate, disruption follows for some time. Also, downsizing can hurt productivity by leaving “surviving” employees overburdened and demoralized. Best practices for companies carrying out layoffs include:43 • • • • • Identify the work that is core to sustaining a profitable business. Identify the knowledge, skills, and competencies needed to execute the business strategy. Protect the bottom line and the corporate brand. Constantly communicate with employees. Pay attention to the survivors. A common myth is that those who are still around after downsizing are so grateful to have a job that they pose no problems to the organization. However, some observers draw an analogy between those who survive downsizing and those who survive wartime battles. Bitterness, anger, disbelief, and shock all are common reactions. For those who survive workforce cuts, the culture and image of the firm as a “lifetime” employer often are gone forever.44 Severance benefits and outplacement services may be offered by companies to cushion the shock of layoffs and protect the company from litigation. Severance benefits are temporary payments made to laid-off employees to ease the financial burden of unemployment. One common strategy is to offer laid-off employees severance benefits that require employees to release the organization from legal claims. Severance benefits are typically based upon length of service with the company, often one or two weeks’ pay per year of service. Outplacement services are provided to give displaced employees support and assistance. Outplacement typically includes personal career counseling, résumé preparation services, interviewing workshops, and referral assistance. Such services are generally provided by outside firms that specialize in outplacement assistance and whose fees usually are paid by the employer. Assisting laid-off workers with gaining new employment can help to alleviate the financial burden on employees and preserve the company image.45 Legal Considerations for Workforce Reductions Severance benefits Temporary payments made to laid-off employees to ease the financial burden of unemployment. HR must be involved during workforce adjustments to ensure that the organization does not violate any of the nondiscrimination or other laws governing workforce reductions. Selection criteria for determining which employees will be laid off must comply with Title VII of the Civil Rights Act as well as the Age Discrimination in Employment Act and the Americans with Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 55 26/06/10 3:36 PM 56 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Disabilities Act. A careful analysis and disparate impact review should be conducted before final decisions are made.46 There is no legal requirement to provide severance benefits, and loss of medical benefits is a major problem for laid-off employees. However, under the federal Consolidated Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act (COBRA), displaced workers can retain their group medical coverage for up to 18 months for themselves, and for up to 36 months for their dependents, if they pay the premiums themselves. Federal stimulus programs in 2009 included enhanced COBRA coverage for displaced workers. Employers must also comply with the Older Workers Benefit Protection Act (OWBPA) when implementing RIFs. The OWBPA requires employers to disclose the ages of both terminated and retained employees in layoff situations, and a waiver of rights to sue for age discrimination must meet certain requirements. The worker must be given something of value (“consideration”) in exchange for the waiver of right to sue, typically severance benefits. When laying off a group of employees, workers over age 40 who are being laid off must be granted 45 days in which to consider accepting severance benefits and waiving their right to sue. To provide employees with adequate notice of plant closings or mass layoffs, a federal law was passed, the Worker Adjustment and Retraining Notification (WARN) Act. This law requires private or commercial organizations that employ 100 or more full-time workers who have worked more than 6 months in the previous year to give a 60-day notice before implementing a layoff or facility closing that involves more than 50 people. However, workers who have been employed less than 6 months in the prior year, as well as parttime staff members working fewer than 20 hours per week, are not counted toward the total of 50 employees. Despite not being formally counted to determine implementation of the law, these individuals should still be given some form of notice.47 The WARN Act imposes heavy fines on employers who do not follow the required process and give proper notice. Managing a Talent Shortage Managing a shortage of employees seems simple enough—simply hire more people. However, as mentioned earlier, there can be mismatches between the qualifications needed by employers and the skills possessed by workers. Manpower’s list of the 10 hardest jobs to fill in the United States includes engineers, nurses, teachers, IT staff, and skilled trades.48 For these jobs, there may not always be sufficient qualified workers to hire. Companies can use a number of alternative tactics to manage a talent shortage: • • • • • • Use overtime Outsource work Implement alternate work arrangements Bring back recent retirees Use contingent workers Reduce turnover The existing workers can work overtime to produce goods or services. This strategy can work on a short-term basis but is not a solution for a longer-term talent shortage. Workers may appreciate the extra hours and pay for awhile, but eventually fatigue sets in and productivity and quality may drop and injuries and absenteeism may increase. Reducing turnover of qualified employees should be an ongoing effort to maintain a talented workforce. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 56 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 57 Special attention may be required in times of talent shortages to hold on to skilled employees. Alternate work arrangements, nontraditional schedules that provide flexibility to employees, include job sharing and telecommuting. These are creative solutions to attract and retain skilled employees who want flexibility. Employees are given more freedom in determining when and how they will perform their jobs. These arrangements are not costly to the organization but do require management support and planning to be effective.49 Retirees may be rehired on a part-time or temporary basis to fill talent gaps. The advantage is that these individuals are already trained and can be productive immediately. Care must be taken not to interfere with pension payments or other benefits tied to retirement. The use of contingent employees, which are noncore employees who work at an organization on a temporary or as-needed basis, can provide short-term help. Professional employer organizations can lease employees to the firm, which is often a good solution for technical talent. Independent contractors can be hired on an as-needed basis to fill talent shortages. The use of independent contractors must be managed closely to ensure compliance with wage and hour, safety, and employee benefit statutes. When using contingent workers, special efforts are needed to assimilate them into the workforce and avoid an “us-andthem” mentality. Contingent workers fill an important need and managers can maximize their contributions through good employee relations practices. Outsourcing involves transferring the management and/or routine performance of a business function to an external service provider. Organizations in the United States outsource a wide variety of noncore functions in order to reduce costs or to obtain skills and expertise not available in the organization. A common LOGGING ON HR function that is outsourced is payroll. The organizaU.S. Department of Labor, Bureau tion pays an outside firm to administer its payroll and of Labor Statistics does not incur the fixed cost of a payroll department. This website contains data on workforce Highly skilled and complex tasks may be outsourced to composition and trends from the U.S. a firm with greater know-how and economies of scale.50 Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Planning and executing outsourced tasks should include Statistics. Visit the site at www.stats HR to ensure legal compliance and appropriate employee .bls.gov. integration. TECHNOLOGY CHALLENGES Alternate work arrangements Nontraditional schedules that provide flexibility to employees. Outsourcing Transferring the management and performance of a business function to an external service provider. Technological advances have a major impact on organizations. New methods for communicating, processing information, and manufacturing have led to economic development around the globe. Evolving technologies using math, science, and the arts can improve life and living conditions. However, the improvements created by technology often mean that people and organizations must change in order to fully benefit from these advances. Evolutions in technology will continue to present exciting, but difficult challenges to managers. Effects on Work and Organizations Jobs have undergone major changes as a result of technology advances. In many cases, monotonous, repetitive operations have evolved into complex knowledge work that requires a new skill set. Work that previously was Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 57 26/06/10 3:36 PM 58 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management done by hand has been replaced by robotics and automation. Tool and die makers, once prized for their intricate, precision hand work, are now utilizing computer-aided design (CAD) and computer numerically controlled (CNC) software to complete their tasks. Rather than having workers standing on the assembly line alone performing small specialized tasks, today’s workplaces utilize teams of workers collaborating and sharing a wide variety of tasks. The skills needed in this work setting are very different from those of the past; communication, collaboration, technical ability, and adaptability are necessary for success in the future.51 The introduction of computers made redundant not only typewriters but also the job of secretary and the lengthy process of creating, editing, and producing written correspondence. Digital imaging has changed the way medical diagnostic tests are taken, read, and stored. A radiologist working remotely can interpret images, and patients can be treated faster than ever before.52 Continuous improvement is an essential strategy for all organizations in the production of goods or the delivery of services. Customer demands for new product features, customized services, higher quality, and greater value mean that employees must continually acquire knowledge and skills in a dynamic environment. Continuous improvement in an organization typically involves ongoing efforts to develop and implement better methods. Recall the HR Headline and Lee Memorial Health System’s use of continuous improvement processes to enhance patient flow and reduce costs. Technology is enabling organizations to improve work flow and process. Business process reengineering (BPR) is a fundamental rethinking and radical redesign of business processes to achieve dramatic improvements in cost, quality, speed, and service.53 Scheduling work, tracking time and attendance, and monitoring employee productivity are all easier with the aid of technology. Workforce management software systems create and balance workloads that can save organizations significant labor costs by matching staffing levels to peak and nonpeak service demands. This can lead to employee discontent because of the inconvenience of shortened workdays or nontraditional schedules for employees. Daycare arrangements may be disrupted, and employees may compete for prime work schedules. HR and operations staff must work cooperatively to ensure that steps taken to improve efficiency do not create employee relations issues.54 Effects on Communication Technology has increased employee expectations regarding the speed and frequency of communication from managers. Employees are no longer content to wait for the monthly company newsletter or find out the latest news through formal channels. Company intranet portals can be a prime source of information for employees and should be used to inform employees about important events within the organization and the industry. The HR Perspective discusses how Verizon Wireless uses its HR portal to enhance employee communication. Facebook, LinkedIn, and other social networking sites allow employees to remain in constant contact with people inside and outside of the organization. Instant messages and cell-phone texting allow for real-time communication. The line between employees’ personal and professional lives becomes blurred as these virtual communities are frequently accessed from the worksite. Potential litigation and damage to the organizational reputation and brand pose risks to the organization if access and content are not properly monitored.55 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 58 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 59 Strategic HR Management and Planning HR perspective Verizon Engages Employees via Web Portal Employee engagement, that is, employees’ involvement with, commitment to, and satisfaction with work, has been tied to retention, productivity, profits, and sustainability. Engaged workers are willing to perform at levels beyond their stated job requirements, are more customer-focused, and produce higher-quality and long-term financial results for the organization. Therefore, organizations seeking to maximize employee engagement must identify specific actions that can lead to engagement. An integral component in driving employee engagement is effective communication. Particularly in harsh economic times, employees need to understand the challenges faced by the organization so that they can accept changes in compensation, work hours, and performance expectations. Messages must be honest, direct, and consistently address critical employee concerns. The range of communications channels provides multiple avenues for connecting with employees and providing vital information that will foster engagement. Verizon Wireless, widely known for its engaged workforce, has embraced the HR portal as a main vehicle for communicating with its employees. The company developed an online HR portal called “About You.” Accessible through the intranet, About You allows employees to make crucial connections between their daily work performance and their Total Rewards package. Real-time details about short-term incentive payouts, wellness initiatives, development programs, and other resources are available at their fingertips. The HR portal is tied to Verizon’s HRIS which delivers personalized employee information on demand. Selfservice tools like “To Do” lists that outline key tasks, approving expense reports, and tracking time and attendance simplify the employee’s life and cement connections between the employee and the company. The user interface mimics the online experience outside the workplace for a seamless, familiar feel. Verizon’s high level of employee engagement results from utilizing technology to deliver its employeecentered, honest communication messages.56 The explosive growth of Twitter in a relatively short period of time shows how quickly new communication channels emerge. Organizations must continually monitor and adapt to these new communication technologies to connect with customers and employees. Effects on Work Processes Monitoring employee actions and performance is much easier and less expensive due to technological advances. Transponders in semitrailer trucks can record speed, mileage, and other operating data to evaluate driver performance. Video surveillance to reduce employee misconduct such as theft or cheating, or to track productivity is simple to implement. Computer use is routinely monitored, and the Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM) found that more than one-third of organizations have either disciplined or terminated employees for improper use of company computers or Internet access.57 The majority of organizations have e-mail use policies in place and monitor employee e-mail use. In general, the courts have supported employer monitoring, and there are few legal restrictions on employer action. Organizations typically address two issues—managing employee performance and creating a positive work environment. Concerns about productivity and employee Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 59 26/06/10 3:36 PM 60 SECTION 1 FIGURE 2-9 Environment of Human Resource Management Factors Involved in Proper Monitoring of Employee E-Mail REASONS TO MONITOR POTENTIAL PROBLEMS The organization is legally responsible for its employees’ conduct and must limit exposure to liability (sexual harassment, etc.) Poorly implemented or excessive monitoring can reduce trust and openness Protect intellectual property and ensure that proprietary information is not disclosed to outside parties Employer should not monitor employees’ external e-mail accounts, only those hosted by the organization Ensure that employees are productive and using computer and Internet access to perform their jobs The blurring of personal and professional time leads to employees working on “their” time, and they expect to have some personal time during the workday U.S. laws may require monitoring for financial reporting and compliance with Sarbanes-Oxley Legal standards vary around the world, and global companies must comply with numerous requirements performance must be balanced with concerns for privacy and positive employee relations. Monitoring can lead to a lack of trust and may discourage creativity and the free exchange of ideas between employees. Figure 2-9 shows some of the important factors involved in proper monitoring of employee e-mail.58 Effects on HR Activities Electronic human resource management systems (e-HRM) The planning, implementation, and application of information technology to perform HR activities. Electronic human resource management systems (e-HRM) is the planning, implementation, and application of information technology to perform HR activities. Sometimes called virtual HRM or business-to-employee (B2E) systems, using technology to support HR activities increases the efficiency of the administrative HR function and reduces costs. Managers benefit from the availability of relevant information about employees. Properly designed e-HRM systems provide historical information on performance, pay, training, career progress, and disciplinary actions. Organizations can make better HR-related decisions as a result. To maximize the value of technology, e-HRM systems should be integrated into the overall IT plan and enterprise software of the organization.59 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 60 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 61 Technology can be used to support every function within human resource management. Recruiting and selection processes have changed dramatically with Web-based job boards, online applications, and even online interviewing. Training is now conducted with the aid of videos, podcasts, Web-enabled training programs, and virtual classrooms. Employee self-service has simplified benefit enrollment and administration by allowing employees to find health care providers and file claims online. Succession LOGGING ON planning and career development are enhanced with realSocial Media Governance time information on all employees and their potential career This is an online database of social media progression. One of the most important ways in which policies from companies, governments, technology can contribute to organizational performance and nonprofit entities. Visit the website is through the collection and analysis of HR-related data. at www.socialmediagovernance.com/ Identifying trends and modeling future conditions help policies.php. managers to plan and optimize human resources. MEASURING EFFECTIVENESS OF HR INITIATIVES A long-standing myth perpetuates the notion that one cannot really measure the value of HR practices. That myth has hurt HR’s credibility because it suggests that either HR efforts do not add value or they are too far removed from business results to matter. That notion is, of course, untrue. HR, like all other functions, must be evaluated by considering the results of its actions and the value it adds to the organization. Unfortunately, the perceptions of managers and employees in many organizations are mixed because HR has not always measured and documented its contributions or communicated those results to executives, managers, and employees. Further, accounting practices treat expenditures on human capital and talent development as expenses rather than capital investments. This encourages a consumption attitude rather than a long-term investment strategy.60 People-related costs are typically the largest controllable expense in organizations. Effective management of these costs can make the difference in the survival of the organization. Collecting and analyzing HR information can pinpoint waste and improper allocation of human resources. It is important that managers understand financial and operational measures that drive the business and relate HR decisions to key performance indicators (KPIs). Metrics, benchmarking, balanced scorecards, and audits can help the organization track HR performance and measure the value of HR practices.61 HR Metrics HR metrics Specific measures tied to HR performance indicators. HR metrics are specific measures tied to HR performance indicators. Metrics are typically used to assess the HR function and results within the organization over time. A metric can be developed using costs, quantity, quality, timeliness, and other designated goals. Metrics can be developed to track both HR’s efficiency and effectiveness. A pioneer in developing HR measurements, Jac Fitz-Enz, has identified a wide range of HR metrics. A number of key HR metrics are shown in Figure 2-10.62 HR and line managers collect and share the data needed to track performance. Data to track these measures come from several sources within the organization. Financial data are needed to determine costs for various HR activities. Performance and turnover data can be found in HR and operations records. The real value in using metrics is not in the collection and reporting of Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 61 26/06/10 3:36 PM 62 Environment of Human Resource Management SECTION 1 Key HR Metrics FIGURE 2-10 HR Staff and Expenses HR-to-employee ratio Total HR staff HR expenses per FTE Compensation Annual wage and salary increases Payroll as a percentage of operating expenses Benefit costs as a percentage of payroll Staffing Number of positions filled Time to fill Cost per hire Annual turnover rate Training Hours of training per employee Total costs for training Percentage of employees participating in tuition reimbursement program Retention and Quality Development Average tenure of employees Percentage of new hires retained for 90 days Performance quality of employees in first year Positions filled internally Percentage of employees with career plan the results. It is the analysis and the interpretation of the data that can lead to improvements in human capital utilization.63 Information and historical data are reviewed and studied to determine the reasons for current performance levels and to learn how to improve in the future. HR can help line managers to understand and interpret the results of these measures and translate these findings into effective steps toward improvement. Unlike financial reporting, there is no standard for the implementation and reporting of HR measures. Managers choose what and how to report to employees, investors, and other interested parties. This lack of consistency in HR reporting makes it difficult to evaluate an organization and to compare HR practices across organizations.64 The following characteristics should be considered when developing HR metrics: • • • • • • Accurate data can be collected. Measures are linked to strategic and operational objectives. Calculations can be clearly understood. Measures provide information valued by executives. Results can be compared both externally and internally. Measurement data drive HR management efforts. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 62 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 Strategic HR Management and Planning 63 HR and Benchmarking Benchmarking is the process of comparing the business processes and outcomes to an industry standard or best practice. In other words, the organization compares itself to “best-in-class” organizations that demonstrate excellence for a specific process. Benchmarking is focused on external practices that the organization can use to improve its own processes and practices. When implementing benchmarking, managers should be careful to find organizations with similar contexts, cultures, operations, and size. Practices that would work effectively in an organization of 500 employees might not transfer very well to an organization with 5,000 employees. The organization should study and choose benchmarks that will have the greatest impact on the organizational performance.65 About half of HR professionals report that their organizations collect benchmark data on a planned, periodic basis while the rest collect it as needed. Major obstacles to collecting benchmarks are uncertainty about how to collect the information and what information to collect.66 Using benchmarking, HR effectiveness is best determined by comparing ratios and measures from year to year. In that way, the organization can track improvements and results from implementing specific HR practices. While benchmarking helps the organization compare its results to other organizations, it does not provide the cause or reason for the relative standing of the organization. So, it is a starting point, not the end point, for improving the organizational HR function. HR and the Balanced Scorecard One effective approach to the measurement of the strategic performance of organizations, including their HR departments, is the balanced scorecard. The balanced scorecard is a framework organizations use to report on a diverse set of performance measures. Organizations that use a balanced scorecard recognize that focusing strictly on financial measures can limit their view. The balanced scorecard balances financial and nonfinancial measures so that managers focus on long-term drivers of performance and organizational sustainability. As shown in Figure 2-11, the balanced scorecard measures performance in four areas: • Benchmarking Comparing the business results to industry standards. Balanced scorecard A framework used to report a diverse set of performance measures. Financial measures: Traditional financial measures such as profit and loss, operating margins, utilization of capital, return on investment, and return on assets are needed to ensure that the organization manages its bottom line effectively. • Internal business processes: Product and service quality, efficiency and productivity, conformance with standards, and cycle times can be measured to ensure that the operation runs smoothly and efficiently. • Customer relations: Customer satisfaction, loyalty, and retention are important to ensure that the organization is meeting customer expectations and can depend on repeat business from its customers. • Learning and growth activities: Employee training and development, mentoring programs, succession planning, and knowledge creation and sharing provide the necessary talent and human capital pool to ensure the future of the organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 63 26/06/10 3:36 PM 64 SECTION 1 F I G U R E 2 - 11 Environment of Human Resource Management Balanced Scorecard Framework Internal Processes Customer Relations Operational effectiveness Conformance to standards Customer satisfaction Customer loyalty Vision and Strategy Learning and Growth Employee capabilities Institutional knowledge Financial Profit and loss Utilization of capital Organizational results in each of these areas determine if the organization is progressing toward its strategic objectives. For example, some firms have noticed that when survey results show a decline in employee satisfaction, several months later there is a decline in customer loyalty and repeat customer sales. Or expenditures in employee leadership development training can be linked to lower employee turnover and reduced time to hire managers from outside the organization. More than 60% of organizations claim to use a balanced scorecard approach. Firms as diverse as Blue Cross, Verizon, and the Mayo Clinic have used this approach to align performance measures with their organizational strategy.67 Using the balanced scorecard requires spending considerable time and effort to identify the appropriate HR measures in each of the four areas and how they tie to strategic organizational success. The balanced scorecard should align with company goals and focus on results. To be effective, the HR scorecard should address three elements—accountability, validity, and actionable results.68 However, regardless of the time and effort spent trying to develop and use objective measures in the balanced scorecard, subjectivity in what is selected and how the measures are interpreted can still occur. Human Capital Effectiveness Measures To fulfill its role as a strategic business partner, HR must quantify things that traditional accounting does not account for. Human resources often provide for both the biggest value and the biggest cost to organizations. Many of the metrics previously discussed reflect people-related costs. Measuring the value is more challenging but equally important.69 Assessing the value of human resources demonstrates the importance of implementing effective HR practices to maintain a high-quality, engaged workforce. Human capital refers to the collective value of the intellectual capital (competencies, knowledge, and skills) of the employees in the organization. This Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 64 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 65 Strategic HR Management and Planning capital is the constantly renewable source of creativity and innovativeness in the organization but is not reflected in its financial statements. Revenue per employee is a basic measure of human capital effectiveness. The formula is Revenue/Head Count (full-time employee equivalents). It is a measure of employee productivity and shows the sales revenue generated by each full-time employee. This measure is commonly used in government reporting (see Bureau of Labor Statistics, BLS) as well as by organizations to track productivity over time. If revenues increase but employee head count remains constant, productivity would increase. A widely used financial measure that can be applied to measure the contribution and cost of HR activities is return on investment (ROI), which is a calculation showing the value of investments in human resources. It can also be used to show how long it will take for the activities to pay for themselves. The following formula can be used to calculate the potential ROI for a new HR activity: ROI = C A+B where: A = Operating costs for a new or enhanced system for the time period B = One-time cost of acquisition and implementation C = Value of gains from productivity improvements for the time period Return on investment (ROI) Calculation showing the value of an investment. Human capital value added (HCVA) Calculated by subtracting all operating expenses except for labor expenses from revenue and dividing by the total full-time head count. Human capital return on investment (HCROI) Directly shows the operating profit derived from investments in human capital. Human economic value added (HEVA) Wealth created per employee. ROI is stressed because it is used in most other functions in an organization and is the “language” used by financial staff and top management. It allows managers to choose among various investment opportunities to determine the best use of funds. Human capital value added (HCVA) is an adjusted operating profitability figure calculated by subtracting all operating expenses except for labor expenses from revenue and dividing by the total full-time head count. It shows the operating profit per full-time employee. Because labor is required to generate revenues, employment costs are added back into operating expense. The formula for HCVA is: Revenue – (Operating Expense – (Compensation + Benefit Costs)) Full-Time Head Count Human capital return on investment (HCROI) directly shows the amount of profit derived from investments in labor, the leverage on labor cost. The formula for HCROI uses the same adjusted operating profitability figure as for HCVA, but it is divided by the human capital cost: Revenue – (Operating Expense – (Compensation + Benefit Costs)) (Compensation + Benefits Costs) Human economic value added (HEVA) shows the wealth created per employee. It shows how much more valuable the organization has become due to the investment in human capital. Wealth is the net operating profit of a firm after the cost of capital is deducted. Cost of capital is the minimum rate of return demanded by shareholders. When a company is making more than the cost of capital, it is creating wealth for shareholders. An HEVA approach requires that all policies, procedures, measures, and methods use cost of Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 65 26/06/10 3:36 PM 66 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management capital as a benchmark against which their return is judged. Human resource decisions can be subjected to the same analysis. The formula for HEVA is: Net Profit after Taxes – Cost of Capital Full-Time Head Count Many financial measures can be tracked and reported to show the contribution human resources make to organizational results. Without such measures, it would be difficult to know what is going on in the organization, identify performance gaps, and provide feedback. Managers should require the same level of rigor in measuring HR practices as they do for other functions in the organization.70 Regardless of the time and effort placed on HR measurement and HR metrics, the most important consideration is that HR effectiveness and efficiency must be measured regularly for managers to know how HR is contributing to organizational success. HR Audit HR audit A formal research effort to assess the current state of HR practices. One general means for assessing HR is through an HR audit, which is similar to a financial audit. An HR audit is a formal research effort to assess the current state of HR practices in an organization. This audit is used to evaluate how well activities in each of the HR areas (staffing, compensation, health and safety, etc.) have been performed, so that management can identify areas for improvement. An HR audit often helps smaller organizations without a formal HR professional to identify issues associated with legal compliance, administrative processes and recordkeeping, employee retention, and other areas. S U M M A R Y • • • • • The strategy an organization follows is its proposition for how to compete successfully and thereby survive and grow. HR should be involved in the development and implementation of strategic decisions throughout the organization. Strategic planning is a core business process that results in a road map of organizational direction. Strategic HR management (HRM) refers to the use of HRM practices to gain or keep a competitive advantage by aligning individual employee performance with the organizational strategic objectives. Environmental scanning helps to pinpoint strengths, weaknesses, opportunities, and threats that the organization will face during the planning horizon. • During an external environmental scan, HR managers identify the effects of economic conditions, legislative/political influences, demographic changes, and geographic and competitive issues. • Mastering the global complexities of managing human resources is important for both HR results and the overall success of the organization. • HR plays a crucial role in mergers and acquisitions, particularly in dealing with integration and organizational culture issues. • Managing a talent surplus may require reducing work hours, downsizing through use of attrition and hiring freezes, voluntary separation programs, and workforce downsizing. • Managing a talent shortage may be addressed through overtime, reducing turnover, using contingent workers, and outsourcing. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 66 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 • Advances in technology have affected job design, communication, work processes, and HR activities. • HR effectiveness must be measured using HR metrics that consider both strategic and operational effectiveness. • Benchmarking allows an organization to compare its practices against “best practices” in C R I T I C A L different organizations, and HR audits used to get a comprehensive overview activities. • The balanced scorecard can be a framework to measure and report on organizational performance measures. T H I N K I N G 1. Discuss how technology has changed jobs in an organization where you have worked. What are some HR responses to those changes? 2. What steps can HR professionals take to ensure that mergers and acquisitions are successful? How can HR help during the integration process? 3. How can an organization maintain its image while dealing with a talent surplus? If layoffs are necessary, what would you recommend H R 67 Strategic HR Management and Planning E X P E R I E N T I A L As the HR Director of a U.S.-based company that is looking at global opportunities in China, you have been asked by the company president to prepare an outline for an HR strategic plan as part of the company’s expansion process. You need to develop an HR strategic plan that will integrate the goals, objectives, and strategies of the HR Department with those of the company. The plan also needs to support the objectives of other departments within can be of HR useful diverse A C T I V I T I E S managers do to ensure that survivors remain committed and productive? 4. As the HR manager for a multinational corporation, you want to identify HR competencies that are critical for global companies. Visit the website for the World Federation of People Management Association (www.wfpma.com) to research the topic and to identify differences in the body of knowledge in different parts of the world. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G the company. To get ideas on how to develop an HR strategic plan, go to www.workinfo.com. 1. What is the process to use for identifying the components of the HR strategic planning process? 2. What other company strategic objectives must the HR strategic plan integrate and support? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 67 26/06/10 3:36 PM 68 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management C A S E Pioneers in HR Analytics The power of HR metrics and analytics is an untapped resource for many organizations. Human resource information systems (HRIS) are commonly used to capture and store gigabytes of data about employees, but few organizations have mined their data to improve human capital decisions. Most business leaders and HR executives do not make people decisions with the same level of rigor and rationale as they do other business decisions, relying more on intuition and gut feelings. This propagates the myth that the impact of human resources on organizations is either not measurable or not significant. Financial, operational, and marketing decisions all depend heavily on detailed analysis and cost justification. The use of analytics in human resource management can enhance the strategic contribution of HR executives and lead to better decisions and organizational outcomes. At Superior Energy Services in New Orleans, careful analysis of turnover data shattered previous beliefs about which employees were most likely to quit. The organization was losing skilled oilfield operators and supervisors faster than semiskilled blue-collar workers. This discovery led to implementation of training and coaching programs for supervisory employees, which resulted in a 15% drop in turnover and improved the bottom line of the company. Without this analytic approach to turnover, attention would have been focused on retaining blue-collar workers, which would not have delivered such impressive results. Thrivent Financial for Lutherans in Minneapolis believed that turnover during the first year of new hires’ careers was related to the previous experience they had in their disciplines. The thinking was that if a customer service employee had previously worked in customer service, she was less likely to leave Thrivent in the first year. Analytics dispelled that theory and Thrivent found that the exact opposite was true. Employees with previous experience in the discipline were leaving at a faster rate than those without such experience. Although they have not determined the causes, this data will help Thrivent’s leaders to address the real issues. One answer will lead to additional questions and lines of inquiry. The food service and convenience company Wawa, Inc., assumed that turnover among store clerks was tied to their hourly wage rate. However, the number of hours worked in a week was a much more significant factor in turnover. Employees liked working part-time, and when their work hours exceeded 30 hours per week, they were more likely to quit. Wawa reduced instore turnover by 60% by scheduling employees for less than 30 hours. Concerns about an aging workforce and a presumption that a high percentage of employees would retire in the near term led the University of Southern California to carefully analyze employee demographic data. To their surprise, HR found that the nontenured staff employees were, on average, too young to begin retiring en masse. Tenured faculty, while much older, are far more likely to work past the age of 70. The anticipated retirements are still a fact for USC to address. However, managers can plan for this and develop a longer-term transition plan because they are not facing massive retirements in the near future. The HR executives at Superior Energy Services, Thrivent, Wawa, and USC are harnessing the power of HR data and statistical models to better understand the challenges facing their organizations. Long-held beliefs about the patterns of employee actions and decisions can be analyzed and either supported or debunked. Either way, the organization can address the true issues only if HR looks beyond the surface and digs deeper into the sea of data. Overcoming the fear of numbercrunching and developing expertise with metrics and analytics can separate winning organizations from those that get left behind. HR professionals who learn to interpret bits and bytes of employee data will help their organizations succeed well into the future.71 QUESTIONS 1. What are some reasons that more organizations do not implement HR analytics? How would you make the case for adopting HR analytics? 2. How can HR professionals develop the needed skills to analyze and interpret metrics? What resources could an HR professional consult to begin building expertise in this area? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 68 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 69 Strategic HR Management and Planning S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Where Do You Find the Bodies? Xerox This case identifies problems associated with HR planning and recruiting in a tight labor market. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/ management/mathis.) This case highlights the challenges of employee retention during stressful and unpredictable times when Xerox was undergoing a significant shift in its strategic focus. (For the case, go to www .cengage.com/management/mathis.) N O T E S 1. Julie C. Ramirez, “Survival of the Fittest,” Human Resource Executive, April 2009, 30–35. 2. “. . . and HR Planning Is Less Formal,” Personnel Today, February 27, 2007, 1–3; Sumita Ketkar and P. K. Sett, “HR Flexibility and Firm Performance: Analysis of a Multi-Level Causal Model,” International Journal of Human Resource Management, 20 (2009), 1009–1038. 3. Edward E. Lawler and John W. Boudreau, “What Makes HR a Strategic Partner?” People & Strategy, 32 (2009), 14–22. 4. Beth Tootell, Meredith Blackler, et al., “Metrics: HRM’s Holy Grail? A New Zealand Case Study,” Human Resource Management Journal, 19 (2009), 375–392. 5. Erich Brockmann and Clifford Koen, “Strategic Planning: A Guide for Supervisors,” Supervision, August 2008, 3–9. 6. NetMBA, “The Strategic Planning Process,” www.netmba.com. 7. Thomas Chermack and Bernadette Kasshann, “The Use and Misuse of SWOT Analysis and Implications for HRD Professionals,” Human Resource Development International, 10 (2007), 383–399. 8. Juan Pablo Gonzalez and Garrett Sheridan, “Get Off the Talent Treadmill: Hardwiring Talent Strategy to Business Strategy,” Workspan, August 2008, 36–40; Milton Perkins, “Aligning Workforce Strategies with Business Objectives” SHRM.org Research Articles, December 7, 2009. 9. Bret J. Becton and Mike Schraeder, “Strategic Human Resources 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Management—Are We There Yet?” Journal for Quality and Participation, January 2009, 11–18. Wendy Boswell, “Aligning Employees with the Organization’s Strategic Objectives: Out of Line of Sight, Out of Mind,” International Journal of Human Resource Management, 17 (2006), 1489–1511. David Ulrich, Wayne Brockbank, et al., HR Competencies: Mastery of the Intersection of People and Business (Alexandria, VA: SHRM, 2008). Steve Williams, “A Working Model of Strategic Human Resource Management,” 2009, Unpublished manuscript, Alliant International University, San Diego, CA. James Combs, Yongmei Liu, et al., “How Much Do High Performance Work Practices Matter? A MetaAnalysis of Their Effects on Organizational Performance,” Personnel Psychology, 59 (2006), 501–528; Jason Shaw, Brian Dineen, et al., “Employee-Organization Exchange Relationships, HRM Practices, and Quit Rates of Good and Poor Performers,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 1016–1033. Patrick Wright and Rebecca Kehoe, “Human Resource Practices and Organizational Commitment: A Deeper Examination,” Cornell University CAHRS Working Paper Series, December 2007. David McCann, “Memo to CFOs: Don’t Trust HR,” March 10, 2009, CFO.com. Stephen Baker, “Management by the Numbers,” BusinessWeek, September 8, 2008, 32–38. 17. “Strategic Management—SWOT Analysis” QuickMBA, 2007, www .quickmba.com. 18. Fay Hansen, “Chief Concern: Leaders,” Workforce Management, July 20, 2009, 17–20; Robert Barnett and Sandra Davis, “Creating Greater Success in Succession Planning,” Advances in Developing Human Resources, 10 (2008), 721–739; Kris Jensen, “Making Succession Plans Work for Your Company,” Workspan, May 2009, 57–62. 19. Fay Hansen, “Strategic Workforce Planning in an Uncertain World,” Workforce Management Online, July 2009, www.workforce.com. 20. Adrienne Fox, “Avoiding Furlough Fallout,” HRMagazine, September 2009, 36–40. 21. U.S. Census Bureau, Population Division, “U.S. Population Projections,” www.census.gov. 22. Bridget Mintz Testa, “New Orbit,” Workforce Management, August 17, 2009, 16–20. 23. Tom Starner, “Thinking Globally,” Human Resource Executive, January 2009, 40–42. 24. Marshall Goldsmith, “Human Resources: The Big Issues,” BusinessWeek, July 8, 2008. 25. SHRM Global Special Expertise Panel, “Things to Think About in International HR Management,” 2006–2007. 26. Damien DeLuca and Han Hu, “Evaluate Workforces in Emerging Economies,” HRMagazine, September 2008, 65–70. 27. Conference Board, “Offshoring Reaches the C-Suite,” 2007–2008 ORN Survey Report; Stephan Manning, Silvia Massini, and Arie Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 69 26/06/10 3:36 PM 70 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 36. SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Lewin, “A Dynamic Perspective on Next-Generation Offshoring: The Global Sourcing of Science and Engineering Talent,” Academy of Management Perspectives, August 2008, 35–54. Kannan Srikanth and Phanish Puranam, “Advice for Outsourcers: Think Bigger,” The Wall Street Journal, January 25, 2010, R7. Susan Allerow and Rebecca Rosenzwaig, “Effective International HR Management,” Workspan, December 2008, 85–92; G. A. Gelade, P. Dobson, and K. Auer, “Individualism, Masculinity, and the Sources of Organizational Commitment,” Journal of CrossCultural Psychology, 39, No. 5 (2008), 599–617. Paula Caligiuri and Ibraiz Tarique, “Predicting Effectiveness in Global Leadership Activities,” Journal of World Business, 44 (2009), 336–346; David Robinson and Michael Harvey, “Global Leadership in a Culturally Diverse World,” Management Decision, 46 (2008), 466–480. David Wentworth, “M&A Bounces Back: What Have We Learned?” Institute for Corporate Productivity (i4cp) TrendWatcher, No. 478, October 2, 2009; Harry Barkema and Mario Schijven, “Toward Unlocking the Full Potential of Acquisitions: The Role of Organizational Restructuring,” Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008), 696–722. Jim Candler, “The Critical HR Role in M&A . . . Made Easier,” Workspan, August 2008, 43–45; John Nigh and Marco Boschetti, “M&A Due Diligence: The 360-Degree View,” Towers Perrin Emphasis, 2006. Christopher Kummer, “Motivation and Retention of Key People in Mergers and Acquisitions,” Strategic HR Review, No. 6, 2008, 5–10. Agata Stachowicz-Stanusch, “Culture Due Diligence Based on HP/Compaq Merger Case Study,” Journal of Intercultural Management, April 2009, 64–81. Aaron Falcione, “Post-Merger Integration: Dealing with Culture,” Workspan, September 2007, 75–79. Bob Bundy, “The Culture of Combination: Changing Behaviors and Deal Success in Mergers and Acquisitions,” WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter, 2007, 35–47. 37. Randolph Croyle and Ava Johnsey, “Dow’s Novel Approach to Managing the Human Element of Mergers and Acquisitions,” Global Business and Organizational Excellence, May/June 2007, 18–26. 38. Joann Lublin and Dana Mattioli, “Strategic Plans Lose Favor,” The Wall Street Journal, January 25, 2010, B7. 39. Peter Coy, “Help Wanted,” BusinessWeek, May 11, 2009, 40–45; Judy Keen, “After Layoffs Many Workers Go Back to School for a Fresh Start,” USAToday, April 8, 2009, 1A. 40. Edward Lawler, “Reducing Labor Costs: Choosing the Right CostCutting Solution for Your Talent Management Strategy,” Workspan, June 2009, 20–25. 41. Raymund Flandez, “Small Businesses Work Hard to Prevent Layoffs,” The Wall Street Journal, March 5, 2009, B5. 42. Deborah Stead, “BTW: ‘You’re Fired,’” BusinessWeek, December 22, 2008, 15–16; Michael O’Brien, “Determining Departures,” Human Resource Executive, April 2009, 44–45; Geoffrey Love and Matthew Kraatz, “Character, Conformity, or the Bottom Line? How and Why Downsizing Affected Corporate Reputation,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 314–335. 43. Taleo/Human Capital Institute, “Recessionary Management: The Top Dos and DON’Ts for Managing Talent in the Current Downturn,” January 2009. 44. Susan Wells, “Layoff Aftermath,” HR Magazine, November 2008, 37–41. 45. “Hewitt Survey Finds U.S. Employers Still Offering Generous Employee Severance Packages Despite Economic Conditions,” March 19, 2009, www .hewittassociates.com. 46. Karyn Model, Elaine Reardon, and Christopher Haan, “Navigating a Reduction in Force: Understanding the Economist’s Perspective,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008, 16–26. 47. “The Worker Adjustment and Retraining Notification Act: A Guide to Advance Notice of Closings and Layoffs,” U.S. Department of Labor Employment and Training Administration Fact Sheet, www .doleta.gov. 48. Manpower, “2009 Talent Shortage Survey Results,” www.manpower .com. 49. Mark Schoeff, “Study: Flexibility Programs Gain Ground in Hard Times,” Workforce Management, July 23, 2009. 50. Sandra Fisher, Michael Wasserman, et al., “Human Resource Issues in Outsourcing: Integrating Research and Practice,” Human Resource Management, 47 (2008), 501–523. 51. Margaret Hilton, “Skills for Work in the 21st Century: What Does the Research Tell Us?” Academy of Management Perspectives, November 2008, 63–78; The Manufacturing Institute, “People and Profitability: A Time for Change,” 2009. 52. Brian Mahony, “Healthcare Thought Leaders Predict the Impact of Technology,” November 29, 2009, www.trenderresearch.com. 53. David Savino, “The Role of Technology as an Enabler in Job Redesign,” Journal of Technology Management and Innovation, 4 (2009), 14–23. 54. Vanessa O’Connell, “Retailers Reprogram Workers in Efficiency Push,” The Wall Street Journal, September 10, 2008, A1; Adrienne Hedger, “The Best Use of Time,” Workforce Management, May 18, 2009, 44–47. 55. Andrew McIlvaine, “The Generational Techno-Divide,” Human Resource Executive Online, July 1, 2009, www.hreonline.com; Judy Payne, “Using Wikis and Blogs to Improve Collaboration and Knowledge Sharing,” Strategic HR Review, No. 3, 2008, 5–12. 56. Antonio Poglianich and Matt Antonek, “Rules of Engagement in Turbulent Times: How Verizon Wireless Uses a Robust HR Portal for Employee Communication,” Global Business and Organizational Excellence, May/June 2009, 29–35. 57. SHRM Poll, “Has Your Organization Disciplined Employees for Improper Use of Technology?” Society for Human Resource Management, June 6, 2007. 58. William Smith and Filiz Tabak, “Monitoring Employee Emails: Is There Any Room for Privacy?” Academy of Management Perspectives, November 2009, 33–48. 59. Lexy Martin and Lia Goudy, “TimeHonored Truths,” Human Resource Executive, June 16, 2009, 30–32. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 70 26/06/10 3:36 PM CHAPTER 2 71 Strategic HR Management and Planning 60. Edward Gordon, “Accounting Change Needed to Address Talent Shortfalls,” Employee Benefits News, January 2010, 12–13. 61. Bruce Ellig, “Speak the Language of the CFO,” Workspan, July 2008, 57–62; Kate Feather, “Helping HR to Measure Up: Arming the Soft Function with Hard Metrics,” Strategic HR Review, No. 1, 2008, 28–33. 62. SHRM, “Human Capital Benchmarking Study: 2009,” Society for Human Resource Management, www.shrm.org. 63. Wayne Cascio and John Boudreau, Investing in People: Financial Impact of Human Resource Initiatives (Upper Saddle River, NJ: FT Press, 2008). 64. John Dooney, “SHRM Symposium on Human Capital Analytics,” Society for Human Resource Management, 2007, www.shrm.org. 65. Robert Greene, “Human Resource Management Strategies: Can We Discover What Will Work Through Benchmarking?” WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter, 2008, 6–15; Dilys Robinson, “Human Capital Measurement: An Approach That Works,” Strategic HR Review, No. 6, 2009, 5–11. 66. SHRM Poll, “How Often Does Your Organization Collect HR Benchmarks/Metrics?” Society for Human Resource Management, February 13, 2008. 67. Nancy Lockwood, “The Balanced Scorecard: An Overview,” SHRM Research Briefly Stated, June 2006. 68. Margaret Fiester, “Balanced Scorecards, Unclaimed Wages, Data,” HRMagazine, December 2008, 24. 69. Debbie Whitaker and Laura Wilson, “Human Capital Measurement: From Insight to Action,” Organization Development Journal, Fall 2007, 59–64. 70. “Human Capital Strategy: Human Capital Measurement,” November 30, 2007, www.humancapital strategy.blogspot.com. 71. Based on: Bill Roberts, “Analyze This!” HR Magazine, October 2009, 34–41. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_02_ch02_p036-071.indd 71 26/06/10 3:36 PM C H A P T E R 3 Equal Employment Opportunity After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Describe key provisions in Title VII of the Civil Rights Acts of 1964 and 1991. • Show how women are affected by pay, job assignment, and career issues in organizations. • Define the two types of sexual harassment and how employers should respond to sexual harassment complaints. • Identify two means that organizations are using to deal with the aging of their workforces. • Discuss how reasonable accommodation is made when managing individuals with disabilities and differing religious beliefs. • Evaluate several arguments supporting and opposing affirmative action. • Discuss why diversity training is important. 72 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 72 26/06/10 8:00 PM HR Headline Sexual Harassment at the United Nations T (DANIEL GARCIA/AFP/Getty Images) he United Nations (U.N.) is struggling with a series of sexual harassment complaints as it strives to protect human rights globally. The U.N.’s global staff includes around 60,000 people stationed around the world. These employees come from many different cultures and backgrounds. The U.N. handles sexual harassment problems differently from other large organizations. Many U.N. managers have diplomatic immunity that protects them from criminal prosecution and from civil lawsuits as well; therefore, the internal justice system of the organization is the only one employees can use. This system dates back to 1946 and employs a “bewildering array” of channels and processes. The net effect has been many harassment cases that have not been settled to anyone’s satisfaction. For example, a female Syrian employee filed a complaint against her boss in the Kuwait office alleging he had made sexual advances, grabbing and kissing her. He then refused to renew her contract when she did not respond. Ten days after a report found evidence of her accusations, the supervisor resigned and could not be disciplined. In another case, a French woman who was in Gaza for the U.N. complained she was harassed by her director. She said he used binoculars to spy on her in her apartment, made sexually explicit comments, and groped her. The Director was cleared at first after an investigation by a “colleague.” Another investigation was stymied when the director reached mandatory retirement age. His accuser’s employment contract ran out and was not renewed and the case ended. In a final case to illustrate the problem, a translator for the U.N. in Lebanon accused a U.N. security officer of rape, but her employment contract expired before her appeal was heard; that was the end of the case. 73 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 73 26/06/10 8:01 PM 74 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Employees at the U.N. in the United States who have been harassed have found that filing a suit in U.S. courts will not work because of the diplomatic immunity.1 Sexual harassment is an international problem in employment, but the U.N., regardless of whether it has a bigger problem than other international organizations, has some unique difficulties in dealing with it. In the United States, using race, gender, disability, age, religion, and certain other characteristics as the basis for choosing among people at work is generally illegal. Doing so can also be quite expensive, as fines and back wages can be awarded as well as sizable law suit settlements. Inequality in the treatment of people with different backgrounds has been an issue for many years, but it was the Civil Rights Act of 1964 that started a legislative movement toward leveling the playing field in employment. Initially focus was on race, gender, and religion, but these characteristics were soon followed by age, pregnancy, and individuals with disabilities. Since then numerous Executive Orders, regulations, and interpretations by courts have affected the employer/employee relationship. Perhaps nothing has had the impact of Equal Employment Opportunity (EEO) on HR during the same period of time. See Appendix C for a listing of the relevant federal laws. Employers have paid (and continue to pay) large amounts for violating EEO laws. Familiarity with EEO requirements and ways to successfully manage workforce diversity are the goals and focus of this chapter.2 NATURE OF EQUAL EMPLOYMENT OPPORTUNITY (EEO) At the core of equal employment is the concept of discrimination. The word discrimination simply means “recognizing differences among items or people.” For example, employers must discriminate (choose) among applicants for a job on the basis of job requirements and candidates’ qualifications. However, when discrimination is based on race, gender, or some other factors, it is illegal and employers face problems. The following bases for protection have been identified by various federal, state, and/or local laws: • • • • • • • • Protected category A group identified for protection under EEO laws and regulations. Race, ethnic origin, color (including multiracial/ethnic backgrounds) Sex/gender (including pregnant women and also men in certain situations) Age (individuals over age 40) Individuals with disabilities (physical or mental) Military experience (military status employees and Vietnam-era veterans) Religion (special beliefs and practices) Marital status (some states) Sexual orientation (some states and cities) These categories are composed of individuals who are members of a protected category under EEO laws and regulations. Discrimination remains a concern as the U.S. workforce becomes more diverse. As Figure 3-1 indicates, there are two types of illegal employment discrimination: disparate treatment and disparate impact. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 74 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 75 Equal Employment Opportunity FIGURE 3-1 Illegal Employment Discrimination Protected Category Members Disparate Treatment Disparate Impact Members of a group are unfairly treated differently from others in employment decisions A policy results in substantially different employment outcomes for a particular group Disparate Treatment The first type of illegal discrimination occurs with employment-related situations in which either: (1) different standards are used to judge individuals, or (2) the same standard is used, but it is not related to the individuals’ jobs. Disparate treatment occurs when members of one group are treated differently from others. For example, if female applicants must take a special skills test not given to male applicants, then disparate treatment may be occurring.3 Often disparate treatment cases are based on evidence that an employer’s actions were intentionally discriminatory. For example, a manufacturing firm in Cleveland, Ohio, paid almost $1 million to settle an EEO lawsuit involving 20 people, charging that S&Z Tool & Die Company intentionally refused to hire African Americans and women except in clerical jobs.4 Disparate treatment Occurs when members of a group are treated differently from others. Disparate impact Occurs when members of a protected category are substantially underrepresented as a result of employment decisions that work to their disadvantage. Disparate Impact Disparate impact occurs when members of a protected category are substantially underrepresented as a result of employment decisions that work to their disadvantage. The landmark case that established the importance of disparate impact as a legal foundation of EEO law is Griggs v. Duke Power, 1401 U.S. 424 (1971). The decision by the U.S. Supreme Court established two major points: 1. It is not enough to show a lack of discriminatory intent if the employment tool results in a disparate impact that discriminates against one group more than another or continues a past pattern of discrimination. 2. The employer has the burden of proving that an employment requirement is directly job related as a “business necessity.” Consequently, the intelligence test and high school diploma requirements of Duke Power LOGGING ON were ruled not to be related to the job. Equal Employment Opportunity Commission This website provides information on the EEOC. It includes details on employment discrimination facts, enforcement statistics, and technical assistance programs. Visit the site at www.eeoc.gov. This and a number of other decisions make it clear that employers must be able to document through statistical analyses5 that disparate treatment and disparate impact have not occurred.6 Knowing how to perform these analyses is important in order for employers to follow appropriate equal employment guidelines. See Appendix E for information relating to these issues. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 75 26/06/10 8:01 PM 76 SECTION 1 FIGURE 3-2 Environment of Human Resource Management EEO Concepts Business Necessity Job Relatedness BFOQs (Bona Fide Occupational Qualifications) Helping to Define EEO Burden of Proof Nonretaliatory Practices Equal Employment Opportunity Concepts Several basic EEO concepts have resulted from court decisions, laws, and regulatory actions. The four key areas discussed next (see Figure 3-2) help clarify key EEO ideas. Business Necessity and Job Relatedness A business necessity is a practice necessary for safe and efficient organizational operations. Business necessity has been the subject of numerous court decisions. Educational requirements often are based on business necessity. However, an employer who requires a minimum level of education, such as a high school diploma, must be able to defend the requirement as essential to the performance of the job (job related), which may be difficult. For instance, equating a degree or diploma with the possession of math or reading abilities is considered questionable. Further, employers are expected to use job-related employment practices. The Washington v. Davis case involved the hiring of police officers in Washington, DC. The issue was a reading comprehension and aptitude test given to all applicants for police officer positions. The test contained actual material that the applicants would have to learn during a training program. The city could show a relationship between success in the training program and success as a police officer, although a much higher percentage of women and blacks than white men failed this aptitude test. The Supreme Court ruled that the City of Washington, DC, did not discriminate unfairly because the test was definitely job related. If a test is clearly related to the job and tasks performed, it is not illegal simply because a greater percentage of minorities or women do not pass it. The crucial outcome is that the test must be specifically job related and cannot be judged solely on its disparate impact.7 Business necessity A practice necessary for safe and efficient organizational operations. Bona Fide Occupational Qualification (BFOQ) Employers may discriminate on the basis of sex, religion, or national origin if the characteristic can be justified as a “bona fide occupational qualification reasonably necessary to the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 76 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 77 normal operation of the particular business or enterprise.” Thus, a bona fide occupational qualification (BFOQ) is a characteristic providing a legitimate reason why an employer can exclude persons on otherwise illegal bases of consideration. What constitutes a BFOQ has been subject to different interpretations in various courts. Legal uses of BFOQs have been found for hiring Asians to wait on customers in a Chinese restaurant or Catholics to serve in certain religiousbased positions in Catholic churches. Burden of Proof Another legal issue that arises when discrimination is alleged is the determination of who has the burden of proof. Burden of proof must be established to file suit against employers and establish that illegal discrimination has occurred. Based on the evolution of court decisions, current laws, and regulations the plaintiff charging discrimination must: • be a protected-category member, and • prove that disparate impact or disparate treatment existed. Bona fide occupational qualification (BFOQ) Characteristic providing a legitimate reason why an employer can exclude persons on otherwise illegal bases of consideration. Burden of proof What individuals who file suit against employers must prove in order to establish that illegal discrimination has occurred. Retaliation Punitive actions taken by employers against individuals who exercise their legal rights. Equal employment Employment that is not affected by illegal discrimination. Blind to differences Differences among people should be ignored and everyone should be treated equally. Affirmative action Employers are urged to employ people based on their race, age, gender, or national origin to make up for historical discrimination. Once a court rules that a preliminary case has been made, the burden of proof shifts to the employer. The employer then must show that the bases for making employment-related decisions were specifically job related and consistent with considerations of business necessity. Nonretaliation Employers are prohibited from retaliating against individuals who file discrimination charges. Retaliation occurs when employers take punitive actions against individuals who exercise their legal rights. For example, an employee who had reported harassment by a supervisor was fired, but the Supreme Court found that it is unlawful to discriminate against someone who has “made a charge, testified, assisted, or participated in any manner in an investigation, proceeding, or hearing.”8 To avoid charges of retaliation, the following actions are recommended for employers: • • • Train supervisors on what retaliation is and what is not appropriate. Conduct a thorough internal investigation of any claims and document the results. Take appropriate action when any retaliation occurs. Progressing Toward Equal Employment Opportunity After almost 50 years, equal employment continues to be a significant focus of HR management. Discrimination, harassment, and retaliation lawsuits are the legal actions most likely to affect employers. (See HR Perspective: “Officer Dirt.”) The number of EEO complaints continues to rise, indicating that more progress is needed to reduce employment discrimination.9 Not everyone agrees on the best way to achieve equal employment opportunity. There seems to be little disagreement that the goal is equal employment, or employment that is not affected by illegal discrimination. However, the way to achieve that goal is open to debate.10 One way is to use the “blind to differences” approach, which argues that differences among people should be ignored and everyone should be treated equally. The second common approach is affirmative action, through which employers are urged to employ people based on their race, age, gender, or national origin. The idea is to make Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 77 26/06/10 8:01 PM 78 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management HR perspective “Officer Dirt” When a former police officer suggested age discrimination was involved in his dismissal, the Kansas City Police Department investigated and decided to fight the case. They might have done a more thorough job, as later was shown. Anthony Hogan had been a police officer for 24 years. With the jury in state court listening, he countered his supervisor’s denials with tape recordings he had made during three meetings in which the supervisor said Officer Hogan was “burned out,” “dragging his feet,” and “no longer a fireball.” Another police official called him “Officer Dirt” because he was “Older than Dirt.” The jury ruled 10–2 in favor of the former officer and awarded him $700,000 in actual damages and $2 million in punitive damages. He settled for $1.95 million during an appeal. EEOC officials expect an increase in discrimination filings as legislation (e.g., the Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act), economic pressures, and baby boomers reaching retirement age change the landscape for such suits. The case of “Officer Dirt” can provide some useful lessons in dealing with similar claims: • • Be thorough in the investigation: Check performance evaluations for the past few years, resist the temptation to talk to only one or two people, and keep a record of interviews. Do not demonize the claimant: Rather than giving in to the tendency to view someone negatively just because the person has brought a claim, ask what the work record says. Managers get emotional when accused of discrimination, but the result of actions that are not thought out can be a retaliation claim. One manager notes that “workers are watching and waiting to see how we handle the claim . . . we want others to believe we did the right thing.”11 up for historical discrimination by giving groups who have been affected enhanced opportunities for employment. RACE/ETHNIC/NATIONAL ORIGIN The focus now shifts to equal employment laws and necessary considerations for managing HR in light of these laws. Civil Rights Act of 1964, Title VII Although the very first civil rights act was passed in 1866, it was not until passage of the Civil Rights Act of 1964 that the keystone of antidiscrimination employment legislation was put into place. The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission (EEOC) was established to enforce the provisions of Title VII, the portion of the act that deals with employment. Title VII of the Civil Rights Act states that it is illegal for an employer to: 1. fail or refuse to hire or discharge any individual, or otherwise discriminate against any individual with respect to his compensation, terms, conditions, or privileges of employment because of such individual’s race, color, religion, sex, or national origin, or 2. limit, segregate, or classify his employees or applicants for employment in any way that would deprive or tend to deprive any individual of employment Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 78 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 79 opportunities or otherwise adversely affect his status as an employee because of such individual’s race, color, religion, sex, or national origin. Title VII Coverage Title VII, as amended by the Equal Employment Opportunity Act of 1972, covers most employers in the United States. Any organization meeting one of the criteria in the following list is subject to rules and regulations that specific government agencies have established to administer the act: • • • • • • All private employers of 15 or more persons who are employed 20 or more weeks a year All educational institutions, public and private State and local governments Public and private employment agencies Labor unions with 15 or more members Joint labor/management committees for apprenticeships and training Title VII has been the basis for several extensions of EEO law. For example, in 1980, the EEOC interpreted the law to include sexual harassment. Further, a number of concepts identified in Title VII are the foundation for court decisions, regulations, and other laws discussed later in the chapter. See Appendix E for information on EEO enforcement. Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478 Numerous executive orders require that employers holding federal government contracts not discriminate on the basis of race, color, religion, national origin, or sex. An Executive Order is issued by the president of the United States to provide direction to government departments on a specific area. The Office of Federal Contract Compliance Programs (OFCCP) in the U.S. Department of Labor has responsibility for enforcing nondiscrimination in government contracts. Executive Orders 11246, 11375, and 11478 are major federal EEO efforts for government contractors; many states have similar requirements for firms with state government contracts. Civil Rights Act of 1991 The Civil Rights Act of 1991 requires employers to show that an employment practice is job related for the position and is consistent with business necessity. The act clarifies that the plaintiffs bringing the discrimination charges must identify the particular employer practice being challenged and must show only that protected-class status played some role in their treatment. For employers, this requirement means that an individual’s race, color, religion, sex, or national origin must play no role in their employment practices. This act allows people who have been targets of intentional discrimination based on sex, religion, or disability to receive both compensatory and punitive damages. One key provision of the 1991 act relates to how U.S. laws on EEO are applied globally. Managing Racial and National Origin Issues The original purpose of the Civil Rights Act of 1964 was to address race and national origin discrimination. This concern continues to be important today, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 79 26/06/10 8:01 PM 80 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management and employers must be aware of potential HR issues that are based on race, national origin, and citizenship in order to take appropriate actions. Employment discrimination can occur in numerous ways, from refusal to hire someone because of the person’s race/ethnicity to the questions asked in a selection interview. See Appendix D for examples of legal and illegal question areas. For example, a trucking company settled a discrimination lawsuit by African American employees who were denied job assignments and promotions because of racial bias. In addition to paying a fine, the firm must report to the EEOC on promotions from part-time to full-time for dock worker jobs. Sometimes racial discriminations can be more subtle. For example, some firms have tapped professional and social networking sites to fill open positions. However, networking sites exclude many people. According to one study, only 5% of LinkedIn users are black and 2% are Hispanic. This lack of access to these sites can easily be viewed as racial discrimination.12 Under federal law, discriminating against people because of skin color is just as illegal as discriminating because of race. For example, one might be guilty of color discrimination but not racial discrimination if one hired lightskinned African Americans over dark-skinned people. Racial/Ethnic Harassment The area of racial/ethnic harassment is such a concern that the EEOC has issued guidelines on it. It is recommended that employers adopt policies against harassment of any type, including ethnic jokes, vulgar epithets, racial slurs, and physical actions. The consequences of not enforcing these policies are seen in a case involving a small business employer that subjected Latinos to physical and verbal abuse. Hispanic males at the firm were subjected to derogatory jokes, verbal abuse, physical harm, and other humiliating experiences. Settling the case was expensive for the employer. Contrast that case with another that shows the advantage of taking quick remedial action. An employee filed a lawsuit against an airline because coworkers told racist jokes and hung nooses in his workplace. The airline was able to show that each time any employee, including the plaintiff, reported problems, management conducted an investigation and took action against the offending employees. The court ruled for the employer in this case because the situation was managed properly. Affirmative Action Affirmative Action The hiring of groups of people based on their race, age, gender or national origin. Through affirmative action, employers are urged to hire groups of people based on their race, age, gender, or national origin to make up for historical discrimination. It is a requirement for federal government contractors to document the inclusion of women and racial minorities in the workforce. As part of those government regulations, covered employers must submit plans describing their attempts to narrow the gaps between the composition of their workforces and the composition of labor markets where they obtain employees. However, affirmative action has been the subject of numerous court cases and an ongoing political and social debate both in the United States and globally.13 For example, a recent Supreme Court ruling held that race should not be used to the detriment of individuals who passed an examination and were qualified for promotions. In this case, the city of New Haven, Connecticut, threw out the results of a test for promotion where more white firefighters passed than blacks or Hispanics. The City claimed it had to junk the tests because they would lead to an avalanche of lawsuits by black candidates who Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 80 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 81 had not passed. The court said fear of litigation was no reason to rely on race to throw out the results.14 Supporters offer many reasons why affirmative action is important, while opponents argue firmly against it. Individuals can examine the points of both sides in the debate and compare them with their personal views of affirmative action. The authors of this text believe that whether one supports or opposes affirmative action, it is important to understand why its supporters believe that it is needed and why its opponents believe it should be discontinued. The reasons given most frequently by both sides are highlighted in Figure 3-3. Managing Affirmative Action Requirements Affirmative action plan (AAP) A document reporting on the composition of an employer’s workforce, required for federal contractors. FIGURE 3-3 Federal, state, and local regulations require many government contractors to compile affirmative action plans to report on the composition of their workforces. An affirmative action plan (AAP) is a formal document that an employer compiles annually for submission to enforcement agencies. Generally, contractors with at least 50 employees and $50,000 in government contracts annually must submit these plans. Courts have noted that any employer may have a voluntary AAP, although employers must have such a plan if they are government contractors. Some courts have ordered employers that are not government The Debate about Affirmative Action Arguments: Why Affirmative Action Is Needed Affirmative action is needed to overcome past injustices or eliminate the effects of those injustices. Affirmative action creates more equality for all persons, even if temporary injustice to some individuals may result. Raising the employment level of protected-class members will benefit U.S. society in the long run. Properly used, affirmative action does not discriminate against males or whites. Goals indicate progress is needed, not quotas. Arguments: Why Affirmative Action Is Not Needed Affirmative action penalizes individuals (males and whites) even though they have not been guilty of practicing discrimination. It is no longer needed as an African American has been elected President. Affirmative action results in greater polarization and separatism along gender and racial lines. Affirmative action stigmatizes those it is designed to help. Goals become quotas and force employers to “play by the numbers.” Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 81 26/06/10 8:01 PM 82 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management contractors to submit required AAPs because of past discriminatory practices and violations of laws. The contents of an AAP and the policies flowing from it must be available for review by managers and supervisors within the organization. Plans vary in length; some are long and require extensive staff time to prepare. M Affirmative Action Plan Metrics A crucial but time-consuming part of an AAP is the analyses. The availability analysis identifies the number of protected-class members available to work in the appropriate labor markets for given jobs. This analysis can be developed with data from a state labor department, the U.S. Census Bureau, and other sources. The utilization analysis E A S U R E identifies the number of protected-class members employed in the organization and the types of jobs they hold. Once all the data have been analyzed and compared, then underutilization statistics must be calculated by comparing the availability analysis with the utilization analysis. It is useful to think of this stage as a comparison of whether the internal workforce is a “representative sampling” of the available external labor force from which employees are hired. Using the underutilization data, goals and timetables for reducing underutilization of protected-class individuals must then be identified. Actions that will be taken to recruit, LOGGING ON hire, promote, and train more protected-class individuals The Affirmative Action and are described. The AAP must be updated and reviewed each Diversity Project year to reflect changes in the utilization and availability A resource for opinions surrounding of protected-category members. If the AAP is audited, the the issues of affirmative action and its employer must be prepared to provide additional details cultural and economic aspects can be and documentation. Appendix F provides information found at http://aad.english.ucsb.edu. about EEO enforcement. SEX/GENDER DISCRIMINATION LAWS AND REGULATIONS A number of laws and regulations address discrimination based on sex or gender. Historically, women experienced employment discrimination in a variety of ways. The inclusion of sex as a basis for protected-class status in Title VII of the 1964 Civil Rights Act has led to various areas of legal protection for women. Pregnancy Discrimination Availability analysis Identifies the number of protected-class members available to work in the appropriate labor markets for given jobs. Utilization analysis Identifies the number of protected-class members employed in the organization and the types of jobs they hold. The Pregnancy Discrimination Act (PDA) of 1978 requires that any employer with 15 or more employees treat maternity leave the same as other personal or medical leaves. Closely related to the PDA is the Family and Medical Leave Act (FMLA) of 1993, which requires that individuals be given up to 12 weeks of family leave without pay and also requires that those taking family leave be allowed to return to jobs (see Chapter 13 for details). The FMLA applies to both men and women. Courts have generally ruled that the PDA requires employers to treat pregnant employees the same as nonpregnant employees with similar abilities or inabilities. Employers have been found to have acted properly when terminating a pregnant employee for excessive absenteeism due to pregnancy-related Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 82 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 83 illnesses, because the employee was not treated differently from other employees with absenteeism problems. Equal Pay and Pay Equity The Equal Pay Act of 1963 requires employers to pay similar wage rates for similar work without regard to gender. A common core of tasks must be similar, but tasks performed only intermittently or infrequently do not make jobs different enough to justify significantly different wages. Differences in pay between men and women in the same jobs may be allowed because of: 1. 2. 3. 4. Pay equity The idea that pay for jobs requiring comparable levels of knowledge, skill, and ability should be similar, even if actual duties differ significantly. Sexual harassment Actions that are sexually directed, are unwanted, and subject the worker to adverse employment conditions or create a hostile work environment. Differences in seniority Differences in performance Differences in quality and/or quantity of production Factors other than sex, such as skill, effort, and working conditions For example, a university was found to have violated the Equal Pay Act by paying a female professor a starting salary lower than salaries paid to male professors with similar responsibilities. In fact, the court found that the woman professor taught larger classes and had more total students than some of the male faculty members.15 Ledbetter v. Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co. was a significant U.S. Supreme Court decision on pay discrimination. Ledbetter, a female manager with Goodyear in Alabama, claimed that she was subjected to pay discrimination because she received lower pay during her career back to 1979, even though she did not file suit until 1998.16 The decision examined this view and stated that the rights of workers to sue for previous years of paid discrimination are limited. However, in 2009 Congress passed the Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act that canceled the Supreme Court ruling. The new law effectively eliminates the statute of limitations for employees to file pay discrimination claims.17 Pay equity is the idea that pay for jobs requiring comparable levels of knowledge, skill, and ability should be similar, even if actual duties differ significantly. This theory has also been called comparable worth in earlier cases. Some state laws have mandated pay equity for public-sector employees. However, U.S. federal courts generally have ruled that the existence of pay differences between the different jobs held by women and men is not sufficient to prove that illegal discrimination has occurred. A major reason for the development of the pay equity idea is the continuing gap between the earnings of women and men. For instance, in 1980, the average annual pay of full-time female workers was 60% of that of full-time male workers. By 2008, the reported rate of about 80% showed some progress but a continuing disparity.18 See Figure 3-4. Sexual Harassment The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission has issued guidelines designed to curtail sexual harassment. Sexual harassment refers to actions that are sexually directed, are unwanted, and subject the worker to adverse employment conditions or create a hostile work environment. Sexual harassment can occur between a boss and a subordinate, among coworkers, and when nonemployees have business contacts with employees. Most of the sexual harassment charges filed involve harassment of women by men. However, some sexual harassment cases have been filed by men Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 83 26/06/10 8:01 PM 84 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Female Annual Earnings as Percentage of Male Earnings Wage Ratio FIGURE 3-4 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 1960 1965 1970 1975 1980 1985 1990 1995 Year 2000 2005 2010 (projected) Source: U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, 2009, www.bls.gov. against women managers and supervisors, and some have been filed by both men and women for same-sex harassment. Managing Sex/Gender Issues The influx of women into the workforce has had major social, economic, and organizational consequences. The percentage of women in the total U.S. civilian workforce has increased dramatically since 1950, to almost 50% today. This growth in the number of women in the workforce has led to more sex/ gender issues related to jobs and careers. A significant issue is related to biology (women bear children) and to tradition (women have a primary role in raising children). A major result of the increasing share of women in the workforce is that more women with children are working. According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, about three-fourths of women aged 25–54 are in the workforce. Further, about half of all women currently working are single, separated, divorced, widowed, or otherwise single heads of households. Consequently, they are “primary” income earners, not co-income providers, and must balance family and work responsibilities. This responsibility may affect managers’ perceptions of family/work conflict that may lead to promotability issues for women.19 To guard against pay inequities that are considered illegal under the Equal Pay Act, employers should follow these guidelines: • • • • • Include all benefits and other items that are part of remuneration to calculate total compensation for the most accurate overall picture. Make sure people know how the pay practices work. Base pay on the value of jobs and performance. Benchmark against local and national markets so that pay structures are competitive. Conduct frequent audits to ensure there are no gender-based inequities and that pay is fair internally. Nontraditional Jobs The right to reassign women from hazardous jobs to ones that may be lower paying but less hazardous because of health-related concerns is another gender-related issue encountered by employers. Fears about Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 84 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 85 Equal Employment Opportunity Women as Percentage of Total Employees by Selected Industries FIGURE 3-5 Higher Percentages Lower Percentages Child day care 95.3 % Taxi/ limousine services 11.6% Home healt h care 89.1% Aut omot ive repair 10.6% Vet erinary services 81.7% Const ruct ion 9.7% Hospit als 76.7% Landscaping services 8.6% E lement ary and secondary schools 75.6% Coal mining 7.2% Pharmacies and drug st ores 64.8% Rail t ransport at ion 5.9% Travel/reservat ion services 61.6% Logging 4.4% Source: U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics, 2008, www.bls.gov. higher health insurance costs and possible lawsuits involving such problems as birth defects caused by damage sustained during pregnancy have led some employers to institute reproductive and fetal protection policies. However, the U.S. Supreme Court has ruled that such policies are illegal. Also, having different job conditions for men and women is usually held to be discriminatory. Figure 3-5 shows some of the occupations in which women constitute high percentages and low percentages of those employed. Jobs that pay well but are nontraditional jobs for women include: architects, computer programmers, software engineers, detectives, chefs, engineers, computer repair, construction, building inspectors, machinists, aircraft pilots, and firefighters.20 Glass ceiling Discriminatory practices that have prevented women and other protectedclass members from advancing to executive-level jobs. Glass Ceiling For years, women’s groups have alleged that women in workplaces encounter a glass ceiling, which refers to discriminatory practices that have prevented women and other protected-class members from advancing to executive-level jobs. Women in the United States are making some progress in getting senior-level, managerial, and professional jobs. Nevertheless, women hold only a small percentage of the highest-ranking executive management jobs in big companies. By comparison, women hold a considerably lower percentage of the same kinds of jobs in France, Germany, Brazil, and many other countries. A related problem is that women have tended to advance to senior management in a limited number of support or staff areas, such as HR and corporate communications. Because executive jobs in these “supporting” areas tend to pay less than jobs in sales, marketing, operations, or finance, the overall impact is to reduce women’s career progression and income. Limits that keep women from progressing only in certain fields have been referred to as “glass walls” or “glass elevators.” These limitations are seen as being tied to organizational, cultural, and leadership issues.21 “Breaking the Glass” A number of employers have recognized that “breaking the glass,” whether ceilings, walls, or elevators, is good business for both Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 85 26/06/10 8:01 PM 86 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management women and racial minorities. Some of the most common means used to “break the glass” are as follows: • • • • • Establish formal mentoring programs for women and members of racial/ ethnic minorities. Provide opportunities for career rotation into operations, marketing, and sales for individuals who have shown talent in accounting, HR, and other areas. Increase the memberships of top management and boards of directors to include women and individuals of color. Establish clear goals for retention and progression of protected-category individuals and hold managers accountable for achieving these goals. Allow for alternative work arrangements for employees, particularly those balancing work/family responsibilities. Individuals with Differing Sexual Orientations As if demographic diversity did not place enough pressure on managers and organizations, individuals in the workforce today have widely varying lifestyles that can have work-related consequences. Legislative efforts have been made to protect individuals with differing lifestyles or sexual orientations from employment discrimination, though at present only a few cities and states have passed such laws. One visible issue that some employers have had to address is that of individuals who have had or are undergoing sex-change surgery and therapy. Federal court cases and the EEOC have ruled that sex discrimination under Title VII applies to a person’s gender at birth. Thus, it does not apply to the new gender of those who have had gender-altering operations. Sexual orientation or sex-change issues that arise at work include the reactions of coworkers and managers and ensuring that such individuals are evaluated fairly and not discriminated against in work assignments, raises, training, or promotions. Nepotism Many employers have policies that restrict or prohibit nepotism, the practice of allowing relatives to work for the same employer. Other firms require only that relatives not work directly for or with each other or not be placed in positions where collusion or conflict could occur. The policies most frequently cover spouses, brothers, sisters, mothers, fathers, sons, and daughters. Generally, employer antinepotism policies have been upheld by courts, in spite of the concern that they tend to discriminate against women more than men (because women tend to be denied employment or to leave employers more often as a result of marriage to other employees).22 Consensual Relationships and Romance at Work Nepotism Practice of allowing relatives to work for the same employer. When work-based friendships lead to romance and off-the-job sexual relationships, managers and employers face a dilemma: Should they “monitor” these relationships to protect the firm from potential legal complaints, thereby “meddling” in employees’ private, off-the-job lives? Or do they simply ignore these relationships and the potential problems they present? These concerns Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 86 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 87 Equal Employment Opportunity are significant, given a survey that found that about 40% of workers have dated coworkers.23 Most executives and HR professionals (as well as employees) agree that workplace romances are risky because they have great potential for causing conflict. They strongly agree that romance must not take place between a supervisor and a subordinate. Some employers have addressed the issue of workplace romances by establishing policies dealing with them.24 Different actions may be appropriate if a relationship is clearly consensual than if it is forced by a supervisor–subordinate relationship. One consideration is the observation that consensual workplace romances can create hostile work environments for others in organizations. Dealing with Sexual Harassment Sexual harassment is a significant concern in many organizations and can occur in a variety of workplace relationships. As shown in Figure 3-6, individuals in many different roles can be sexual harassers. For example, third parties who are neither employers nor employees have been found to be harassers. Both customer service representatives and food servers have won sexual harassment complaints because their employers refused to protect them from regular sexual harassment by aggressive customers. Most frequently, sexual harassment occurs when a male in a supervisory or managerial position harasses women within his “power structure.” However, as noted earlier, women managers have been found guilty of sexually harassing male employees, and same-sex harassment also has occurred. Court decisions have held that a person’s sexual orientation neither provides nor precludes a claim of sexual harassment under Title VII. It is enough that the harasser engaged in pervasive and unwelcome conduct of a sexual nature. FIGURE 3-6 Potential Sexual Harassers Supervisors Other Employees Customers Employee Former Employees Vendors CoWorkers Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 87 26/06/10 8:01 PM 88 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Types of Sexual Harassment Two basic types of sexual harassment have been defined by EEOC regulations and a large number of court cases. The two types are different in nature and defined as follows: 1. Quid pro quo is harassment in which employment outcomes are linked to the individual granting sexual favors. 2. Hostile environment harassment exists when an individual’s work performance or psychological well-being is unreasonably affected by intimidating or offensive working conditions. In quid pro quo harassment, an employee may be promised a promotion, a special raise, or a desirable work assignment, but only if the employee grants some sexual favors to the supervisor. The second type, hostile environment harassment, may include actions such as commenting on appearance or attire, telling jokes that are suggestive or sexual in nature, allowing revealing photos and posters to be on display, or making continual requests to get together after work that can lead to the creation of a hostile work environment. Rude and discourteous behavior often is linked to sexual harassment. As computer and Internet technology has spread, the number of electronic sexual harassment cases has grown.25 Sexual harassment is increasingly occurring via e-mails and Internet access systems. Cyber sexual harassment may occur when an employee forwards an e-mail joke with sexual content or accesses pornographic websites at work and then shares content with other employees. Cyber stalking, in which a person continually e-mails an employee requesting dates and sending personal messages, is growing as instant messaging expands. Many employers have policies addressing the inappropriate use of e-mail, company computer systems, and electronic technology usage. Serious situations have led to employee terminations. Once a company disciplined more than 200 employees and fired 50 of them for having e-mailed pornographic images and other inappropriate materials using the company information system. Many employers have equipped their computer systems with scanners that screen for inappropriate words and images. Offending employees receive warnings and/or disciplinary actions associated with “flagged” items. Employer Responses to Sexual Harassment Quid pro quo Sexual harassment in which employment outcomes are linked to the individual granting sexual favors. Hostile environment Sexual harassment in which an individual’s work performance or psychological well-being is unreasonably affected by intimidating or offensive working conditions. Employers must be proactive to prevent sexual and other types of harassment. If the workplace culture fosters harassment, and if policies and practices do not inhibit harassment, an employer is wise to reevaluate and solve the problem before lawsuits follow. Only if the employer can produce evidence of taking reasonable care to prohibit sexual harassment does the employer have the possibility of avoiding liability through an affirmative defense.26 Critical components of ensuring such reasonable care include the following: • • • • Establish a sexual harassment policy. Communicate the policy regularly. Train employees and managers on avoiding sexual harassment. Investigate and take action when complaints are voiced. As Figure 3-7 indicates, if an employee has suffered any tangible employment action (such as being denied raises, being terminated, or being refused access to Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 88 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 89 Equal Employment Opportunity FIGURE 3-7 Sexual Harassment Liability Determination Sexual Harassment (Quid pro quo or hostile environment occurred) Legal Focus Employee Consequence Employee Suffered No Tangible Employment Action Employee Suffered Tangible Employment Actions Employer Action Employer Produced an Affirmative Defense Employer Produced No Affirmative Defense Employer Liability Employer Is Probably Not Liable Employer Is Probably Liable Source: Virginia Collins, PhD, SPHR, and Robert L. Mathis, PhD, SPHR, Omaha, Nebraska. training) because of sexual harassment, then the employer is liable. Even if the employee has suffered no tangible employment action, if the employer has not produced an affirmative defense, then employer liability still exists. Harassment Likelihood G L O B A L Research suggests that some people are more likely to be sexually harassed than others. For example, one study found that supervisors or women with more workplace authority are more likely to be harassed.27 Further research suggests that the likelihood of men to sexually harass, and the tolerance for sexual harassment by women vary across countries. Fundamental differences regarding power between men and women and a cultural support of sexual harassment lead to very different sexual harassment situations from country to country. According to this research, Canada, Denmark, Germany, The Netherlands, Sweden, and the United States are likely to have relatively less sexual harassment than countries like East Africa, Hong Kong, Indonesia, Malaysia, Mexico, Turkey, and Yugoslavia.28 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 89 26/06/10 8:01 PM 90 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management INDIVIDUALS WITH DISABILITIES The passage of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) in 1990 began the laws and regulations on discrimination against individuals with disabilities. These laws and regulations affect employment matters as well as public accessibility for individuals with disabilities. Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) Organizations with 15 or more employees are covered by the provisions of the ADA, which are enforced by the EEOC. The act applies to private employers, employment agencies, and labor unions.29 State government employees are not covered by the ADA, which means that they cannot sue in federal courts for redress and damages. However, they may still bring suits under state laws in state courts. Essential job functions Fundamental job duties. Reasonable accommodation A modification to a job or work environment that gives a qualified individual an equal employment opportunity to perform. Undue hardship Significant difficulty or expense imposed on an employer in making an accommodation for individuals with disabilities. Disabled person Someone who has a physical or mental impairment that substantially limits life activities, who has a record of such an impairment, or who is regarded as having such an impairment. ADA and Job Requirements Discrimination is prohibited against individuals with disabilities who can perform the essential job functions—the fundamental job duties—of the employment positions that those individuals hold or desire. These functions do not include marginal functions of the position. For a qualified person with a disability, an employer must make a reasonable accommodation, which is a modification to a job or work environment that gives that individual an equal employment opportunity to perform. EEOC guidelines encourage employers and individuals to work together to determine what are appropriate reasonable accommodations, rather than employers alone making those judgments. Reasonable accommodation is restricted to actions that do not place an undue hardship on an employer. An undue hardship is a significant difficulty or expense imposed on an employer in making an accommodation for individuals with disabilities. The ADA offers only general guidelines in determining when an accommodation becomes unreasonable and will place undue hardship on an employer. ADA Restrictions and Medical Information The ADA contains restrictions on obtaining and retaining medically related information on applicants and employees. Restrictions include prohibiting employers from rejecting individuals because of a disability and from asking job applicants any question about current or past medical history until a conditional job offer is made. Also, the ADA prohibits the use of preemployment medical exams, except for drug tests, until a job has been conditionally offered. Who Is Disabled? As defined by the ADA, a disabled person is someone who has a physical or mental impairment that substantially limits that person in some major life activities, who has a record of such an impairment, or who is regarded as having such an impairment. Figure 3-8 shows the most frequent disabilities identified in ADA charges. However, it is not always concluded that people have disabilities when they feel they are disabled. For example, in a case involving United Parcel Service, the Court ruled that an employee who had high blood pressure but was on blood pressure medications was not disabled under the ADA.30 Another U.S. Supreme Court case found that an employee who had been fired for drug Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 90 26/06/10 8:01 PM 91 Equal Employment Opportunity CHAPTER 3 Most Frequent ADA Disabilities Cited FIGURE 3-8 Non-paralytic orthopedic 8.6% 6.7% Depression 4.2% Impairment/Special Diabetes Heart/ cardiovascular 3.9% Hearing impairments 3.1% Cancer 2.7% Psychological disorders 2.7% 2.5% Vision Epilepsy 0.0% 1.9% 2.0% 4.0% 6.0% 8.0% 10.0% % of Total Cases Source: Based on data from U.S. Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, 2009; see www.eeoc.gov for details. addiction was not entitled to be rehired because his addiction was not a disability. The ADA does not protect current users of illegal drugs and substances, but it does protect those who are recovering addicts. Mental Disabilities A growing area of concern to employers under the ADA is individuals with mental disabilities. A mental illness is often more difficult to diagnose than a physical disability. Employers must be careful when considering “emotional” or “mental health” factors such as depression in employment-related decisions. They must not stereotype individuals with mental impairments or disabilities but must instead base their evaluations on sound medical information. Amendments to ADA (ADAAA) Congress passed amendments to the ADA, effective in 2009, that overruled several key cases and regulations. The effect was to expand the definition of disabled individuals to include anyone with a physical or mental impairment that substantially limits one or more major life activities without regard for the ameliorative effects of mitigating measures such as medication, prosthetics, hearing aids, and so on. Major life activities include, among others, walking, seeing, breathing, working, sleeping, concentrating, thinking, and communicating.31 Genetic Bias Regulations Related to medical disabilities is the emerging area of workplace genetic bias. As medical research has revealed the human genome, medical tests have been developed that can identify an individual’s genetic markers for various diseases. Whether these tests should be used and how they are used can raise ethical issues. Employers that use genetic screening tests do so for two primary reasons. Some use genetic testing to make workers aware of genetic problems that Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 91 26/06/10 8:01 PM 92 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management may exist so that medical treatments can begin. Others use genetic testing to terminate employees who may make extensive use of health insurance benefits and thus raise the benefits costs and utilization rates of the employer. A major railroad company, Burlington Northern Santa Fe, had to publicly apologize to employees for secretly testing to determine if they were genetically predisposed to carpal tunnel syndrome. Genetic Information Nondiscrimination Act (GINA) Congress passed GINA to limit the use of information by health insurance plans. Employers are prohibited from collecting genetic information or making employment decisions based on genetic decisions. “Genetic information” includes genetic tests of the employee or family members and family medical history. It does not apply to “water cooler talk,” or the inadvertent acquisition of information.32 Managing Disabilities in the Workforce At the heart of managing individuals with disabilities is for employers to make reasonable accommodations in several areas. Common means of reasonable accommodation are shown in Figure 3-9. First, architectural barriers should not prohibit disabled individuals’ access to work areas or restrooms. Second, appropriate work tasks must be assigned. Satisfying this requirement may mean modifying jobs, work area layouts, or work schedules or providing special equipment. Key to making reasonable accommodations is identifying the essential job functions and then determining which accommodations are reasonable so that the individual can perform the core job duties. Fortunately for employers, most accommodations needed are relatively inexpensive.33 Recruiting and Selecting Individuals with Disabilities Numerous employers have specifically targeted the recruitment and selection of individuals with disabilities. However, as the HR On-the-Job indicates, questions asked in the employment process should be job related. FIGURE 3-9 Common Means of Reasonable Accommodation Modified Work Schedules Special Equipment Job Restructuring Reasonable Accommodation Job Reassignment Employer-Provided Assistance Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 92 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 93 Equal Employment Opportunity ADA and Employment Questions The Americans with Disabilities Act prohibits asking job applicants questions about past or current health history until a conditional job offer is made. The offer often is based on passing a physical exam or a medical background check. Any physical or medical requirements must be related to the specific job for which the applicant is being considered. Two HR areas that are affected are employment applications and interviews. In these areas, a general question such as the following is often used: Can you perform the essential functions of the job for which you are applying with or without accommodation? Several examples of specific questions concerning disabilities that should and should not be asked in employment interviews are shown in the following chart. As is evident, the questions that should be asked are specifically related to the job and address essential job functions. HR on-the-job ✗ DO NOT ASK • Do you have any physical or mental disabilities? • Why are you using crutches, and how did you become injured? • How many times were you absent due to illness in the past two years? • Have you been treated for any of the following medical conditions? • Have you ever filed for or collected workers’ compensation? ✓ DO ASK • How would you perform the essential tasks of the job for which you have applied? • If hired, which tasks outlined in the job description that you reviewed would be more enjoyable and which ones most difficult? • Describe your attendance record on your last job. • Describe any problems you would have reaching the top of a six-foot filing cabinet. • What did your prior job duties consist of, and which ones were the most challenging? One common selection test is a physical abilities test, which can be challenged as discriminatory based on the ADA. Such physical tests must be specifically job related, and not general. For example, having all applicants lift 50-pound weights, even though only some warehouse workers will have to lift that much, could be illegal. Also, rather than testing with barbells or other artificial weights, the employer should use the actual 50-pound boxes lifted in performing the specific jobs. Employees Who Develop Disabilities For many employers, the impact of the ADA has been the greatest when handling employees who develop disabilities, not dealing with applicants who already have disabilities. As the workforce ages, it is likely that more employees will develop disabilities. For instance, a warehouse worker who suffers a serious leg injury while motorcycling away from work may request reasonable accommodation. Employers must develop responses for handling accommodation requests from individuals who have been satisfactory employees without disabilities, but who now must be considered for accommodations if they are to be able to Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 93 26/06/10 8:01 PM 94 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management continue working. Handled inappropriately, these individuals are likely to file either ADA complaints with the EEOC or private lawsuits. Employees sometimes can be shifted to other jobs where their disabilities do not affect them as much. For instance, the warehouse firm might be able to move the injured repair worker to a purchasing inventory job inside so that climbing and lifting are unnecessary. But the problem for employers is what to do with the next worker who develops problems if an alternative job is not available. Even if the accommodations are just for one employee, the reactions of coworkers must be considered. Individuals with Mental Disabilities More ADA complaints are being filed by individuals who have or claim to have mental disabilities. The cases that have been filed have ranged from individuals with a medical history of paranoid schizophrenia or clinical depression to individuals who claim that job stress has affected their marriage or sex life. Regardless of the type of employees’ claims, it is important that employers respond properly by obtaining medical verifications for claims of mental illnesses and considering accommodation requests for mental disabilities in the same manner as accommodation requests for physical disabilities. Individuals with Life-Threatening Illnesses The U.S. Supreme Court has determined that individuals with life-threatening illnesses are covered by the ADA. Individuals with leukemia, cancer, or AIDS are all considered as having disabilities, and employers must respond to them appropriately or face charges of discrimination. Numerous individuals with life-threatening illnesses may intend to continue working, particularly if their illness is forecast to be multiyear in nature. An additional requirement of the ADA is that all medical information be maintained in files separated from the general personnel files. The medical files must have identified security procedures, and limited access procedures must be identified. Management Focus on ADAAA Adaptation After the changes made by ADAAA, less effort should be placed on determining whether an individual is indeed disabled—the individual probably is disabled. Rather, management should: • • • • Define essential functions in advance. Handle all requests for accommodation properly. Interact with the employee with good faith and documentation. Know and follow the reasonable accommodation rules. AGE AND EQUAL EMPLOYMENT OPPORTUNITY The populations of most developed countries—including Australia, Japan, most European countries, and the United States—are aging. These changes mean that as older workers with a lifetime of experiences and skills retire, HR faces significant challenges in replacing them with workers having the capabilities and work ethic that characterize many mature workers in the United States. Employment discrimination against individuals age 40 and older is prohibited by the Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA). Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 94 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 95 Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA) The Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA) of 1967, amended in 1978 and 1986, prohibits discrimination in terms, conditions, or privileges of employment against all individuals age 40 years or older working for employers having 20 or more workers. However, the U.S. Supreme Court has ruled that state employees may not sue state government employers in federal courts because the ADEA is a federal law. The impact of the ADEA is increasing as the U.S. workforce has been aging.34 Consequently, the number of age discrimination cases has been increasing, according to EEOC reports. A number of countries have passed age discrimination laws. For example, age discrimination regulations in Great Britain focus on preventing age discrimination in recruitment, promotion, training, and retirement-related actions.35 As with most EEO issues, age discrimination details are continuing to be defined by the various courts, with the Supreme Court having decided employers are not liable if the disparate age impact is due to “reasonable factors other than age” (RFOA). The specific cases decided recently suggest that the employee retains the heavier burden for proving that the adverse employment action was taken because of the employee’s age.36 However, employers that focus on recruiting or providing “preferential treatment” of older workers do not violate the ADEA. Older Workers Benefit Protection Act (OWBPA) This law is an amendment to the ADEA and is aimed at protecting employees when they sign liability waivers for age discrimination in exchange for severance packages. To comply with the act, employees must be given complete accurate information on the available benefits. For example, an early retirement package that includes a waiver stating the employee will not sue for age discriminaLOGGING ON tion if the employee takes the money for early retirement Administration on Aging must include a written, clearly understood agreement to This government website provides that effect. information on aging and age The impact of the OWBPA is becoming more evident. discrimination from government Industries such as manufacturing and others offer early agencies, associations, and organizations. Visit the site at retirement buyouts to cut their workforces. For instance, www.aoa.gov. Ford and General Motors have offered large buyouts of which thousands of workers have taken advantage. Managing Age Discrimination One issue that has led to age discrimination charges is labeling older workers as “overqualified” for jobs or promotions. In a number of cases, courts have ruled that the term overqualified may have been used as a code word for workers being too old, thus causing them not to be considered for employment. Also, selection and promotion practices must be “age neutral.” Older workers face substantial barriers to entry in a number of occupations, especially those requiring significant amounts of training or ones where new technology has been recently developed. In some cases involving older employees, age-related comments such as “That’s just old Fred” or “We need younger blood” in conversations were used as evidence of age discrimination. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 95 26/06/10 8:01 PM 96 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management To counter significant staffing difficulties, some employers recruit older people to return to the workforce through the use of part-time and other scheduling options. During the past decade, the number of older workers holding part-time jobs has increased. It is likely that the number of older workers interested in working part-time will continue to grow. A strategy used by employers to retain the talents of older workers is phased retirement, whereby employees gradually reduce their workloads and pay levels. This option is growing in use as a way to allow older workers with significant knowledge and experience to have more personal flexibility, while the organizations retain them for their valuable capabilities. Some firms also rehire their retirees as part-time workers, independent contractors, or consultants.37 Some provisions in the Pension Protection Act of 2006 allow pension distributions for employees who are reducing their work hours. RELIGION AND SPIRITUALITY IN THE WORKPLACE Title VII of the Civil Rights Act identifies discrimination on the basis of religion as illegal. The increasing religious diversity in the workforce has put greater emphasis on religious considerations in workplaces. However, religious schools and institutions can use religion as a bona fide occupational qualification for employment practices on a limited scale. Also, employers must make reasonable accommodation efforts regarding an employee’s religious beliefs according to the U.S. Supreme Court. Since the terrorist attacks in New York and Washington, DC, increased discrimination complaints have been filed by Muslims because of treatment or insults made by coworkers and managers.38 Religious cases also have addressed the issues of beards, mustaches, and hair length and style. African American men, who are more likely than white men to suffer from a skin disease that is worsened by shaving, have filed suits challenging policies prohibiting beards or long sideburns. Generally, courts have ruled for employers in such cases, except where certain religious standards expect men to have facial hair. The legal requirement to reasonably accommodate religious practices and beliefs leads to different types of religious expression in the workplace and different limits to accommodation.39 Managing Religious Diversity Phased retirement Approach in which employees gradually reduce their workloads and pay levels. Employers increasingly are having to balance the rights of employees with differing religious beliefs. One way to do that is to make reasonable accommodation for employees’ religious beliefs when assigning and scheduling work, because many religions have differing days of worship and holidays. For example, some firms have established “holiday swapping pools,” whereby Christian employees can work during Passover or Ramadan or Chinese New Year, and employees from other religions can work on Christmas. Other firms allow employees a set number of days off for holidays, without specifying the holidays in company personnel policies. Figure 3-10 indicates common areas for accommodating religious diversity. One potential area for conflict between employer policies and employee religious practices is dress and appearance. Some religions have standards about appropriate attire for women. Also, some religions expect men to have beards and facial hair, which may violate company appearance policies.40 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 96 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 97 Equal Employment Opportunity FIGURE 3-10 Managing Religion and Spirituality in Workplaces Managing Religious Diversity in Workplaces Accommodation of Religious Beliefs in Work Schedules Respect for Religious Practices Affecting Dress and Appearance Accommodation of Religious Expression in the Workplace Another issue concerns religious expression. In the last several years, employees in several cases have sued employers for prohibiting them from expressing their religious beliefs at work. In other cases, employers have had to take action because of the complaints by workers that employees were aggressively “pushing” their religious views at work, thus creating a “hostile environment.” Executives and owners of some firms have strong evangelical Christian beliefs that are carried over into their companies. Some display crosses, have Bible study groups for employees before work, sponsor Christian prayer groups, and support other efforts. But such actions can lead to non-Christians feeling discriminated against, thus creating a “hostile environment.” Other areas that may need to be considered when dealing with religion at work are food, onsite religion-based groups, office decorations, and religious practices at work.41 MANAGING OTHER DISCRIMINATION ISSUES Several different employment circumstances have resulted in a number of other key areas of potential discrimination. Some of the key issues are immigration, language, military status, sexual orientation, and appearance and weight. Immigration Reform and Control Acts (IRCA) The United States has always had a significant number of immigrants who come to work in this country. The increasing number of immigrants who have entered illegally has led to extensive political, social, and employment-related debates. The existence of more foreign-born workers means that employers must comply with the provisions of the Immigration Reform and Control Acts (IRCA). Employers are required to obtain and inspect I-9 forms, and verify documents such as birth certificates, passports, visas, and work permits. They can be fined if they knowingly hire illegal aliens. E-verify is a federal government source that can be used for this verification.42 Federal contractors must use it to verify employees legal status. Visas and Documentation Requirements Various revisions to the IRCA changed some of the restrictions on the entry of immigrants to work in U.S. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 97 26/06/10 8:01 PM 98 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management organizations, particularly organizations with high-technology and other “scarce skill” areas. More immigrants with specific skills have been allowed legal entry, and categories for entry visas were revised. Visas are granted by U.S. consular offices (there are more than 200 such offices throughout the world). Many different types of visas exist. Among those most commonly encountered by employers are the B1 for business visitors, H-1B for professional or specialized workers, and L-1 for intracompany transfers. Usually an employer must sponsor the workers. Companies are not supposed to hire employees to displace U.S. workers, and they must file documents with the Labor Department and pay prevailing U.S. wages to the visa holders. Despite these regulations, a number of unions and other entities view such programs as being used to circumvent the limits put on hiring foreign workers to displace U.S. workers. Given the volatile nature of this area, changes in federal, state, and local laws are likely to continue to be discussed, implemented, and reviewed in court decisions.43 Language Issues As the diversity of the workforce increases, more employees have language skills beyond English. Interestingly, some employers have attempted to restrict the use of foreign languages, while other employers have recognized that bilingual employees have valuable skills A number of employers have policies requiring that employees speak only English at work. These employers contend that the policies are necessary for valid business purposes. For instance, a manufacturer requires that employees working with dangerous chemicals use English to communicate hazardous situations to other workers and to read chemical labels. The EEOC has issued guidelines clearly stating that employers may require workers to speak only English at certain times or in certain situations, but the business necessity of the requirements must be justified. Teaching, customer service, and telemarketing are examples of positions that may require English skills and voice clarity. Some employers have found it beneficial to have bilingual employees so that foreign-language customers can contact someone who speaks their language. Some employers do not pay bilingual employees extra, believing that paying for the jobs being done is more appropriate than paying for language skills that are used infrequently on those jobs. Other employers pay “language premiums” if employees must speak to customers in another language. For instance, one employer pays workers in some locations a bonus if they are required to use a foreign language a majority of the time with customers. Bilingual employees are especially needed among police officers, airline flight personnel, hospital interpreters, international sales reps, and travel guides. Military Status and USERRA The employment rights of military veterans and reservists have been addressed in several laws. The two most important laws are the Vietnam Era Veterans Readjustment Assistance Act of 1974 and the Uniformed Services Employment and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA) of 1994. Under the latter, employees are required to notify their employers of military service obligations. Employers must give employees serving in the military leaves of absence protections under the USERRA, as Figure 3-11 highlights. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 98 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 99 Equal Employment Opportunity F I G U R E 3 - 11 Uniformed Services Employment and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA) Provisions Common Issues Leaves of absence Return to employment rights Prompt reemployment on return Protection from discharge/retaliation Health insurance continuation Continued seniority rights LOGGING ON Uniformed Services Employment and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA) For information on the U.S. Department of Labor’s Uniformed Services Employment and Reemployment Rights Act (USERRA), visit www.dol.gov/vets/programs/userra. With the use of reserves and National Guard troops abroad, the provisions of USERRA have had more impact on employers. This act does not require employers to pay employees while they are on military leave, but many firms provide some compensation, often a differential. Many requirements regarding benefits, disabilities, and reemployment are covered in the act as well.44 Sexual Orientation Recent battles in a number of states and communities illustrate the depth of emotions that accompany discussions of “gay rights.”45 Some states and cities have passed laws prohibiting discrimination based on sexual orientation or lifestyle. Even the issue of benefits coverage for “domestic partners,” whether heterosexual or homosexual, has been the subject of state and city legislation. No federal laws of a similar nature have been passed. Whether gays and lesbians have any special rights under the equal protection amendment to the U.S. Constitution has not been decided by the U.S. Supreme Court. A related issue is dealing with transgender individuals who have had sexchange surgery. Court cases and the EEOC have ruled that sex discrimination under Title VII applies to a person’s gender at birth. Thus, it does not apply to the new gender of those who have had gender-altering operations. Transvestites and individuals with sexual behavior disorders are specifically excluded from being considered as disabled under the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990. However, some states and several cities have laws prohibiting bias against transgender persons.46 Appearance and Weight Discrimination Several EEO cases have been filed concerning the physical appearance of employees. Court decisions consistently have allowed employers to set dress codes as long as they are applied uniformly. For example, establishing a dress code for women but not for men has been ruled discriminatory. Also, employers should Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 99 26/06/10 8:01 PM 100 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management Discrimination against “Caregivers” The federal government is receiving increasing complaints that new mothers are being discriminated against on the job, but it is not just new mothers who are complaining. Men also are complaining that if they must care for an aging parent, they are no longer considered on a “fast track” for promotion. The complaints have been numerous enough that the EEOC has issued guidance for employers on the issue (available at the EEOC website under unlawful disparate treatment of workers with caregiving responsibilities). The phenomenon has even received its own label: FRD, or family responsibility discrimination. Cases under FRD usually involve an employee who must care for a disabled spouse, aging parent, or child. Classic complaints may include retaliation and not being hired or promoted because of caregiving responsibilities. The FRD issue arises as the “sandwich generation,” employees with both children and aging relatives, is appearing. Caregivers do not all file suits; HR perspective some try to hide the fact they are caring for someone in hope of avoiding discrimination. Family responsibility discrimination charges come in many forms, but the allegations are usually that a person has been disadvantaged in promotion, pay, or work. The lawsuits are usually filed under Title VII or the Family Medical Leave Act, but suits have been filed under the ADA as well. The Supreme Court in 1971 held that women with school-aged children could not be barred from applying for jobs held by fathers of school-aged children. Then the Civil Rights Act of 1991 gave employees claiming sex discrimination the right to a jury trial and damages for emotional suffering and punitive damages. However, the issue of disparate treatment is not always clear. For example, is a failure to promote a young mother the result of her work history before her current job, current job performance, caregiving, or failure to apply for a specific job opening? This is the type of debate going on in courtrooms regarding FRD.48 be cautious when enforcing dress standards for women employees who are members of certain religions that prescribe appropriate and inappropriate dress and appearance standards. Some individuals have brought cases of employment discrimination based on height or weight. The crucial factor that employers must consider is that any weight or height requirements must be related to the job, such as when excess weight would hamper an individual’s job performance.47 Family Responsibility Discrimination (FRD) The HR Perspective shows the emergence of a recently identified and labeled discrimination based on complaints “caregivers” have about the way they are treated at work. The EEOC has issued guidelines for employers. The phenomenon has been labeled family responsibility discrimination (FRD). DIVERSITY TRAINING Traditional diversity training has a number of different goals. One prevalent goal is to minimize discrimination and harassment lawsuits. Other goals focus on improving acceptance and understanding of people with different backgrounds, experiences, capabilities, and lifestyles. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 100 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 Equal Employment Opportunity 101 Components of Traditional Diversity Training Approaches to diversity training vary, but often include at least three components. Legal awareness is the first and most common component. Here, the training focuses on the legal implications of discrimination. A limited approach to diversity training stops with these legal “do’s and don’ts.” By introducing cultural awareness, trainers hope to build greater understanding of the differences among people. Cultural awareness training helps all participants to see and accept the differences in people with widely varying cultural LOGGING ON backgrounds. American Institute for Managing The third component of diversity training—sensitivity Diversity training—is more difficult. The aim here is to “sensitize” The nation’s leading nonprofit think tank people to the differences among them and how their words dedicated to promoting and furthering and behaviors are seen by others. Some diversity training the field of diversity management can includes exercises containing examples of harassment and be found at www.aimd.org. other behaviors. Mixed Results for Diversity Training The effects of diversity training are viewed as mixed by both organizations and participants. A limited number of studies have been done on the effectiveness of diversity training.49 There is some concern that the programs may be interesting or entertaining, but may not produce longer-term changes in people’s attitudes and behaviors toward others with characteristics different from their own. Some argue that traditional diversity training more often than not has failed, pointing out that it does not reduce discrimination and harassment complaints. Rather than reducing conflict, in a number of situations diversity training has heightened hostility and conflicts. In some firms, it has produced divisive effects, and has not taught the behaviors needed for employees to work well together in a diverse workplace.50 This last point, focusing on behaviors, seems to hold the most promise for making diversity training more effective. For instance, dealing with cultural diversity as part of training efforts for sales representatives and managers has produced positive results. Teaching appropriate behaviors and skills in relationships with others is more likely to produce satisfactory results than focusing just on attitudes and beliefs among diverse employees. Backlash against Diversity Training Efforts The negative consequences of diversity training may manifest themselves broadly in a backlash against all diversity efforts. This backlash takes two main forms. First, and somewhat surprisingly, the individuals in protected groups, such as women and members of racial minorities, sometimes see the diversity efforts as inadequate and nothing but “corporate public relations.” Thus, it appears that by establishing diversity programs, employers are raising the expectation levels of protected-group individuals, but the programs are not meeting the expectations. On the other side, a number of individuals who are not in protected groups, primarily white males, believe that the emphasis on diversity sets them up as scapegoats for societal problems. Sometimes white males show hostility and anger at diversity efforts. Diversity programs are widely perceived as Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 101 26/06/10 8:01 PM 102 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management benefiting only women and racial minorities and taking away opportunities for men and nonminorities. This resentment and hostility is usually directed at affirmative action programs that employers have instituted.51 Trainers emphasize that the key to avoiding backlash in diversity efforts is to stress that people can believe whatever they wish, but at work their values are less important than their behaviors. Dealing with diversity is not about what people can and cannot say; it is about being respectful to others. S U M M A R Y • • • • • • • • Equal employment is an attempt to level the field of opportunity for all people at work. Disparate treatment occurs when members of a protected category are treated differently from others. Disparate impact occurs when employment decisions work to the disadvantage of members of protected categories. Employers may be able to defend their management practices using business necessity, job relatedness, and bona fide occupational qualifications (BFOQ). Title VII of the 1964 Civil Rights Act was the first significant equal employment law. The Civil Rights Act of 1991 both altered and expanded on the 1964 provisions. Affirmative action has been intensely litigated, and the debate continues today. Several laws on sex/gender discrimination have addressed issues regarding pregnancy discrimination, unequal pay for similar jobs, and sexual harassment. It is vital that employers train all employees on what constitutes sexual harassment, promptly investigate complaints, and take action when sexual harassment is found to have occurred. C R I T I C A L • • • • • • • • As more women have entered the workforce, sex/gender issues in equal employment have included both discrimination through pay inequity and discrimination in jobs and careers. The Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) requires that most employers identify the essential functions of jobs and that they make reasonable accommodations for individuals with disabilities unless doing so would result in undue hardship. Age discrimination against persons older than age 40 is illegal, according to the Age Discrimination in Employment Act (ADEA). The Immigration Reform and Control Acts (IRCA) identify employment regulations affecting workers from other countries. A number of other concerns have been addressed by laws, including discrimination based on religion, military status, and other factors. Individuals with disabilities represent a significant number of current and potential employees. Employers must make reasonable accommodations for individuals with disabilities, including those with mental or life-threatening illnesses. Diversity training has had limited success, possibly because it too often has focused on beliefs rather than behaviors. T H I N K I N G 1. If your employer asked you to review the decision not to hire an African American applicant for a job, what would you need to consider? 2. Explain why you agree or disagree with affirmative action and how affirmative action may be affected by growing workforce diversity. A C T I V I T I E S 3. From your own experience or that of someone you know, give examples of the two types of sexual harassment. 4. Use this text and the U.S. Department of Justice website (www.usdoj.gov/crt/ada/) to identify what is reasonable accommodation and how it is determined. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 102 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 H R 103 Equal Employment Opportunity E X P E R I E N T I A L The leadership in your company has changed as the result of a merger of your company with another company. The other company provides services similar to those provided by your company; however, the workforce demographic varies from that of your existing employees. For instance, the other company in the merger has a culture that recognizes and supports domestic partners. You have received a request to prepare a Diversity Initiative Plan. As HR Manager, you are aware that your existing employees will have P R O B L E M S O L V I N G issues and concerns and that you will need to institute some new policies, practices, and procedures. A resource for information on developing a Diversity Initiative Plan and diversity training is www.diversitycentral.com. 1. What should the plan include? 2. What diversity training programs should be offered to assist the employees of both companies in merging the two companies together? C A S E Religious Accommodation? As immigrants continue to come to the United States from many different cultures and religions, differences will cause some challenges and problems. One area where this has occurred is with Islamic culture and religion in the meat processing industry. A plant (a fresh chicken facility) belonging to Tyson Foods, Inc., in Shelbyville, Tennessee, is one example. The company hired about 250 people from Somalia. A long-running civil war in their country has forced many Somalis to settle in the United States as refugees, and many Somalis are Muslim. The union at the plant requested replacing the paid holiday Labor Day with Eid ul-Fitr, a religious holiday marking the end of the Muslim holy month of Ramadan. The request was brought up as part of negotiations for a new labor contract, and was part of the overall contract proposal approved by union members. The plant is often open on Labor Day anyway to meet consumer demand during the barbeque season. Along with holiday pay, the workers also received time and a half for hours worked on Labor Day. The EEOC says employers may not treat people more or less favorably because of their religion. However, religious accommodation may be warranted unless it would impose an undue hardship on the employer. Flexible scheduling, voluntary time swaps, transfers, and reassignments are possible means of accommodation, along with other policies and practices. Tyson’s consideration of exchanging Labor Day for Eid ul-Fitr brought strong reactions from non-Muslim workers and the general public. The union voted again on the issue and overwhelmingly voted to reinstate Labor Day as a paid holiday. The company’s solution was to have eight paid holidays, including a “personal holiday” that could be either the employee’s birthday, Eid ul-Fitr, or another day approved by the employee’s supervisor. That compromise was acceptable to the workers. Another company that faced similar issues is JBS-SWIFT, a meat packer with plants in Grand Island, Nebraska, and Greeley, Colorado. That company also hired many Somali Muslims. The issue there was prayer time. In Greeley, the Muslim workers demanded time to pray at sundown—a requirement during Ramadan. The plant works three shifts. More than 300 workers walked out when they were told they could not have the time to pray. More than 100 were fired later, not for walking out but for not returning to work. The walkout touched off protests from workers of different faiths who thought the request for religious accommodation was too much. The EEOC ruled that JBS-SWIFT had violated the civil rights of the employees it had fired. The company was found to have denied religious accommodation and retaliated against workers who complained. JBS-SWIFT has since set up special prayer rooms at its plants and allows Muslim workers to meet their religious obligations, which include prayers five times daily.52 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 103 26/06/10 8:01 PM 104 SECTION 1 Environment of Human Resource Management QUESTIONS 1. What is the legal basis for the EEOC to hold that JBS-SWIFT had violated the employees’ civil rights? 2. Contrast the solutions to the Tyson situation and the JBS-SWIFT situation. Which is likely to have the greatest positive impact on the company and why? S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Keep on Trucking Mitsubishi Believes in EEO—Now This case illustrates the problems that can be associated with the use of employment tests that have not been validated. (For the case, http://www .cengage.com/management/mathis.) This case shows the problems Mitsubishi had with sexual harassment in the United States. (For the case, http://www.cengage.com/management/ mathis.) N O T E S 1. Steve Stecklow, “Sexual Harassment Cases Plague the U.N.,” The Wall Street Journal, May 21, 2009, A1. 2. Scott E. Page, “Making the Difference: Applying a Logic of Diversity,” Academy of Management Perspectives, November 2009, 6–20. 3. Margaret M. Pinkham, “Employers Should Take Care When Making Decisions about Caregivers,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Summer 2008, 35–40. 4. Mike Tobin, “S&Z Settles 2003 Bias Case,” The Cleveland Plain Dealer, August 26, 2006, C1. 5. Mary Birk, “RIFS: Use Statistical Analysis to Avoid Disparate Impact Based on Age,” Legal Report Society for Human Resources Management, April 2008, 5–8. 6. Anne Lindberg, “Disparate Impact or Disparate Treatment: Either Way Leads to Court,” Trend Watcher, July 10, 2009, 1–5. 7. Washington, Mayor of Washington, DC v. Davis, 74 U.S. 1492 (1976). 8. Cynthia Marcotte Stamer, “Supreme Court Decision May Open Doors to More Retaliation Claims,” Employee Benefit News Legal Alert, July 31, 2009, 1–5. 9. “Discrimination Charges on the Rise,” Benefit News.com Employee Benefit News, September 15, 2007, 82; Sam Hananei, “Federal Job Discrimination Complaints Hit Record,” Yahoo! News, March 11, 2009, 1–2. 10. Lilia M. Corting, “Unseen Injustice: Incivility as Modern Discrimination in Organizations,” Academy of Management Review, January 2008, 55–75. 11. Robert J. Grossman, “Defusing Discrimination Claims,” HR Magazine, May 2009, 47–51. 12. Fay Hansen, “Discriminatory Twist in Networking Sites Puts Recruiters in Peril,” Work Force Management, September 2009, 1–5. 13. Gail Heriot, “Affirmative Action Backfires,” The Wall Street Journal, August 24, 2007, A15; Jonathan Kaufman, “Fair Enough?” The Wall Street Journal, June 14–15, 2008, A1. 14. C. Tuna, N. Koppel, and M. Sanserino, “Job-Test Ruling Cheers Employers,” The Wall Street Journal, July 1, 2009, B1; Adam Liptak, “Justices Find Bias Against Whites,” The Denver Post, June 30, 2009, 1A. 15. EEOC v. Eastern Michigan University, No. 98-71806 (E.D. Mich., September 3, 1999). 16. Allen Smith, “Pay Bias Figures Prominently in New Supreme Court Forum,” HR News, September 26, 2009, www.shrm.org/hrnews. 17. “New Law Makes Companies More Vulnerable to Complaints of Pay Discrimination,” March 2009, www .towerswatson.com, 1–4. 18. “Lilly Ledbetter Fair Pay Act Signed into Law 1/29/2009,” www .compensationresources.com, 1; 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. Jonathan A. Segal, “I Did It, But . . . ,” HR Magazine, March 2008, 91–95. J. Hoobler, S. Wayne, and G. Lemmon, “Bosses’ Perceptions of Family/Work Conflict and Women’s Promotability: Glass Ceiling Effects,” Academy of Management Journal, October 2009, 939–957. “Nontraditional Occupations for Women 2008,” Ceridian Abstracts, April 2009, www.hrcompliance .ceridian.com, 1–5. Eddy S. W. Ng, “Why Organizations Choose to Manage Diversity: Toward a Leadership-Based Theoretical Framework,” Human Resource Development Review, March 2008, 58–78; S. Pichler, P. Simpson, and L. Stroh, “The Glass Ceiling in Human Resources: Exploring the Link Between Women’s Representation in Management and the Practices of Strategic HRM and Employee Involvement,” Human Resource Management, Fall 2008, 463–479. L. Grensing-Pophal, “All in the Family,” HR Magazine, September 2007, 66–70. “Nearly 40% of Workers Have Had Workplace Romance,” Newsline, January 31, 2007, www.spherion.com. P. Dvorak, B. Davis, and L. Radnofsky, “Firms Confront Boss-Subordinate Love Affairs,” The Wall Street Journal, October 27, 2008, B5. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 104 26/06/10 8:01 PM CHAPTER 3 105 Equal Employment Opportunity 25. Jennifer Thiel, “Harassment Claim Advances,” HR Magazine, October 2008, 99. 26. “Model Discrimination and Harassment Policy,” Ceridian Abstracts, www.hrcompliance .ceridian.com, 1–3. 27. Allen Smith, “Study: Women Supervisors Are More Likely to Be Harassed,” www.shrm.org, 1. 28. Harsh Luther and Uipan Luther, “A Theoretical Framework Explaining Cross-Cultural Sexual Harassment: Integrating Hofsteds and Schwartz,” Journal of Labor Research, Winter 2007, 169–188. 29. Stephanie Overman, “EEOC Opinion: Mandated Health Assessments Violate ADA,” Employee Benefit News, July 2009, 1 and 48. 30. Murphy v. United Parcel Service, 527 U.S. 516 (1999). 31. Andrew Slobodien and Katie O’Brien, “The ADA Amendments Act of 2008 and How It Will Change the Workplace,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008, 32–39. 32. Bill Leonard, “The Stealth Statute,” HR Magazine, December 2008, 47–51; Ann Murrary and Leah Singleton, “Employers Beware: New Antidiscrimination Legislation Has Been Passed,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008, 27–31; Cynthia Stamer, “Group Health Plans Will Face Challenges with GINA,” Employee Benefit News Legal Alert, May 8, 2009, 1–4. 33. Kelly M. Butler, “10 Million Ways to Fill the Talent Gap,” Employee Benefit News, March 2007, 22; Laurence P. Postol, “ADAAA Will Result in Renewed Emphasis on Reasonable Accommodations,” SHRM Legal Report, January 2009, 1–6. 34. Jennifer Levitz, “More Workers Cite Age Bias After Layoffs,” The Wall Street Journal, March 11, 2009, D1. 35. Rosemary Lucas and Shobana Keegan, “Probing the Basis for Differential Pay Practices of Younger Workers in Low Paying 36. 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. Hospitality Firms,” Human Resource Management Journal, 18, (2008), 386–404. Heidi Gattau-Fox, “U.S. Supreme Court’s Age Discrimination Decision Is Good News for Employers,” Blair D Holm Labor and Employment Law Update, August 2009, 2–3; Cara Woodson Welch, “The Supreme Court Weighs in on Total Rewards,” Workspan, July 2008, 20–23. G. Wood, A. Wilkerson, and M. Harcourt, “Age Discrimination and Working Life: Perspectives and Contestations—A Review of the Contemporary Literature,” International Journal of Management Reviews, Volume 10, 2008, 425–442. David Migoya, “EEOC: Swift Acted with Bias,” The Denver Post, September 1, 2009, 7B. Eileen Kelly, “Accommodating Religious Expression in the Workplace,” Employer Responsibility and Rights Journal, 20 (2008), 45–56. Mark Downey, “Keeping the Faith,” HR Magazine, January 2008, 85–88. Robert Grossman, “Religion at Work,” HR Magazine, December 2008, 27–33. Bruce Finley, “Immigration Checks Rise,” The Denver Post, June 1, 2009, 1; Anna Gorman, “Businesses Flock to E-Verify,” Casper StarTribune, May 17, 2009, C2. “Jobs and Immigrants,” The Wall Street Journal, April 4, 2007, A14; Pia Orrenius and Madeline Zavondny, “Does Immigration Affect Wages?” Labour Economics, 14, (2007), 757–773; Scott Wright, “Worksite Enforcement of US Immigration Law,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Autumn 2008, 66–102. Thomas McKinney, “The USERRA Minefield,” Human Resource Executive, October 2, 2008, 8. Diane Cadrain, “Sexual Equity in the Workplace,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 44–48; Bill Leonard, “Workplace Diversity Library—Sexual Orientation,” 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52. SHRM Knowledge Center, April 19, 2007, www.shrm.org. Nancy Day and Patricia Greene, “A Case for Sexual Orientation Diversity Management in Small and Large Organizations,” Human Resource Management, Fall 2008, 637–654. Catherine Arnst, “Bias of the Bulge,” BusinessWeek, April 28, 2008, 22; Lisa Finkelstein, et al., “Bias Against Overweight Job Applicants,” Human Resource Management, Summer 2007, 203–222; Mark Roehling, Richard Posthuma, and James Dulebohn, “Obesity Related ‘Perceived Disability’ Claims,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Spring 2007, 30–51. Stephanie Armour, “More Employers Face Caregiver Related Suits,” USA Today, October 25, 2007, 3B; Stephan Barlas, “Caregivers Unite,” Human Resource Executive, June 16, 2008, 53–55; C. W. VonBerger, W. T. Marver, and R. Howard, “Family Responsibilities Discrimination: The EEOC Guidance,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Summer 2008, 14–34. Rohini Anand and Mary-Francis Winters, “A Retrospective of Corporate Diversity Training from 1964 to the Present,” Academy of Management Learning and Education, September 2008, 356–373. Susan Awbrey, “The Dynamics of Vertical and Horizontal Diversity in Organization and Society,” Human Resource Development Review, 6 (2007), 7–32. Carol Kulik, et al., “The Rich Get Richer: Predicting Participation in Voluntary Diversity Training,” Journal of Organizational Behavior, Volume 28 (2007), 753–769. Tom Wray, “Learning to Adapt: Companies Acclimate to a Changing Workforce,” The National Provisioner, November 1, 2008, 1–2; David Migoya, “EEOC: SWIFT Acted with Bias,” The Denver Post, September 1, 2009, 7B. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_03_ch03_p072-106.indd 105 26/06/10 8:01 PM S E C T I O N 2 Jobs and Labor Chapter 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis Chapter 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention Chapter 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets Chapter 7 Selecting Human Resources 107 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 107 21/07/10 8:50 PM C H A P T E R 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Explain how the diversity of the workforce affects HR management functions. • Identify components of work flow analysis that must be considered. • Define job design and identify common approaches to varying job design. • Describe different types of work teams and HR facets that must be considered. • Discuss how telework and work flexibility are linked to work-life balancing efforts. • Describe job analysis and the stages and methods used in the process. • List the components of job descriptions. 108 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 108 26/06/10 4:00 PM HR Headline Work-Life Balancing J (© Getty Images/Jupiter Image) obs must be balanced with work-life issues. Workforce demographics of employees by racial/ethnic background, age, and gender, indicate that organizations must adjust to the fact that employees want to increase flexibility in their work schedules to accommodate the life outside the job. A comprehensive study of more than 500 organizations and their employees by the Institute for Corporate Productivity identified two reasons employees want flexible work: (1) much of their work does not require being in the office all of the time, or (2) they have long commutes. Using occupational groups, the study identified that approximately threefourths of professional employees and half of administrative employees wanted flexible schedules. Women were another group that wanted more flexibility. A change that has affected work is the growth in telecommuting. Through greater use of technology, more employees are working outside of the workplace. For instance, managers and other employees may work from home, an elder parent’s apartment, a client’s facility, an airport conference room, a work suite in a hotel resort, or even a vacation location. Thus, balancing workers and jobs with technology and flexibility in work schedules and location is likely to increase in importance, affecting both organizational and individual performance.1 109 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 109 26/06/10 4:03 PM 110 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Throughout organizations of all types, the composition of workers and jobs is shifting in nature. As the HR Headline shows, these shifts are likely to continue growing in the next years, requiring changes in the way some HR functions are done. Relevant changes in the workforce follow. WORKFORCE COMPOSITION The existing U.S. workforce is changing, and projections indicate that more shifting will occur in the next few years.2 To analyze the composition of workers and jobs in the United States, the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS) undertakes studies to identify current and future projected compositions. Because of economic shifts and their effects in different industries, some types of workers are scarce but in high demand, while others are available in excessive numbers. According to studies by the BLS and various industry groups, health care and health-related jobs are increasing, in part because of the aging U.S. population. The rapid growth in technology is creating a need for more workers with special technical capabilities. However, many manufacturing industries, such as automobile and airline firms, have had significant decline in numbers of jobs and workers. These and other factors make it likely that the workforce composition will continue to change. Another worker-related shift results from the U.S. workforce becoming more diverse. As organizations develop or increase global operations, diversity in the workforce is becoming more prominent. Diversity reflects the differences in human characteristics and composition in an organization. The tangible indicators of diversity that employers must consider include the following: • • • • • • • • Race/ethnicity National origin/immigration Age/generational differences Gender—men and women Marital and family status Sexual orientation Disabilities Religion In addition, individuals can be multicultural and be included in several groups. Business Contribution of Diverse Workers Diversity Differences in human characteristics and composition in an organization. Different organizations approach the management of diversity from several perspectives.3 As Figure 4-1 shows, the continuum can run from resistance to creation of an inclusive diversity culture. For diversity to succeed, the most crucial component is seeing it as a commitment throughout the organization, beginning with top management.4 Diversity results must be measured, and management accountability for achieving results must be emphasized and rewarded. For instance, PepsiCo, a large food and beverage company, has developed and implemented a Diversity and Inclusion Council so that diversity considerations are part of all strategic efforts. PepsiCo also has regular diversity celebrations, newsletters, and other events. This inclusion of diversity issues throughout the company contributes to PepsiCo’s success with employees, managers, and customers.5 One survey found that more than 60% of firms were committed to diversity and almost 50% of senior managers recognized the business case for diversity.6 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 110 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 111 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis Various Approaches to Diversity and Their Results FIGURE 4-1 Approach Ignore Diversity Status quo is protected Possible legal issues are increased Diversity is not important Results Begin the Process of Dealing with Diversity Diversity training is provided Affirmative action compliance occurs Protected classes are a focus Conflicts and problems occur Build Acceptance of Diversity Diversity pays off for company Conflicts are reduced Internal problem solving takes place Solve Diversity Issues and Create an Inclusive Culture Diversity permeates the company Problems are approached proactively Everyone gets along Business results improve However, the “business case” for diversity must be linked to key business goals and strategies and organizational results.7 The business case for diversity includes the following: • • • • Diversity allows new talent and ideas from employees of different backgrounds, which can enhance organizational performance. Diversity helps recruiting and retention because protected-class individuals often prefer to work in organizations with coworkers of various demographics. Diversity allows for an increase of market share because customers can be attracted to purchase products and services with varied demographic marketing activities. Diversity can lead to lower costs because there may be fewer discrimination lawsuits. The results of increased diversity for organizations, work groups, individuals, and society/community must be considered. An example of an organization that has utilized diversity is NASA/Goddard Space Flight Center. Diversity at Goddard is a core value and part of its business objectives.8 Goddard has engaged in recruiting diverse individuals and integrating them through training and other HR actions, which include establishing communications and bulletin board systems that enhance diversity efforts. One concern with diversity programs is that they may be perceived as benefiting only certain groups of persons and not others. Diversity actions must be well thought out and address both the positive and negative aspects of such programs, given the workforce composition of many organizations.9 Race and Ethnicity Significant race and ethnic shifts in the U.S. population will occur in the next several decades. By the year 2050, racial/ethnic groups currently in the minority Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 111 26/06/10 4:04 PM 112 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Resolving Language Barriers Pays Off A firm that has been recognized by a national competitive workforce award is Nebraska Furniture Mart (NFM). Selling furniture, appliances, and many home items, NFM needs numerous individuals to work a wide range of hours every week. Owned primarily by the well-known investor Warren Buffet, NFM has been operating in Nebraska, Iowa, and Kansas. When NFM expanded from Omaha to Kansas City, it encountered a major turnover of Hispanic employees in its Kansas City operation. As turnover increased, reductions in work quality and productivity resulted. Management recognized that the concerns of both Hispanic customers and employees needed to be better addressed. Executives, managers, and HR professionals at NFM recognized that they needed to do a better job HR best practices of attracting, retaining, and training Hispanic workers. They created a three-part effort called “Bienvenido a la Familia de NFM” (Welcome to Our NFM Family). They also expanded recruiting efforts, using Hispanic newspapers. In addition, NFM hired a bilingual interpreter as part of HR, and then offered employees free basic English classes. The results of these efforts over several years have been very positive, resulting in more recruiting and less turnover of Hispanic workers. Work-related quality and productivity also have increased, particularly in the warehouse where many Hispanic people work. Responding to racial/ethnic diversity in terms of a specific group enhanced HR and organizational performance in NFM.10 will likely make up more than 50% of the U.S. population. The Census Bureau says whites represent 67% of the population currently, but will be at approximately 48% in 2050. The Hispanic population will increase dramatically, to about 39% of the overall population, and will exceed the African American population. The Asian population will triple to about 9% by 2050.11 These statistics indicate that accommodating racial/ethnic differences are a part of everyday life, and such efforts do bring results. For example, a Michigan manufacturing firm dealt with racial tensions between whites and workers of other ethnic/racial backgrounds. Initially, few nonwhites attended company social events, and if they did, they sat apart from the white population. However, after five years of diversity training and other HR efforts, people of all races and ethnic groups were interacting more frequently and working together more effectively. This example illustrates why efforts to integrate people of different types must be made.12 Integrated work groups, social events, electronic communications, and other approaches can be used to help with conflict. The HR Best Practices illustrates how Nebraska Furniture Mart has successfully worked with its Hispanic/Latino employees. Immigrant Workers Another racial/ethnic factor is the growth in the number of immigrants to the United States and other developed countries. The United States has always had a significant number of immigrants who have come to work in this country. The increasing number of immigrants entering illegally has led to extensive political, social, and employment-related issues. In the United States, one concern is the large number of illegal immigrants hired to fill certain jobs at low cost, despite availability of unemployed U.S. workers. With the growth in racial/ethnic immigrants projected to increase and with the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 112 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 113 likelihood of more changes in immigration laws, HR professionals will have to monitor and manage the immigrant issue as it applies to both company and industry. Generational Differences Much has been written about the expectations of individuals in different age groups and generations. For employers, these varied expectations present challenges, especially given economic, global, technology, and other changes in the workplace. Some common age/generational groups are labeled as follows: • • • • Matures (born before 1946) Baby boomers (born 1946–1964) Generation Xers (born 1965–1980) Generation Yers (millenials) (born 1981–2000) As the economy and industries have changed, the aging of the U.S. workforce has become a significant concern. Workers over age 55 are delaying retirement more often, working more years, and/or looking for part-time work or phased retirement. Economic conditions are the predominant reasons why these workers are bypassing the “normal” retirement age of 65.13 As older and more experienced employees retire in the future, employers will face increasing gaps as they try to replace the experience and capabilities of baby boomers. Generational differences in expectations are likely to add to challenges and conflicts in organizations. For instance, many baby boomers and matures are concerned about security and experience, while younger people have different concerns. Generation Yers are often seen as the “why” generation; they expect to be rewarded quickly, use more technology, and often ask more questions about why managers and organizations make the decisions they do. Consider the dynamics of a mature manager directing generation X and Y individuals, or generation X managers supervising older, more experienced baby boomers as well as generation Y employees. However, it is crucial to be aware that stereotyping these individuals by generations may not reflect how actual individuals view their jobs and produce organizational results.14 Managing Multigenerational Workforce What the discussion of generations suggests is that managers must be aware of the possible opportunities as well as the challenges with a multigenerational workforce in an organization. Firms are engaging in activities to enhance multigenerational and managerial effectiveness as described in Figure 4-2. For example, Border’s Group bookstores and a Virginia hospital have had good experiences, because of expanded training, with different generations of individuals working together.15 The generation gaps may be less severe than many articles suggest. How much such gaps are reduced relates to supervisor/subordinate/coworker relationships and how employees of all types are engaged in the organization through training work teams and by other means.16 Gender Workforce Diversity Women are becoming a greater percentage of workers in the U.S. workforce; they comprise more than 46% of the total employed individuals. However, men average more work time daily than do women.17 Interestingly, as the economic and labor market has been shifting, the job fields dominated by men have been hit harder than those consisting mostly of women. Male workers Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 113 26/06/10 4:04 PM 114 SECTION 2 FIGURE 4-2 Jobs and Labor Positive Multigenerational Management Activities Positive Multigenerational Management Activities Integrating generational individuals Recognizing employees’ different expectations Developing varied mentoring means Adapting training methods to reflect generational capabilities Utilizing younger persons’ technology skills to aid baby boomers Supporting individual career expectations that vary by groups Openly addressing generational issues Establishing multigenerational work groups and projects are more heavily represented in manufacturing, farming, and other “maledominated” industries, so male employees have been impacted more severely by the market shifts than women employees with their higher rates of participation in industries such as health care and education. From this follows some of the gender issues that occur in organizations. First, women overall have lower average pay than men due to the nature of their jobs and work hours. Second, in some industries and countries, women make up a much smaller percentage of senior executives and managers in many organizations and occupations. Over the past decade more women have become managers, but women comprise only about 10% or less of senior level executive and board members.18 Some of the wage gap between men and women is due to the greater family/home responsibilities that females have to meet. One survey found that more than 40% of working mothers would take pay cuts to have more time with their children.19 Both women and men also are increasingly facing the need to aid older family members, as matures and baby boomers encounter health disabilities and other problems. Addressing work and family issues is part of work-life balancing, which is examined later in this chapter in the discussion of workforce flexibility in jobs. NATURE OF JOBS AND WORK One way to visualize an organization is as an entity that takes inputs from the surrounding environment and then, through some kind of “work,” turns those inputs into goods or services. Work is effort directed toward accomplishing results. Work Effort directed toward accomplishing results. Work flow analysis Study of the way work (inputs, activities, and outputs) moves through an organization. Work Flow Analysis Work flow analysis is the study of the way work moves through an organization. Usually, it begins with an examination of the quantity and quality of the desired and actual outputs (goods and services). Then the activities (tasks and jobs) that lead to the outputs are evaluated to see if they are achieving Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 114 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 115 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis the desired outputs. Finally, the inputs (people, material, information, data, equipment, etc.) must be assessed to determine if they make the outputs and activities better and more efficient. An integrating work flow analysis is likely to lead to better employee involvement, greater efficiency, and more customer satisfaction as organizational work is divided into jobs so that it can be coordinated. A job is a grouping of the tasks, duties, and responsibilities that constitutes the work assignment for an employee. Tasks, duties, and responsibilities may change over time; therefore, jobs may change and may increase or decrease in number. If internal changes do not happen, an organization is probably failing to adapt to the shifting business and competitive environment and may be becoming outmoded or noncompetitive. As an example, at Southwest Airlines, organizational values and strategies are tied to having involved employees working in a flexible enjoyable culture that delivers dependable service at low fares. Southwest employees have a high degree of flexibility in how they perform their work as workload demands shift. Other airlines, such as American and United, have higher fares, fewer service amenities, and employees with more narrowly defined jobs. The way work is done and how jobs are designed and performed vary significantly under these two approaches, and the differences impact the number of jobs and people needed. Technology and Work Flow Analysis A factor that must be considered in work flow analysis in organizations is technology. The information-based systems used by many employees make work flow different from what it was in previous years. Sometimes the differences are positive and highly productive, but technology also can reduce work flow and productivity. For example, consider the amount of time some employees spend on personal use of technology such as text-messaging, twitters, and personal websites such as Facebook. Such usage can distract workers and may reduce work-related productivity. Job Grouping of tasks, duties, and responsibilities that constitutes the total work assignment for an employee. Business process reengineering (BPR) Measures for improving such activities as product development, customer service, and service delivery. Business Process Reengineering After work flow analysis provides an understanding of how work is being done, reengineering generates the needed changes in the operations. The purpose of business process reengineering (BPR) is to improve such activities as product development, customer service, and service delivery. BPR consists of three phases: 1. Rethink: Examine how the current organization of work and jobs affects customer satisfaction and service. 2. Redesign: Analyze how jobs are put together, the work flow, and how results are achieved; then redesign the process as necessary. 3. Retool: Look at new technologies (equipment, computers, software, etc.) as opportunities to improve productivity, service quality, and customer satisfaction. LOGGING ON Prosci Learning Center An online resource for material on the topic of business process reengineering can be found at www.prosci.com. Because of the desire to improve HR efficiency and effectiveness, BPR is increasingly being applied to HR management. Although implementation of reengineering can be difficult, if done well it can aid work success. For instance, firms such as AT&T and a mid-sized Italian bank have done reengineering that has been successful for both the organization and the workforce.20 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 115 26/06/10 4:04 PM 116 Jobs and Labor SECTION 2 JOB DESIGN Job design refers to organizing tasks, duties, responsibilities, and other elements into a productive unit of work. Identifying the components of a given job is an integral part of job design. Job design receives attention for three major reasons: • • • Job design Organizing tasks, duties, responsibilities, and other elements into a productive unit of work. Job design can influence performance in certain jobs, especially those where employee motivation can make a substantial difference. Job design can affect job satisfaction. Because people are more satisfied with certain job elements than others, identifying what makes a “good” job becomes critical. Reduced turnover and absenteeism also can be linked to effective job design. Job design can impact both physical and mental health. Problems that may require assistance such as hearing loss, backache, leg pain, stress, high blood pressure, and even heart disease sometimes can be traced directly to job design. Managers play a significant role in job design because often they are the people who establish jobs and their design components. They must make sure that job expectations are clear, that decision-making responsibilities and the accountability of workers are clarified, and that interactions with other jobs are integrated and appropriate.21 The nature and characteristics of both jobs and people should be considered when job design is done. As Figure 4-3 indicates, managers can influence or control job characteristics, but not people characteristics. FIGURE 4-3 Some Characteristics of People and Jobs Job Characteristics (Management can control) Tasks Authority/ responsibility Policies/ procedures Tools Variety Time requirements Social opportunities Working conditions Stress People Characteristics (Management cannot control) Motivation Interests Energy level Personality variables Physical characteristics Honesty Conscientiousness Intelligence Satisfaction predisposition Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 116 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 117 Workers and Job Design Organizations are employing a variety of workers, and not just full-time ones. Depending on economic and competitive factors, the types of workers in one firm may include: • • • • • Full-time employees Part-time employees Independent contractors Temporary workers Contingent workers Although some organizations still use the traditional approach of employing full- and part-time workers, many firms are making significant use of independent, temporary, and contingent individuals. These persons are not employees but generally work at-will or on limited contracts, and they may be working for other employers as well. A contingent worker is someone who is not an employee, but a temporary or part-time worker for a specific period of time and type of work. According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, contingent workers are a part of “alternative workers” who may be on-call, working through an employment agency, or operating as independent contractors.22 A number of contingent workers have contracts with employers that establish their pay, hours, job requirements, limitations, and time periods. As mentioned in Chapter 1, more employers are using contingent or temporary workers. Estimates are that up to 50% of some types of jobs are performed by contingent workers who are not regular employees. Nike, Kelly Services, and Earthlink are examples of firms that are using more contingent workers.23 Person-Job Fit Not everyone would enjoy being an HR manager, an engineer, a nurse, or a drill-press operator. But some people like and do well at each of these jobs. The person-job fit is a simple but important concept of matching characteristics of people with characteristics of jobs. If a person does not fit a job, theoretically either the person can be changed or replaced or the job can be altered. However, though an employer can try to make a “round” person fit a “square” job, it is hard to successfully reshape people. By redesigning jobs, the person-job fit may sometimes be improved more easily. For example, bank tellers talk to people all day; an individual who would rather not talk to others all day may do better in a job that does not require so much interaction because that part of the bank teller job probably cannot be changed. Different people will consider some jobs “good” and others “bad.” As a result, people will fit different kinds of work. Contingent worker Someone who is not an employee, but a temporary or part-time worker for a specific period of time and type of work. Person-job fit Matching characteristics of people with characteristics of jobs. Job-Person Match Matching people with jobs they like and fit can have positive consequences. Higher or lower turnover rates in the first few months of employment are often linked to recruiting and selection screening efforts. Then, once individuals have been placed in jobs, other job/work factors affect retention. Because individuals spend significant time on their jobs, they expect to have modern equipment, technology, and good working conditions. Physical and environmental factors such as space, lighting, temperature, noise, and layout can affect retention of employees as well as their work. Additionally, workers want a safe work environment, in which risks of accidents and injuries have been addressed. That is especially true for employees in such industries as manufacturing, agriculture, utilities, and transportation, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 117 26/06/10 4:04 PM 118 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor which have higher safety risks than do many service industries and office environments. Common Approaches to Job Design One approach for designing or redesigning jobs is to simplify the job tasks and responsibilities. Job simplification may be appropriate for jobs that are to be staffed with entry-level employees. However, making jobs too simple may result in boring jobs that appeal to few people, causing high turnover. Several other approaches also have been used as part of job design. Job Enlargement and Job Enrichment Attempts to alleviate some of the problems encountered in excessive job simplification fall under the general headings of job enlargement and job enrichment. Job enlargement involves broadening the scope of a job by expanding the number of different tasks to be performed. Job enrichment is increasing the depth of a job by adding responsibility for planning, organizing, controlling, or evaluating the job. Some examples of job enrichment are: • • • • • Job enlargement Broadening the scope of a job by expanding the number of different tasks to be performed. Job enrichment Increasing the depth of a job by adding responsibility for planning, organizing, controlling, or evaluating the job. Job rotation Process of shifting a person from job to job. Job sharing Scheduling arrangement in which two employees perform the work of one full-time job. Giving the employee an entire job rather than just a piece of the work Allowing the employee more flexibility to perform the job as needed Increasing the employee’s accountability for work by reducing external control Expanding assignments for employees to do new tasks and develop special areas of expertise Directing feedback reports to the employee rather than only to management Job Rotation One technique that can break the monotony of an otherwise simple routine job is job rotation, which is the process of shifting a person from job to job. There are several advantages to job rotation with one being that it develops an employee’s capabilities for doing several different jobs. For instance, some firms have been successful at using job rotation for employees with disabilities in special assembly lines and different work requirement times.24 Even people without disabilities can be adaptable and change jobs and careers internally in appropriate ways. Clear policies that identify for employees the nature and expectations of job rotations are more likely to make job rotation work.25 Job Sharing Another alternative used is job sharing, in which two employees perform the work of one full-time job. For instance, a hospital allows two radiological technicians to fill one job, and each individual works every other week. Such arrangements are beneficial for employees who may not want or be able to work full-time because of family, school, or other reasons. The keys to successful job sharing are that both “job sharers” must work effectively together and each must be competent in meeting the job requirements. Characteristics of Jobs A model developed by Hackman and Oldham focuses on five important design characteristics of jobs. Figure 4-4 shows that skill variety, task identity, and task significance affect the meaningfulness of work; autonomy stimulates responsibility; and feedback provides knowledge of results. Each aspect can make a job better for the jobholder to the degree that it is present. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 118 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 119 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis Job Characteristics Model FIGURE 4-4 Job Characteristics (enriched jobs) • Skill variety Extent to which the work requires several different activities for successful completion. Task identity Extent to which the job includes a “whole” identifiable unit of work that is carried out from start to finish and that results in a visible outcome. Task significance Impact the job has on other people. Autonomy Extent of individual freedom and discretion in the work and its scheduling. Feedback The amount of information employees receive about how well or how poorly they have performed. • • • • Psychological States Skill variety Task identity Task significance Experienced meaningfulness Autonomy Experienced responsibility Feedback Knowledge of results Desired Outcomes Motivation Performance Satisfaction Skill variety is the extent to which the work requires several different activities for successful completion. For example, lower skill variety exists when an assembly-line worker performs the same two tasks repetitively. Skill variety is not to be confused with multitasking, which is doing several tasks at the same time with computers, telephones, personal organizers, and other means. The impact of multitasking for an employee may be never getting away from the job—not a “better” outcome for everyone. Task identity is the extent to which the job includes a “whole” identifiable unit of work that is carried out from start to finish and that results in a visible outcome. For example, when a customer calls with a problem, a customer specialist can handle the stages from maintenance to repair in order to resolve the customer’s problem. Task significance is the impact the job has on other people. A job is more meaningful if it is important to other people for some reason. For instance, police officers may experience more fulfillment when dealing with a real threat than when merely training to be ready in case a threat arises. Autonomy is the extent of individual freedom and discretion in the work and its scheduling. More autonomy leads to a greater feeling of personal responsibility for the work. Feedback is the amount of information employees receive about how well or how poorly they have performed. The advantage of feedback is that it helps employees to understand the effectiveness of their performance and contributes to their overall knowledge about the work. Using Worker Teams in Jobs Typically, a job is thought of as something done by one person. However, where appropriate, jobs may be designed for teams to take advantage of Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 119 26/06/10 4:04 PM 120 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor the increased productivity and commitment that can follow such a change. Organizations can assign jobs to teams of employees instead of just individuals. Some firms have gone as far as dropping such terms as workers and employees, replacing them with teammates, crew members, associates, and other titles that emphasize teamwork. As organizations have changed, the types of teams have changed as well. Having global operations with diverse individuals and using technology advances have affected the nature of teams contributing to organizational projects. For example, one survey found that about one-third of the different types of teams possible were used in major HR projects.26 Special Types of Teams There are several types of teams that function outside the scope of members’ normal jobs and meet from time to time. One is the special-purpose team, which is formed to address specific problems, improve work processes, and enhance the overall quality of products and services. Often, special-purpose teams are a mixture of employees, supervisors, and managers. The self-directed team is composed of individuals who are assigned a cluster of tasks, duties, and responsibilities to be accomplished. Unlike specialpurpose teams, self-directed work teams become entities that use regular internal decision-making processes. Use of self-directed work teams must be planned well and fit the culture of the organization. The virtual team is composed of individuals who are separated geographically but linked by communications technology. The success of virtual work teams depends on a number of factors, including training of team members, planning and managing virtual tasks and projects, and using technology for expansion of teamwork. However, some research has identified that virtual teams can lead to unresolved problems, less productivity, and miscommunications.27 G L O B A L Special-purpose team Organizational team formed to address specific problems, improve work processes, and enhance the overall quality of products and services. Self-directed team Organizational team composed of individuals who are assigned a cluster of tasks, duties, and responsibilities to be accomplished. Virtual team Organizational team composed of individuals who are separated geographically but linked by communications technology. Global Teams Global operations have resulted in an increasing use of virtual teams. Members of these teams seldom or never meet in person. Instead, they “meet” electronically using Web-based systems. With global teams, it is important for managers and HR to address various issues, including who is to be chosen for the teams, how they are to communicate and collaborate online and sometimes in person, and what tasks and work efforts may be done with these teams.28 Teams and Work Efforts As the use of teams has grown, creating ones that contribute to organizational performance is important. Factors that affect the work team success and performance increasingly have become part of HR.29 Figure 4-5 highlights some common team elements related to team performance. The use of work teams has been a popular form of job redesign in the last decade. Improved productivity, increased employee involvement, greater coworker trust, more widespread employee learning, and greater employee use of knowledge diversity are among the potential benefits.30 In a transition to work teams, efforts are necessary to define the areas of work, scope of authority, and goals of the teams. Also, teams must recognize and address dissent, conflict, and other problems.31 The role of supervisors and managers changes with use of teams because of the emergence or development of team leaders. Rather than giving orders, often the team leader becomes a facilitator to assist the team, to mediate and resolve conflicts among team members, and to interact with other teams and managers elsewhere. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 120 26/06/10 4:04 PM CHAPTER 4 121 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis FIGURE 4-5 Encouraging Team Performance Success Choose a Variety of Employees Different levels Various jobs Geographic locations ⴙ Encourage Creative Collaboration New approaches Changes in processing Interactive means Leads to Team Performance Accomplishing expectations Meeting timelines Measuring performance results LOGGING ON Team Building, Inc. This website provides information for team building services and team building training products. Visit the site at www.teambuildinginc.com. Teams can be enhanced through task responsibility, discussion structures, and cooperation efforts. Age and educational diversity can expand task-relevant information and team performance bases.32 However, some organizations have noted a lack of willingness of team members to share information with those who are different from themselves. To counteract such problems, diversity training for teams and their members could be part of the design when establishing and managing teams.33 JOBS AND WORK SCHEDULING Considerations that can affect job design for both employers and employees are how the work is to be done, the time during which work is scheduled, and the location of employees when working. One factor changing how and when work is done is technology, including the creation of telework for some people. Telework Telework Employees work with technology via electronic, telecommunications, and Internet means. Individuals who may be working at home or at other places illustrate telework, which means that employees work via electronic, telecommunications, and Internet means. The use of technology for telework is expected to grow, with almost 70% of private-sector respondents predicting more usage of IT resources in telework.34 Some employers are allowing employees to telecommute one or more days a week. Telecommuting allows employees to work from home when bad weather or widespread health issues (e.g., pandemic flu) prevents them from coming to office facilities.35 Common advantages of telework for employers are highlighted in Figure 4-6. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 121 26/06/10 4:05 PM 122 SECTION 2 FIGURE 4-6 Jobs and Labor Telework Advantages for Employers Business Impacts Improves business/employee productivity Reduces organizational costs Saves on paid travel and commuting time Reduces environmental and energy costs and effects Provides work services at varied hours Employee Impacts Aids individual retention and reduces turnover Expands employee recruitment “area” and attractiveness May enhance employee job satisfaction and morale Enhances employees’ personal lives and health Teleworking Considerations As more employers use telework, there are both advantages and concerns to consider. Several firms have found that telework can cut costs and raise productivity. For example, Home Shopping Network has 900 telecommuters in three states and has increased productivity and employee applicant desirability. This is why, according to one survey, almost 40% of organizations offer some telecommuting.36 However, the working relationship with teleworkers should begin with a carefully worded policy. This is necessary because the fact that managers have less direct supervision of teleworkers raises a number of issues and employee concerns. Such a policy must consider work time use, evaluation of performance, handling of expenses, and other factors. Additional issues affect employees and their relationships with coworkers and managers. One is overwork when having to balance home and work requirements. Maintaining employee motivation when individuals are not physically present at company facilities also LOGGING ON can be challenging and may increase employee stress. This The Telework Coalition is a special concern for global employees. Also, the 15-hour This coalition is a nonprofit organization time zone difference between the United States and some committed to advancing the growth and Asian countries may make it difficult for global employees success of telecommuting. Visit their to participate in conference calls or do extensive travel for site at www.telcoa.org. meetings. Work Schedule Alternatives Different types of work schedules have been developed for employees in different occupations and areas. The traditional U.S. work schedule of 8 hours a day, 5 days a week, is in transition. Workers in various occupations may work less or more than 8 hours at a workplace, and may have additional work at home. The work schedules associated with jobs vary. Some jobs must be performed during “normal” daily work hours and on weekdays, while others require employees to work nights, weekends, and extended hours. Hours worked vary globally as well. As the HR Perspective indicates, there are significant differences in the hours worked in different countries. Given the global Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 122 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 HR perspective Global Work Schedule Differences The number of work hours in a week and a year varies from country to country. Some of the differences in annual work hours are illustrated in the following chart. Annual Hours Worked by Employed Person by Country • Korea • Mexico • Italy • The United States • Japan 123 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 2,305 hours 1,871 hours 1,824 hours 1,794 hours • Canada • Australia • France • Germany 1,736 hours 1,722 hours 1,561 hours 1,433 hours 1,785 hours • The Netherlands 1,392 hours These numbers are interesting when other countries are compared with the United States. What is thought of as the “normal” U.S. work schedule is 40 hours per week, up to 50 weeks per year, excluding vacation time, making about 2,000 hours annually. However, the numbers of 1,794 hours in the United States and those in other countries may be affected by extended time-off polices set by laws and/or policies of employers.37 The European Union (EU) has issued the Working Time Directive, which states that employees in EU countries should work a maximum of 48 hours a week. However, EU workers can opt out of the maximum. For instance, France has had a law limiting working hours to 35 hours a week, but because exceptions have been made, the weekly average in different firms sometimes is lower or higher than 35. Notice that workers in other countries average different numbers of work hours. Given the global organizations in many industries, the differences in work hours must be considered across countries. Doing so means that work scheduling expectations and policies may have to be different for an operation in different countries. nature of many organizations, HR must adjust to different locations because of the international variations. Organizations are using many different work scheduling arrangements, based on industry demands, workforce needs, and other organizational factors.38 These different types include shift work and the compressed workweek. Shift Work A common work schedule design is shift work. Many organizations need 24-hour coverage and therefore may schedule three 8-hour shifts per day. Most of these employers provide some form of additional pay, called a shift differential, for working the evening or night shifts. Some types of shift work have been known to cause difficulties for some employees personally, such as weariness, irritability, lack of motivation, and illness.39 Nevertheless, some employers must have 24-hour, 7-day coverage, so shift work is likely to continue to be an option. Compressed workweek A workweek in which a full week’s work is accomplished in fewer than five 8-hour days. Compressed Workweek One type of work schedule design is the compressed workweek, in which a full week’s work is accomplished in fewer than five 8-hour days. Compression usually results in more work hours each day and fewer workdays each week, such as four 10-hour days, a 3-day week, or 12-hour shifts. One survey in chemical industry plants found that 96% of the workers who shifted to 12-hour schedules did not wish to return to 8-hour schedules.40 However, 12-hour schedules have led to sleep difficulties, fatigue, and an increased number of injuries. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 123 26/06/10 4:05 PM 124 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Work Flexibility and Scheduling Flexible work schedules allow organizations to make better use of workers by matching work demands to work hours. One type of scheduling is flextime, in which employees work a set number of hours a day but vary the starting and ending times. In some industries, flextime allows more employees to be available at peak times when more customers and clients are present. The flexibility has aided in recruiting and retaining key staff members.41 Employees Working at Home As part of organizational job restructurings, economic conditions, and work-life considerations, a number of individuals work at their home locations. Estimates are that more than 15 million employees work from home either full-time or part-time. While some may be selfemployed, others are full-time or part-time employees of firms. For instance, a senior HR professional for Hewlett-Packard leads a team of 40 professionals in compensation and benefits who support full-time employees in more than 50 countries. His approach requires regular teleworking and personal communications, as well as planning and communicating with executives and others primarily from home.42 Employer Policies on Flexible Work Schedules Flexible scheduling allows organizational and HR managers to choose when, where, and how workers will perform their jobs, while still covering workloads.43 With work flexibility and home work, electronic monitoring of activities and performance may be necessary. For instance, at a call-service firm, home-based employees are monitored on their use of phones through electronic links and get unpaid time off for taking personal breaks. Restrictions such as these are designed to keep workers meeting employers’ requirements.44 Employers still must comply with federal and state compensation laws when using flexible schedules. Flextime Scheduling arrangement in which employees work a set number of hours a day but vary starting and ending times. Work-Life Balancing For many employees throughout the world, balancing their work and personal lives is a significant concern. According to several surveys of workers and executives, work-life balance is one of the top ten concerns in most countries.45 Another survey found that work-life balance is the second most important item for executives, with only compensation being more important. A lack of sufficient work-life balance was cited by more than 40% of surveyed employees, and almost half said they might quit their current employers in an effort to get better work-life balance.46 Single parents, especially women, may face more work-life balancing issues than some other employees.47 Thousands of employees, both in large global firms like IBM and HewlettPackard and in many smaller firms, have flexible work schedules and/or use technology to work from locations away from the workplace as a way to help balance work and personal lives. Firms such as Xerox and J.M. Smucker give employees paid time off for community volunteer work. Numerous health care firms allow employees to adjust their work schedules in order to address personal, family, health, and other issues.48 JOB ANALYSIS While job design attempts to develop jobs that fit effectively into the flow of the organizational work, the more narrow focus of job analysis centers on using a formal system to gather data about what people do in their jobs. The basic Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 124 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 125 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis Job Analysis in Perspective FIGURE 4-7 JOB ANALYSIS Methods Questionnaires Interviews Observation Logs/diaries Sources of Data Employees Supervisors Managers Job analyst Conducted by Job analyst (HR) Outside consultant Supervisor/manager Used for Job Descriptions Job Specifications Used for EEO/ADA HR planning Recruiting Selection Compensation Training Peformance management Health, safety, and security Employee/labor relations building block of HR management, job analysis, is a systematic way of gathering and analyzing information about the content, context, and human requirements of jobs. Most other functions in HR are based on and affected by job analysis. An overview of job analysis is shown in Figure 4-7. The value of job analysis begins as the information is compiled into job descriptions and job specifications for use in virtually all HR activities. Purposes of Job Analysis Job analysis Systematic way of gathering and analyzing information about the content, context, and human requirements of jobs. Job analysis has grown in importance as the workforce and jobs have changed. To be effective, HR planning, recruiting, and selection all should be based on job requirements and the capabilities of individuals identified by job analysis. In EEO matters, accurate details on job requirements are needed, as the credentials in job descriptions can affect court decisions.49 Additionally, compensation, training, and employee performance appraisals all should be based on the specific identified needs of the jobs. Job analysis also is useful in identifying job factors and duties that may contribute to workplace health/safety and employee/labor relations issues. Information coming from job analyses that can be helpful in making the distinction among jobs includes the following: • • Work activities and behaviors Interactions with others Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 125 26/06/10 4:05 PM 126 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor • • • • • • Performance standards Financial and budgeting impact Machines and equipment used Working conditions Supervision given and received Knowledge, skills, and abilities needed Job Analysis Responsibilities Job analysis requires a high degree of coordination and cooperation between the HR unit and operating managers. The assignment of responsibility for job analysis depends on who can best perform various parts of the process. In large companies, the HR unit supervises the process to maintain its integrity and writes the job descriptions and specifications for uniformity. The managers review the efforts of the HR unit to ensure accuracy and completeness. They also may request new job analyses when jobs change significantly. In small organizations, managers may perform all job analysis responsibilities. Figure 4-8 shows a typical division of responsibilities in organizations with an HR unit. Different types of job analysis are used as part of HR efforts. The most traditionally and widely used method is task-based job analysis. But some have emphasized the need for competency-based job analysis. Both types of job analysis are discussed next. Task-based analysis is still the most widely used method. Task-Based Job Analysis Task Distinct, identifiable work activity composed of motions. Duty Work segment composed of several tasks that are performed by an individual. FIGURE 4-8 Task-based job analysis is the most common form and focuses on the tasks, duties, and responsibilities performed in a job. A task is a distinct, identifiable work activity composed of motions, whereas a duty is a larger work segment composed of several tasks that are performed by an individual. Because both tasks and duties describe activities, it is not always easy or necessary to distinguish between the two. For example, if one of the employment supervisor’s Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Job Analysis HR Unit Coordinates job analysis Writes job descriptions and specifications for review by managers Periodically reviews job descriptions and specifications Reviews managerial input to ensure accuracy May seek assistance from outside experts for difficult or unusual analyses Managers Complete or help complete job analysis information Review job descriptions and specifications and maintain their accuracy Request new analyses as jobs change Use job analysis information to identify performance standards Provide information to outside experts Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 126 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 127 duties is to interview applicants, one task associated with that duty would be asking job-related questions. Responsibilities are obligations to perform certain tasks and duties. Task-based job analysis seeks to identify all the tasks, duties, and responsibilities that are part of a job. Competency-Based Job Analysis Unlike the traditional task-based approach to analyzing jobs, the competency approach considers how knowledge and skills are used. Competencies are individual capabilities that can be linked to performance by individuals or teams. The concept of competencies varies widely from organization to organization. The term technical competencies is often used to refer to specific knowledge and skills of employees. For example, the following have been identified as behavioral competencies: • • • • • • • • • • Responsibilities Obligations to perform certain tasks and duties. Competencies Individual capabilities that can be linked to enhanced performance by individuals or teams. Customer focus Team orientation Technical expertise Results orientation Communication effectiveness Leadership Conflict resolution Innovation Adaptability Decisiveness The competency approach attempts to identify the competencies have been identified as driving employee performance.50 For instance, many supervisors talk about employees’ attitudes, but they have difficulty identifying exactly what they mean by “attitude.” A variety of methodologies are used to help supervisors articulate examples of competencies and how those factors affect performance.51 Unlike the traditional task-based job analysis, one purpose of the competency approach is to influence individual and organizational behaviors in the future. The competency approach may be more broadly focused on behaviors, rather than just on tasks, duties, and responsibilities. Some of the more comprehensive competency-based job analysis components may extensively include knowledge, skills, abilities, and personality characteristics.52 Integrating Technology and Competency-Based Job Analysis As jobs continue to change, technology expands, and workers become more diverse, it may be that there will be a more integrated use of both job analysis approaches. Another factor that will contribute to the use of both types of job analysis is that strategic competencies are identified for some jobs, not just performing job tasks and duties. In the future, people doing jobs are more likely to need integrated job analyLOGGING ON sis means, rather than just one approach.53 The decision Job Analysis.net about whether to use a task-based or competency-based A resource for conducting a job approach to job analysis is affected by the nature of jobs analysis, including different types of and how work is changing. However, task-based analysis is methods, legal issues, questionnaires, likely to remain more widely used as it is the most defenand job descriptions, can be found at sible legally, and it is the primary focus of the remainder of www.jobanalysis.net. this chapter. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 127 26/06/10 4:05 PM 128 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor IMPLEMENTING JOB ANALYSIS The process of job analysis must be conducted in a logical manner, following appropriate management and professional psychometric practices. Analysts usually follow a multistage process, regardless of the specific job analysis methods used. The stages for a typical job analysis, as outlined in Figure 4-9, may vary somewhat with the number of jobs included. Each of the phases is discussed next. Planning the Job Analysis Prior to the job analysis process itself is the planning done to gather data from managers and employees. Probably the most important consideration is to identify the objectives of the job analysis, which might be as simple as updating job descriptions or as comprehensive as revising the compensation programs in the organization. Whatever the purpose identified, the effort needs the support of top management. FIGURE 4-9 Stages in the Job Analysis Process I. Planning the Job Analysis A. Identify objectives of job analysis B. Obtain top management support II. Preparing For and Introducing Job Analysis A. Identify jobs and methodology B. Review existing job documentation C. Communicate process to managers/employees III. Conducting the Job Analysis A. Gather job analysis data B. Review and compile data IV. Developing Job Descriptions and Job Specifications A. Draft job descriptions and specifications B. Review drafts with managers and employees C. Finalize job descriptions and recommendations V. Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions and Job Specifications A. Update job descriptions and specifications as organization changes B. Periodically review all jobs Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 128 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 129 Preparing for and Introducing the Job Analysis Preparation for job analysis includes identification of the jobs to be analyzed. Next reviewing organization charts, existing job descriptions, previous job analysis information, and other resources is part of the planning. This phase also identifies those who will be involved in conducting the job analysis and the methods to be used. A key part is identifying and communicating the process to appropriate managers, affected employees, and others. Conducting the Job Analysis If questionnaires are used, it is often helpful to have employees return them to supervisors or managers for review before giving them back to those conducting the job analysis. Questionnaires should be accompanied by a letter explaining the process and instructions for completing and returning them. If interviews are used, they may occur after the return of the questionnaires, in order to clarify more details. Once data from job analyses are compiled, the information should be sorted by job, organizational unit, and job family. Developing Job Descriptions and Job Specifications At the fourth stage, the job analysts draft job descriptions and job specifications. Generally, organizations find that having managers and employees write job descriptions is not recommended for several reasons. First, it reduces consistency in format and details, both of which are important given the legal consequences of job descriptions. Second, managers and employees vary in their writing skills so they may write the job descriptions and job specifications to reflect what they do and what their personal qualifications are, not what the job requires. However, completed drafts should be reviewed with managers and supervisors, and then employees, before they are finalized. Maintaining and Updating Job Descriptions and Job Specifications Once job descriptions and specifications have been completed and reviewed by all appropriate individuals, a system must be developed for keeping them current and posted on a firm’s intranet source. One effective way to ensure that appropriate reviews occur is to use current job descriptions and job specifications as part of other HR activities. For example, each time a vacancy occurs, the job description and specifications should be reviewed and revised as necessary before recruiting and selection efforts begin. Similarly, in some organizations, managers and employees review job descriptions during performance appraisal interviews. JOB ANALYSIS METHODS Another consideration is the method to be used. Job analysis information about what people are doing in their jobs can be gathered in a variety of ways. Traditionally the most common methods have been observation, interviewing, and questionnaires. However, the expansion of technology has led to computerization and Web-based job analysis information resources. The use of Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 129 26/06/10 4:05 PM 130 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor a combination of these approaches depends on the situation and the organization.54 Each of these methods is discussed next. Observation With the observation method, a manager, job analyst, or industrial engineer observes the individual performing the job and takes notes to describe the tasks and duties performed. Use of the observation method is limited because many jobs do not have complete and easily observed job duties or job cycles. Thus, observation may be more useful for repetitive jobs and in conjunction with other methods. Work Sampling One type of observation, work sampling, does not require attention to each detailed action throughout an entire work cycle. This method allows a manager to determine the content and pace of a typical workday through statistical sampling of certain actions rather than through continuous observation and timing of all actions. Work sampling is particularly useful for routine and repetitive jobs. Employee Diary/Log Another observation method requires employees to “observe” their own performances by keeping a diary/log of their job duties, noting how frequently those duties are performed and the time required for each one. Although this approach sometimes generates useful information, it may be burdensome for employees to compile an accurate log. The logging approach can be technology-based, reducing some of the problems. Interviewing The interview method requires a manager or an HR specialist to talk with the employees performing each job. A standardized interview form is used most often to record the information. Both the employee and the employee’s supervisor must be interviewed to obtain complete details on the job. Sometimes, group or panel interviews are used. A team of subject matter experts (SMEs) who have varying insights about a group of jobs is assembled to provide job analysis information. This option may be particularly useful for highly technical or complex jobs. For instance, the competency approach may use interviewing to identify dimensions that are more than task-based. Because the interview method can be quite time consuming, combining it with one of the other methods is common. Questionnaires The questionnaire is a widely used method of gathering data on jobs. A survey instrument is developed and given to employees and managers to complete. The typical job questionnaire often covers the areas shown in Figure 4-10. The questionnaire method offers a major advantage in that information on a large number of jobs can be collected inexpensively in a relatively short period of time. However, the questionnaire method assumes that employees can accurately analyze and communicate information about their jobs. Using interviewing and observation in combination with the questionnaire method allows analysts to clarify and verify the information gathered in questionnaires. Position Analysis Questionnaire (PAQ) The Position Analysis Questionnaire is a specialized instrument that incorporates checklists. Each Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 130 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 131 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis FIGURE 4-10 Typical Areas Covered in a Job Analysis Questionnaire Duties and Percentage of Time Spent on Each Contact with Other People • Regular duties • Special duties performed less frequently • Internal contacts • External contacts Supervision Physical Dimensions • Supervision given to others • Supervision received from others • Physical demands • Working conditions Decisions Made Jobholder Characteristics • Records and reports prepared • Materials and equipment used • Financial/budget responsibilities • • • • Knowledge Skills Abilities Training needed job is analyzed on 27 dimensions composed of 187 “elements.” The PAQ has a number of divisions, each containing numerous job elements. The PAQ focuses on “worker-oriented” elements that describe behaviors necessary to do the job rather than on “job-oriented” elements that describe the technical aspects of the work. Although its complexity may deter potential users, the PAQ can be used to conduct validity studies on selection tests. It also may contribute to internal pay fairness because it considers the varying demands of different jobs. Managerial Job Analysis Questionnaire Because managerial jobs often differ from jobs with clearly observable routines and procedures, some specialized job analysis methods exist. One well-known method is the Management Position Description Questionnaire (MPDQ). Composed of more than 200 statements, the MPDQ examines a variety of managerial dimensions, including decision making and supervising. Computerized Job Analysis Systems With the expansion of information technology and Web-based resources, computerized job analysis systems have been developed. An important feature of technological job analysis is the specificity of data that can be gathered and compiled into a job analysis database. As a result, a technology-based job analysis system can often reduce the time and effort involved in writing job descriptions. These systems often store banks of job duty statements that relate to each of the task and scope statements of the questionnaires. The use of computerized methods will likely continue to grow because of the advantages offered (see the later section on O*Net). Combination Methods A number of different ways to obtain and analyze information about a job exist. Each method has strengths and weaknesses, and a combination of methods Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 131 26/06/10 4:05 PM 132 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor HR online O*Net Resources for Employers Since the recent expansion of the O*Net databases for employers, this resource contains data on more than 800 occupations, classified by industry. Included in the occupational categories are the following: • Task statements or importance, relevance, and frequency • Abilities (work activities, knowledge, skills, and work content) • Training, work experiences, and education • Interests and work values, work styles, and job zones O*Net can be used in different ways. For example, one way is to see what abilities will be needed in certain jobs. More than 50 abilities are listed, including arm-hand steadiness, fluency of ideas, time sharing, visualization, written and oral comprehension, and speech clarity. Employers can use the abilities and the other components to generate data for some parts of job analysis and for developing job descriptions. O*Net also now contains the Dictionary of Occupational Titles (DOT) and has hundreds of jobs descriptions. For example, on HR jobs, the DOT and O*Net have listed details on occupations such as Employee Relations Specialist and Human Resource Advisor. For these and all other types of jobs, an extensive list of tasks and detailed work activities is provided. A Spanish version database is available to aid with diverse workers and jobs. The details provided give supervisors, managers, and HR professionals a valuable resource as they develop or revise job descriptions, compare recruiting advertisements, develop training components, and perform other HR activities. In summary, O*Net is a database of worker attributes and job characteristics to describe jobs and the skills workers will need to perform them. It can be accessed at www.onetcenter.org.55 generally may be more appropriate than one method alone. Regardless of the methods used, job analysis provides the information necessary to develop job descriptions and job specifications. Job Analysis and O*Net A variety of resources related to job analysis are available from the U.S. Department of Labor (DOL). The resources have been developed and used over many years by various entities. Functional job analysis uses a competency approach to job analysis. A functional definition of what is done in a job can be generated by examining the three components of data, people, and things. The levels of these components traditionally have been used to identify and compare important elements of more than 120 jobs in the Dictionary of Occupational Titles (DOT). But O*Net is now the main DOL resource available and provides employers with a wide range of useful items, as noted in the HR Online description. Although not specifically a job analysis, O*Net is a database compiled by the U.S. Department of Labor to provide basic occupational data that covers Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 132 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 133 more than 800 occupations based on the Standard Occupational Classification (SOC) developed by the government. O*Net also provides extensive links to additional resources on workplace issues. BEHAVIORAL AND LEGAL ASPECTS OF JOB ANALYSIS Job analysis involves determining what the “core” job is. A detailed examination of jobs, although necessary, sometimes can be a demanding and disruptive experience for both managers and employees, in part because job analysis can identify the difference between what currently is being performed in a job and what should be done. This is a major issue about job analysis for some people, but it is not the only concern. Thus, some behavioral factors that can affect job analysis are discussed next. Current Incumbent Emphasis A job analysis and the resulting job description and job specifications should not describe just what the person currently doing the job does and that person’s qualifications. The incumbent may have unique capabilities and the ability to expand the scope of the job to assume more responsibilities, and the employer might have difficulty finding someone exactly like that individual if the person left. Consequently, it is useful to focus on core duties and necessary knowledge, skills, and abilities by determining what the job would be if the incumbent were to quit or be moved to a different job. “Inflation” of Jobs and Job Titles People have a tendency to inflate the importance and significance of their jobs. Because job analysis information is used for compensation purposes, both managers and employees hope that “puffing up” jobs will result in higher pay levels, greater “status” for résumés, and more promotional opportunities. Inflated job titles also can be used to enhance employees’ images without making major job changes or pay adjustments.56 For instance, banking and financial institutions often use officer designations to enhance status. In one small Midwestern bank, an employee who had three years’ experience as a teller was “promoted” with no pay increase to Second Vice President of Customer Service. In effect, she became the lead teller when her supervisor was out of the bank, and now could sign more customer account forms, but her duties and compensation were basically the same. An additional concern is the use of offbeat titles. For example, what is a “group idea management director,” “chief transformation officer,” or “marketing evangelist”? What does a “human character manager” really do? These examples illustrate how job titles may be misleading, both inside and outside the place of employment. Titles should convey a clear view of what a job involves. Employee and Managerial Anxieties Both employees and managers have concerns about job analysis. Through job analysis, the job description is supposed to identify what is done in a Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 133 26/06/10 4:05 PM 134 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor job. However, it is difficult to capture all facets of a job in which employees perform a variety of duties and operate with a high degree of independence. Employee Fears One fear that employees may have concerns the purpose of a detailed investigation of their jobs. Some employees fear that an analysis of their jobs will put a straitjacket on them, limiting their creativity and flexibility by formalizing their duties. However, having accurate, well-communicated job descriptions can assist employees by clarifying their roles and the expectations within those roles. One effective way to handle anxieties is to involve the employees in the revision process. Often the content of a job may reflect the desires and skills of the incumbent employee. For example, in one firm, an employee promoted to customer service supervisor continued to spend considerable time answering customer calls, rather than supervising employees taking the calls. As part of job analysis discussions, the operations manager discussed the need for the supervisor to train the employees on handling special customer requests and to delegate more routine duties to others. Managerial Straitjacket One primary concern of managers and supervisors is that the job analysis and job descriptions will unrealistically limit managerial flexibility. Because workloads and demands change rapidly, managers and supervisors want to be able to move duties to other employees, cross-train employees, and have more dynamic, flexible means available to accomplish work. If job descriptions are written or used restrictively, some employees may use an omission to limit managerial flexibility. In some organizations with unionized workforces, very restrictive job descriptions exist. Because of such difficulties, the final statement in many job descriptions is a miscellaneous clause that consists of a phrase similar to “Performs other duties as needed upon request by immediate supervisor.” This statement covers unusual situations in an employee’s job. However, duties covered by this phrase cannot be considered essential functions under legal provisions including the Americans with Disabilities Act, as discussed next. Legal Aspects of Job Analysis Chapter 3 on equal employment laws, regulations, and court cases emphasized that legal compliance must focus on the jobs that individuals perform. The Uniform Guidelines on Employee Selection Procedures make it clear that HR requirements must be tied to specific job-related factors if employers are to defend their actions as a business necessity. This approach has direct impact on job descriptions and persons with disabilities who may apply for those jobs. Job Analysis and the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA) One result of the ADA is increased emphasis by employers on conducting job analyses, as well as developing and maintaining current and accurate job descriptions and job specifications. The ADA requires that organizations identify the essential job functions, which are the fundamental duties of a job. These do not include the marginal Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 134 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 135 functions of the positions. Marginal job functions are duties that are part of a job but are incidental or ancillary to the purpose and nature of the job. Job analysts, HR staff members, and operating managers must evaluate and make decisions when information on three considerations is not clear. The three major considerations used in determining essential functions and marginal functions are as follows: • • • Percentage of time spent on tasks Frequency of tasks done Importance of tasks performed Job analysis also should identify the physical demands of jobs. For example, the important physical skills and capabilities used on the job of nursing representative could include being able to hear well enough to aid clients and doctors. However, hearing might be less essential for a heavy equipment operator in a quarry. An important part of job analysis is obtaining information about what duties are being performed and what percentage of time is devoted to each duty. As the ADA suggests, the percentage of time spent on a duty generally indicates its relative importance. Another consideration is the ease or difficulty of assigning a duty to be performed by someone else, or in a different job. Job Analysis and Wage/Hour Regulations Typically, job analysis identifies the percentage of time spent on each duty in a job. This information helps determine whether someone should be classified as exempt or nonexempt under the wage/hour laws. As will be noted in Chapter 11, the federal Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA) and most state wage/hour laws indicate that the percentage of time employees spend on manual, routine, or clerical duties affects whether they must be paid overtime for hours worked in excess of 40 hours a week. To be exempt from overtime, the employees must perform their primary duties as executive, administrative, professional, or outside sales employees. Primary has been interpreted to mean occurring at least 50% of the time Other legal-compliance efforts, such as those involving workplace safety and health, can also be aided through the data provided by job analysis. In summary, it is difficult for an employer to have a legal staffing system without performing job analysis. Truly, job analysis is the most basic HR activity and the foundation for most other HR activities. JOB DESCRIPTIONS AND JOB SPECIFICATIONS Marginal job functions Duties that are part of a job but are incidental or ancillary to the purpose and nature of the job. The output from analysis of a job is used to develop a job description and its job specifications. Together, these two documents summarize job analysis information in a readable format and provide the basis for defensible jobrelated actions. They also identify individual jobs for employees by providing documentation from management. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 135 26/06/10 4:05 PM 136 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor HR on-the-job Writing Job Descriptions Although not the most exciting part of HR management, developing and maintaining current job descriptions is important. Some key suggestions for writing a job description that includes the essential functions and duties of a job follow: • • • Compose specific duty statements that contain most of the following elements: • A precise action verb and its object • The frequency of the duties and the expected outcomes • The tools, equipment, aids, and processes to be used Be logical: If the job is repetitive, describe the tasks as they occur in the work cycle. For varied jobs, list the major tasks first and follow those with the less frequent and/or less important tasks in order. Use proper details: Make sure the description covers all the meaningful duties of the job, but avoids too many details. • • • • • Be specific: For example, instead of saying “Lifts heavy packages,” say “Frequently lifts heavy packages weighing up to 50 pounds.” Use the active voice: Start each statement with a functional verb in the present tense (thirdperson singular)—for instance, “Compiles,” “Approves,” or “Analyzes.” Avoid terms like handles, maintains, and processes. Describe, do not prescribe: Say “Operates electronic imaging machine,” not “Must know how to operate electronic image machine.” (The latter is a job specification, not a job description.) Be consistent: Define terms like may, occasionally, and periodically. Prepare a miscellaneous clause: This clause provides flexibility and may be phrased as follows: “Performs other related duties as assigned by supervisory personnel.” Job Descriptions In most cases, the job description and job specifications are combined into one document that contains several sections. A job description identifies the tasks, duties, and responsibilities of a job. It describes what is done, why it is done, where it is done, and, briefly, how it is done. The HR On-the-Job shows suggestions for writing job descriptions. Job description Identification of the tasks, duties, and responsibilities of a job. Job specifications The knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) an individual needs to perform a job satisfactorily. Performance standards Indicators of what the job accomplishes and how performance is measured in key areas of the job description. Job Specifications While the job description describes activities to be done, the job specifications list the knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) an individual needs to perform a job satisfactorily. KSAs include education, experience, work skill requirements, personal abilities, and mental and physical requirements. Accurate job specifications identify what KSAs a person needs to do the job, not necessarily the current employee’s qualifications. Performance Standards Performance standards flow directly from a job description and indicate what the job accomplishes and how performance is measured in key areas of the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 136 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis 137 job description. If employees know what is expected and how performance is to be measured, they have a much better chance of performing satisfactorily. Unfortunately, performance standards are often not developed as supplemental items from job descriptions. Even if performance standards have been identified and matched to job descriptions, they must be communicated to employees if the job descriptions are to be effective HR tools. Job Description Components A typical job description contains several major parts. The following content presents an overview of the most common components. Identification The first part of the job description is the identification section, in which the job title, department, reporting relationships, location, and date of analysis may be given. Usually, it is advisable to note other information that is useful in tracking jobs and employees through HR systems. Additional items commonly noted in the identification section are job code, pay grade, exempt/nonexempt status under the Fair Labor Standards Act (FLSA), and the EEOC classification (from the EEO-1 form). General Summary The second part, the general summary, is a concise statement of the general responsibilities and components that make the job different from others. One HR specialist has characterized the general summary statement as follows: “In thirty words or less, describe the essence of the job.” Often, the summary is written after all other sections are completed so that a more complete overview is prepared. Essential Job Functions and Duties The third part of the typical job description lists the essential functions and duties, generally in order of importance. It contains clear, precise statements on the major tasks, duties, and responsibilities performed. Writing this section is the most time-consuming aspect of preparing job descriptions. Job Specifications The next portion of the job description gives the qualifications needed to perform the job satisfactorily. The job specifications typically are stated as: (1) knowledge, skills, and abilities; (2) education and experience; and (3) physical requirements and/or working conditions. The components of the job specifications provide information necessary to determine what accommodations might and might not be possible under the Americans with Disabilities Act. Disclaimers and Approvals The final section on many job descriptions contains approval signatures by appropriate managers and a legal disclaimer. This disclaimer allows employers to change employees’ job duties or to request employees to perform duties not listed, so that the job description is not viewed as a contract between the employer and the employee. Figure 4-11 contains a sample job description and job specifications for a Customer Service Supervisor. Also, Appendix G has sample HR-related job descriptions. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 137 26/06/10 4:05 PM 138 SECTION 2 F I G U R E 4 - 11 Jobs and Labor Sample Job Description Identification Section Position Title: Customer Service Supervisor Department: Marketing/Customer Service Reports To: Marketing Director EEOC Class: O/M FLSA Status: Exempt General Summary Supervises, coordinates, and assigns work of employees to ensure customer service department goals and customer needs are met. Essential Job Functions 1. Supervises the work of Customer Service Representatives to enhance performance by coordinating duties, advising on issues or problems, and checking work. (55%) 2. Provides Customer Service training for company employees in all departments. (15%) 3. Creates and reviews reports for service orders for new and existing customers. (10%) 4. Performs employee performance evaluations, training, and discipline. (10%) 5. Follows up with customer complaints and issues and provides resolutions. (10%) 6. Conducts other duties as needed by guided by Marketing Director and executives. Knowledge, Skills, and Abilities • Knowledge of company products, services, policies, and procedures. • Knowledge of marketing and customer programs, data, and results. • Knowledge of supervisory requirements and practices. • Skill in completing multiple tasks at once. • Skill in identifying and resolving customer problems. • Skill in oral and written communication, including Spanish communications. • Skill in coaching, training, and performance evaluating employees. • Skill in operating office and technological equipment and software. • Ability to communicate professionally with coworkers, customers and vendors. • Ability to work independently and meet managerial goals. • Ability to follow oral and written instructions. • Ability to organize daily activities of self and others and to work as a team player. Education and Experience Bachelor’s degree in business or marketing, plus 3–5 years of industry experience. Supervisory, marketing, and customer service experience helpful. Physical Requirements Percentage of Work Time Spent on Activity 0–24% 25–49% 50–74% 75–100% Seeing : Must be able to see well enough to read reports. X Hearing : Must be able to hear well enough to communicate with customers, vendors and employees. X Standing/Walking : Must be able to move about department. X Climbing/Stooping/Kneeling : Must be able to stoop or kneel to pick up paper products or directories. X Lifting/Pulling/Pushing : Must be able to lift up to 50 pounds. X Fingering/Grasping/Feeling : Must be able to type and use technical sources. X Working Conditions: Normal working conditions absent extreme factors. Note: The statements herein are intended to describe the general nature and level of work being performed, but are not to be seen as a complete list of responsibilities, duties, and skills required of personnel so classified. Also, they do not establish a contract for employment and are subject to change at the discretion of the employer. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 138 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 139 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis S U M M A R Y • • • • • • • • Diversity management focuses on organizational efforts to ensure that all people are valued regardless of their differences. The “business case” for diversity is built on its ability to allow new talent and ideas, aid in employee attraction and retention, allow for an increase in market share, and lead to lower costs. The workforce composition is becoming more diverse based on race/ethnicity, age, gender, and other life components. Work is organized into jobs for people to do. Work flow analysis and business process reengineering are both approaches used to check how well this has been done. Job design involves developing jobs that people like to do. It may include simplification, enlargement, enrichment, rotation, or sharing. Designing jobs so that they incorporate skill variety, task identity and significance, autonomy, and feedback is important for both employers and employees. The use of work teams and virtual teams is growing in organizations throughout the United States and globally. Work-related teams are aiding organizational and managerial productivity and growth, despite some problems that may occur. C R I T I C A L • • • • • • • • Telework, whereby employees work with technology, is leading to more work flexibility. Work scheduling through flextime allows employees to work more at home, which enhances their work-life balancing activities. Job analysis is a systematic investigation of the content, context, and human requirements of a job. Task-based job analysis focuses on the tasks, duties, and responsibilities associated with jobs. Competency-based job analysis focuses on basic characteristics that can be linked to enhanced performance, such as technical and behavioral competencies. The job analysis process has five stages, beginning with planning and ending with maintaining and updating job descriptions and job specifications. A number of methods of job analysis are used, with interviews and questionnaires being the most popular. Both the behavioral reactions of employees and managers and legal-compliance issues must be considered as part of job analysis. The end products of job analysis are job descriptions, which identify the tasks, duties, and responsibilities of jobs, and job specifications, which list the knowledge, skills, and abilities needed to perform a job satisfactorily. T H I N K I N G 1. Describe how diversity of workers has been impacting organizations, including organizations for which you have worked recently. 2. For many individuals, the nature of work and jobs is changing. Describe these changes, some reasons for them, and how they are affecting both HR management and individuals. 3. Explain how you would conduct a job analysis in a company that has never had job H R • E X P E R I E N T I A L You have recently assumed the role of HR Manager in your company. In reviewing the company records, you note that the job descriptions were last updated 5 years ago. The Company President has taken the A C T I V I T I E S descriptions. Utilize the O*Net as a resource for your information. 4. You need to convince upper management of the usefulness of a companywide diversity program. How will you define diversity, and what arguments can be made for so defining it? Use the website www.diversityinc .com and other sources to gather the necessary information. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G position that there is no need to update the job descriptions. However, you also note that the company has grown by 50% during the last 5 years, resulting in many changes, including some in job Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 139 26/06/10 4:05 PM 140 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor functions. You want to build a business case to convince the Company President of the need to update the job descriptions. To help you build your case, use the information on the purpose of job descriptions at www.hrtools.com. 1. How can job descriptions be used as a management tool? 2. What role do job descriptions have in helping companies comply with various legal issues? C A S E ROWE and Flexible Work and Success at Best Buy Best Buy is a large national retailer with many full-time and part-time employees in more than 1,000 stores. Beginning several years ago, Best Buy has made major changes in its work schedules. Rather than emphasizing fixed hours, Best Buy increased use of flexible work hours in its corporate headquarters and stores. Based on the success of an initial experimental program with 300 employees in some departments, the changes have evolved into a more broadly used program labeled ROWE—Results Only Work Environment. At the heart of ROWE is the philosophy of focusing on employees getting their work done, not just meeting clock hours. To implement ROWE, managers and employees have had to identify performance result expectations and measures for all jobs. The focus of ROWE has been on how people make judgments on work to be done and the time at work to do it. The core focus of ROWE is employee performance meeting expectations, not just being at work. The HR payoff of ROWE has been significant. According to metrics, voluntary employee turnover has declined in some divisions by as much as 75% to 90% over several years. Average worker productivity in the same period increased over one-third. Some other key results of the ROWE plan have been: • • • Increased customer satisfaction because of the work-results focus of Best Buy employees Higher employee morale and engagement because of the ability to place work and life demands in balance Higher managerial performance because of the attention to results, not just on training schedules and regulations For some employees and managers with family responsibilities and personal interests, one of the greatest advantages of the ROWE program is the ability for them to achieve better work-life balance. From mothers of school-aged children to single males involved in hobbies and sports, employees can adjust schedules to meet their personal and professional needs. For instance, one employee left often in early afternoon in order to participate in entertainment activities. Other employees have finished work and gone hunting or golfing during the “normal workweek” because they had completed their work requirements. Obviously, these persons can make expansive use of technology for doing their work anywhere, such as getting messages while at family or sporting events, responding quickly to job-related questions, and providing immediate work-related information. The ROWE program now has been expanded to include retail store managers and workers. Doing so has meant making some modifications to ensure that sufficient salespersons are available to serve customers at a wide range of days and times. But with Best Buy retail stores previously experiencing a turnover rate of 60% plus, adapting to ROWE has been important. It has helped with recruiting store employees, retaining them so that turnover has decreased, and enhancing customer service. In summary, the change in the culture at Best Buy to focus on results, employee success, and greater work flexibility has made Best Buy one of the best places for many people to shop and work. How this program will expand and modify as economic, workforce diversity, and jobs change will be interesting to observe.57 QUESTIONS 1. Discuss how a ROWE-type program would fit in organizations where you have worked. Explain why it would or would not work. 2. Identify factors in the ROWE program that might make using it for retail employees more difficult than using it for managers and employees in corporate offices, technical centers, and nonretail jobs and locations. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 140 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 141 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S The Reluctant Receptionist Jobs and Work at R.R. Donnelley This case illustrates how incomplete job analysis and job descriptions create both managerial and employee problems. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/ management/mathis.) This case describes how a printing firm had to increase productivity and redesign jobs. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/ mathis.) N O T E S 1. Kathleen Koster, “Flex Schedules Key to Corporate Performance,” Employee Benefit News, May 28, 2009, http://ebn.benefitnews.com/ news; “Survey Results: Flexible Work Arrangements,” Institute for Corporate Productivity, 2008, 3–8, www.i4cp.com. 2. “Employment Projections” U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov. 3. David A. Harrison and Katherine L. Klein, “What’s the Difference? Diversity Constructs as Separation, Variety, or Disparity in Organizations,” Academy of Management Review, 22 (2007), 1199–1228. 4. Eddy S.W. Nig, “Why Organizations Choose to Manage Diversity,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 58–78. 5. Robert Rodriguez, “Diversity Finds Its Place,” HR Magazine, August 2006, 56–61. 6. Kathy Gurchiek, “Putting Diversity into Practice Stymies Many Firms,” HR News, August 27, 2007, www.shrm.org/hrnews. 7. Bill Leonard, “Diversity Initiatives Must Grow from Key Business Goals,” SHRMOnLine, April 29, 2009, www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines; Ellen F. Curtis and Janice L. Dreachslin, “Integrative Literature Review: Diverse Management Interventions and Organizational Performance,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 107–134. 8. Lynn M. Shore, et al., “Diversity in Organizations: Where Are We Now and Where Are We Going?” Human Resource Management Review, 22 (2007), 1199–1228; Sharon Wong, “Diversity—Making Space for 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Everyone at NASA/Goddard Space Flight Center . . .,” Human Resource Management, 47 (2008), 389–399. Gill Kilton and Anne-Marie Greene, “The Costs and Opportunities of Doing Diversity Work in Mainstream Organizations,” Human Resource Management Journal, 19 (2009), 159–175; Orlando C. Richard, et al., “The Impact of Racial Diversity on Intermediate and Long-Term Performance,” Strategic Management Journal, 28 (2007), 1213–1233. Based on Terence F. Shea, “Dismantling Language Barriers,” HR Magazine, November 2008, 48–52. “An Older and More Diverse Nation by Mid-Century,” U.S. Census Bureau News, August 14, 2008, www.census.gov. Sherri B. Welch, “Diversity as Business Strategy: Company Faced Racial Tensions Head-on,” Workforce Week, April 2009, www.workforce.com; G. M. Combs and J. Griffith, “An Examination of Interracial Contact,” Human Resource Development Review, 6 (2007), 222–244. Tara Kalwarski, “Retirement: Not When It Used to Be?” Business Week, November 3, 2008, 96; Stephen Miller, “60 Percent of Older Workers Delay Retirement,” HR Disciplines, March 23, 2009, www.shrm.org. “Managing Across the Generations,” HR Compliance, May 14, 2009, www.ceridian.com; “Gen Y Creates Need for Cultural Overhaul,” WorldatWork Newsline, January 11, 2008, www.worldatwork.org/ 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. waw; “Generation X: Magic or Mayhem in the Middle,” 2009, www.talentAnarchy.com. Nancy Lockwood, et al., “The Multigenerational Workforce: Opportunity for Competitive Success,” SHRM Research Quarterly, First Quarter, 2009, 1–10; Robert J. Grossman, “Keep Pace with Older Workers,” HR Magazine, May 2008, 39–46. Frank Giancola, “The Generation Gap: More Myth than Reality,” Human Resource Planning, 29 (2006), 32; Susan A. Murphy, Leading a Multigenerational Workforce (Washington, DC: AARP, 2007). American Time Use Survey, U.S. Department of Labor, 2008, www .bls.gov/tus/#news. George Desvaux, et al., “A Business Case for Women,” The McKinsey Quarterly, September 2008, 1ff.; Philip N. Cohen and Matt Huffman, “Working for the Woman? Female Mangers and the Gender Wage Gap,” American Sociological Review, 72 (2007), 681–704. “43% of Working Moms Would Take Pay Cuts to Spend Time with Kids,” May 8, 2008, www.careerbuilder.com; Jean Kimmel and Rachel Connnelly, “Mother’s Time Choices,” Journal of Human Resources, 62 (2007), 643–681. Eugene A. Hall, et al., “How to Make Reengineering Really Work,” The McKinsey Quarterly, September 2008, www .mckinseyquarterly.com. George McCormick, et al., “The Manager’s Impact on Job and Organization Design,” WorldatWork Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 141 26/06/10 4:05 PM 142 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2007, 82–91. For more details and data on contingent employees, go to www .bls.gov. Fay Hansen, “A Permanent Strategy for Temporary Hires,” Workforce Management, February 26, 2007, 25–32. Allysson M. Costa and Cristobal Mirrales, “Job Rotation in Assembly Lines Employing Disabled Workers,” International Journal of Production Economics, 112 (2009), 1016. Margaret Fiester, “Job Rotation, Total Rewards, Measuring Value,” HR Magazine, August 2008, 33. Kathy Gurchiek, “HR Structure Reflects Organizational Size,” HR News, June 15, 2009, www.shrm.org. Michael O’Brien, “Long-Distance Relationship Troubles,” Human Resource Executive Online, July 7, 2009, www.hrexecutive.com. Billie Williamson, “Managing at a Distance,” BusinessWeek, July 27, 2009, 64–65; Lynda Gratton, “Working Together . . . When Apart,” The Wall Street Journal, June 16, 2007, R4. “Innovative Work Teams in a Challenging Business Environment,” SHRM Workplace Visions, 2009, No. 1, 1–6. Ramon Rico, et al., “Team Implicit Coordination Processes,” Academy of Management Review, 33 (2008), 163–184. Marjo Sinokki, “The Association Between Team Climate at Work and Mental Health,” Occupational and Environmental Medicine, 66 (2009), 523–526; Christopher M. Barnes and John R. Hollenbeck, “Sleep Deprivation and DecisionMaking Teams,” Academy of Management Review, 34 (2009), 56–66l. Jessica Mesmert-Magnus and Leslie A. DeChurch, “Information Sharing and Team Performance: A Meta-Analysis,” Journal of Applied Psychology, 94 (2009), 535–546; Erick Kearney, et al., “When and How Diversity 33. 34. 35. 36. 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. Benefits Teams,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 581–598. Andrew R. McIlvane, “The Problem with Diverse Teams,” Human Resource Executive Online, June 2, 2009, www.hreonline.com. Rita Zeidner, “Telework Influencing Technology Investments,” HR Magazine, July 2008, 22. Heidi Russell Rafferty, “Experts: Telework Might Hold Key to Pandemic Solution,” HR News, May 7, 2009, www.shrm.org/ publications. Lorrie Lykins and Mark Vickers, “Can Telework Cut Costs and Raise Productivity in Today’s Economy?” Trend Watcher, March 6, 2009, www.i4cp.com. Based on “Annual Hours Worked per Employed Person, 1997 and 2007,” Labor Market Indicators, Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development, 2009, www.oecd.org. Terrance M. McMenamin, “A Time to Work: Recent Trends in Shift Work and Flexible Schedules,” Monthly Labor Review, December 2007, 3–14. “Extended Unusual Work Shifts,” U.S. Occupational Safety & Health Administration, September 7, 2005, www.osha.gov. Martin Moore-Ede, et al., “Advantages and Disadvantages of Twelve-Hour Shifts, A Balanced Perspective,” 2007, www.ciridian .com. “Innovative Workplace Flexibility Options for Hourly Workers,” Corporate Voices for Working Families, 2009, www .cvworkingfamilies.org/ publications. Euan Hutchinson, “‘People People’ Work at Home, Too,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 60–62. E. Jeffrey Hill, et al., “Defining and Conceptualizing Work Flexibility,” Community, Work, and Family, 11 (2008), 149–163. Sue Shellenbarger, “Work at Home: Employers Watch,” The 45. 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52. 53. Wall Street Journal, July 30, 2008, D1ff. Beth A. Heinen and Rebecca R. H. Mulvaney, “Global Factors Influencing Work-Life Policies and Practices,” WorldatWork Journal, First Quarter, 2008, 34–41; Sheri Gaster and Virginia G. McMorrow, “Expatriates Assignments Influence on Work-Life Balance,” WorldatWork Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2008, 62–69. Kathleen Koster, “Work-Life Balance Key for Employees,” Employee Benefit News, May 7, 2009, http://ebn .benefitnews.com; Maggie C. Moore and Nancy R. Lockwood, “Work/Life Balance: A Global Perspective,” HRM Research, April 1007, www.shrm.org/ research. Jean Kimmel and Rachel Connelly, “Mothers’ Time Choices,” Journal of Human Resources, 62 (2006), 643–681; Melanie A. Hulbert, “Unveiling Gendered Assumptions in the Organizational Implementation of Work-Life Policies,” WorldatWork Journal, First Quarter, 2009, 42–54. For examples, see Sherry Sullivan and Lisa Mainiero, “Benchmarking Ideas for Fostering Family-Friendly Workplaces,” Organizational Dynamics, 36 (2006), 45–62; Pamela Babcock, “Elder Care at Work,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 111–113. Lamb v. Boeing Co., No. 5-18431 (4th Cir., Jan. 11, 2007). Douglas W. Crisman, “Using Competencies to Drive Talent Management,” Workspan, December 2006, 11. Garry Kranz, “Calling on Experts,” Workforce Management, June 2008, www .workforce.com. “Competency Modeling and Job Analysis: Current Trends and Debates in the Academic Literature,” ICF International, 2009, www.icfi.com. Juan L. Sanchez and Edward L. Levine, “What Is (or Should Be) the Difference Between Competency Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 142 26/06/10 4:05 PM CHAPTER 4 143 Workers, Jobs, and Job Analysis Modeling and Traditional Job Analysis?” Human Resource Management Review, 19 (2009), 53–63. 54. Jason C. Kovac, “The Purpose of Job Analysis,” Workspan, December 2006, 11. 55. For details, go to the website listed in the boxed feature, as well as www.dol.gov and www .onetcenter.org. The value of O*Net is identified in various publications, including Max Maller, The Manager’s Guide to HR, Chapter 1 (Alexandria, VA: SHRM, 2009). 56. Arthur D. Martinez, et al., “Job Title Inflation,” Human Resource Management Review, 18 (2008), 19–27. 57. Based on Lynn Gresham, “Best Buy Puts Work-Life Balance on New Axis,” Employee Benefit Advisor, March 2007, 24–26; Michelle Conlin, “Smashing the Clock,” BusinessWeek, December 11, 2006, 60–68. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_04_ch04_p107-143.indd 143 26/06/10 4:05 PM C H A P T E R 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Define HR planning and outline the HR planning process. • Describe the means for assessing the external and internal workforce in HR planning. • Identify methods for forecasting HR supply and demand levels. • Explain the nature of the psychological contract and how motivation is linked to individual performance. • Describe different kinds of turnover and how turnover can be measured. • Identify the six drivers of retention and ways retention measurement can occur. 144 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 144 17/07/10 5:47 PM HR Headline Need More Workers? A (AP Photo/Toby Talbot) s economic conditions have changed negatively for many organizations, they have had to cut jobs and workers. One industry that has made many reductions has been the automotive industry. Yet, employers in some other industries have had a continuing shortage of workers. One illustration of such problems is in the milk producing industry as well as other agricultural employers. Many U.S. individuals, even if they are unemployed, do not want to work in jobs such as those in these industries, since they have relatively low pay rates and the working conditions tend to be outdoors or in warehouses. Therefore, U.S. dairy farmers have had to use immigrants from Latin countries to fill 40% of their jobs, but the use of immigrants has created HR issues due to state and federal laws regarding employment of illegal immigrants. Employers in other industries also are needing workers. Some construction companies, health care organizations, and technology employers are facing shortages of qualified individuals. Attracting, recruiting, and retaining good employees are crucial. For instance, Google, the large technology employer, estimated that it could lose a significant number of employees to technology competitors such as Facebook, Twitter, or new firms. Whatever the industry, where more workers are needed, HR efforts should be expanded. Employers in different industries face staffing issues emphasizing HR planning and retention. As industry and economic conditions continue to change, planning and retention will only increase in importance.1 145 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 145 17/07/10 5:48 PM 146 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor Staffing an organization is an HR activity that is both strategic and operational in nature. As the HR Headline indicates, HR planning is important in a wide variety of industries and firms. HR planning affects what employers do when recruiting, selecting, and retaining people, and, of course these actions affect organizational results and success. The challenges caused by changing economic conditions during recent years show why HR workforce planning should occur.2 A study by Watson Wyatt that found that it does occur in more than 80% of organizations in more than 30 countries. However, only one-fourth of smaller U.S.-based companies had formal HR plans.3 Planning in small firms is more informal, as shown below. HUMAN RESOURCE PLANNING Human resource planning is the process of analyzing and identifying the need for and availability of human resources so that the organization can meet its objectives. The focus of HR planning is to ensure the organization has the right number of human resources, with the right capabilities, at the right times, and in the right places. In HR planning, an organization must consider the availability and allocation of people to jobs over long periods of time, not just for the next month or even the next year.4 Additionally, as part of the analyses, HR plans can include several approaches. Actions may include shifting employees to other jobs in the organization, laying off employees or otherwise cutting back the number of employees, retraining present employees, and/or increasing the number of employees in certain areas. Factors to consider include the current employees’ knowledge, skills, and abilities and the expected vacancies resulting from retirements, promotions, transfers, and discharges. To do this, HR planning requires efforts by HR professionals working with executives and managers. The HR Best Practices box illustrates how several firms have made HR planning important. Organizational Size and HR Planning Human resource planning Process of analyzing and identifying the need for and availability of human resources so that the organization can meet its objectives. The need for HR planning in larger organizations is especially important. For example, in a review, the U.S. government’s Corps of Engineers, with a workforce of 35,000, was found to have an outdated strategic HR plan. Also, it had not done an organization-wide needs analysis for current and future workforce. If adjustments to foreseeable changes were not made, people or even entire divisions could be working at cross-purposes with the rest of the organization.5 An illustration of an effective HR planning emphasis can be seen in Walgreens, the large retail drugstore chain. This firm has had an aggressive business plan. Since each Walgreens store must be staffed with pharmacists, managers, and customer service employees, the firm’s HR planning has involved identifying how and where to find enough pharmacists to fill openings caused by turnover and retirement, as well as how to staff new stores. Walgreens illustrates that part of HR planning is identifying the knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs), as well as experience and other capabilities, for current and future jobs. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 146 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 147 Human Resource Planning and Retention HR best practices Effective HR Planning for the Workforce Future Important HR functions in many organizations revolve around staffing: recruiting, employing, and retaining employees. More than half of the HR professionals in a Society for Human Resource Management (SHRM) survey identified efforts in those areas as the most important HR activities in their firms. Forecasting the need for employees and identifying how to retain them are components of these functions. Several examples illustrate their importance. At Valero Energy, employee turnover was projected to increase significantly over a 5-year period. This forecast triggered an increase in HR planning. Within 2 years, Valero had established the means, linked to its strategic HR planning, to build its workforce for an additional 3 years. Another firm that has used HR planning effectively is Corning, Inc., a worldwide technology firm with more than 25,000 employees. This firm used HR planning globally to identify that hiring more engineers in Taiwan instead of the United States would be better and less expensive, given the pay levels and the supply of potential U.S. engineering employees. In a different industry, Chicago-based CNA Financial identified that it would have an insufficient number of underwriters in 2 years at its current turnover rate, and that more than 80% of its safety engineers were eligible to retire. To address these concerns, extensive planning was undertaken for reducing turnover in both occupations and identifying sources for possible recruits. As a result, the turnover rates at CNA in both groups dropped significantly, and relevant training and development efforts were expanded. These examples reinforce how HR planning can help meet future workforce supply and demand in terms of employees. Also, increasing employee retention by reducing turnover can aid in enhancing organizational performance and effective HR management.6 Small Business HR Planning In a smaller business, even though the owner/ manager knows on a daily basis what is happening and what should be done, planning is still important. One difficult area for HR planning in small businesses is family matters and succession. Particular difficulties arise when a growing business is passed from one generation to another, resulting in a mix of family and nonfamily employees. Key to successful transition in a small business is having a clear HR plan. In small businesses, such a plan includes incorporating key nonfamily members in HR planning efforts because nonfamily members may have important capabilities and expertise that family members do not possess. Planning for the attraction and retention of these LOGGING ON “outsiders” may be vital to the future success of smaller Human Resource Planning H anning organizations. Society S Small businesses may use the HR planning process, IInformation and resources es on building which is discussed next. But in very small organizations, too a strategic HR plan are available at often the process is much more intuitive and is done entirely www.hrps.org. by the top executives, who often are family members, which may eliminate nonfamily members from the process. HR Planning Process The steps in the HR planning process are shown in Figure 5-1. Notice that the process begins with considering the organizational strategic planning objectives. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 147 17/07/10 5:48 PM 148 SECTION 2 FIGURE 5-1 Jobs and labor HR Planning Process Review Organizational HR Strategic Plans Assess External and Internal Workforce External conditions and influences Internal workforce capabilities and KSAs Compile HR Planning Forecasts Demands for human resources Supply of human resources Develop HR Staffing Plans and Actions Employee retention and turnover utilization Recruiting sources and means Selection process and actions Then the possible available workforce must be evaluated by identifying both the external and internal workforce. Once those assessments are complete, forecasts must be developed to identify both the demand for and supply of human resources. Management then formulates HR staffing plans and actions to address imbalances, both shortterm and long-term. One means of developing and measuring HR planning is use of a team of subject matter experts (SMEs) to increase the validity and reliability of the HR planning results.7 Specific strategies may be developed to fill vacancies or deal with surplus employees. For example, a strategy might be to fill 50% of expected vacancies by training employees in lower-level jobs and promoting them into more advanced anticipated openings. Finally, HR plans are developed to provide specific direction for the management of HR activities related to employee recruiting, selection, and retention. The most telling evidence of successful HR planning is a consistent alignment of the availabilities and capabilities of human resources with the needs of the organization over shorter or longer periods of time. ASSESSING THE EXTERNAL WORKFORCE The first stage of HR planning is to examine organization objectives and plans. If a network technology firm plans to double its number of client accounts from 100 to 200 in a 3-year period, that firm also must identify how many and what types of new employees will be needed to staff the expanded services, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 148 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention 149 locations, and facilities. Several common external factors to be considered are highlighted next. Economic and Governmental Factors The general cycles of economic recession and economic boom in different businesses affect HR planning. Factors such as interest rates, inflation, and economic decline or growth affect the availability of workers and should figure into organizational and HR plans and objectives. There is a considerable difference between finding qualified applicants in a 4% unemployment market and in a 9% unemployment market. As the unemployment rate rises, the number of qualified people looking for work increases, often making it easier to fill some jobs. But those hired may receive lower pay and benefits than in their previous jobs. A broad array of government regulations affects the labor supply and therefore HR planning. As a result, HR planning must be done by individuals who understand the legal requirements of various government regulations. In the United States and other countries, tax legislation at local, state, and federal levels affects HR planning. Pension provisions and Social Security legislation may change retirement patterns and funding options. Elimination or expansion of tax benefits for job-training expenses might alter some job-training activities associated with workforce expansions. In summary, an organization must consider a wide variety of government policies, regulations, and laws during the HR planning process. Competitive Evaluations When making HR plans, employers must consider a number of geographic and competitive concerns. The net migration into a particular region is important. For example, in the past decade, the populations of some U.S. cities in the South, Southwest, and West have grown rapidly and have provided sources of labor. However, areas in the Northeast and Midwest have experienced declining populations. Direct competitors are another important external force in HR planning. Failure to consider the competitive labor market and to offer pay scales and benefits competitive with those of organizations in the same general industry and geographic location may cost a company dearly in the long run. Finally, the impact of international competition must be considered as part of environmental scanning. Global competition for labor intensifies as global competitors shift jobs and workers around the world, as illustrated by the outsourcing of jobs from the United States to countries with cheaper labor. Changing Workforce Considerations As mentioned in the previous chapter, significant changes in the workforce, both in the United States and globally, must be considered when doing external assessments for HR planning. Shifts in the composition of the workforce, combined with the use of different work patterns, have created workplaces and organizations that are notably different from those of a decade ago. Many organizations face major concerns about having sufficient workers with the necessary capabilities. When scanning the potential and future workforce, it is important to consider a number of variables, including: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 149 17/07/10 5:48 PM 150 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor • • • • • Aging of the workforce Growing diversity of workers Female workers and work-life balancing concerns Availability of contingent workers Outsourcing possibilities LOGGING ON T Sloan Center on The n Aging and Work a FFor research and resources ces on managing the talents of the various generations in the workforce, orce, visit this site at www.bc.edu/research/agingandwork. When considering these factors, it is important to analyze how they affect the current and future availability of workers with specific capabilities and experience. For instance, in a number of industries, the median age of highly specialized professionals is over 50 years, and the supply of potential replacements with adequate education and experiences is not sufficient to replace such employees as they retire. One global study found that less than 15% of surveyed firms have planned for workforce shortages due to the “brain drain” created by the retirement of existing older workers.8 ASSESSING THE INTERNAL WORKFORCE Analyzing the jobs that will need to be done and the capabilities of people who are currently available in the organization to do them is the next part of HR planning. The needs of the organization must be compared against the labor supply available both inside and outside the organization. Current and Future Jobs Audit The starting point for evaluating internal workforce strengths and weaknesses is an audit of the jobs being done in the organization. A comprehensive analysis of all current jobs provides a basis for forecasting what jobs will need to be done in the future. Much of the data in the audit should be available from existing staffing and organizational databases. The following questions may be some key ones addressed during the internal assessment: • • • • • • What jobs exist now and how essential is each job? How many individuals are performing each job? What are the reporting relationships of jobs? What are the vital KSAs needed in the jobs? What jobs will be needed to implement future organizational strategies? What are the characteristics of those anticipated jobs? Employee and Organizational Capabilities Inventory As HR planners gain an understanding of the current and future jobs that will be necessary to carry out organizational plans, they can conduct a detailed audit of current employees and their capabilities. The basic source of data on employees is available in the HR records in the organization. The HR Online illustrates the growth of technology in obtaining such data. An inventory of organizational skills and capabilities may consider a number of elements. The following ones are important: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 150 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 151 Human Resource Planning and Retention Technology Expanding Employee Skills Databases Both employers and employees are using the expansion of technology as part of workforce-related factors. Technological systems and software related to HR planning and talent management are growing about 15% a year. Some examples of the uses of such technology follow. For employees, dramatic growth in information technology (IT) methods is occurring. Aon Corporation surveyed 800 employees using Web 2.0 social media. The study found that more than two-thirds of both younger and older workers were using technology for job-related purposes. Aon recommended that employees use technology means such as textmessaging, blogs, wikis, and twitters to identify and enhance their skills and productivity. Skills databases are an increasingly popular tool being used to track employee talent. The concept is simple: Put employees’ skills and technical expertise, prior jobs, training, coaching aptitude, certifications, geographical experience, languages, career aspirations, and other topics in a database, and then use analyses of • • • HR online this information as part of HR forecasting for individual capabilities. These databases also can be evaluated to fill jobs or can be analyzed to identify strengths and weaknesses of a division or even the whole company. Some systems rely on managers to enter and update employee information in the database, but managers sometimes fail to do so or withhold information, fearing they might lose their most skilled employees to someone else in the company. Other approaches request employees to enter their skills and proficiency levels, and then managers review the reports. However, employees, because of either personal confidentiality concerns or being overworked, may not always enter their skills data accurately. In spite of such difficulties, obtaining and utilizing IT data on employees’ skills can aid both managers and employees in HR planning and forecasting. Then using those HR plans and forecasts may enhance the identification, engagement, and retention of both existing workers and potential employees.9 Individual employee demographics (age, length of service in the organization, time in present job) Individual career progression (jobs held, time in each job, education and training levels, promotions or other job changes, pay rates) Individual performance data (work accomplishment, growth in skills, working relationships) All the details on an individual employee’s skills that go into a databank may affect that person’s career. Therefore, the data and their use must meet the same standards of job-relatedness and nondiscrimination as those met when the employee was initially hired. Furthermore, security measures must ensure that sensitive information is available only to those who have a specific use for it. Managers and HR staff members can gather data on individual employees and aggregate details into a profile of the current organizational workforce. This profile may reveal many of the current strengths and deficiencies of people in the organization. For instance, a skills mismatch may be identified in which some workers are either overqualified or underqualified for their jobs.10 The profile also may highlight potential future problems. For example, if some specialized expertise, such as advanced technical skills, is absent in many workers, the organization may find it difficult to take advantage of its changing technological developments; or if a large group of experienced employees are all in the same age bracket, their eventual retirements about the same time might lead to future “gaps” in the organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 151 17/07/10 5:48 PM 152 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor FORECASTING HR SUPPLY AND DEMAND The information gathered from scanning the external environment and assessing internal strengths and weaknesses is used to predict HR supply and demand in light of organizational objectives and strategies. Forecasting uses information from the past and the present to identify expected future conditions. Projections for the future are, of course, subject to error. Fortunately, experienced people usually are able to forecast with enough accuracy to positively affect long-range organizational planning. Forecasting Using information from the past and the present to identify expected future conditions. Forecasting Methods and Periods Forecasting methods may be either judgmental or mathematical, as Figure 5-2 shows. Methods for forecasting human resources range from a manager’s best FIGURE 5-2 HR Forecasting Example Methods Judgmental Methods Estimates can be either top-down or bottom-up, but essentially people who are in a position to know are asked, “How many people will you need next year?” The rule of thumb method relies on general guidelines applied to a specific situation within the organization. For example, a guideline of “one operations manager per five reporting supervisors” aids in forecasting the number of supervisors needed in a division. However, it is important to adapt the guideline to recognize widely varying departmental needs. The Delphi technique uses input from a group of experts whose opinions of forecasted situations are sought. These expert opinions are then combined and returned to the experts for a second anonymous opinion. The process continues through several rounds until the experts essentially agree on a judgment. For example, this approach is used to forecast effects of technology on HR management and staffing needs. Nominal groups, unlike the Delphi method, require experts to meet face to face. Their ideas may be cited independently at first, discussed as a group, and then compiled as a report. Mathematical Methods Statistical regression analysis makes a statistical comparison of past relationships among various factors. For example, a statistical relationship between gross sales and number of employees in a retail chain may be useful in forecasting the number of employees that will be needed if the retailer’s sales increase 15% or decrease 10%. Simulation models are representations of real situations in abstract form. For example, an econometric model of the growth in software usage would lead to forecasts of the need for software developers. Numerous simulation methods and techniques are available. Productivity ratios calculate the average number of units produced per employee. These averages can be applied to sales forecasts to determine the number of employees needed. For example, a firm could forecast the number of needed sales representatives using these ratios. Staffing ratios can be used to estimate indirect labor. For example, if the company usually uses one clerical person for every 25 production employees, that ratio can be used to estimate the need for clerical employees. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 152 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention 153 guess to a rigorous and complex computer simulation. Despite the availability of sophisticated judgmental and mathematical models and techniques, forecasting is still a combination of quantitative methods and subjective judgment. The facts must be evaluated and weighed by knowledgeable individuals, such as managers or HR planners, who use the mathematical models as tools and make judgments to arrive at decisions. HR forecasting should be done over three planning periods: short range, intermediate range, and long range. The most commonly used planning period of six months to one year focuses on short-range forecasts for the immediate HR needs of an organization. Intermediate- and long-range forecasting are much more difficult processes. Intermediate-range plans usually project one to three years into the future, and long-range plans extend beyond three years. Forecasting the Demand for Human Resources The demand for employees can be calculated for an entire organization and/ or for individual units in the organization. For example, a forecast might indicate that a firm needs 125 new employees next year, or that it needs 25 new people in sales and customer service, 45 in production, 20 in accounting and information systems, 2 in HR, and 33 in the warehouse. The unit breakdown obviously allows HR planners to better pinpoint the specific skills needed than does the aggregate method. Demand for human resources can be forecast by considering specific openings that are likely to occur. The openings (or demands) are created when new jobs are being created or current jobs are being reduced. Additionally, forecasts must consider when employees leave positions because of promotions, transfers, turnovers, and terminations. An analysis is used to develop decision rules (or “fill rates”) for each job or level. For example, a decision rule for a financial institution might state that 50% of branch supervisor openings will be filled through promotions from customer service tellers, 25% through promotions from personal bankers, and 25% from new hires. Forecasters must be aware of multiple effects throughout the organization, because as people are promoted from within, their previous positions become available. Continuing the example, forecasts for the need for customer service tellers and personal bankers would also have to be developed. The overall purpose of the forecast is to identify the needs for human resources by number and type for the forecasting period. Forecasting the Supply of Human Resources Once human resources needs have been forecast, then availability of qualified individuals must be identified. Forecasting availability considers both external and internal supplies. Although the internal supply may be somewhat easier to calculate, it is important to calculate the external supply as accurately as possible. External Supply The external supply of potential employees available to the organization needs to be identified. Extensive use of government estimates of labor force populations, trends in the industry, and many more complex and interrelated factors must be considered. Such information is Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 153 17/07/10 5:48 PM 154 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor often available from state or regional economic development offices, including these items: • • • • • • • • • Net migration into and out of the area Individuals entering and leaving the workforce Individuals graduating from schools and colleges Changing workforce composition and patterns Economic forecasts for the next few years Technological developments and shifts Actions of competing employers Government regulations and pressures Circumstances affecting persons entering and leaving the workforce Internal Supply Figure 5-3 shows in general terms how the internal supply can be calculated for a specific employer. Estimating internal supply considers the number of external hires and the employees who move from their current jobs into others through promotions, lateral moves, and terminations. It also considers that the internal supply is influenced by training and development programs, transfer and promotion policies, and retirement policies, among other factors. In forecasting the internal supply, data from the replacement charts and succession planning efforts are used to project potential personnel changes, identify possible backup candidates, and keep track of attrition (resignations, retirements, etc.) for each department in an organization. FIGURE 5-3 Estimating Internal Labor Supply for a Given Unit Current Staffing Level ⫺ Projected Outflows This Year Source of Inflows ⫹ Projected Inflows This Year ⫽ Internal Supply for Next Year Source of Outflows The Unit External hires Internal transfers Promotions Recalls Employees In Promotions Turnover Terminations Demotions Retirements Deaths Layoffs Current Staffing Level Employees Out Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 154 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention 155 INDIVIDUAL WORKERS AND ORGANIZATIONAL RELATIONSHIPS Relationships between individuals and their employers can vary widely from favorable to unfavorable. The individual’s performance is a major part of why the employer wants the individual to stay or go. Competent employees who are satisfied with their employers, who know what is expected, and who have reduced turnover potential are assets to the organization. But just as individuals in an organization can be a competitive advantage, they can also be a liability. When few employees are satisfied with their jobs, when people are constantly leaving, and when the employees who do remain work ineffectively, the organization faces a competitive disadvantage. Understanding the relationships between individuals and organizations is more than just academically interesting. The economic health of most organizations depends on the efforts of employes with the ability and motivation to do their jobs well. The exchanges in the relationship between an employee and an employer affect both of them.11 Two considerations in these relationships include the psychological contract and motivation, which can help with understanding employee retention. Psychological Contract A concept that has been useful in discussing individuals’ relationships with their employers is that of a psychological contract, which refers to the unwritten expectations employees and employers have about the nature of their work relationships. The psychological contract can create either a positive or negative relationship between an employer and an individual. It is based on trust and commitment that leads to meeting both the employer’s and employee’s expectations and needs.12 Unwritten psychological contracts between employers and employees encompass expectations about both tangible items (e.g., wages, benefits, employee productivity, and attendance) and intangible items (e.g., loyalty, fair treatment, and job security). Employers may attempt to detail their expectations through handbooks and policy manuals, but those materials are only part of the total “contractual” relationship. Psychological contract The unwritten expectations employees and employers have about the nature of their work relationships. The Changing Psychological Contract Traditionally, employees expected to exchange their efforts and capabilities for secure jobs that offered competitive pay, a solid range of benefits, and career progression within an organization, among other factors. But as some organizations have changed in economic terms, they have had to address various organizational crises by downsizing and eliminating workers who had given long and loyal service. Consequently, in these firms, a growing number of remaining employees are questioning whether they should remain loyal to and stay with their employers. When individuals feel that they have some control and perceived rights in the organization, they are more likely to be committed to the organization and utilize their knowledge, skills, and abilities to accomplish performance results.13 A psychological contract recognizes the following components: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 155 17/07/10 5:48 PM 156 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor Employers Provide Employees Contribute • Competitive compensation • Continuous skill improvement and benefits and increased productivity • Flexibility to balance work • Reasonable time with the and home life organization • Career development • Extra efforts and results when opportunities needed Psychological contracts can be strengthened and employee commitment enhanced when the organization is involved in a cause the employee values highly. Conversely, psychological contracts can be violated, not only in reaction to personal mistreatment, but from a perception that the organization has abandoned an important principle or cause. For instance, when unethical or illegal behavior of upper management occurs, the psychological contract is violated. Thus, employees may feel anger, distrust, reduced loyalty and commitment, and increased willingness to leave. Also, social exchange relationships in organizations can be affected by psychological contract breaches and violations.14 G L O B A L Global Psychological Contract Concerns With many organizations having global operations, the psychological contract becomes more complicated. Employees in foreign countries and expatriate employees from the United States have varying psychological contract expectations. For expatriates, if the organizational expectations are not made clear prior to their relocation, more of them will be likely to quit within the first year or demand return to their home country.15 An additional concern for multinational firms is to meet the psychological contract expectations of individuals in different cultures and countries. Consider the number of jobs that have been shifted from the United States and Europe to China, India, Romania, Mexico, the Philippines, Brazil, and other countries with different global factors. Being aware of varying psychological contract issues with foreign employees is important if global HR efforts are to be successful. Individual Employee Performance and Motivation The idea of a psychological contract between the individual employee and the organization helps clarify why people might stay or leave a job. But for an employer to want to keep an employee, that person must be performing well. The HR unit in an organization exists in part to provide ways to analyze and address the performance and motivation of individual employees. Individual Performance Factors The three major factors that affect how a given individual performs are illustrated in Figure 5-4. They are: (1) individual ability to do the work, (2) effort expended, and (3) organizational support. The relationship of those factors is widely acknowledged in management literature as follows: Performance (P) = Ability (A) × Effort (E) × Support (S) Individual performance is enhanced to the degree that all three components are present with an individual employee, and diminished if any of these factors is reduced or absent. For instance, if several production workers have the abilities to do their jobs and work hard, but the organization provides outmoded equipment Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 156 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 157 Human Resource Planning and Retention FIGURE 5-4 Components of Individual Performance Effort Expended Motivation Work ethic Attendance/turnover Job design Individual Performance (including quantity and quality) Individual Ability Talents Interests Personality characteristics Organizational Support Training and development Equipment and technology Performance standards Management and coworkers or the management style of supervisors causes negative reactions by the workers, the lack of organizational support may reduce individual performance. An example of how this performance equation can work in a positive way is seen in the link between individual motivation and organizational support in the form of coworkers. Studies have shown that the motivation of poor-performing employees can be improved when these employees work more intensely with a group of better-performing workers. The link between individual motivation and organizational support has important HR management implications.16 Motivation The desire within a person causing that person to act. Individual Motivation and Management Implications The desire within a person causing that person to act is called motivation. People usually act to reach a goal, which means that motivation is a goal-directed drive that seldom occurs in a void. The words need, want, desire, and drive are all similar to motive, from which the word motivation is derived. Approaches to understanding motivation vary because different theorists have developed their own views and models.17 Each approach has contributed to the understanding of human motivation, and details on different approaches can be found in various organizational behavior textbooks. Motivation is complex and individualized, and managerial strategies and tactics must be broad-based to address the motivation concerns of individuals at work. Factors that can inhibit motivation and work performance include a worker’s capacities and determination to get work done regardless of difficulties.18 For instance, with a poor-performing employee, managers must determine whether inadequate individual behavior is due to employee deficiencies, inconsistent reward policies, or low desire for the rewards offered. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 157 17/07/10 5:48 PM 158 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor By having supportive supervisors and managers who serve as mentors, concerns about motivations can be better addressed with employees.19 Understanding motivation is important because employee engagement can affect both performance and retention. Fostering motivation can improve performance and can reduce turnover. Many organizations spend a considerable amount of money to “motivate” their employees, using a wide range of tactics. For example, some firms hire motivational speakers to inspire employees, and “motivational coaches” command fees of up to $50,000 a speech. Other employers give employees items such as T-shirts, mugs, or books as motivators. However, such efforts may or may not be effective in improving employees’ job satisfaction and loyalty. Many employees rely on the unspoken psychological contract, and their hope that the employer will honor this “agreement” affects their job satisfaction and motivation. One survey found that 45% of the surveyed workers indicated that personal job satisfaction was their main motivation for job performance.20 Nature of Job Satisfaction Job satisfaction A positive emotional state resulting from evaluating one’s job experiences. Attitude survey A survey that focuses on employees’ feelings and beliefs about their jobs and the organization. Organizational commitment The degree to which employees believe in and accept organizational goals and desire to remain with the organization. In its most basic sense, job satisfaction is a positive emotional state resulting from evaluating one’s job experiences. Job dissatisfaction occurs when one’s expectations are not met. For example, if an employee expects clean and safe working conditions, that employee is likely to be dissatisfied if the workplace is dirty and dangerous. Dimensions of job satisfaction frequently mentioned include worker relationships, pay and benefits, performance recognition, and communications with managers and executives. Sometimes job satisfaction is called morale, which appears to have declined somewhat in recent years in some firms due to economic factors and changes in the elements of the employee-employer relationship. Frequently cited reasons for decline in morale include more demanding and stressful work, fewer relationships with management, and less confidence in compensation and other rewards.21 Depending on the job, the work-life balancing mentioned earlier also can lead to either positive or negative effects in workers’ job satisfaction.22 One way employers address job satisfaction, and ultimately retention, is by regularly surveying employees. One specific type of survey used by many organizations is an attitude survey, which focuses on employees’ feelings and beliefs about their jobs and the organization. Once the survey results are compiled, management responds to the results. If the employer takes responsive actions, employees may view the employer more positively; however, if management ignores the survey results, their inaction can lead to less employee job satisfaction.23 Organizational Commitment and Job Satisfaction The degree to which employees believe in and accept organizational goals and want to remain with the organization is called organizational commitment. Job satisfaction influences organizational commitment, which in turn affects employee retention and turnover. As Figure 5-5 depicts, the interaction of the individual and the job determines levels of job satisfaction and organizational commitment. Engagement and Loyalty A related idea is employee engagement, which is the extent to which an employee feels linked to organizational success. Surveys have shown that levels of employee engagement range from 15% to 45% for highly engaged workers, and 5% to 20% for disengaged ones.24 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 158 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 159 Human Resource Planning and Retention FIGURE 5-5 Factors Affecting Job Satisfaction and Organizational Commitment Ability The Individual Motivation Support The Job Design Job elements Job Satisfaction/ Dissatisfaction Organizational Commitment Retention/ Turnover Engaged employees may be seen as “loyal” employees who are more than just satisfied with their jobs; they are pleased with the relationships with their employers. In changing labor markets, employers find that turnover of key people occurs more frequently when employee loyalty is low. For example, the Federal Office of Personnel Management has used engagement efforts with retirement-eligible employees to defer their departures, which reduces turnover.25 Excessive turnover makes clear the importance of having an engaged and committed workforce. A logical extension of organizational engagement focuses more specifically on continuance commitment factors. These are the factors that influence decisions to remain with or leave an organization, and ultimately they are reflected in employee retention and turnover statistics. The relationships among satisfaction, commitment, and turnover have been affirmed across cultures, full- and part-time workers, genders, and LOGGING ON occupations. Organizational engagement and commitment can be seen as essential in retaining employees in organizaLoyalty Research Center L nter tions. Individuals who are not as satisfied with their jobs TThis research center provides ovides employee or who are not as committed to the organization are more lloyalty/employee engagement ement research likely to withdraw from the organization. Understanding and consulting services. Visit their site at www.loyaltyresearch.com. h.com. engagement and commitment in relation to turnover is one facet of retention efforts for managers. EMPLOYEE TURNOVER Turnover The process in which employees leave an organization and have to be replaced. Turnover occurs when employees leave an organization and have to be replaced. Many organizations have found that turnover is a costly problem. For instance, health care firms experienced over 30% turnover annually in one state. Just in registered nurse jobs, the turnover cost in the state was more than $125 million per year, with individual nurse turnover costs being $32,000 per person.26 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 159 17/07/10 5:48 PM 160 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor The extent to which employers face high turnover rates and costs varies by organization and industry. For higher-level executives and professionals, turnover costs can run as much as two times the departing employees’ annual salaries, and rates often are linked to executive job expectations and needed skills changes.27 In many service industries, the turnover rates and costs are frequently very high. In the retail industry, turnover in some companies averages more than 100% a year for part-time workers and around 75% a year for full-time workers. The U.S. supermarkets, fast-food restaurants, and other retail service industry firms spend billions of dollars each year to deal with worker turnover. Types of Employee Turnover Turnover is classified in a number of ways. One classification uses the following categories, although the two types are not mutually exclusive: • Involuntary Turnover • Voluntary Turnover Employees are terminated for poor performance or work rule violations Employees leave by choice Involuntary turnover is triggered at all levels by employers terminating workers due to organizational policies and work rule violations, excessive absenteeism, performance standards that are not met by employees, and other issues. Voluntary turnover too can be caused by many factors, some of which are not employer controlled. Common voluntary turnover causes include job dissatisfaction, pay and benefits levels, supervision, geography, and personal/family reasons. Career opportunities in other firms, when employees receive unsolicited contacts, may lead to turnover for individuals, especially those in highly specialized jobs such as IT.28 Voluntary turnover may increase with the size of the organization, most likely because larger firms are less effective in preventing turnover and have more employees who are inclined to move. Another view of turnover classifies it based on whether it is good or bad for the organization: • Functional Turnover • Dysfunctional Turnover Lower-performing or disruptive Key individuals and high performers employees leave leave at critical times Not all turnover is negative for organizations; on the contrary, functional turnover represents a positive change. Some workforce losses are desirable, especially if those who leave are lower-performing, less reliable, and/or disruptive individuals.29 Of course, dysfunctional turnover also occurs. That happens when key individuals leave, often at crucial times. For example, a software project leader who leaves in the middle of a system upgrade in order to take a promotion at another firm could cause the system upgrade timeline to slip due to the difficulty of replacing the employee and could also lead other software specialists in the firm to seek out and accept jobs at competitive firms. Employees quit for many reasons, only some of which can be controlled by the organization, so another classification uses the following terms to describe types of turnover: • Uncontrollable Turnover Employees leave for reasons outside the control of the employer • Controllable Turnover Employees leave for reasons that could be influenced by the employer Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 160 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 161 Human Resource Planning and Retention Some examples of reasons for turnover the employer cannot control include: (1) the employee moves out of the geographic area, (2) the employee decides to stay home with young children or an elder relative, (3) the employee’s spouse is transferred, and (4) the employee is a student worker who graduates from college. Even though some turnover is inevitable, employers recognize that reducing turnover saves money, and that they must address the turnover that is controllable. Organizations are better able to keep employees if they deal with the concerns of those employees that might lead to the controllable turnover. Turnover and “Churn” Hiring new workers while laying off others is called churn. This practice raises a paradox in which employers complain about not being able to find skilled workers while they are laying off others. As organizations face economic and financial problems that result in layoffs, the remaining employees are more likely to consider jobs at other firms.30 In this situation, turnover is more likely to occur, and efforts are needed to keep existing employees. HR actions such as information sharing, opportunities for more training/learning, and emphasis on job significance can be helpful in lowering turnover intentions of individuals.31 Measuring Employee Turnover The U.S. Department of Labor estimates that the cost of replacing an employee ranges from one-half to five times the person’s annual salary.32 The turnover rate for an organization can be computed as a monthly or yearly cost. The following formula, in which separations means departures from the organization, is widely used: Number of employee separations during the year Total number of employees at midyear × 100 Common turnover rates range from almost 0% to more than 100% a year and vary among industries. As a part of HR management systems, turnover data can be gathered and analyzed in a number of different ways, including the following categories: • • • • Churn Hiring new workers while laying off others. Job and job level Department, unit, and location Reason for leaving Length of service • • • • Demographic characteristics Education and training Knowledge, skills, and abilities Performance ratings/levels Two examples illustrate why detailed analyses of turnover are important. A manufacturing organization had a companywide turnover rate that was not severe, but 80% of the turnover occurred within one department. That imbalance indicated that some specific actions on training supervisors and revising pay levels were needed to resolve problems in that unit. In a different organization, a global shipping/delivery firm found ways to reduce turnover of sales and service employees. The actions of that firm reduced its turnover 29%, which contributed to an annual savings of more than $18 million in direct and indirect costs.33 In both of these examples, the targeted turnover rates declined as a result of employer actions taken in response to the turnover analyses that were done. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 161 17/07/10 5:48 PM 162 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor Model for Costing Lost Productivity FIGURE 5-6 Job Title: ______________________ A. B. C. D. Typical annual pay for this job Percentage of pay for benefits multiplied by annual pay Total employee annual cost (add A ⴙ B) Number of employees who voluntarily quit the job in the past 12 months E. Number of months it takes for 1 employee to become fully productive F. Per person turnover cost (multiply [E ⴜ 12] ⴛ C ⴛ 50%*) G. Annual turnover cost for this job (multiply F ⴛ D) __________ __________ __________ __________ __________ __________ __________ *Assumes 50% productivity throughout the learning period (E). HR Metrics: Determining Turnover Costs M E A S U R E A major step in reducing the expense of turnover is to decide how the organization is going to record employee departures and what calculations are necessary to maintain and benchmark the turnover rates. Determining turnover costs can be relatively simple or very complex, depending on the nature of the efforts made and the data used. Figure 5-6 shows a model for calculating the cost of productivity lost to turnover. If a job pays (A) $20,000 and benefits cost (B) 40%, then the total annual cost for one employee (C) is $28,000. Assuming that 20 employees have quit in the previous year (D) and that it takes three months for 1 employee to be fully productive (E), the calculation results in a per person turnover cost (F) of $3,500. Overall, the annual lost productivity (G) would be $70,000 for the 20 individuals who have left. In spite of the conservative and simple nature of this model, it easily makes the point that turnover is costly. As another example, if 150 tellers in a large bank corporation leave in a year, calculations done according to this model produce turnover costs of more than $500,000 a year. Detailing Turnover Costing Other areas to be included in calculating detailed turnover costs are also available.34 Some of the most common areas considered include the following: • • • Separation costs: HR staff and supervisory time, pay rates to prevent separations, exit interview time, unemployment expenses, legal fees for separations challenged, accrued vacation expenditures, continued health benefits, and others Vacancy costs: Temporary help, contract and consulting firm usage, existing employee overtime, and other costs until the person is replaced Replacement costs: Recruiting and advertising expenses, search fees, HR interviewer and staff time and salaries, employee referral fees, relocation and moving costs, supervisor and managerial time and salaries, employment testing costs, reference checking fees, preemployment medical expenses, relocation costs, and others Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 162 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention • • 163 Training costs: Paid orientation time, training staff time and pay, costs of training materials, supervisor and manager time and salaries, coworker “coaching” time and pay, and others Hidden/indirect costs: Costs that are not obvious, such as reduced productivity, decreased customer service, additional unexpected employee turnover, missed project deadlines, and others These turnover metrics illustrate that turnover is a crucial HR and managerial issue that must be constantly evaluated and addressed. Not all turnover is negative. Turnover of low performers should be considered positive. There may be an “optiLOGGING ON mal” amount of useful turnover in order to replace low TalentKeepers T performers and add part-time or contract workers with FFor Web-based employee e special capabilities to enhance workforce performance.35 rretention solutions, visit HR professionals should take actions to reduce negative www.talentkeepers.com. m. turnover and to address the retention of key employees. RETENTION OF HUMAN RESOURCES Retention of employees as human resources is part of HR staffing and planning efforts. Turnover, as the opposite of retention, often has been seen as a routine HR matter requiring records and reports. However, what was once a bothersome detail has become a substantial HR issue for many employers. Thus, organizations are being forced to study why employees leave and why they stay. Sometimes an individual in the HR area is assigned to specifically focus on retention to ensure that it receives high priority. Myths and Realities about Retention Keeping good employees is a challenge that all organizations share and that becomes even more difficult as labor markets change. Unfortunately, some myths have arisen about what it takes to retain employees. Some of the most prevalent myths and realities are as follows: 1. Money is the main reason people leave. Money certainly is a vital HR tool, and if people feel they are being paid inadequately, they may be more likely to leave. But if they are paid close to the competitive level they expect, other parts of the job become more important. 2. Hiring has little to do with retention. This is not true. Recruiting and selecting the people who fit the jobs and who are less likely to leave in the first place, and then orienting them to the company, can greatly increase retention. It is important to select for retention. 3. If you train people, you are only training them for another employer. Developing skills in employees may indeed make them more marketable, but it also tends to improve retention. When an employer provides employees with training and development assistance, job satisfaction may increase and employees are more likely to stay, particularly if they see more future opportunities internally. 4. Do not be concerned about retention during organizational change. That is exactly the time to worry about retention. Although some people’s jobs may have to be cut because of economic organizational Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 163 17/07/10 5:48 PM 164 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor factors, the remaining employees that the company would like to keep may have the most opportunity and reason to leave voluntarily. For example, during a merger or acquisition, most workers are concerned about job security and their employer’s future. If they do not feel a part of the new organization early on, many may leave or evaluate alternatives. 5. If solid performers want to leave, the company cannot hold them. Employees are best viewed as “free agents,” who indeed can leave when they want. The key to keeping solidly performing employees is to create an environment in which they want to stay and grow. Drivers of Retention Because both people and jobs are so varied, managers and HR professionals need to realize that individuals may remain or leave their employment for both job-related and personal reasons. For instance, if employees choose to leave an organization for family reasons (e.g., because a spouse is transferring or to raise children), there may be a limited number of actions the employer can take to keep them on the job. However, there are significant actions that an employer can take to retain employees in many other circumstances. Figure 5-7 illustrates some of these “drivers” of retention, or areas in which employers can take action to strengthen the possibility of keeping employees. The actual reasons that people stay or leave vary according to job groupings, industry and organizational issues, geographical global aspects, and other factors. For instance, a survey of executives by Robert Half International found that the most common factors that caused satisfactory employees to quit their jobs were unhappiness with management, limited career advancements and recognition, insufficient pay and benefits, and job boredom.36 This survey illustrates that many of the factors involved in retention drivers are organizational and management factors within the employer’s control. FIGURE 5-7 Drivers of Retention Organizational and Management Factors Employee-Supervisor Relationships Job and Work-Life Rewards: Compensation, Benefits, and Performance Retention Career Training and Development Employer Policies and Practices Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 164 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention 165 Organizational and Management Factors A number of organizational/ management factors influence individuals in their decisions to stay with or leave their employers. Organizations that have clearly established goals and hold managers and employees accountable for accomplishing results are viewed as better places to work, especially by individuals wishing to progress both financially and career-wise. Further, effective management provides the resources necessary for employees to perform their jobs well.37 These factors reflect workplace commitment by employees, which leads to more positive organizational views in the industry and communities. Other organizational components that affect employee retention are related to the management of the organization. Some organizations see external events as threatening, whereas others see changes as challenges requiring responses.38 The latter approach can be a source of competitive advantage, especially if an organization is in a growing, dynamic industry. Another organizational factor that can affect employee job performance and potential turnover intentions is “organizational politics.”39 This can include managerial favoritism, having to be involved in undesirable activities, taking credit for what others do, and other actions that occur in many departments and organizational settings. A final factor affecting how employees view their organizations is the quality of organizational leadership. Often, leaders have an identified strategic plan that guides how the firm responds to changes. If a firm is not effectively managed, then employees may be disappointed by the ineffective responses and inefficiencies they deal with in their jobs. A survey of 700 workers identified that “bad bosses” who do not give employees recognition for accomplishments or who fail to keep promises can lead to almost 40% of the workers being dissatisfied and more likely to look for other jobs.40 Work Relationships Work relationships that affect employee retention include supervisory/management support and coworker relations. A supervisor or manager builds positive relationships and aids retention by being fair and nondiscriminatory, allowing work flexibility and work-family balancing, giving feedback that recognizes employee efforts and performance, and supporting career planning and development. Additionally, many individuals build close relationships with coworkers. Such work-related friendships do not appear on employee records, but these relationships can be an important signal that a workplace is positive. Overall, what this means is that it is not just where people work, but also with whom they work, that affects employee retention. If individuals are not linked with or do not relate well to their coworkers, there is greater likelihood for turnover to occur.41 Job and Work-Life Many individuals have seen a decline in job security during the past decade. All the downsizings, layoffs, mergers and acquisitions, and organizational restructurings have affected employee loyalty and retention. As coworkers experience layoffs and job reductions, the anxiety levels of the remaining employees rise. Consequently, employees start thinking about leaving before they too get cut. Organizations in which job continuity and security are high tend to have higher retention rates. Some jobs are considered “good” and others are thought to be “bad,” but not all people agree on which jobs are which. As mentioned previously, the design of jobs and peoples’ preferences can vary significantly. Job design factors that can impact retention include the following: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 165 17/07/10 5:48 PM 166 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor HR perspective Global Retention The same core elements that affect retention in the United States are important across the globe according to a McKinsey Global Institute study. Higher turnover and lower retention rates can be seen among expatriate employees working outside their home countries. Also, repatriating those who have been overseas only to return to less-than-ideal situations later in the United States is another source of international retention difficulties.42 Retention can also be a challenge in countries where national workers staff the firms. India with its large global economic market illustrates what kinds of difficulties can occur. Estimates are that service industries in India will encounter a shortfall in one year of 500,000 employees who are qualified for jobs in those industries, which include financial services, information technology, and retail, among others. • • • • One would think that given the large Indian population, recruitment and retention would not be problems. But the need for individuals with special skills in cities such as Mumbai, Delhi, and others is creating major issues. Firms are giving 12% to 15% yearly pay increases to many key workers in order to retain them; in addition, they are using both yearly and longer-term incentives for more senior-level employees. The retention situation in India is expected to expand to other countries as global economic conditions improve and change, and the global market continues to grow. For instance, a survey of 32,000 employers in 26 countries indicated that almost onethird of them would have hired more professional staff members if they had been available. So, global attraction and retention are growing HR concerns.43 A knowledge, skills, and abilities mismatch, either through overqualification or underqualification, can lead to turnover. Job accomplishments and workload demands that are dissatisfying or stressful may impact performance and lead to turnover. Both timing of work schedules and geographic locations may contribute to burnout of some individuals but not others. The ability of employees to balance work and life requirements affects their job performance and retention. Numerous examples could be given on how each of these items affect retention, but one example comes from a survey of chief financial officers on the impact of these issues in their firms. In this survey, work-life flexibility efforts were seen as creating significant retention, recruitment, and productivity results.44 This study illustrates that how organizations address jobs can drive retention efforts, including global retention as discussed in the HR Perspective. Rewards: Compensation, Benefits, and Performance The tangible rewards that people receive for working come in the form of pay, incentives, and benefits. Employees often cite better pay or benefits as the reason for leaving one employer for another. Employers do best if they offer competitive pay and benefits, which means they must be close to what other employers are providing and what individuals believe to be consistent with their capabilities, experience, and performance. If compensation is not close, often defined as within 10% to 15% of the “market” rate, turnover is likely to be higher. However, the reality of compensation is a bit more complex than it seems at first glance. For instance, one study of public-sector employees identified Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 166 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 Human Resource Planning and Retention 167 that broad reward programs, not just pay and benefits, aided with workforce retention in difficult economic situations.45 A number of employers have used a wide range of special benefits and perks to attract and retain employees. For example, Student Media Group in Delaware added work-related plasma television screens, videogame players, and free soda and snacks as part of a special rewards package to create more positive views to aid in retaining employees.46 Another part of rewards generally is that individuals need to be satisfied with both the actual levels of pay and the processes used to determine pay. That is why the performance management systems and performance appraisal processes in organizations must be designed so they are linked to compensation increases. To strengthen links between organizational and individual performance, an increasing number of fast-growing private-sector firms are using variable pay and incentives programs.47 Some programs offer cash bonuses or lump-sum payments to reward extra performance, which also aids with retention efforts. Another rewards aspect that affects retention is employee recognition, which can be both tangible and intangible. Tangible recognition comes in many forms, such as “employee of the month” plaques and perfect-attendance certificates. Intangible and psychological recognition includes feedback from managers and supervisors that acknowledges extra effort and performance, even if monetary rewards are not given. For instance, one firm, Fairmont Hotels and Resorts, is using a “Serviceplus Colleague Recognition Program” to engage its 30,000 employees. Different types of recognitions include “Star of the Month” and “Memory Maker” for significant service. For such recognition, a small amount of money (under $50) and other types of rewards are given. An employee survey has shown significant increases in positive employee views of both their jobs and the Fairmont firm.48 Career Training and Development Many employees in all types of jobs consistently indicate that organizational efforts to aid their career training and development can significantly affect employee retention. Opportunities for personal growth lead the list of reasons why individuals took their current jobs and why they stay there. In one survey, nearly one-third of workers identified the lack of career advancement opportunities to be the most important reason for potentially changing employers.49 Training and development efforts can be designed to indicate that employers are committed to keeping employees’ knowledge, skills, and abilities current. Also, training and development can help underused employees attain new capabilities. Such a program at Southwest Airlines has been very successful. Recruiters were reassigned to different departments, which resulted in their generating sales and revenues in flight operations and other areas.50 Organizations address training and development in a number of ways. Tuition aid programs, typically offered as a benefit by many employers, allow employees to pursue additional educational and training opportunities. These programs often contribute to higher employee retention rates because the employees’ new knowledge and capabilities can aid the employer. Also, through formal career planning efforts, employees discuss with their managers career opportunities within the organization and career development activities that will help them to grow. Career development and planning efforts may include formal mentoring programs. For instance, information technology (IT) organizations are using career development programs so that IT individuals can expand their skills Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 167 17/07/10 5:48 PM 168 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor outside of technical areas. Programs in some firms cover communication and negotiation tactics, which gives the employees additional capabilities that are needed in managerial and other jobs.51 Companies can help reduce attrition by showing employees that they are serious about career advancement opportunities. Employer Policies and Practices A final set of factors found to affect retention is based on the employer relations policies that exist. Such areas as the reasonableness of HR policies, the fairness of disciplinary actions, and the means used to decide work assignments and opportunities all affect employee retention. If individuals feel that policies are unreasonably restrictive or are applied inconsistently, they may be more likely to look at jobs offered by other employers. The increasing demographic diversity of U.S. workplaces makes the nondiscriminatory treatment of employees LOGGING ON important, regardless of gender, age, and other characterisRetensa R tics. The organizational commitment and job satisfaction FFor resources and newsletters letters on of ethnically diverse individuals are affected by perceived current trends in employee c ee retention discriminatory treatment. A number of firms have recogstrategies, visit this site at nized that proactive management of diversity issues results www.retensa.com. in greater retention of individuals of all backgrounds. MANAGING RETENTION The foregoing sections summarized the results of many studies and popular HR practices to identify factors that can cause retention difficulties. Retention matters because turnover can cause poor performance in otherwise productive units. Now our focus turns toward the keys to managing retention as part of effective HR management. Retention Assessment and Metrics M E A S U R E To ensure that appropriate actions are taken to enhance retention, management decisions require data and analyses rather than subjective impressions, anecdotes of selected individual situations, or panic reactions to the loss of key people. Examples of data for analyzing retention are highlighted in Figure 5-8. Discussion on some of these sources follows. The analysis of turnover data is an attempt to get at the cause of retention problems. Analysis should recognize that turnover is a symptom of other factors that may be causing problems. When the causes are treated, the symptoms can go away. Some of the first areas to consider when analyzing data for retention include the work, pay/benefits, supervision, and management systems. Common methods of obtaining useful perspectives are employee surveys, exit interviews, and first-year turnover evaluations. Employee Surveys Employee surveys can be used to diagnose specific problem areas, identify employee needs or preferences, and reveal areas in which HR activities are well received or viewed negatively. Whether the surveys are on general employee attitudes, job satisfaction, or specific issues, the survey results must be examined as part of retention measurement efforts. For Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 168 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 169 Human Resource Planning and Retention FIGURE 5-8 Retention Measurement and Assessment Sources Occupational Types Department Specialties Demographics/Characteristics Experience Components Retention Returns on Investments Employee Replacement Costs Training/Development Analyses Possible HR Retention Metrics example, a growing number of “mini-surveys” on specific topics are being sent via e-mail questionnaires, blogs, and other means. Regardless of the topics in a survey, obtaining employee input provides managers and HR professionals with data on the “retention climate” in an organization. By obtaining data on how employees view their jobs, their coworkers, their supervisors, and organizational policies and practices, these surveys can be starting points for reducing turnover and increasing the length of time that employees are retained. Some employers conduct attitude surveys yearly while others do so intermittently. By asking employees to respond candidly to an attitude survey, management is building employees’ expectations that actions will be taken on the concerns identified. Therefore, a crucial part of conducting an attitude survey is providing feedback to those who participated in it. It is especially important that even negative survey results be communicated to avoid fostering the appearance of hiding the results or placing blame. Exit interview An interview in which individuals who are leaving an organization are asked to give their reasons. Exit Interviews One widely used means for assisting retention assessment efforts is the exit interview, in which individuals who are leaving the organization are asked to give their reasons. HR must regularly summarize and analyze the data by category (e.g., reasons for leaving, department, length of service, etc.) to provide managers and supervisors with information for improving company efforts. As described in the HR On-the-Job feature, the exit interview process should contain some important aspects. Many HR departments regularly contact former employees who were valuable contributors, as they may be willing to provide more information on questionnaires that are e-mailed to their homes or in telephone conversations conducted some time after they have left the organization.52 For instance, one health care firm contacts former employees within 60 days after they have left. Many times these follow-up conversations reveal the “real” reasons for departures, other than what was said in the exit interviews. This health care firm also has a program through which ex-employees are invited to return as “alumni” and have lunch with former coworkers, which has led to a number of departed individuals indicating they would like to return to the firm because the jobs they took elsewhere did not turn out to be as “promising” as they had anticipated. Thus, rehiring can be aided by ongoing efforts such as e-mails, exit interview follow-ups, and continuing contacts with good former employees. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 169 17/07/10 5:48 PM 170 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor HR on-the-job Conducting Exit Interviews Departing employees may be reluctant to divulge their real reasons for leaving. A skilled HR interviewer may be able to gain useful information that departing employees do not wish to share with managers and supervisors. The following suggestions may be useful when conducting exit interviews: • • • Decide who will conduct the exit interview and when the discussion will occur. Often these interviews occur on the last day or so of a departing individual’s employment. Emphasize that the information provided by the departing employee will be treated confidentially and used to make improvements. Utilize a checklist or a set of standard questions so that the information can be summarized. Typical areas covered include reasons for leaving, supervision, pay, training, liked and disliked aspects of the job, and details on the organization to which the employee is moving. When doing the actual exit interview, numerous questions can be asked. Ones typically asked of individuals include the following: • • • • Why are you leaving as an employee? What have you liked and disliked about your job and managers? What company actions have made you and other employees more or less positive? What would or would not lead you to recommend the employer to future possible hires? First-Year Turnover Evaluations A special type of retention assessment focuses on first-year employees. It is not unusual for turnover to be high among newer employees during their first year. Sometimes the cause of departure is voluntary; for example, individuals may identify a mismatch between what they expected in their jobs and managers and what actually occurs, or between their perceptions of the new job and its reality. Other times individuals are involuntarily removed in the first year. Some causes can be excessive absenteeism and poor performance, mismatches with job requirements, and conflicts with other employees and managers. If these situations occur too often, HR may need to reevaluate its recruiting and selection processes, as well as its job previews to make sure they are realistic.53 Overall, focus on first-year retention and turnover is useful because individuals who stay for a year are more likely to extend their employment and have greater retention beyond the first year. Also, effective first-year efforts may lead to future career development, higher performance, and other positive retention factors. Retention Evaluation and Follow-Up Management can take numerous actions to deal with retention issues. The choice of a particular action depends on the analysis of the turnover and retention problems in a particular organization and should be custom tailored for that organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 170 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 171 Human Resource Planning and Retention Tracking of intervention results and adjustment of intervention efforts should be part of retention evaluation and follow-up. Some firms use pilot programs to see how changes affect retention before extending them to the entire organization. For instance, to test the effect of flextime scheduling on employee turnover, a firm might try flexible scheduling in one department. If the turnover rate in that department drops in comparison to the turnover rates in other departments still working set schedules, the firm might extend the use of flexible scheduling to other departments. Retention evaluation and follow-up are key facets of the broader organizational HR planning and staffing. Effective retention management can have major impacts on the integrated HR attraction, recruiting, and selection processes. S U M M A R Y • • • • • • • • HR planning involves analyzing and identifying the need for and availability of human resources so that the organization can meet its objectives. When developing HR plans, it is important to examine potential HR availability, both external and internal. When assessing external labor supply sources, economic, governmental, competitive, and workforce composition changes should be analyzed. Assessing internal strengths and weaknesses as a part of HR planning requires auditing and inventorying current jobs and employee capabilities. The supply and demand for human resources can be forecast with a variety of methods and for differing periods of time. Psychological contracts are unwritten expectations that employees and employers have about the nature of their work relationships. The components of individual performance are individual ability, effort expended, and organizational support. Motivation deals with the needs and desires of human behavior and managerial and organizational factors. C R I T I C A L • • • • • • The interaction between individuals and their jobs affects both job satisfaction and organizational commitment. The extent to which employees feel linked to organizational success can affect employee engagement and loyalty. Turnover occurs when employees leave an organization and must be replaced. It can be classified in a number of ways, but it should be measured and its costs determined. Increasing employee retention or reducing turnover is important in HR management. Drivers of retention include organizational, managerial, and job factors that may affect employees’ work-life balancing; compensation and other rewards; career training and development; and employer policies and practices. Retention of employees is a major focus of HR management efforts in organizations, as demonstrated by the use of retention measures, including employee surveys and exit interviews. Managing retention should include evaluation and tracking of both retention actions and turnover follow-up. T H I N K I N G 1. Discuss the major components of HR planning and forecasting efforts. 2. Describe your expectations for a job. How well does your employer meet the expectations you bring to the psychological contract? 3. If you became the new manager at a restaurant with high employee turnover, what actions A C T I V I T I E S would you take to increase retention of employees? 4. As the HR manager, you must provide the senior management team with turnover costs for the following high-turnover position. Use Web sites such as Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 171 17/07/10 5:48 PM 172 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor www.talentkeepers.com and www .keepemployees.com, to calculate turnover and analyze the variables involved. Also identify any other data that might be relevant, and then discuss how you would reduce the turnover. H R E X P E R I E N T I A L Your company has reaped the benefits of having long-term, tenured employees, but many of them are now approaching retirement. It is anticipated that approximately 20% of the company’s workforce will retire in the next 3 to 5 years. In reviewing the remaining workforce through HR planning efforts, you have become aware of work-life balance issues that need to be reviewed and addressed. The Company President has requested that you prepare a Retention Plan outlining these issues as Position: Machine Operator Number of employees: 250 Number of turnovers: 85 Average wage: $11.50/hour Cost of benefits: 35% of payroll P R O B L E M S O L V I N G well as ways to address them. Resources to help you address the issues in the Retention Plan can be found at www.workfamily.com. 1. What steps will you take to identify key priorities in the work-life balance issues? 2. How will you present a business case to gain management support for addressing those issues in order to help retain existing workers and to fill the positions vacated by retiring employees? C A S E Accenture—Retaining for Itself Accenture is a firm that provides a wide range of consulting and services to organizations worldwide. With more than 170,000 employees, the firm has clients in 120 countries that receive many HR and other consulting services. Among others, these services include organizational, strategic, and change management analyses; leadership training and development; and technology assistance and supply chain assistance. Large and small client organizations also outsource various operational functions to Accenture instead of performing them internally with employees. Thus, Accenture has many individuals who serve as consultants and support experts on specialized areas and industries. Because of its many professional consulting and support staff members, Accenture has to manage its own human resources effectively in order to serve both itself and its clients. The rapid growth of this widespread firm has caused Accenture to hire up to 60,000 employees in just one year due to the expansion of clients and the need to replace employees who have left to become employees at other firms, to become independent consultants, or to work as employees at client firms. What Accenture does for its own employees illustrates one reason why it is widely used by clients. At the heart of Accenture’s approach for itself is to consider its employees as a virtual workforce. This means that numerous employees work in many different places at different times, often using work-life balancing, technology resources, and work-related job flexibility. With offices in more than 150 cities worldwide, the work locations and schedules vary so much that numerous Accenture consultants have to reserve a desk at an office when they need to be there. Otherwise, many employees are encouraged to work outside offices. The out-of-office environment presents an extensive HR challenge for Accenture in terms of engaging its employees. Many consultant employees work intermittently with a variety of managers and coworkers, in teams as large as 1,000 consultants, throughout multiple countries. To practice retention in its own firm, Accenture does extensive training and development of employees. All new Accenture workers participate in “New Joiner Orientation” where they learn what is expected of them, do sample client projects with coworkers, and become linked to personal career counselors. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 172 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 173 Human Resource Planning and Retention Career training and development efforts include a wide range of activities, access to Accenture’s “Career Marketplace” website, and training in how to work effectively on different types of projects and in global locations. The value of these activities is shown in the fact that almost 39% of Accenture’s open U.S. jobs are filled by current employees who change and/or increase their job levels. What Accenture’s employee retention program emphasizes is that the firm does not just consult about HR and other services for clients, but also does for itself what many current and potential clients need to do, which is to view HR planning and retention as crucial for organizational success and growth.54 QUESTIONS 1. Identify how some Accenture-type efforts have and have not occurred in your current and previous workplaces. Also, discuss why focusing on employee retention pays off for Accenture clients, and not just for Accenture itself. 2. Go to the Accenture website, www.accenture .com, to research and gather job- and careerrelated information that might need to be adapted by other employers. As part of this research, examine how Accenture markets itself to current and potential employees. S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S The Clothing Store Alegent Health This case describes the approach of one firm to improving employee retention. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) This case discusses how Alegent, a large nonprofit health care system, improved employee retention and reduced turnover. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) N O T E S 1. Based on Susan J. Wells, “Say Hola to the Majority Minority,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 38–45; Miriam Jordan, “Got Workers? Dairy Farms Run Low on Labor,” The Wall Street Journal, July 30, 2009, A13; Scott Morrison, “Google Searches for Staffing Answers,” The Wall Street Journal, May 19, 2009, B1; and Anton Trianovski, “Skilled Trades Seek Workers,” The Wall Street Journal, August 19, 2008, B1. 2. Fay Hansen, “Strategic Workforce Planning in an Uncertain World,” Workforce Management Online, July 2009, www.workforce.com. 3. Carol Morrison, “The Time to Plan Is Now,” Trend Watcher, April 17, 2009, www.i4cp.com. 4. For an overview, see Robert J. Greene, “Ensuring Future Work Viability,” WorldatWork Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2007, 23–33. 5. “Corps of Engineers Needs to Update Its Workforce Planning . . .,” Human Capital, U.S. Government Accountability Office, May 2008, www.goa.gov. 6. Based on HR’s Evolving Role in Organizations and Its Impact on Business Strategy, SHRM, 2008, 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. www.shrm.org/surveys; Carolyn Hirschman, “Putting Forecasting in Focus,” HR Magazine, March 2007, 44–49. Kenneth J. Zulz and Thomas J. Chernack, “Development and Initial Validation of an Instrument for Human Capital Planning,” Human Resource Development Quarterly, 19 (2008), 7–33. Pamela Babcock, “Workforce Planning Remains Largely Unaddressed Global Challenge,” SHRM Staffing Management, December 2007, www.shrm.org/ema. Based on Lydell C. Bridgeford, “Point-and-Click Productivity,” Employee Benefit News, June 15, 2009, 18–19; Ed Frauenheim, “HR Technology: Talent Tools Still Essential,” Workforce Management, April 20, 2009, 20. Arne L. Kallenberg, “The Mismatched Worker: When People Don’t Fit Their Jobs,” Academy of Management Perspectives, February 2008, 24–40. Jacqueline A.M. Coyle-Shapiro and Lynn M. Shore, “The Employee-Organization Relationship,” Human Resource Management Review, 17 (2007), 166–179. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 173 17/07/10 5:48 PM 174 SECTION 2 Jobs and labor 12. S. Lester, et al., “Managing Employee Perceptions of the Psychological Contract over Time,” Journal of Organizational Behavior, 28 (2007), 191–208. 13. “The Employment Relationship: Implications for the Psychological Contract,” SHRM Research, May 2008. 14. Tanguy Dulac, et al., “Not All Responses to Breach Are the Same,” Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008), 1079–1098. 15. S. Chi and S. Chen, “Perceived Psychological Contract Fulfillment and Job Attitudes Among Repatriates,” International Journal of Manpower, 28 (2007), 474–488. 16. B. Weber and G. Hertel, “Motivation Gains of Inferior Group Members: A Meta-Analytical Review,” Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 93 (2007), 973–993. 17. Piers Steel and Cornelius König, “Integrating Theories of Motivation,” Academy of Management Review, 31 (2006), 889–913. 18. Brian A. Altman and Mesut Akdere, “Towards a Theoretical Model of Performance Inhibiting Workplace Dynamics,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 408. 19. Thomas Zagenczk, “Mentors, Supervisors, and Role Models: Do They Reduce the Effects of Psychological Contract Breach?” Human Resource Management Journal, 19 (2009), 237–259. 20. “Workers Want Personal Satisfaction More than Money,” WorldatWork Newsline, May 22, 2009, www.worldatwork.org. 21. For a more detailed review of job satisfaction factors, see “2009 Employee Job Satisfaction: Understanding the Factors That Make Work Gratifying,” SHRM Research, 2009, www.shrm.org.; Daniel C. Ganseter, “Measurement Challenges for Studying Work-Related Stressors and Strains,” Human Resource Management Review, 18 (2008), 259–270. 22. Remus Ilies, et al., “The Spillover of Daily Job Satisfaction onto Employees’ Family Lives,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 87–102. 23. Rebecca R. Hastings, “Employee Surveys: Prepare to Act,” HR Disciplines, June 15, 2009, www.shrm.org. 24. Frank Giancola, “Employee Engagement: What You Need to Know,” Workspan, October 2007, 55–59. 25. For more information, see Nancy R. Lockwood, “Leveraging Employee Engagement for Competitive Advantage,” SHRM Research, No. 1, 2007, 1–11. 26. “Estimating Turnover Costs,” www.keepemployees.com. 27. M. D. Burton and C. H. Beckman, “Leaving a Legacy,” American Sociological Review, 72 (2007), 239–266. 28. Tae Hean Lee, et al., “Understanding Voluntary Turnover,” Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008), 651–671. 29. Kris Dunn, “Good Versus Bad Turnover,” Workforce Management Online, July 2007, www.workforce.com. 30. Charlie O. Trevor and Anthony Nyberg, “Keeping Your Headcount When All About You Are Losing Theirs,” Academy of Management Journal, 51 (2008), 259–276. 31. Thomas Ng and Marcus M. Butts, “Effectiveness of Organizational Efforts to Lower Turnover Intentions,” Human Resource Management, 48 (2009), 289–310. 32. For details on industries, types of jobs, and other components, go to www.dol.gov. 33. “Global Shipping and Delivery Giant . . .,” Talent Keepers Retention Case Study, www.talentkeepers.com. 34. For detailed examples, go to www.talentkeepers.com, www.shrm.org, and www.keepemployees.com. Also see “Tool: The Cost of Turnover,” Workforce Management, November 2003, www.workforce.com. 35. John Sullivan, “Not All Turnover Is Equal,” Workforce Management, May 21, 2007, 42; W. S. Siebert and Nikolay Zubanov, “Searching for the Optimal Level of Employee Turnover,” Academy of Management Journal, 5 (2009), 294–313. 36. “Unhappiness with Management, Limited Advancement Cited as Top Reasons Employees Quit,” WorldatWork Study, January 21, 2009, www.worldatwork.org. 37. For an overview, see Sandra L. Fornes, et al., “Workplace Commitment: A Conceptual Model Developed from Integrative Review of Research,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 339. 38. Sarah E. Needleman, “Allying Workers Fears During Uncertain Times,” The Wall Street Journal, October 6, 2008, B5. 39. Chu-Hsiang Chang, et al., “The Relationship Between Perceptions of Organizational Politics, Employee Attitudes, Strain, and Behavior,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 779–801. 40. Kathy Gurchiek, “Bad Bosses—More than Bad Salaries—Drive Workers Away,” HR News, January 11, 2007, www.shrm.org. 41. David R. Hekman, et al., “Combined Effects of Organizational and Professional Identification on the Reciprocity Dynamics for Professional Employees,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 506–526. 42. Riki Takevchi, et al., “A Model of Expatriate Withdrawal Related Outcomes,” Human Resource Management Review, 15 (2005), 119–138; Kathryn Tyler, “Retaining Repatriates,” HR Magazine, March 2006, 1–4. 43. Based on Padmaja Alaganandan, “India’s Human Capital Challenge,” Workspan, November 2008, 111–114; “The World of Work,” BusinessWeek, January 6, 2007, 57–58. 44. Cali Williams Yost, “CFO’s See Business Impacts of Work Flexibility . . . ,” WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter 2009, 59–67. 45. Patricia K. Zinghum and Jay R. Schuster, “Workforce Retention, Pay and Rewards Practices in Tough-Market Cities,” WorldatWork Journal, Fourth Quarter, 2008, 16–27. 46. Raymund Flandez, “Rewards Help Soothe Hard Times,” The Wall Street Journal, July 7, 2008, B4. 47. Patricia K. Zingheim, et al., “Compensation, Reward, and Retention Practices in Fast-Growth Companies,” WorldatWork Journal, Second Quarter, 2009, 22–37. 48. Matthew Smith and Derek Irvine, “Employee Recognition Program . . . ,” Workspan, August 2009, 29–37. 49. Kathy Gurchiek, “Lack of Career Advancement Main Reason Workers Consider Leaving,” HR News, February 29, 2008, www.shrm.org. 50. Phred Dvorak, “Firms Shift Underused Workers,” The Wall Street Journal, June 22, 2009, B2. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 174 17/07/10 5:48 PM CHAPTER 5 175 Human Resource Planning and Retention 51. Lisa Cooling, “Keep Your IT People Happy,” Inside Supply Management, May 2008, 38–40. 52. William Werhane “How Do We Get Better Information from Our Exit Interviews?” Workforce Management Online, October 1, 2009, www.workforce.com. 53. “First-Year Turnover Rate,” SHRM Metric of the Month, October 1, 2006, www.shrm.org/research. 54 Based on Jessica Marquez, “Accentuating the Positive,” Workforce Management, September 22, 2008, 18–25. Also see information available at www.accenture.com. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_05_ch05_p144-175.indd 175 17/07/10 5:48 PM C H A P T E R 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • List different ways that labor markets can be identified and approached. • Discuss strategic recruiting decisions on recruiting images, outsourcing, and other related areas. • Explain why Internet recruiting has grown and how it affects recruiting efforts done by employers. • List and briefly discuss five external recruiting sources. • Identify three internal sources for recruiting and issues associated with their use. • Describe three factors to consider when doing recruiting measurement and metrics. 176 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 176 26/06/10 5:09 PM HR Headline Passive Recruiting Becomes Active E Digital Vision/Photodisc/Jupiter Images mployed individuals who may not be considering other jobs but who are recruited are called passive job seekers. For firms to search to fill jobs with persons who are not actively looking for a job means that they have to use a variety of means to encourage passives to become actives. Many passives are approached via Internet tools. This approach is especially used for executive and other hard-to-fill openings, even for passives who do not have current résumés. Search consultants use passive recruiting to locate possible individuals to fill jobs to which the consultants have been assigned. Use of IT networking sites such as Facebook, Linked In, ZoomInfo, and others provides information on passive individuals. Once information on a “passive candidate” is located, personal contact can be made and conversations held to encourage the passive to consider job openings. Personal communication about certain employers and job openings helps get passives to consider the openings. This type of recruiting is becoming increasingly common as people use the Internet sites that can be accessed by others to learn about both jobs and individuals. Several Internet sites are adding thousands of individual profiles weekly. More than 20% of the large Fortune 500 firms use such sites along with other ways to find candidates for difficult-to-fill openings and top executive jobs.1 So, as an employer, are you ready to find passives? 177 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 177 26/06/10 5:09 PM 178 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor The staffing process used by an employer, based on HR planning and retention as key components, must include successful recruiting and selection efforts. However, as the HR Headline illustrates, new approaches to those actions are evolving. Without significant attention and measurement, recruiting and selection can become just a set of administrative functions: coordinating internal openings, handling the flow of candidate data, dealing with regulatory reporting, and moving candidates through the system. This chapter examines recruiting, and the next chapter examines selection. Recruiting is the process of generating a pool of qualified applicants for organizational jobs. If the number of available candidates equals the number of people to be hired, no real selection is required—the choice has already been made. The organization must either leave some openings unfilled or take all the candidates. One survey of employers in slow labor markets found that almost half of the hiring managers cited less qualified applicants as the biggest recruiting and hiring challenge.2 It is important to view recruiting broadly as a key part of staffing, and not just as a collection of administrative and operational activities. RECRUITING Recruiting is becoming more important as labor markets shift. Although recruiting can be expensive, an offsetting concept that must be considered is the cost of unfilled jobs. For example, consider a company in which three operations-related jobs are vacant. Assume these three vacancies cost the company $300 for each business day the jobs remain vacant. If the jobs are not filled for four months, the cost of this failure to recruit in a timely fashion will be about $26,000. Although cost is certainly an issue, and some employers are quite concerned about cost per hire as well as the cost of vacancies, quality might be an important trade-off. For example, if an organizational strategy focuses on quality as a competitive advantage, a company might choose to hire only from the top 15% of candidates for critical jobs, and from the top 30% of candidates for all other positions. Though this approach may raise the cost per hire, it will improve workforce quality. These examples illustrate that recruiting should not just be seen as an expense, but as part of overall HR planning and strategy. To be effective, recruiters need to integrate efforts involving labor markets, recruiting responsibilities and goals, and recruiting sources, including the Internet. Figure 6-1 highlights key integrative recruiting components. Strategic Recruiting and HR Planning It is important that recruiting be treated as a part of strategic HR planning because it is a key mechanism for filling positions necessary to get the work done. Recruiting requires an employer to: • • Recruiting Process of generating a pool of qualified applicants for organizational jobs. • • Know the industry and where to successfully recruit qualified employees. Identify keys to success in the labor market, including competitors’ recruiting efforts. Cultivate relationships with sources of prospective employees. Promote the “company brand” so that the employer is known as a good place to work. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 178 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 179 Recruiting and Labor Markets FIGURE 6-1 Integrating Recruiting Components Integrative Recruiting Success Recruiting Sources, including Internet Labor Markets Recruiting Responsibilities and Goals • LOGGING ON Airs Training and educational resources for recruiters are available at www.airsdirectory.com. Use recruiting metrics in order to measure the effectiveness of recruiting efforts. Recruiting decisions can identify not only the kinds and numbers of applicants, but also how difficult or successful recruiting efforts may be by type of jobs. In addition, effective recruiting focuses on discovering talent before it is needed. Training of Recruiters and Managers Regardless of the methods used, an important recruiting issue is how much training will be given to recruiters and managers. Training on recruitingrelated activities, communications skills, and job-specific details is common. Also, those involved in recruiting should learn the types of actions that violate EEO regulations and how to be sensitive to diversity issues with applicants. Such training areas often include appropriate language to use with applicants so that racist, sexist, and other inappropriate remarks do not hurt the image of the employer and result in legal complaints. Training recruiters may include the importance of employers engaging in ethical behaviors during recruiting efforts. One way to evaluate training efforts in this area is through follow-up activities. For instance, to assess ethical behavior when recruiting college graduates, some employers send followup surveys to interviewees asking about the effectiveness of the recruiters and the image the candidates have of the employers as a result of the recruiting contacts.3 LABOR MARKETS Labor markets External supply pool from which employers attract employees. Because staffing takes place in different labor markets that can vary a great deal, learning some basics about labor markets aids in understanding recruiting. Labor markets are the external supply pool from which employers attract employees. To understand where recruiting takes place, one can think of the sources of employees as a funnel, in which the broad scope of labor markets Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 179 26/06/10 5:10 PM 180 SECTION 2 FIGURE 6-2 Jobs and Labor Labor Market Components narrows progressively to the point of selection and job offers, as Figure 6-2 shows. Of course, if the selected candidates reject the offers, then HR staff members must move back up the funnel to the applicant pool for other candidates, and in extreme cases may need to reopen the recruiting process. Labor Market Components Labor force population All individuals who are available for selection if all possible recruitment strategies are used. Applicant population A subset of the labor force population that is available for selection using a particular recruiting approach. Applicant pool All persons who are actually evaluated for selection. Several different means of identifying labor markets exist. One useful approach is to take a broad view of the labor markets and then narrow them down to specific recruiting sources. The broadest labor market component and measure is the labor force population, which is made up of all individuals who are available for selection if all possible recruitment strategies are used. For firms with global locations in multiple countries, the labor force population can be much larger than that of a business operating in only one country. For example, some U.S.-based airlines have customer service centers located in the Philippines, India, and other countries as well as the United States. The labor force population for such businesses is much broader than that of a business operating in a single country. The applicant population is a subset of the labor force population that is available for selection if a particular recruiting approach is used. This population can be broad or narrow depending on the jobs needing to be filled and the approaches used by the employer. For example, if a firm is recruiting highly specialized engineers for multiple geographic locations, the recruiting methods may involve a broad range of approaches and sources, including professional associations, convention attendance, general and specialized websites, using recruiting consulting firms, and offering recruitment incentives to existing employees. However, a smaller firm in a limited geographic location might limit its recruiting for management trainees to MBA graduates from major universities in the area. This recruiting method would result in a different group of applicants from those who might apply if the employer were to advertise the openings for management trainees on a local radio station, post a listing on an Internet jobs board, or encourage current employee referrals and applications. Figure 6-3 illustrates some common items that affect recruiting applicant populations. The applicant pool consists of all persons who are actually evaluated for selection. Many factors can affect the size of the applicant pool, including the reputation of the organization and industry as a place to work, the screening efforts of the organization, the job specifications, and the information available. It is important to develop an applicant tracking system when considering Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 180 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 181 Recruiting and Labor Markets FIGURE 6-3 Considerations for Determining Applicant Populations CONSIDERATIONS FOR DETERMINING APPLICANT POPULATIONS Number and type of recruits needed Timing of recruiting to ensure timely placement External and internal messages on job details Qualifications of competent applicants to be considered Sources for obtaining qualified applicants Outside and inside recruiting means to be used Administrative recruiting and application review activities LOGGING ON JobWeb For a special report about labor markets and jobs outlook, visit www.jobweb.com. the applicant pool. Using such a system, both administratively and electronically, can make the recruiting process more effective.4 For example, when the applicant pool size increases, recruiters can consistently identify the most effective future employees for several jobs, and not just fill current jobs because of a larger supply.5 Unemployment Rates and Applicant Population When the unemployment rate is high in a given market, many people are looking for jobs. When the unemployment rate is low, there are fewer applicants. Unemployment rates vary with business cycles and present very different challenges for recruiting at different times. For instance, in some U.S. states, when many automobile plants closed and workers were laid off, manufacturers in other industries and even retailers experienced a significant increase in their numbers of job applicants, making recruiting easier and larger applicant pools a fact. Different Labor Markets and Recruiting The supply of workers in various labor markets differs substantially and affects staffing. Organizations recruit in a number of different labor markets, including industry-specific markets and occupational, educational and technical, and geographic markets. Labor markets can be viewed in several ways to provide information that is useful for recruiting. It is important to understand the broad labor markets from which candidates are identified and attracted. These labor markets can include both internal and external sources, which will be discussed later. Industry and Occupational Labor Markets Labor markets can be classified by industry and occupation. Depending on economic and industry aspects, recruiting emphases can be changed. For example, the biggest increases in U.S. jobs until the year 2016 are going to be in the positions of registered nurses, retail sales and customer service representatives, home health aides, and postsecondary teachers.6 These data illustrate that recruiting will be more difficult in filling these jobs during the next few years. Trucking and welding jobs are also expected to present significant recruiting difficulties.7 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 181 26/06/10 5:10 PM 182 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Recruiting for smaller firms can be challenging. For instance, a small certified professional accounting (CPA) firm had to work extensively to identify which CPA professionals would prefer working in a small firm rather than a large one. One key to this firm’s recruiting efforts was to clearly identify the unique characteristics of working in a smaller firm, which included greater assignment variety, more work flexibility, and better career possibilities.8 Those characteristics would appeal to some but not all who might apply. Educational and Technical Labor Markets Another way to look at labor markets is by considering the educational and technical qualifications that define the people being recruited. Employers may need individuals with specific licenses, certifications, or educational backgrounds. For instance, recruiting physician leaders for a medical organization led to the establishment of a special search committee to set goals for the committee members. Then, as part of recruiting and selection, the top candidates were asked to develop departmental vision statements and three-year goals. That information made the recruiting and selection process more effective.9 Another special labor market is suppliers and contractors for U.S. military forces. Firms such as Cintas Corporation, with more than 34,000 employees, and Raytheon, with 77,000 employees, serve as federal government defense contractors. The need to recruit for specialty jobs in engineering and technology by such firms illustrates why considering different types of labor markets is appropriate.10 A prominent occupational area that is expected to be extremely tight during the next few years is the information technology (IT) labor market. That labor market, which was tight several years ago, is now becoming tight again as IT is used in a wider variety of jobs.11 Another example of a tight labor market is that of business professors with PhDs, who are forecast to be in short supply in the next few years due to the retirement of baby boomers from faculty positions. Other examples of shortages in specific labor markets include certified auto mechanics, heating and air-conditioning technicians, and network-certified computer specialists. Geographic Labor Markets One common way to classify labor markets is based on geographic location. Markets can be local, area or regional, national, or international. Local and area labor markets vary significantly in terms of workforce availability and quality, and changes in a geographic labor market may force changes in recruiting efforts. For instance, if a new major employer locates in a regional labor market, other existing area employers may see a decline in their numbers of applicants. Geographic markets require different recruiting considerations. For example, attempting to recruit locally for a job market that is a national competitive market will likely result in disappointing applicant rates. A catalog retailer that tries to recruit a senior merchandising manager from the small town where the firm is located may encounter difficulties, although it may not need to recruit nationally for workers to fill administrative support jobs. This example shows how varying geographic labor markets must be evaluated as part of recruiting. G L O B A L Global Labor Markets Employers in the United States are tapping global labor markets when necessary and expanding export work to overseas labor markets when doing so is advantageous. Firms in different industries are expanding in India, China, Indonesia, Romania, Poland, and other countries. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 182 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 183 The migration of U.S. work overseas has been controversial. While many decry the loss of American jobs, some employers respond that they cannot be competitive in a global market if they fail to take advantage of labor savings. For example, at some operations in India and China, U.S. employers pay less than half of what they would pay for comparable jobs to be performed in U.S. facilities. A significant number of U.S. and European firms have farmed out software development and back-office work to India and other countries with lower wages. However, some advancements in American worker productivity have made it possible to have fewer U.S. employees to produce certain items, which has resulted in a cost savings, even at those employees’ higher wage rates. Hence, those types of jobs are not being exported to other countries. The use of the Internet has resulted in global jobs being recruited in many places, but often recruiting employees for global assignments requires different approaches from those used for typical recruiting efforts in the home country. The recruiting processes must consider variations in culture, laws, and language. For instance, in some countries, potential recruits like to work for European and U.S. firms, so recruiters emphasize the “Western” image. But in other countries, cultural employer operational differences change how recruiting is done. Dealing with foreign labor markets can present challenges. For example, in China recruiting is regulated and generally requires the approval of local personnel or labor authorities. Hiring foreign employees into U.S. jobs must meet certain legal requirements, including H1 visa requirements. Concerns exist about hiring illegal immigrants as well.12 STRATEGIC RECRUITING DECISIONS When there are economic declines in certain geographic areas and occupations, a greater number of talented recruits are available, and recruiting costs can be lower.13 But whether recruits are plentiful or scarce, employers must decide on several recruiting issues. These important strategic decisions for recruiting are discussed next. Recruiting Presence and Image Recruiting efforts may be viewed as either continuous or intensive. Continuous efforts to recruit offer the advantage of keeping the employer in the recruiting market. For example, with college recruiting, some organizations may find it advantageous to have a recruiter on a given campus each year. Employers that visit a campus only occasionally are less likely to build a following at that school over time. Also, continuous recruiting may lead to constant Internet job postings, contact with recruiting consultants, and other market-related actions. Intensive recruiting may take the form of a vigorous recruiting campaign aimed at hiring a given number of employees, usually within a short period of time. Sometimes such efforts are the result of unforeseeable changes in external factors, but they also can result from a failure in the HR planning system to identify needs in advance or to anticipate drastic changes in workforce needs. Employment “Branding” and Image The “employment brand” or image of an organization is the view of it held by both employees and outsiders. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 183 26/06/10 5:10 PM 184 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Effective Recruitment at USDA Every year Optimas Awards are given by Workforce.com to recognize and highlight how organizations improve results through workforce actions. One federal government entity received the award for its recruitingrelated efforts. The federal agency, the United States Department of Agriculture (USDA) Food Safety and Inspection Service, faced significant competition with private employers for candidates in positions such as science professionals, veterinarians, and other jobs. With position openings at 6,000 sites, the agency had to take significant action. First, more than 100 agency employees were trained to be effective recruiters as an expansion of their regular professional job responsibilities. Next, these “recruiters” annually visited more than 50 universities and colleges to recruit more staff. By using their training, these USDA individuals were able to reduce the time in which jobs were unfilled by more than five days on average. HR best practices One occupational group that needed significantly more recruiting was veterinarians. Given a shortage of qualified individuals, the agency took several actions in this area. One was raising the beginning salary level for veterinarians. Also, a hiring incentive was established in the form of 25% of base pay over four years. As a result, the shortage of veterinarians decreased by 50% as approximately 100 veterinarians were hired each year. The recruiting efforts have significantly changed agency operation as well. Some operational actions that have been implemented are more flexible work scheduling, telework usage, and flexible management. These actions have helped make the USDA Food Safety and Inspection Service more appealing to applicants and employees. That this entity received the Optimas award indicates that governmental and publicsector employers, and not just private-sector ones, must continually adapt and improve their recruiting planning and strategies.14 Organizations that are seen as desirable employers are better able to attract qualified applicants than are those with poor reputations. For example, one firm had good pay and benefits, but its work demands were seen as excessive, and frequent downsizings had resulted in some terminations and transfers. The result was high turnover and fewer applicants interested in employment at the company. That firm had a poor brand or image as an employer. Companies can spend considerable effort and money establishing brand images for their products. Not only can the company brand help generate more recruits, but it also can help with applicant self-selection because it affects whether individuals ever consider a firm and submit applications. Recruiting and employer branding should be seen as part of organizational marketing efforts and linked to the overall image and reputation of the organization and its industry. The HR Best Practices illustrates how a federal government agency changed its recruitment culture to improve its image and be more effective in its recruiting efforts. Organization-Based versus Outsourced Recruiting A basic decision is whether the recruiting will be done by the employer or outsourced to someone else. This decision need not be focused on an “either-or” situation entirely. In most organizations, HR staff members handle many of Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 184 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 185 the recruiting efforts. However, because recruiting can be a time-consuming process and HR staff and other managers in organizations have many other responsibilities, outsourcing is a way to decrease the number of staff needed for recruiting and free some of their time for other responsibilities. Recruitment process outsourcing (RPO) can be done to improve the number and quality of recruiting candidates, as well as to reduce recruiting costs.15 Estimates are that RPO is expected to grow significantly in the near future. Both large and small employers in different industries outsource such functions as placement of advertisements, initial screening of résumés, and initial telephone contacts with potential applicants. For example, General Electric (GE) uses RPO to save time and efforts of HR staff, as well as to target its recruiting efforts more effectively. Once the RPO activities are done, the employer’s HR staff members can take over the rest of the recruiting activities in a cost-effective and timely manner.16 Professional Employer Organizations and Employee Leasing A specific type of outsourcing uses professional employer organizations (PEOs) and employee leasing. The employee leasing process is simple: An employer signs an agreement with the PEO, after which the staff is hired by the leasing firm and leased back to the company for a fee. In turn, the leasing firm writes the paychecks, pays taxes, prepares and implements HR policies, and keeps all the required records for the employer. One advantage of leasing companies for employees is that they may receive better benefits than they otherwise would get in many of the small businesses that use leasing firms. But all this service comes at a cost to employers. Leasing companies often charge employers between 4% and 6% of employees’ monthly salaries. Thus, while leasing may save employers money on benefits and HR administration, it also may increase total payroll costs. The PEO and the employment agency are different types of entities. A PEO has its own workforce, which it supplies by contract to employers with jobs. However, an employment agency provides a “work-finding” service for job seekers and supplies employers with applicants whom they may then hire. Regular versus Flexible Staffing Another strategic decision affects how much recruiting will be done to fill staffing needs with regular full-time or part-time employees. Decisions as to which should be recruited hinge on whether to seek regular employees or to use more flexible approaches, which might include temporaries or independent contractors. A number of employers have decided that the cost of keeping a regular workforce has become excessive and is growing worse due to economic, competitive, and governmental considerations. However, not just money is at issue. The large number of employment regulations also constrains the employment relationship, making many employers reluctant to hire new regular full-time employees. Flexible staffing uses workers who are not traditional employees. Using flexible staffing arrangements allows an employer to avoid some of the cost of full-time benefits such as vacation pay and pension plans. Flexible staffing may lead to recruiting in different markets, since it includes the use of temporary workers and independent contractors. Temporary Workers Employers who use temporary employees can hire their own temporary staff members or contract with agencies supplying Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 185 26/06/10 5:10 PM 186 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor temporary workers on a rate-per-day or rate-per-week basis. Originally developed to provide clerical and office workers to employers, temporary workers in professional, technical, and even managerial jobs are becoming more common. The importance of using temporary workers is illustrated through the use of computer technology by an educational publisher. The publisher utilized an automated employment, recruiting, and screening system to obtain sufficient temporary workers for its firm. That employer obtained sufficient qualified workers which resulted in a return on its hiring investment of $6 for every $1 of cost.17 Some employers hire temporary workers as a way for individuals to move into full-time, regular employment. Better-performing workers may move to regular positions when these positions become available. This “try before you buy” approach is potentially beneficial to both employers and employees. However, if individuals come through temporary service firms, those firms typically bill client companies a placement charge if a temporary worker is hired full-time. Also, employing temporary workers as opposed to full-time workers can have implications in regard to federal laws such as the Family Medical Leave Act, the Fair Labor Standards Act, and others.18 Independent Contractors Some firms employ independent contractors as workers who perform specific services on a contract basis. These workers must be truly independent as determined by regulations used by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service and the U.S. LOGGING ON Department of Labor. Independent contractors are used in Arbita a number of areas, including building maintenance, security, This consulting firm provides resources advertising, and others. One major reason for the use of on recruiting-related topics, including a independent contractors is that some employers experience collection of articles and white papers. significant savings because benefits are not provided to those Visit the website at www.arbita.net. individuals. Recruiting and EEO: Diversity Considerations Recruiters must consider EEO and diversity factors for several reasons, as Figure 6-4 indicates. The following text highlights each of the diversity consideration dimensions. FIGURE 6-4 Recruiting and Diversity Considerations Compliance with EEO Regulations Targeting Recruiting of Diverse Applicants of Varying Types Diversity-Specific Recruiting Efforts (ads, websites, etc.) Training of Recruiters on EEO/Diversity Issues Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 186 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 187 EEO and Recruiting Efforts Recruiting as a key employment-related activity is subject to various considerations, especially equal employment laws and regulations. As part of legal compliance in the recruiting process, organizations must work to reduce external disparate impact, or underrepresentation of protected-class members compared to the labor markets utilized by the employer. If disparate impact exists, then the employer may need to make special efforts to persuade protected-class individuals to apply for jobs. For employers with affirmative action plans (AAPs), special ways to reduce disparate impact can be identified as goals listed in those plans. Also, many employers that emphasize internal recruiting should take actions to obtain protected-class applicants externally if disparate impact exists in the current workforce. The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission (EEOC) guidelines state that no direct or indirect references implying gender or age are permitted. These guidelines affect interviews, advertisements, and other recruiting activities. Some examples of impermissible terminology are: “young and enthusiastic,” “Christian values,” and “journeyman lineman.” Also, advertisements should contain wording about being an Equal Opportunity Employer (EEO), or even more specific designations such as EEO/M-F/AA/ADA. Employers demonstrate inclusive recruiting by having diverse individuals represented in company materials, in advertisements, and as recruiters. Recruiting Diversity A broad range of factors applies to recruiting diversity. Many employers have expanded efforts to recruit workers from what, for some, are nontraditional labor pools. Nontraditional diverse recruitees for certain jobs may include: • • • • • • Persons with different racial/ethnic backgrounds Older workers over 40 years of age Single parents Workers with disabilities Welfare-to-work workers Homeless/substance abuse workers The growth in racial/ethnic workforce diversity means that a wider range of potential employment sources should be utilized. Almost 60% of surveyed employers review their recruitment practices to ensure that they are inclusive, and almost half provide diversity training to managers involved in hiring.19 The population growth in Hispanics in the United States means that specialized recruiting programs to tap Hispanics as applicants may grow in use. For instance, Goodwill Industries, a large nonprofit organization, provides diversity training of staff members and has partnerships with Hispanic community organizations to aid in the recruitment and retention of Hispanic workers.20 Older potential workers may include retirees who have become bored (or need money), those who have been involuntarily laid off, or those who are making career changes and want to try a new field. But some employers prefer younger workers as recruites, even though that can create both legal and recruiting supply issues.21 Single parents may be attracted to a familyfriendly employer that offers flexibility, including part-time work, because it is frequently difficult to balance job and family life. Some firms also recruit stay-at-home parents by using flexibility and work-at-home technology. Individuals with disabilities are another group of potential resources. More than 21 million people with disabilities are of working age, but only about 8 million of them are employed. Therefore, it is appropriate that employers Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 187 26/06/10 5:10 PM 188 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor expand their educational, training, and staffing policies and practices to employ more individuals with disabilities.22 Realistic Job Previews Providing a balanced view of the advantages, demands, expectations, and challenges in an organization or a job may help attract employees with more realistic expectations and reduce the number of employees who quit a few months after being hired because the “reality” they discover does not match what they expected. Thus, recruiting efforts can benefit from realistic job previews, but their usage must be monitored. RJPs will be further discussed in the next chapter as part of the selection process.23 Recruiting Source Choices: Internal versus External Most employers combine the use of internal and external recruiting sources. Both promoting from within the organization (internal recruitment) and hiring from outside the organization (external recruitment) come with advantages and disadvantages. Organizations that face rapidly changing competitive environments and conditions may need to place a heavier emphasis on external sources in addition to developing internal sources. A possible strategy might be to promote from within if a qualified applicant exists and to go to external sources if not. However, for organizations existing in environments that change slowly, emphasis on promotion from within may be more suitable. Once the various recruiting policy decisions have been addressed, the actual recruiting methods can be identified and used for both internal and external recruiting. INTERNET RECRUITING The Internet has become the primary means for many employers to search for job candidates and for applicants to look for jobs. The growth in Internet use is a key reason that the following employer actions occur: • • • Adjusting general employer recruiting systems to use new approaches Identifying new types of recruiting for specific jobs Training managers and HR professionals on technical recruiting sources, skills, and responsibilities E-Recruiting Means The growth in the Internet has led both employers and employees to use Internet recruiting tools. Internet links, Web 2.0 sites, blogs, twitters, and other types of Internet/Web-based usages have become viable parts of recruiting. One survey of e-recruiting software providers identified numerous firms as e-recruiting clients, and some of them serve more than 1,000 employers.24 Of the many recruiting sites using special software, the most common ones are Internet job boards, professional/career websites, and employer websites. Internet Job Boards Numerous Internet job boards, such as Monster and Yahoo! HotJobs, provide places for employers to post jobs or search for Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 188 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 189 candidates. Job boards offer access to numerous candidates. Some Internet locations allow recruiters to search one website, such as MyJobHunter.com, to obtain search links to many other major job sites. Applicants can also use these websites to do one match and then send résumés to all jobs in which they are interested.25 However, a number of the individuals accessing these sites are “job lookers” who are not serious about changing jobs, but are checking out compensation levels and job availability in their areas of interest. Despite such concerns, HR recruiters find general job boards useful for generating applicant responses. Professional/Career Websites Many professional associations have employment sections at their websites. As illustration, for HR jobs, see the Society for Human Resource Management site, www.shrm.org, or WorldatWork, www.worldatwork.org. The SHRM organization has established a Job Posting Center that numerous recruiters and employers can use to post a wide range of industry openings.26 A number of private corporations maintain specialized career or industry websites to focus on IT, telecommunications, engineering, medicine, and other areas. Use of these targeted websites may limit somewhat recruiters’ search time and efforts. Also, posting jobs on such websites is likely to target applicants specifically interested in the job field and may reduce the number of applications from less-qualified applicants. Employer Websites Despite the popularity of job boards and association job sites, many employers have learned that their own websites can be most effective and efficient when recruiting candidates. The most successful of these websites are created by highly prominent firms and take extensive actions to guide job seekers to their firm.27 Employers include employment and career information on their websites under headings such as “Employment” or “Careers.” This is the place where recruiting (both internal and external) is often conducted. On many of these sites, job seekers are encouraged to e-mail résumés or complete online applications. It is important for the recruiting and employment portions of an employer website to be seen as part of the marketing efforts of the firm.28 The formatting of the employment section of an organizational website must be shaped to market jobs and organizational careers effectively. A company website should market the employer by outlining information on the organization, including its products and services, organizational and industry growth potential, and organizational operations. The attractiveness, usability, and formatting of an employer’s website can affect job seekers’ view of that organization positively or negatively.29 See HR On-the-Job for company website recruiting ideas. Recruiting and Internet Social Networking The Internet has led to social networking of individuals on blogs, twitters, and a range of websites. Many people initially use the social media more than job board sites.30 Internet connections often include people who work together as well as past personal contacts and friends. The informal use of the Web presents some interesting recruiting advantages and disadvantages for both employers and employees. Social networking sites allow job seekers to connect with employees of potential hirers. For instance, some sites include posts on what it is like to work for a boss, and job hunters can contact the posters and ask questions. An example is LinkedIn, which has a job-search engine that allows people to search for contacts who work for employers with posted job openings. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 189 26/06/10 5:10 PM 190 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor HR on-the-job Effective Recruiting Using an Employer Website Employers who are effective recruiters through their company websites have sites that enhance the image of their companies and their jobs. Important guidelines to creating an effective website include: • • • Make the site easy to navigate. The “Employment” or “Careers” button should be on the home page. Job information should be no more than three clicks away. Include information that people want. Describe the company, its products and services, careers in the organization, and advantages of working for the firm. Use qualifying categories (location, job function, skills, education, etc.) to help candidates find the jobs for which they are eligible. Use of such categories saves time, especially for companies who are large employers. • Use self-assessment checklists to ask candidates about experience and interests and to direct them to the jobs that fit them the best. • Make it easy to apply for a job by providing the means to build a résumé on the site or to paste in an existing résumé. Online applications also should be provided. • Design the site to provide recruiters with an additional way to post jobs, search for résumés and applications, and screen applicants. Otherwise, it is difficult to manage a busy website. • Collect metrics on the site. To determine its effectiveness, gather information about the site, such as the number of visitors, hits from ads, actual hires, and other details. Firms and employers are now engaging in social collaboration by joining and accessing social technology networks such as MySpace, Facebook, and many others. Posting job openings on these sites means that millions of website users can see the openings and can make contact online. Often those doing recruiting can send individuals to the company website and then process candidates using electronic résumés or completed online applications.31 Job Applicants and Social Network Sites Many individuals see social media and networking websites as a key part of online recruiting. A study of 200 users of one such website indicated that the individuals who were job seeking were doing so for active reasons such as career opportunities, job inquiries, and others; relatively few of them were passive job seekers who were just looking at website information.32 Almost half of surveyed employers indicated that instead of using general job boards, they were changing to social networking and niche job sites for recruiting workers with specific skills. However, employers who use social networking sites for recruiting must have plans and well-defined recruiting tools to take full advantage of these sites.33 Recruiting Using Special Technology Means For a number of years, the Internet has been used by people globally. Several special Internet tools that can be used as part of recruiting efforts are blogs, e-videos, and twitters. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 190 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 191 Blogs and Recruiting Both employers and individuals have used blogs as part of recruiting to fill jobs. Firms such as Best Buy, Microsoft, Honeywell, and Manpower have used blogs on which individuals could read and provide content. For instance, describing job openings and recruiting needs on the Best Buy blog has resulted in individuals responding to job areas such as finance, marketing, HR, and other specialties. Numerous other employers have used blogs to generate recruiting results as well.34 E-Video and Recruiting With video capabilities of all types available, employers are using videos in several ways. Some firms use videos to describe their company characteristics, job opportunities, and recruiting means. Suppliers such as Monstor.com, CareerTV, and others have worked with employer clients to produce online recruitment videos.35 Some of the online videos contain “employment games” for both current and potential employees that focus on creating positive employment images. People who are interested in working for the company can then follow up by using online job application documentation and information. For example, MITRE, a systems engineering firm, developed a “Job of Honor” video game that drew more than 5,000 hits in one year; more than 600 people in the United States and from 25 other countries became registered players in the game. Participation levels like this have led employers to increase job-related recruiting and follow-up activities using Web-based linkages.36 Recruiting through Twitter Twitter can be used for many different purposes, including personal, social, legal, and employment-related messages. More than 7 million people have joined Twitter.com to become “tweeters.” One professional sent a tweet in January 2009, and by June of that year more than 20,000 people had responded by contacting JobAngels with tweets.37 The Twitter system limits messages to 140 specific charLOGGING ON acters, but even so tweeting has rapidly become a social RecruitingBlogs.com network recruiting method. Recruiters send tweet messages For HR professional resources and to both active and passive job candidates, and then follow information on using social networks up with longer e-mails to computers, personal contacts, and for recruiting, including Twitter, other actions to facilitate recruiting. Since Twitter is such a Facebook, and LinkedIn, visit relatively new service, how exactly it will be best used for www.recruitingblogs.com. recruiting is still evolving.38 Legal Issues in Internet Recruiting With Internet recruiting expanding, new and different concerns have arisen. Several of these issues have ethical and moral as well as legal implications. The following examples illustrate some of these concerns: • • • • When companies use screening software to avoid looking at the thousands of résumés they receive, are rejections really based on the qualifications needed for the job? How can a person’s protected-category and other information be collected and analyzed for reports? Are too many individuals in protected categories being excluded from the later phases of the Internet recruiting process? Which applicants really want jobs? If someone has accessed a job board and sent an e-mail asking an employer about a job opening, does the person actually want to be an applicant? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 191 26/06/10 5:10 PM 192 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor • What are the implications of Internet recruiting in terms of confidentiality and privacy? Loss of privacy is a potential disadvantage with Internet recruiting. Sharing information gleaned from people who apply to job boards or even company websites has become common. As a company receives résumés from applicants, it is required to track those applicants and report to the federal government. But the personal information that can be seen by employers on websites such as MySpace, Facebook, LinkedIn, and others may be inappropriate and can possibly violate legal provisions. Also, blogging creates enough possible legal concerns that regulations may be implemented by the U.S. Federal Trade Commission (FTC).39 Employment lawyers are issuing warnings to employers about remarks and other characteristics posted on LinkedIn, Facebook, and Twitter. According to one survey of employers, about three-fourths of hiring managers in various-sized companies checked persons’ credentials on LinkedIn, about half used Facebook, and approximately one-fourth used Twitter.40 Some of the concerns raised have included postings of confidential details about an employee’s termination, racial/ethnic background, or gender and the making of discriminatory comments. All of these actions could lead to wrongful termination or discrimination lawsuits. Thus, because Internet usage has both advantages and disadvantages for recruiting, legal advice should be obtained, and HR employment-related policies, training, and enforcement should include such advice. Advantages of Internet Recruiting Employers have found a number of advantages to using Internet recruiting. A primary one is that many employers have saved money using Internet recruiting versus other recruiting methods such as newspaper advertising, employment agencies, and search firms, all of which can cost substantially more. Another major advantage is that a very large pool of applicants can be generated using Internet recruiting. Individuals may view an employer more positively and obtain more useful information, which can result in more individual applications.41 In fact, a large number of candidates may see any given job listing, although exposure depends on which Internet sources are used. One side benefit of Internet recruiting is that jobs literally are posted globally, so potential applicants in other geographic areas and countries can view job openings posted on the Internet. It also improves the ability to target specific audiences, including more diverse persons, through the use of categories, information, and other variables.42 Internet recruiting also can save time. Applicants can respond quickly to job postings by sending electronic responses, rather than using “snail mail.” Recruiters can respond more rapidly to qualified candidates in order to obtain more necessary applicant information, request additional candidate details, and establish times for further communication, including interviews.43 A good website and useful Internet resources also can help recruiters reach “passive” job seekers—those who have a good job and are not really looking to change jobs but who might consider it if a better opportunity were presented. These individuals often do not list themselves on job boards, but they might visit a company website for other reasons and check out the careers or employment section. A well-designed corporate website can help stimulate interest in some passive job seekers, as well as other potential candidates. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 192 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 193 Recruiting and Labor Markets Disadvantages of Internet Recruiting The positive things associated with Internet recruiting come with a number of disadvantages. Because of broader exposure, Internet recruiting often creates additional work for HR staff members and others internally. More online job postings must be sent; many more résumés must be reviewed; more e-mails, blogs, and twitters need to be dealt with; and expensive specialized software may be needed to track the increased number of applicants resulting from Internet recruiting efforts. Another issue with Internet recruiting is that some applicants may have limited Internet access, especially individuals from lower socioeconomic groups and from certain racial/ethnic groups. In addition, many individuals who access Internet recruiting sources are browsers who may submit résumés just to see what happens, but they are not actively looking for new jobs. Internet recruiting is only one approach to recruiting, but its use has been expanding. Information about how Internet recruiting methods compare with other, more traditional approaches is relevant. Also, how well the Internet recruiting resources perform must be compared to the effectiveness and integration of other external and internal recruiting sources. EXTERNAL RECRUITING SOURCES Even when the overall unemployment rate increases, numerous jobs and/or employers still face recruiting challenges. External recruiting is part of effective HR staffing. Regardless of the methods used, external recruiting involves some common advantages and disadvantages, which are highlighted in Figure 6-5. Some of the prominent traditional and evolving recruiting methods are highlighted next. Media Sources Media sources such as newspapers, magazines, television, radio, and billboards typically have been widely used in external recruiting. Some firms have sent FIGURE 6-5 Advantages and Disadvantages of External Recruiting ADVANTAGES New sources bring new perspectives. Training new hires may be cheaper and faster because of prior external experience. New hires are likely to have fewer internal political supporters in the firm. New hires may bring new industry insights and expertise. DISADVANTAGES The firm may not select someone who will fit well with the job and the organization. The process may cause morale problems for internal candidates not selected. New employees may require longer adjustment periods as well as orientation efforts. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 193 26/06/10 5:10 PM 194 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor direct mail using purchased lists of individuals in certain fields or industries. Internet usage has led to media sources being available online, including postings, ads, videos, webinars, and many other expanding media services. In some cities and towns, newspaper ads are still very prominent, though they may trigger job searchers to go to an Internet source for more details. Recruiting differs depending on company and location; for instance, filling jobs at community banks in rural areas might involve different types of recruiting from filling jobs in larger banks in urban areas.44 Whatever medium is used, it should be tied to the relevant labor market and should provide sufficient information on the company and the job. Thus, one major key is to make the wording of job ads readable and understandable, rather than using extensive abbreviations and omitting appealing details.45 Figure 6-6 shows the kinds of information a good recruiting ad contains. Evaluating Media Ads HR recruiters should measure the responses that different media generate in order to evaluate the effectiveness of various sources. The easiest way to track responses to ads is to use different contact names, e-mail addresses, or phone number codes in each ad, so the employer can identify which advertisement has prompted each applicant response that is received. Although the total number of responses to each ad should be tracked, judging the success of an ad only by this number is a mistake. For example, it is better to have 10 responses with two qualified applicants than 30 responses with only one qualified applicant. Therefore, after individuals are hired, follow-up should be done to see which sources produced the employees who stay longer and perform better. FIGURE 6-6 What to Include in an Effective Recruiting Ad Information on the Job and on the Application Process Job title and responsibilities Geographic/flexible location of job Starting pay range Acceptance of online applications Where/how to submit application or résumé details Closing date of application Desired Candidate Qualifications Years of experience Three to five key characteristics of successful candidates Special useful work capabilities Effective Details in Recruiting Ads Information on the Organization Organizational values and culture An EEO employer Primary business capabilities Unique characteristics and recognition Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 194 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 195 Competitive Recruiting Sources Other sources for recruiting include professional and trade associations, trade publications, and competitors. Many professional societies and trade associations publish newsletters or magazines and have websites containing job ads. Such sources may be useful for recruiting the specialized professionals needed in an industry. Some employers have extended recruiting to customers. Retailers such as Wal-Mart and Best Buy have aggressive programs to recruit customers to become employees in stores. While in the store, customers at these firms can pick up applications, apply online using kiosks, and even schedule interviews with managers or HR staff members. Other firms have included employment announcements when sending out customer bills or newsletters. Employment Agencies Employment agencies, both public and private, are a recruiting source. Every state in the United States has its own state-sponsored employment agency. These agencies operate branch offices in cities throughout the states and do not charge fees to applicants or employers. They also have websites that potential applicants can use without having to go to the offices. Private employment agencies operate in most cities. For a fee collected from either the employee or the employer, these agencies do some preliminary screening and put employers in touch with applicants. Private employment agencies differ considerably in the levels of service, costs, policies, and types of applicants they provide. One specific type of private agency, the outplacement firm, is highlighted in the HR Perspective. “Headhunters” The size of the fees and the aggressiveness with which some firms pursue candidates for executive and other openings have led to such firms being called headhunters. These employment agencies focus their efforts on executive, managerial, and professional positions. The executive search firms are split into two groups: (1) continLOGGING ON gency firms that charge a fee only after a candidate has been Job Agencies.com hired by a client company, and (2) retainer firms that charge For information about employment a client a set fee whether or not the contracted search is agencies, including a directory of successful. Most of the larger firms work on a retainer basis. worldwide agencies spanning many However, search firms are generally ethically bound not to employment industries, visit approach employees of client companies in their search for www.jobagencies.com. job candidates for another employer.46 Labor Unions Labor unions may be a useful source of certain types of workers. For example, in electrical and construction industries, unions traditionally have supplied workers to employers. A labor pool is generally available through a union, and workers can be dispatched from the hiring hall to particular jobs to meet the needs of employers. In some instances, labor unions can control or influence recruiting and staffing activity. An organization with a strong union may have less flexibility than a nonunion company in deciding who will be hired and where those people will be placed. Unions can benefit employers through apprenticeship and cooperative staffing programs, as they do in the building and printing industries. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 195 26/06/10 5:10 PM 196 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Outplacement Firms as Recruiting Sources Outplacement firms typically aid individuals who have lost jobs with obtaining reemployment. As mentioned in earlier chapters, jobs can be lost because specific employees are removed from their jobs, because broad organizational downsizing or department reorganization occurs, or because people leave their jobs. Causes for eliminating specific persons or for people leaving jobs can include work factors, managerial conflicts, and various personal or work-life reasons. The outplacement firms offer individuals a number of services, such as career counseling, résumé preparations and revisions, website sourcing, training on interview skills, and other useful job-related activities. By providing this assistance, these firms help individuals improve their job-hunting capabilities. One beneficial service of many outplacement firms HR perspective is helping job seekers develop and utilize personal networks, composed of past and present professional industry persons, business contacts from previous jobs, and other people. A major asset of large outplacement firms such as Right Management and Keystone Partners is that they have contacts with a wide range of employers. They can contact potential employers and ask them to meet with outplaced individuals. These firms also utilize networking contacts with the employers with whom they have worked in the past. In summary, outplacement firms provide a “recruiting bank” for both job-searching individual clients and employers needing new recruits. Because such firms serve both groups, they are another recruiting source that is widely used.47 Job Fairs and Creative Recruiting Employers in various labor markets needing to fill a large number of jobs quickly have used job fairs and special recruiting events. Job fairs have been held by economic development entities, employer and HR associations, and other community groups to help bring employers and potential job candidates together. For instance, the SHRM chapter in a midwestern metropolitan area annually sponsors a job fair at which 75 to 100 employers can meet applicants. Publicity in the city draws several hundred potential recruits for different types of jobs. However, two cautionary notes are in order: (1) Some employers at job fairs may see attendees who are currently their employees “shopping” for jobs with other employers; and (2) “general” job fairs are likely to attract many people, including attendees who are not only unemployed but also unemployable. Industry- or skill-specific events usually offer more satisfactory candidates. Such job fairs also can attract employed candidates who are casually looking around but may not put their résumés on the Internet. “Virtual” job fairs with Web-based links have been used by the federal government and others. “Drive-through” job fairs at shopping malls have been used by employers in a number of communities. At one such event, interested persons could drive up to a tent outside the mall, pick up applications from a “menu board” of employers, and then park and interview in the tent with recruiters if time allowed. Such creative recruiting methods sometimes can be used to generate a pool of qualified applicants so that jobs can be filled in a timely manner. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 196 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 197 Recruiting and Labor Markets Educational Institutions and Recruiting College and university students are a significant source of entry-level professional and technical employees. Most universities maintain career placement offices in which employers and applicants can meet. A number of considerations affect an employer’s selection of colleges and universities at which to conduct interviews, as Figure 6-7 indicates. Because college/university recruiting can be expensive and require significant time and effort, employers need to determine whether both current and future jobs require persons with college degrees in specific fields. Despite the economic changes in industries and among employers, a majority of employers who were surveyed still plan to have more than half of their hires be college graduates.48 A number of factors determine success in college recruiting. Some employers actively build continuing relationships with individual faculty members and career staff at designated colleges and universities. Maintaining a presence on campus by providing guest speakers to classes and student groups increases the contacts for an employer. Employers with a continuing presence and support on a campus are more likely to see positive college recruiting results. Desirable Capabilities of College Recruits For many employers, a moderately high grade point average (GPA) is a criterion for considering candidates for jobs during on-campus interviews. Recruiters may use GPA benchmarks to initially screen applicants in college recruiting decisions. Considerations beyond grades include the graduates’ leadership potential, interpersonal communication skills, and professional motivation factors.49 Employers also FIGURE 6-7 College Recruiting: Considerations for Employers Organizational budget and college graduate pay levels Experiences with prior college graduates and interns Current/anticipated job openings College Recruiting: Employer Aspects Reputation of firm at college and with previous graduates College graduate specialty programs and faculty links College placement office reputation, assistance, and programs Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 197 26/06/10 5:10 PM 198 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor HR on-the-job Internships as Part of College Recruiting Many employers utilize internships as a basis for recruiting college students and graduates. Companies using internships believe they achieve better retention through the use of internships and cooperative programs. Well-planned internships have the potential to benefit both the individual student interns and the employers.50 A student gets an opportunity to see if an employer and its culture fit, and the employer gets the equivalent of several months worth of “interview experiences” instead of the short traditional one. The following basic guidelines for the employer can help improve the odds that internships will be rewarding: • Decide what the company needs in terms of specific jobs and projects, rather than just providing general internships. • • • If interns are paid, provide relatively realistic competitive wages, as that will help attract talented individuals. Treat the interns like new employees by giving them appropriate work spaces, tools, Internet access, and other resources. Effectively manage the interns, including training, mentoring, and performance feedback. The growth in IT resources has led to some “virtual internships.”51 In these arrangements, interns can access an employer’s website, do project work, and interact with managers and others via e-mail, text-messages, and other means. Still, having some personal contact is likely to be useful for establishing the employer and intern images and relationships, which can lead to successful job offers for some interns. are more likely to hire college candidates with related experience. That is one reason why internships are very important to employers, candidates, and college/university efforts, as the HR On-the-Job indicates. School Recruiting High schools and vocational/technical schools may be valuable sources of new employees for some organizations. Many schools have a centralized guidance or placement office. Participating in career days and giving company tours to school groups are ways of maintaining good contact with school sources. Cooperative programs, in which students work part-time and receive some school credits, also may be useful in generating qualified future applicants for full-time positions. Employers recognize that they may need to begin attracting students with capabilities while those students are in high school. For example, GE, IBM, and other corporations fund programs to encourage students with science and math skills to participate in engineering internships during summers. Some employers specifically target talented members of racial/ethnic groups in high schools and provide them with career encouragement, summer internships, and mentoring programs as part of aiding workforce diversity efforts. INTERNAL RECRUITING METHODS Filling openings internally may add motivation for employees to stay and grow in the organization rather than pursuing career opportunities elsewhere. The most common internal recruiting methods include: organizational databases, job postings, promotions and transfers, current-employee Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 198 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 199 Recruiting and Labor Markets FIGURE 6-8 Advantages and Disadvantages of Internal Recruiting ADVANTAGES DISADVANTAGES The morale of a promotee is usually high. The firm can better assess a candidate’s abilities due to prior work actions. Recruiting costs are lower for some jobs. The process is a motivator for good performances by employees. The process can aid succession planning, future promotions, and career development. The firm may have to hire only at the entry level and then move employees up based on experience and performance. “Inbreeding” of employees may result in a less diverse workforce, as well as a lack of new ideas. Those persons not promoted may experience morale problems. Employees may engage in “political” infighting for promotions. A development program often is needed to transfer employees into supervisory and management jobs. Some managers may resist having employees promoted into their departments. referrals, and rerecruiting of former employees and applicants. Some of the common advantages and disadvantages of internal recruiting are highlighted in Figure 6-8. Internal Recruiting Databases and Internet-Related Sources HR information technology systems allow HR staff to maintain background and knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSA) information on existing employees. As openings arise, HR can access databases by entering job requirements and then get a listing of current employees meeting those requirements. Employment software can sort employee data by occupational fields, education, areas of career interests, previous work histories, and other variables. For instance, if a firm has an opening for someone with an MBA and marketing experience, the key words MBA and marketing can be entered in a search field, and the program displays a list of all current employees with these two items identified in their employee profiles. The advantage of such databases is that they can be linked to other HR activities. Opportunities for career development and advancement are a major reason why individuals stay at or leave their employers. With employee databases, internal opportunities for individuals can be identified. Employee profiles are continually updated to include such items as additional training and education completed, special projects handled, and career plans and desires noted during performance appraisals and career mentoring discussions. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 199 26/06/10 5:10 PM 200 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Job Posting The major means for recruiting current employees for other jobs within the organization is job posting, a system in which the employer provides notices of job openings and employees respond by applying for specific openings. Without some sort of job posting system, it is difficult for many employees to find out what jobs are open elsewhere in the organization. In many unionized organizations, job posting and bidding can be quite formal because the procedures are often spelled out in labor agreements. Seniority lists may be used by organizations that make promotions based strictly on seniority. Regardless of the means used, the purpose of the job posting system is to provide employees with more opportunities to move within the organization. When establishing and managing a job posting system, a number of questions must be addressed: • • • • What happens if no qualified candidates respond to postings? Must employees inform their supervisors that they are applying for another job? Are there restrictions on how long an employee must stay in a job before applying for another internal one? What types of or levels of jobs will not be posted? Internet/Web-Based Job Posting While many employers historically have had some kind of job posting system in place for internal jobs, a number of companies are using proactive efforts to get employees to apply through Webbased systems. Kenexa, Oracle, Softscape, LinkedIn, ResumePal, Facebook, and JobFox are just some of the vendors that provide internal recruiting website job posting. The complexity of using such job posting methods varies according to the employer and the technology capabilities and systems available.52 Employees can log onto a company intranet and create personal profiles, including career objectives, education, skill sets, and pay expectations. They also may attach a résumé. When a job opens, the placement program automatically mines the database for matches. Candidates then are notified by e-mail and go through the regular hiring cycle. Effective Job Posting For job posting efforts to be effective, especially with better-performing employees, posting wording must be relevant and accurate. Also, the posting should be based on the important characteristics of talented employees. Those people may be most likely to respond because of the organizational reputation, coworkers and bosses, and the possibility of more important and interesting work.53 Jobs generally are posted before any external recruiting is done. The organization must allow a reasonable period of time for present employees to check notices of available jobs before it considers external applicants. Employees whose bids are turned down should discuss with their supervisors or someone in the HR area what knowledge, skills, and abilities are needed in order to improve their opportunities in the future. Job posting System in which the employer provides notices of job openings and employees respond by applying for specific openings. Promotions and Transfers Many organizations choose to fill vacancies through promotions or transfers from within whenever possible. Firms such as Verizon Communications, Dow Chemical, Microsoft, and IBM have established systems to encourage employees to learn about current and future career needs and opportunities. Some advantages of these programs are reducing Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 200 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 201 Recruiting and Labor Markets Enhancing Opportunities for Internal Promotion Recruiting tools can help identify prospective candidates internally. It has been noted that “if you are not recruiting your own employees, someone else will.” This is another way of saying that if employees have no internal opportunities for advancement, the best performers will look outside the company. By taking an electronic look within the company for candidates to promote, firms may not only save money, but also enhance the prospects for retention of current employees. Employers are using HR technology systems to identify employee capabilities for entering management positions from within the company. Some firms have implemented electronic systems for internal HR perspective recruiting. The advantage of this Web-based approach can be seen in statistics that show that in one year, a significant number of positions were filled internally, much higher than previously. When a job opens, Internet programs automatically look in the company database for qualified applicants, and those persons can be notified by e-mail or personal contact. Those individuals can then participate in the firm’s hiring process by registering their profiles easily and quickly. Other internal approaches took more time, and fewer people participated. Thus, these technological changes have helped with employee recruiting for promotions and reduced employers’ time and costs.54 employee turnover, enhancing individuals’ skills and talent, and improving productivity.55 The HR Perspective highlights some of the opportunities of these programs. Although often successful, internal transfer and promotion of employees within the company may have some drawbacks. For instance, a person’s performance on one job may not be a good predictor of performance on another, because different skills may be required on the new job. Also, as employees transfer or are promoted to other jobs, individuals must be recruited to fill the vacated jobs. Planning on how to fill those openings should occur before the job transfers or promotions, not afterward. Employee-Focused Recruiting One reliable source of potential recruits is suggestions from current or former employees. Because current and former employees are familiar with the employer, most of them will not refer individuals who are likely to be unqualified or who will make them look bad for giving the referral. Also, follow-up with former employers is likely to be done only with persons who were solid employees previously. Current-Employee Referrals A reliable source of people to fill vacancies is composed of acquaintances, friends, and family members of current employees. The current employees can acquaint potential applicants with the advantages of a job with the company, furnish e-mails and other means of introduction, and encourage candidates to apply. Word-of-mouth referrals and discussions can positively aid organizational attractiveness and lead to more application decisions by those referred.56 However, using only word-of-mouth or current-employee referrals can violate equal employment regulations if protected-class individuals are underrepresented in the current organizational Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 201 26/06/10 5:10 PM 202 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor workforce. Therefore, some external recruiting might be necessary to avoid legal problems in this area. Utilizing this source is usually one of the most effective methods of recruiting because many qualified people can be reached at a relatively low cost. Some firms indicate that more than 60% of new hires are due to employee referrals.57 In an organization with numerous employees, this approach can develop quite a large pool of potential employees. As an example, Integris Health Institute in Oklahoma used a referral program to hire more than 500 medical technicians and nurses in relatively difficult-to-fill jobs. One key component of this program was a referral incentive, whereby the individuals giving the referrals received up to $1,000 per difficult-to-fill job.58 Employers in many geographic areas and occupational fields have established employee referral incentive programs similar to that at Integris Health Institute. Mid-sized and larger employers are more likely to use employee referral bonuses. Some referral programs provide different bonus amounts for hard-to-fill jobs compared with common openings; in these situations, appropriate legal concerns should be met.59 Rerecruiting of Former Employees and Applicants Former employees and applicants represent another source for recruitment. Both groups offer a time-saving advantage because something is already known about them. Seeking them out as candidates is known as rerecruiting because they were successfully recruited previously. Former employees are considered an internal source in the sense that they have ties to the employer; sometimes they are called “boomerangers” because they left and came back. Individuals who have left for other jobs sometimes are willing to return because the other jobs and employers turned out to be less attractive than initially thought. For example, at Qualcomm, a California-based telecommunications firm, about 70% of former Qualcomm individuals who left voluntarily indicated that they would return if requested.60 The discussion on follow-up of exit interviews in the previous chapter illustrated that rerecruiting can be a key recruiting contribution. To enhance such efforts, some firms have established “alumni reunions” to keep in contact with individuals who have left, and also to allow the companies to rerecruit individuals as appropriate openings arise. Key issues in the decision to rerecruit someone include the reasons why the individual left originally and whether the individual’s performance and capabilities were good. Another potential source consists of former applicants. Although they are not entirely an internal source, information about them can be found in the organizational files or an applicant database. Recontacting those who have previously applied for jobs can be a quick and inexpensive way to fill unexpected openings. For instance, one firm that needed two cost accountants immediately contacted qualified previous applicants and was able to hire two persons who were disenchanted with their current jobs at other companies. RECRUITING EVALUATION AND METRICS To determine how effective various recruiting sources and methods have been, it is important to evaluate recruiting efforts. But in a survey, a majority of HR executives identified that their firms were not getting sufficient metrics on the quality of hires and how well the new hires fit into the organizations.61 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 202 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 203 Recruiting and Labor Markets The primary way to find out whether recruiting efforts are financially effective is to conduct formal analyses as part of recruiting evaluation. An evaluation done by a consulting firm found that higher shareholder value occured when using time of successful recruiting as a metric. If recruiting was completed within two weeks, the study noted that the total return to shareholders was about 60%, compared to about 10% for companies that needed more than seven weeks to fill job openings. Also, greater use of employee referrals produced a much higher return to shareholders than use of other recruiting means.62 Various areas can be measured when evaluating recruiting. Figure 6-9 indicates key recruiting measurement areas in which employers frequently conduct evaluations. Evaluating Recruiting Quantity and Quality To evaluate recruiting, organizations can see how their recruiting efforts compare with past patterns and with the recruiting performance of other organizations. Measures of recruiting effectiveness can be used to see whether sufficient numbers of targeted population groups are being attracted. For example, one area of concern in recruiting might be protected category persons. In Chicago, a network-based recruiting firm received only 16 black and 4 Hispanic applicants out of 276 persons for a customer service job. Yet Chicago has 37% blacks and 26% Hispanics in its population. Clearly, the efforts to increase recruiting in these racial/ethnic groups needed major attention.63 Information about job performance, absenteeism, cost of training, and turnover by recruiting source also helps adjust future recruiting efforts. For example, some companies find that recruiting at certain colleges or universities furnishes stable, high performers, whereas recruiting at other schools provides employees who are more prone to leave the organization. General metrics for evaluating recruiting include quantity and quality of applicants. FIGURE 6-9 Recruiting Measurement Areas Recruits: Quantity and Quality Time to Fill Openings Costs per Recruiting Method Recruitment Satisfaction Analyses Recruiting Measurement Metric Areas Process Metrics Yield Ratios Selection Rates Acceptance Rates Success Base Rates Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 203 26/06/10 5:10 PM 204 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Quantity of Applicants Because the goal of a good recruiting program is to generate a large pool of applicants from which to choose, quantity is a natural place to begin evaluation. The basic measure here considers whether the quantity of recruits is sufficient to fill job vacancies. A related question is: Does recruiting at this source provide enough qualified applicants with an appropriate mix of protected-class individuals? Quality of Applicants In addition to quantity, a key issue is whether or not the qualifications of the applicant pool are sufficient to fill the job openings. Do the applicants meet job specifications, and do they perform the jobs well after hire? What is the failure rate for new hires for each recruiter? Measures that can be used include items such as performance appraisal scores, months until promotion, production quantity, and sales volume for each hire. Evaluating Recruiting Satisfaction The satisfaction of two groups is useful in evaluating recruiting. Certainly the views of managers with openings to fill are important, because they are “customers” in a very real sense. But the applicants (those hired and those not hired) also are an important part of the process and can provide useful input. Managers can respond to questions about the quality of the applicant pool, the recruiter’s service, the timeliness of the process, and any problems that they see. Applicants might provide input on how they were treated, their perceptions of the company, and the length of the recruiting process and other aspects. Evaluating the Time Required to Fill Openings Looking at the length of time it takes to fill openings is a common means of evaluating recruiting efforts.64 If openings are not filled quickly with qualified candidates, the work and productivity of the organization are likely to suffer. If it takes 45 days to fill empty positions, managers who need those employees will be unhappy. Also, as noted earlier, unfilled positions cost money. Generally, it is useful to calculate the average amount of time it takes from contact to hire for each source of applicants, because some sources may produce recruits faster than others. For example, one firm calculated the following averages for nonexempt, warehouse and manufacturing jobs: Source Internet applicants Employment agencies Walk-in candidates Employee referrals Average Time from Contact to Hire 32 25 17 12 days days days days These data revealed that, at least for this firm, the Internet methods and use of employment agencies took significantly longer to fill the openings than did relying on other means. Matching the use of sources to the time available showed that employee referrals resulted in faster recruiting results for that particular group of jobs. However, different results might occur when filling executive jobs or highly skilled network technician jobs. Overall, analyses need to be made both organization-wide and by different types of jobs. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 204 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 205 Recruiting and Labor Markets Evaluating the Cost of Recruiting Different formulas can be used to evaluate recruiting costs. The calculation most often used to measure such costs is to divide total recruiting expenses for the year by the number of hires for the year: Recruiting expenses Number of recruits hired The problem with this approach is accurately identifying what details should be included in the recruiting expenses. Should expenses for testing, background checks, relocations, or signing bonuses be included, or are they more properly excluded? Once those questions are answered, the costs can be allocated to various sources to determine how much each hire from each source costs. It is logical that employers should evaluate the cost of recruiting as a primary metric. Recruiting costs might include costs for employment agencies, advertising, internal sources, external means, and others.65 The costs also can be sorted by type of job—costs for hiring managers, secretaries, bookkeepers, and sales personnel will all be different. Certainly, cost is an issue, and some employers are quite concerned about cost per hire, but quality might be the trade-off. For example, if an organizational HR strategy focuses on quality as a competitive advantage, a company might choose to hire only from the top 15% of candidates for critical jobs. General Recruiting Process Metrics Because recruiting activities are important, the costs and benefits associated with them should be analyzed. A cost–benefit analysis of recruiting efforts may include both direct costs (advertising, recruiters’ salaries, travel, agency fees, etc.) and indirect costs (involvement of operating managers, public relations, image, etc.). Cost–benefit information on each recruiting source can be calculated. Comparing the length of time that applicants hired from each source stay in the organization with the cost of hiring from that source also offers a useful perspective. Yield Ratios One means for evaluating recruiting efforts is yield ratios, which compare the number of applicants at one stage of the recruiting process with the number at another stage. The result is a tool for approximating the necessary size of the initial applicant pool. It is useful to visualize yield ratios as a pyramid in which the employer starts with a broad base of applicants that progressively narrows. As Figure 6-10 depicts, to end up with five hires for the job in question, a sample company must begin with 100 applicants in the pool, as long as yield ratios remain as shown. A different approach to using yield ratios suggests that over the length of time, organizations can develop ranges for crucial ratios. When a given indicator ratio falls outside that range, it may indicate problems in the recruiting process. As an example, in college recruiting the following ratios might be useful: Yield ratio Comparison of the number of applicants at one stage of the recruiting process with the number at the next stage. College seniors given second interviews = Range of 30%–50% Total number of seniors interviewed Number who accept offer = Range of 50%–70% Number invited to the company to visit Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 205 26/06/10 5:10 PM 206 SECTION 2 FIGURE 6-10 Jobs and Labor Sample Recruiting Evaluation Pyramid Hires / Offer recipients (Yield ratio ⴝ 50%) 5/10 Hires ⴝ 5 Offer recipients ⴝ 10 Offer recipients / Final interviewees (Yield ratio ⴝ 66%) 10/15 Hires / Total initial contacts (Selection rate ⴝ 5%) 5/100 Final interviewees ⴝ 15 Final interviewees / Initial contacts (Yield ratio ⴝ 15%) 15/100 Formal applicants ⴝ 30 Total initial contacts ⴝ 100 Number hired = Range of 70%–80% Number offered a job Number finally hired = Range of 10%–20% Total number interviewed on campus Selection rate Percentage hired from a given group of candidates. Acceptance rate Percent of applicants hired divided by total number of applicants offered jobs. Selection Rate Another useful calculation is the selection rate, which is the percentage hired from a given group of candidates. It equals the number hired divided by the number of applicants; for example, a rate of 30% indicates that 3 out of 10 applicants were hired. The selection rate is also affected by the validity of the selection process. A relatively unsophisticated selection program might pick 8 out of 10 applicants for the job. Four of those might turn out to be good employees. A more valid selection process might pick 5 out of 10 applicants but all perform well. Selection rate measures not just recruiting but selection issues as well. So do acceptance rate and success base rate. Acceptance Rate Calculating the acceptance rate helps identify how successful the organization is at hiring candidates. The acceptance rate is the percent of applicants hired divided by the total number of applicants offered jobs. After the company goes through all the effort to screen, interview, and make job offers, hopefully most candidates accept job offers. If they do not, Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 206 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 Recruiting and Labor Markets 207 then HR might want to look at reasons why managers and HR staff cannot “close the deal.” It is common for HR staff members to track the reasons candidates turn down job offers. That analysis helps explain the rejection rate in order to learn how competitive the employer is compared with other employers and what factors are causing candidates to choose employment elsewhere. Success Base Rate A longer-term measure of recruiting effectiveness is the success rate of applicants. The success base rate can be determined by comparing the number of past applicants who have become successful employees against the number of applicants they competed against for their jobs, using historical data within the organization. Also, the success base rate can be compared with the success rates of other employers in the area or industry using benchmarking data. This rate indicates whether the quality of the employees hired results in employees who perform well and have low turnover. For example, assume that if 10 people were hired at random, it might be expected that 4 of them would be satisfactorily performing employees. Thus, a successful recruiting program should be aimed at attracting the 4 in 10 who are capable of doing well on this particular job. Realistically, no recruiting program will attract only the people who will succeed in a particular job. However, efforts to make the recruiting program attract the largest proportion possible of those in the base rate group can make recruiting efforts more productive in both the short and long term. Increasing Recruiting Effectiveness Evaluation of recruiting should be used to make recruiting activities more effective. Some common activities that are reviewed during evaluation are: • • • • • • Résumé mining—a software approach to getting the best résumés for a fit from a big database Applicant tracking—an approach that takes an applicant all the way from a job listing to performance appraisal results Employer career website—a convenient recruiting place on an employer’s website where applicants can see what jobs are available and apply Internal mobility—a system that tracks prospects in the company and matches them with jobs as they come open Realistic job previews—a process that persons can use to get details on the employer and the jobs Responsive recruitment—whereby applicants receive timely responses Recruiting effectiveness can be increased by using the evaluation data to target different applicant pools, tap broader labor markets, change recruiting methods, improve internal handling and interviewing of applicants, and train recruiters and managers. Another key way to increase recruiting effectiveness rests with the recruiters themselves. Those involved in the recruiting process can either turn off recruits or create excitement. For instance, recruiters who emphasize positive aspects about the jobs and their employers can enhance recruiting effectiveness. Thus, it is important that recruiters communicate well with applicants and treat them fairly and professionally. Effective recruiting is a crucial factor for HR management, as it leads to selecting individuals for employment who will enhance organizational success. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 207 26/06/10 5:10 PM 208 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor S U M M A R Y • Recruiting is the process of generating a pool of qualified applicants for organizational jobs through a series of activities. • Recruiting must be viewed strategically as tied to HR planning, and discussions should be held about the relevant labor markets in which to recruit. • The components of labor markets are labor force population, applicant population, and the applicant pool. • Labor markets can be categorized by geographic area, industry, occupation, qualifications, and other characteristics. • Employers must make decisions about organization-based versus outsourced recruiting, regular versus flexible staffing, and other aspects of recruiting. • Efforts should be made to recruit a diverse workforce, including older workers, individuals with disabilities, women, and members of racial/ ethnic groups. • Internet recruiting has grown in use through job boards, various websites, social networking, and special technology methods. • While Internet recruiting may be able to save costs and time, it also can generate more C R I T I C A L • • • • T H I N K I N G 1. What labor markets should be considered when recruiting to fill an opening for a sales representative for a pharmaceutical manufacturer? 2. Discuss ways a regional bank could use the Internet effectively to recruit loan officer professionals. 3. Describe how a local firm might be able to utilize college/university interns to generate H R • unqualified applicants and may not reach certain groups of potential applicants. The decision to use internal or external recruiting sources should consider both the advantages and disadvantages of each source. The most common external recruiting sources are media sources, competitive sources, labor unions, employment agencies, job fairs and special events, and educational institutions. The most common methods of internal recruiting include organizational databases, job postings, promotions and transfers, current-employee referrals, and rerecruiting of former employees and applicants. Recruiting efforts should be evaluated as part of utilizing HR measurement to assess the effectiveness of the methods and approaches. Recruiting evaluation using recruiting metrics typically includes evaluating recruiting quantity and quality, tracking the time to fill openings, examining the costs and benefits of various recruiting sources, and determining recruiting satisfaction. E X P E R I E N T I A L Your small marketing company of about 50 workers has traditionally recruited employees using newspaper print advertisements. Due to diminished recruiting efforts from your ads, the company is interested in using more Internet and social media recruiting. The company President has requested that you, as HR Manager, prepare an overview A C T I V I T I E S future applicants for jobs planned within the next one to two years. 4. Assume you are going to look for a current job of interest to you. Utilize broad websites such as www.Job.com, Yahoo! HotJobs, Monster, Taleo, and others to learn about job possibilities for yourself. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G of how Internet recruiting efforts will be different from the traditional methods used by the company. You will need to make a case for why the company should transition to Internet recruiting and identify the benefits for doing so. To prepare an overview, review the resources found at http://www.recruitersnetwork.com/ Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 208 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 209 Recruiting and Labor Markets 1. What will your company need to do differently to actively use Internet recruiting as you compete with other employers for qualified applicants? 2. As you recruit marketing professionals, identify the niche websites that you recommend be used for your Internet postings and the reasons for your recommendations. C A S E Recruiting at Kia As economic conditions became more demanding for some employers, other firms continued to recruit people for jobs. One firm, Kia Motors America, added a large number of jobs at one of its newer facilities. As a subsidiary of a South Korean corporation, Kia Motors America added tons of equipment at its West Point, Georgia, plant, so that ultimately about 300,000 vehicles would be produced annually. As the firm sought recruits to fill its Georgia plant workforce, more than 40,000 individuals applied for the jobs, the bulk of which were production and maintenance positions. However, the need for people in a variety of other occupations, including air-conditioning service people, cafeteria workers, and medical staff, added to the depth and scope of Kia’s recruiting. A limited time frame for applications was set by Kia as part of its recruitment planning. In the recruiting process, a variety of regional and area sources were contacted as part of the Kia broad publicity and inclusive efforts in the area. Randy Jackson, HR Director, spent a month visiting colleges and churches, appearing on radio and television shows, and using other means to market Kia’s recruiting and employment efforts. All of these activities were done to inform applicants about the numerous jobs at Kia and the monthlong time frame for application. To make its recruiting system effective in screening the large number of applicants, Kia established an online-only application process on a special website. As part of its recruiting efforts, Kia and a Georgia Department of Labor agency worked together. One of the agency activities was to make computers available at a local technical college, libraries, and other locations for those persons without home-based Internet. Having the online system allowed Kia’s HR staff to move quickly to identify those applicants who matched available jobs. The use of this system by HR recruiters and managers doing the hiring made the selection process more efficient. To aid in the selection of employees, recruiting software was used to sort applicants into electronic “buckets,” divided by work experiences and education. Then an eight-step process was established to let applicants obtain a realistic job preview of working at Kia. These recruiting actions resulted in the hiring of more than 500 new employees within six months. During the rest of the year, an additional 1,200 workers were hired, primarily for the second shift, and more were hired later. Although smaller employers might not use such an extensive recruiting process, the Kia process illustrates the kinds of recruiting planning, activities, Internet linkages, and other means that can be used by both large and small employers doing recruiting. The long-term success of Kia’s efforts to staff its Georgia operation demonstrates ways in which HR can use both time- and costeffective recruiting to hire qualified individuals.66 QUESTIONS 1. Describe how employing a large number of new workers requires strategic recruiting planning and operational efforts, and discuss what aspects might be different in smaller firms. 2. Discuss how utilizing the Internet, like Kia did and other employers do, is changing how recruiting efforts are occurring for a variety of jobs in employers of different sizes. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 209 26/06/10 5:10 PM 210 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Northwest State College Enterprise Recruiting This case shows how recruiting policies can work against successful recruiting when a tight labor market exists. (For the case, go to www.cengage .com/management/mathis.) This case highlights how a large car rental firm uses a range of recruiting approaches successfully. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/ management/mathis.) N O T E S 1. Based on John Flanigan, “Capturing & Captivating the Passive Job Seeker,” Best Practices in Candidate Sourcing, Workforce Management, 2008; Amitai Givertz, “Passive Candidate Recruiting,” ZoomInfo White Paper, 2008, www.zoominfo.com. 2. Rick Be, “Employment Doldrums May Be Easing, Survey Notes,” Workforce Management Online, August 25, 2009, www.workforce.com. 3. “Ethics as Recruiting Tool,” Journal of Accountancy, January 2009, 21. 4. “What SmBs Should Look for in an Applicant Tracking System,” September 25, 2009, www.taleo.com. 5. John Yuva, “Round Up the Recruits,” Inside Supply Management, July 2008, 23–25; Auren Hoffman, “Why Hiring Is Paradoxically Harder in a Downturn,” HR Leaders, July 14, 2009, www.hrleaders.org. 6. U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, www.bls.gov. 7. Joe Barrett, “Manufacturers Get Top Talent for Hard-to-Fill Jobs,” The Wall Street Journal, May 30, 2009, A5. 8. “Recruiting for Small Firms,” Journal of Accountancy, December 2008, 40. 9. Kurt Scott, “The Search for Effective Physician Leaders,” Physician Executive, March/April 2009, 44–48. 10. Theresa Minton-Eversole, “Mission: Recruitment,” HR Magazine, January 2009, 43–45. 11. Bill Roberts, “Manage Candidates Right from the Start,” HR Magazine, October 2008, 73–76. 12. Rita Zeidner, “Does the United States Need Foreign Workers?” HR Magazine, June 2009, 42–49; 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. Paul Gallagher, “H-1B Headaches,” Human Resource Executive, April 2009, 23–27; Jessica E. Vascellero and Justin Scheck, “Justice Department Probes Hiring Practices in Silicon Valley,” The Wall Street Journal, June 4, 2009, B3. John Sullivan, “Countercyclical Hiring: The Greatest Recruiting Opportunities in the Last 25 Years,” Electronic Resource Exchange, August 24, 2009, www.ere.net. Based on Mark Schoeff, Jr., “Managing Change: USDA Food Safety and Inspection Service,” Workforce Management, October 20, 2008, 26. “What Is Recruitment Process Outsourcing?” Recruitment Process Outsourcing Association, June 2009, www.RPOassociation.org. Beth Ellyn Rosenthal, “GE Looks to Recruitment Process Outsourcing . . .,” Outsourcing Journal, October 2006, 1–4. Justin Lahart, “Employers Shed Fewer Temp Workers,” The Wall Street Journal, September 5–6, 2009, A2; Patrick Buckley, et al., “The Use of Automated Employment Recruiting and Screening System for Temporary Professional Employees,” Human Resource Management, 43 (2004), 233–241. Keisha-Ann G. Gray, “Dividing Lines,” Human Resource Executive Online, September 8, 2009, www.hreonline.com. “Study Ranks Top Diversity Hiring Tools,” WorldatWork Newsline, August 21, 2008, www.worldatwork.org. Gina Ruiz, “Goodwill Offers Recruiting Ideas on Training Hispanic Workers,” Workforce Management, May 2007, www.workforce.com. 21. Joanna N. Lahey, “Age, Women, and Hiring,” Journal of Human Resources, 43 (2008), 30–56. 22. Mark L. Lengnick-Hall, et al., “Overlooked and Underutilized: People with Disabilities Are an Untapped Human Resource,” Human Resource Management, 47 (2008), 255–273. 23. Brendan J. Morse and Paula M. Popovich, “Realistic Recruitment Practices in Organizations,” Human Resource Management Review, 19 (2009), 1–8; William Gardner, et al., “Attraction to Organizational Culture Profiles: Effects of Realistic Recruiting . . .,” Management Communication Quarterly, 22 (2009), 437–472. 24. “E-Recruiting Software Providers,” Workforce Management, June 22, 2009, 14. 25. “New Job Search Engine Makes Finding a Job Easier,” The Career News, September 21, 2009, www.thecareernews.com. 26. For details, go to www.shrm.org/jpc. 27. Emma Parry and Shaun Tyson, “An Analysis of the Use and Success of OnLine Recruitment Methodism in the U.K.,” Human Resource Management Journal, 18 (2008), 257–274. 28. Steven D. Maurer and Yupin Liu, “Developing Effective E-Recruiting Websites: Insights for Managers from Marketers,” Business Horizons, 50 (2007), 305–314. 29. Lori Foster Thompson, et al., “E-Recruitment and the Benefits of Organizational Web Appeal,” Human Behavior, 24 (2008), 2384–2398. 30. Dan Schaubel, “Skip Job Boards and Use Social Media Instead,” BusinessWeek Online, July 29, 2009, 14. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 210 26/06/10 5:10 PM CHAPTER 6 211 Recruiting and Labor Markets 31. Chris Tratar, “Recruiting by Relationship to Fill the Candidate Pipeline,” Workforce Management, July 20, 2009, S5. 32. Vangie Sison, “Social Media: Attracting Talent in the Age of Web 2.0,” Workspan, May 2009, 45–49; Sam De Kay, “Are BusinessOriented Social Networking Websites Useful Resources for Locating Passive Job Seekers?” Business Communications Quarterly, March 2009, 101–104. 33. Gonzado Hernandez and Ed Frauenheim, “Logging Off of Job Boards,” Workforce Management, June 22, 2009, 25–28. 34. Juki Hasson, “Blogging for Talent,” HR Magazine, October 2007, 65–68. 35. Andrew R. McIlvaine, “Lights, Camera, Interview,” Human Resource Executive, September 16, 2009, 22–25; Rita Zeidner, “Companies Tell Their Stories in Recruitment Videos,” HR Trendbook, 2008, 28. 36. Michael O’Brien, “Building a Buzz,” Human Resource Executive, June 16, 2008, 36–38. 37. Adrienne Fox, “Newest Social Medium Has Recruiters All-aTwitter,” HR Disciplines, June 24, 2009, www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines. 38. Tracy Cote and Traci Armstrong, “Why Tweeting Has Become an Ad Agency’s Main Job Posting Strategy . . .?” Workforce Management Online, May 2009, www.workforce.com. 39. For details and current status, go to www.ftc.gov. Also see Ed Fraurnheim and Rich Bell, “A Tighter Rein on HR Blogging?” Workforce Management Online, September 2009, www.workforce.com. 40. Tresa Baidas, “Lawyers Warn Employers Against Giving Glowing Reviews on LinkedIn,” National Law Journal, July 6, 2009, www.nlj.com. 41. Marcel J. H. Van Birgelen, et al., “Effectiveness of Corporate Employment Web Sites,” 42. 43. 44. 45. 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52. 53. 54. International Journal of Manpower, 29 (2008), 731–751. Caren B. Goldberg and David G. Allen, “Black and White and Read All Over: Race Differences in Reactions to Recruitment Web Sites,” Human Resource Management, 47 (2008), 217–236. Gary Crispin, “The Future of Recruiting,” Human Resource Executive, September 16, 2009, 32–35. Eric Robbins and Forest Myers, “The Staffing Challenges Lie Ahead for Community Banks,” RMA Journal, April 2009, 18–23. Mo Edjlali, “The 2 Keys to Killer Job Ads,” Electronic Recruiting Exchange, July 27, 2006, www.ere.net. Stephanie Overman, “Searching for the Top,” HR Magazine, January 2008, 47–52. Fay Hansen, “Recruiters Seeking Untapped Talent Among Outplacement Firms,” Workforce Management Online, March 2009. Theresa Minton-Eversole, “Companies Plan Modest Hiring of 2009 College Graduates,” HR Disciplines, April 17, 2009, www.shrm.org/hrdisciplines. George Violette and Douglas Chene, “Campus Recruiting: What Local and Regional Accounting Firms Look for in New Hires,” CPA Journal, December 2008, 66–68. Donna M. Owens, “College Recruiting in a Downturn,” HR Magazine, April 2009, 51–54. Jonnelle Marte, “An Internship from Your Couch,” The Wall Street Journal, September 29, 2009, D1. Bill Kutik, “Still Trying to Get Recruiting Right,” Human Resource Executive Online, April 6, 2009, www.hreonline.com/HRE. Peter Weddle, “The Really Big Impact of a Small Number of Sentient Specifics,” Dice Review, July 2009, http://marketing.dice.com. Kathryn Tyler, “Helping Employees Step Up,” HR Magazine, August 1, 2007, 48. 55. Sarah E. Needleman, “New Career, Same Employer,” The Wall Street Journal, April 21, 2008, B9. 56. Greet Von Hoye and Filip Lievens, “Tapping the Grapevine: A Closer Look at Word-of-Mouth as a Recruitment Source,” Journal of Applied Psychology, 94 (2009), 341–352. 57. Robert Gandossy and Tina Kao, “The Right People, Right Now . . .,” WorkSpan, December 2007, 71–74. 58. Leo Jakobson, “Nursing: A Referral Program,” Incentive, April 2007, 36–39. 59. “What Issue Should We Consider in Implementing Employee Referral Program?” HRCompliance, August 15, 2009, www.hrcompliance .cerdian.com. 60. Michael O’Brien, “Gone, But Not Forgotten,” Human Resource Executive, September 2, 2009, 30–33. 61. Stephanie Overman, “Staffing Management: Measure What Matters,” Staffing Management, October 1, 2008, www.shrm.org. 62. Ed Emerman, “Effective Recruiting Tied to Strong Financial Performance,” Watson-Wyatt Workside, 2009, www.watsonwyatt .com/news. 63. Fay Hansen, “Sourcing Disappears as Applications Pile Up for Overwhelmed Recruiters,” Workforce Management Online, July 23, 2009, www.workforce.com. 64. “Building Championship Recruiting Teams,” Staffing Exclusives, April 14, 2009, www. StaffingInstitute.org. 65. Alice Snell, “Focus on Process to Reduce Your Recruiting Costs,” Best Practices in Recruitment, 2009, www.workforce.com, S5. 66. Based on Julie Cook Ramirez, “Engines of Growth,” Human Resource Executive, August 2009, 36–39; Larry Copeland, “Kia Breathes Life into Old Georgia Textile Mill Town,” USA Today, March 25, 2010, 5A. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_06_ch06_p176-211.indd 211 26/06/10 5:10 PM C H A P T E R 7 Selecting Human Resources After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Summarize the importance of realistic job previews and application screening efforts to the selection process. • Diagram the sequence of a typical selection process. • Discuss how validity and reliability are related to selection. • Identify three types of selection tests and legal concerns about their uses. • Contrast several types of selection interviews and some key considerations in conducting these interviews. • Specify how legal concerns affect background investigations of applicants and use of medical examinations in the selection process. • Describe the major issues to be considered when selecting candidates for global assignments. 212 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 212 26/06/10 5:12 PM HR Headline Using Virtual Worlds for Selection S ome employers are experimenting with a virtual online community to screen possible hires. The program allows job candidates to create a computer-generated image to represent them and to communicate with employers as if text-messaging. The image is called an “avatar.” The avatar can be used to interview or to attend virtual job fairs. Company representatives also create avatars. The interactions among these creations in a virtual environment become the basis for screening decisions. Those who are less tech-savy are finding that they can shoot themselves in their virtual feet. Some people have a difficult time designing and controlling their avatars. For example, one candidate spent 6 hours working on his avatar and could not figure out how to make him sit in a chair; he finally decided to let him sit on top of the chair instead. Other candidates’ avatars at an online job fair began floating in the air. It is not just applicants who have difficulties. Company representatives are not used to recruiting in the virtual world either. One consulting company partner’s avatar slumped over by accident and looked like it had gone to sleep during an interview. Mishaps involving avatars are usually viewed as amusing. The mistakes can even be icebreakers. One candidate attending the job fair tried to hand a copy of his résumé to a Hewlett-Packard employee and instead handed her a virtual beer. Luckily they both laughed it off, and the candidate was given an opportunity to continue the interview process. Using this virtual interaction is cheaper than holding an actual job fair. Higher-ups in the company who might want to attend can do so easily as avatars. Job seekers seem to be much more relaxed in the virtual environment than they would be at a real job fair, since they have time to think 213 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 213 26/06/10 5:12 PM 214 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor before they type their responses rather than having to think and talk at the same time. Employers say they do not view this as a replacement for traditional selection, but rather as an additional step that can help narrow the field of candidates for some jobs. “This is really a supplement to our regular recruiting practices,” says a manager for Hewlett-Packard.1 Some would argue that picking the right people for the jobs that need to be done is the most important part of human resource management.2 Certainly for a business that depends on good people and good performance for the organization to succeed, its importance is very high. For an organization that is failing, improvement may need to come from many different sources, but it is difficult to imagine appropriate changes coming without some new competent people to carry out those changes. In athletic organizations that are not doing well, it is the selection of new coaches and players that creates improvements, if any are to come, and the continued selection of good athletes and coaches that allows ongoing success. SELECTION AND PLACEMENT Selection is the process of choosing individuals with the correct qualifications needed to fill jobs in an organization. Without these qualified employees, an organization is far less likely to succeed. A useful perspective on selection and placement comes from two HR observations that underscore the importance of effective staffing: • “Hire hard, manage easy.” The investment of time and effort in selecting the right people for jobs will make managing them as employees much less difficult because many problems are eliminated. • “Good training will not make up for bad selection.” When people without the appropriate aptitudes are selected, employers will have difficulty training them to do those jobs that they do not fit.3 Placement Selection The process of choosing individuals with the correct qualifications needed to fill jobs in an organization. Placement Fitting a person to the right job. Person/job fit Matching the KSAs of individuals with the characteristics of jobs. The ultimate purpose of selection is placement, or fitting a person to the right job. Placement of human resources should be seen primarily as a matching process. How well an employee is matched to a job can affect the amount and quality of the employee’s work, as well as the training and operating costs required to prepare the individual for work life. Further, employee morale is an issue because good fit encourages individuals to be positive about their jobs and what they accomplish.4 Selection and placement activities typically focus on applicants’ knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs), but they should also focus on the degree to which job candidates generally match the situations experienced both on the job and in the company. Psychologists label this person-environment fit. In HR it is usually called person/job fit. Fit is related not only to satisfaction with work but also to commitment to a company, and to quitting intentions. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 214 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 215 Lack of fit between KSAs and job requirements can be classified as a “mismatch.” A mismatch results from poor pairing of a person’s needs, interests, abilities, personality, and expectations with characteristics of the job, rewards, and the organization in which the job is located. Five mismatch situations are:5 • • • • • Skills/job qualifications Geography/job location Time/amount of work Earnings/expectations Work/family Mismatches related to skills/job qualifications and amount of work/time required are likely to cause a person to change jobs to improve fit. The other kinds of mismatches have more to do with conflicts of interests. What makes placement difficult and complex is the need to match people and jobs on multiple dimensions.6 People already working in jobs can help identify the most important KSAs for success as part of job analysis. The fit between the individual and job characteristics is particularly important when dealing with overseas assignments because employees must have the proper personalities, skills, and interpersonal abilities to be effective in the international environment. In addition to the match between people and jobs, employers are concerned about the congruence between peoLOGGING ON ple and companies, or the person/organization fit.7 Person/ HR-Guide.com organization fit is important from a “values” perspective, This website offers links to HR websites with many organizations trying to positively link a person’s relating to selection and staffing principles to the values of the company. Organizations tend resources, including information on to favor job applicants who effectively blend into how methods, best practices, tests, and business is conducted. Person/organization fit can influence software programs. Visit the site at employees’ and customers’ beliefs about the organization, www.hr-guide.com. making this fit a key selection consideration. Selection, Criteria, Predictors, and Job Performance Person/organization fit The congruence between individuals and organizational factors. Selection criterion Characteristic that a person must possess to successfully perform work. Predictors of selection criteria Measurable or visible indicators of selection criteria. Regardless of whether an employer uses specific KSAs or a more general approach, effective selection of employees involves using selection criteria and predictors of these criteria. At the heart of an effective selection system must be the knowledge of what constitutes good job performance. When one knows what good performance looks like on a particular job, the next step is to identify what it takes for the employee to achieve successful performance. These are called selection criteria. A selection criterion is a characteristic that a person must possess to successfully perform work. Figure 7-1 shows that ability, motivation, intelligence, conscientiousness, appropriate risk, and permanence might be selection criteria for many jobs. Selection criteria that might be more specific to managerial jobs include “leading and deciding,” “supporting and cooperating,” “organizing and executing,” and “enterprising and performing.”8 To determine whether candidates might possess certain selection criteria (such as ability and motivation), employers try to identify predictors of selection criteria that are measurable or visible indicators of those positive characteristics (or criteria). For example, as Figure 7-1 indicates, three good predictors of “permanence” might be individual interests, salary requirements, and tenure on previous jobs. If a candidate possesses appropriate amounts of any or all of these predictors, it might be assumed that the person would stay on the job longer than someone without those predictors.9 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 215 26/06/10 5:12 PM 216 SECTION 2 FIGURE 7-1 Jobs and Labor Job Performance, Selection Criteria, and Predictors The information gathered about an applicant through predictors should focus on the likelihood that the individual will execute the job competently once hired. Predictors can be identified through many formats such as application forms, tests, interviews, education requirements, and years of experience, but such factors should be used only if they are found to be valid predictors of specific job performance.10 Using invalid predictors can result in selecting the “wrong” candidate and rejecting the “right” one. Validity Correlation coefficient Index number that gives the relationship between a predictor variable and a criterion variable. Concurrent validity Measured when an employer tests current employees and correlates the scores with their performance ratings. In selection, validity is the correlation between a predictor and job performance. In other words, validity occurs to the extent that the predictor actually predicts what it is supposed to predict. Several different types of validity are used in selection. Most validity decisions use a correlation coefficient, an index number that gives the relationship between a predictor variable and a criterion (or dependent) variable. Correlations always range from −1.0 to +1.0, with higher absolute scores suggesting stronger relationships. Concurrent validity is one method for establishing the validity associated with a predictor. Concurrent validity uses current employees to validate a predictor or “test.” As shown in Figure 7-2, concurrent validity is measured when an employer tests current employees and correlates the scores with Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 216 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 217 Selecting Human Resources FIGURE 7-2 Concurrent and Predictive Validity Concurrent Validity Predictive Validity Current Employees Applicants Review Job Performance (past records) Give Employment Test Give Employment Test Hire Applicants without Considering Tests Measure Job Performance Success Score the Test Score the Test Evaluate Job Performance (later) Compare Results Compare Results Measure Job Performance Success If Correlation Is Significant, Validity Exists Correlation Can Be Used as a Predictor of Job Success with Future Applicants Predictive validity Measured when test results of applicants are compared with subsequent job performance. their performance ratings on such measures as their scores on performance appraisals. A disadvantage of the concurrent validity approach is that employees who have not performed satisfactorily at work are probably no longer with the firm and therefore cannot be tested. Also, extremely good employees may have been promoted or may have left the company for better work situations. Any learning on the job also might confound test scores. Another method for establishing criterion-related validity is predictive validity. To calculate predictive validity, test results of applicants are compared with their subsequent job performance (see Figure 7-2). Job success is measured by assessing factors such as absenteeism, accidents, errors, and performance appraisal ratings. If the employees who had one year of experience at the time of hire demonstrate better performance than those without such Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 217 26/06/10 5:12 PM 218 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor experience, then the experience requirement can be considered a valid predictor of job performance. In addition, individual experience may be utilized as an important “selection criterion” when making future staffing decisions. The Equal Employment Opportunity Commission (EEOC) has favored predictive validity because it includes the full range of performance and test scores. However, establishing predictive validity can be challenging for managers because a large sample of individuals is needed (usually at least 30) and a significant amount of time must transpire (perhaps one year) to facilitate the analysis. Because of these limitations, other types of validity calculations tend to be more popular. Reliability Reliability of a predictor or “test” is the extent to which it repeatedly produces the same results over time. For example, if a person took a test in December and scored 75, and then took the same test again in March and scored 76, the exam is probably a reliable instrument. Consequently, reliability involves the consistency of predictors used in selection procedures. A predictor that is not reliable is of no value in selection. Combining Predictors If an employer chooses to use only one predictor, such as a pencil-and-paper test, to select the individuals to be hired, the decision becomes straightforward. If the test is valid and encompasses a major dimension of a job, and an applicant does well on the test, then that person should be given a job offer. When an employer uses predictors such as “three years of experience,” “possesses a college degree,” and “acceptable aptitude test score,” job applicants are evaluated on all of these requirements and the multiple predictors must be combined in some way. Two approaches for combining predictors are: • • Multiple hurdles: A minimum cutoff is set on each predictor, and each minimum level must be “passed.” For example, in order to be hired, a candidate for a sales representative job must achieve a minimum education level, a certain score on a sales aptitude test, and a minimum score on a structured interview. Compensatory approach: Scores from individual predictors are added and combined into an overall score, thereby allowing a higher score on one predictor to offset, or compensate for, a lower score on another. The combined index takes into consideration performance on all predictors. For example, when admitting students into graduate business programs, a higher overall score on an admissions test might offset a lower undergraduate grade point average. Selection Responsibilities Selection is a key responsibility for all managers and supervisors in a company. However, organizations vary in how they allocate selection responsibilities between HR specialists and operating managers. The typical selection responsibilities are shown in Figure 7-3. The need to meet EEO requirements and the inherent strategic implications of the staffing function have caused many companies to place greater emphasis on hiring procedures and techniques and to centralize selection in the HR department. In other companies, each department (or its management team) screens and hires its own personnel. Managers, especially those working in smaller firms, often select their own employees Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 218 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 219 Selecting Human Resources FIGURE 7-3 Typical Division of HR Responsibilities: Selection HR UNIT Provides initial reception for applicants Conducts initial screening interview Administers appropriate employment tests Obtains background and reference information and sets up a physical examination, if used Refers top candidates to managers for final selection Evaluates success of selection process MANAGERS Requisition employees with specific qualifications to fill jobs Participate in selection process as appropriate Interview final candidates Make final selection decision, subject to advice of HR specialist Provide follow-up information on the suitability of selected individuals because these individuals directly impact their work areas. But the validity and effectiveness of this approach may be questionable because of lack of training in selection among operating managers. Another approach has HR professionals initially screening the job candidates, and the managers or supervisors making the final selection decisions from the qualified applicant pool. Generally, the higher the positions being filled, the greater the likelihood that the ultimate hiring decisions will be made by operating managers rather than HR professionals. Selection responsibilities are affected by the existence of a central employment office, which is often housed within a human resources department. In smaller organizations, especially in those with fewer than 100 employees, a full-time employment specialist or group is impractical. But for larger firms, centralizing activities in an employment office might be appropriate. The employment function in any organization may be concerned with some or all of the following activities: (1) receiving applications, (2) interviewing the applicants, (3) administering tests to applicants, (4) conducting background investigations, (5) arranging for physical examinations, (6) placing and assigning new employees, (7) coordinating follow-up of these employees, (8) conducting exit interviews with departing employees, and (9) maintaining appropriate records and reports. THE SELECTION PROCESS Most organizations take a series of consistent steps to process and select applicants for jobs. Company size, job characteristics, the number of people needed, the use of electronic technology, and other factors cause variations on the basic process. Selection can take place in a day or over a much longer period of time, and certain phases of the process may be omitted or the order changed, depending on the employer. If the applicant is processed in one day, the employer usually checks references after selection. Figure 7-4 shows steps in a typical selection process. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 219 26/06/10 5:12 PM 220 SECTION 2 FIGURE 7-4 Jobs and Labor Selection Process Flowchart Applicant Job Interest Preemployment Screening Application Form Test Interview Background Investigation Additional Interview (optional) Conditional Job Offer Medical Exam/Drug Test Job Placement Applicant Job Interest Individuals wanting employment can indicate interest in a number of ways. Traditionally, individuals have submitted résumés by mail or fax, or applied in person at an employer’s location. But with the growth in Internet recruiting, many individuals complete applications online or submit résumés electronically. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 220 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 221 Regardless of how individuals express interest in employment, the selection process has an important public relations dimension. Discriminatory hiring practices, impolite interviewers, unnecessarily long waits, unreturned telephone inquiries, inappropriate testing procedures, and lack of follow-up responses can produce unfavorable impressions of an employer. Job applicants’ perceptions of the organization will be influenced by how they are treated. Realistic Job Previews Many individuals know little about companies before applying for employment. Consequently, when deciding whether to accept a job, they pay particularly close attention to the information received during the selection process, including compensation data, work characteristics, job location, and promotion opportunities. Unfortunately, some employers make jobs appear better than they really are. Realistic job previews provide potential employees with an accurate introduction to a job so that they can better evaluate the employment situation. Indeed, a realistic job preview can directly enhance individual training and clarify a job role. Also, in global assignments, the use of realistic job previews increases individual confidence and improves decision making about an expatriate position. A company should consider several strategies when developing a recruiting brand and conveying it to potential employees via realistic job previews. The brand of the company should establish in the minds of recruits the company’s overall purpose for being in business, and it should honestly portray the jobs that are performed by individuals already employed in the firm. A project director of a recruiting firm suggests that a firm should evaluate its own strengths and develop a list of employment benefits that would make the company attractive to potential employees. These points may include building human capital, good compensation, and ethics and social responsibility. At the same time, a company needs to convey the less attractive aspects of work, such as difficult work schedules or extensive travel. However, any negative job attributes can be outweighed by the positive factors already covered. Truth-in-Hiring Lawsuits Recruiters may exaggerate promotional opportunities, pay, or even the company’s financial position in an attempt to hire a candidate. However, a candidate who leaves a good job to accept a position and later discovers such exaggerations may choose to sue the company for misrepresenting the job. In some cases, recruiters feel such pressure to “sell” the company that they “oversell” it. The best way to avoid truth-in-hiring lawsuits is to use the realistic job preview correctly.11 Preemployment Screening Many employers conduct preemployment screening to determine if applicants meet the minimum qualifications for open jobs before they have the applicants fill out an application. Realistic job preview Process through which a job applicant receives an accurate picture of a job. Electronic Assessment Screening The use of electronic preemployment screening or assessment has grown. Much of this screening utilizes computer software to review the many résumés and application forms received during the recruiting and selection process. Large companies often use different types of software to receive, evaluate, and track the applications of many potential employees. When a job posting generates 1,000 or more applications, which is not unusual with large companies or in difficult economic times, responding to each would be a full-time job. Electronic screening can speed up the process. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 221 26/06/10 5:12 PM 222 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor HR perspective Cheating on Electronic Assessments Many retailers make applicants take an assessment online before interviewing them. If they do not do well on this “test,” they will not be interviewed. Such tests also are given at in-store kiosks so hiring managers can interview high-scoring persons before they leave the store, but 90% of the time these tests are done online. These assessment tests ask applicants to agree or disagree with statements such as “You have to give up on some things that you start” or “Any trouble you have is your own fault.” The tests cut the amount of time store managers spend interviewing and can improve the levels of measured results in areas such as sales performance, turnover, safety, and so on; but the tests also create a culture of cheating and raise questions for some applicants about their “fairness.” Anton Smith took such a test when he applied for hourly work at a sneaker store, but before taking it, he had a friend do a little digging online to find an unauthorized answer key. Then when he took the test, Anton had a good idea how to answer the 130 statements in it. He was hired, but he does not think the test was useful. The test Smith took is called UNICRV, which is used by about 16% of major retailers. The company that designed it believes the incidence of cheating is low and does not affect the benefits to retailers of using it. CVS Caremark is pleased with the test, according to its head of HR, who says, “I think our field organization is happy with the quality of the candidate.” The more critical the test is to getting a job, the more applicants will try to “game” it. They may take it several times, compare notes with other test takers, consult an online cheat sheet, or have a friend take it for them. Mark Scott took the UNICRV test when applying at Circuit City and did not get hired. A friend told him the test disqualified him. He applied to another chain that uses the test, but this time he had a friend who coached him because the friend had taken and passed the test many times. Scott was hired immediately. He observed that the test process “weeds out people who are honest and selects those who lie.” Opportunities to cheat with electronic assessments exist, and people certainly will find them.12 This may take several forms: disqualification questions; screening questions to get at KSAs and experience; valid assessment tests; and background, drug, and financial screening. Some of the assessments might include auditions for the job that are based on simulations of specific job-related tasks. For example, in a call center, candidates are given virtual customers with service problems, and branch manager candidates demonstrate their ability to foster relationships with virtual clients and to make quick personnel decisions with virtual employees.13 A good strategy is to use simple electronic assessment early to cut down the number of applicants before requiring applications or interviews. That leaves a much more qualified list of remaining applicants with which to work.14 However, such assessments have a down side as well, as shown in the HR Perspective. Application Forms Some employers do not use preemployment screening prior to having applicants fill out an application form. Instead, they have every interested individual complete an application first. These completed application forms then become Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 222 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 223 the basis for prescreening information. But collecting, storing, and tracking these forms can create significant work for HR staff members. Application forms, which are used universally, can take on different formats. Properly prepared, the application form serves four purposes: 1. It is a record of the applicant’s desire to obtain a position. 2. It provides the interviewer with a profile of the applicant that can be used during the interview. 3. It is a basic employee record for applicants who are hired. 4. It can be used for research on the effectiveness of the selection process. Many employers use only one application form for all jobs, but others use several different forms depending on the position. For example, a hotel might use one form for management and supervisory staff and another for line employees. Application Disclaimers Application forms should contain disclaimers and notices so that appropriate legal protections are clearly stated. These recommended disclosures include: • Employment-at-will: Indicates the right of the employer or the applicant to terminate employment at any time with or without notice or cause (where applicable by state law) • Reference contacts: Requests permission to contact previous employers listed by the applicant on the application form or résumé • Employment testing: Notifies applicants of required drug tests, penciland-paper tests, physical exams, or electronic or other tests that will be used in the employment decision • Application time limit: Indicates how long application forms are active (typically 6 months), and that persons must reapply or reactivate their applications after that period • Information falsification: Conveys to an applicant that falsification of application information can be grounds for serious reprimand or termination EEO Considerations and Application Forms An organization should retain all applications and hiring-related documents and records for 3 years. Guidelines from the EEOC and court decisions require that the data requested on application forms must be job related. Though frequently found on application forms, questions that ask for the following information are illegal. (See Appendix D for review.) • • • • • • Marital status Height/weight Number and ages of dependents Information on spouse Date of high school graduation Contact in case of emergency Most of the litigation surrounding application forms has involved questions regarding the gender and age of a potential employee, so special consideration should be dedicated to removing any items that relate to these personal characteristics. Concerns about inappropriate questions stem from their potential to elicit information that should not be used in hiring decisions. Figure 7-5 shows a sample application form containing questions that generally are legal. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 223 26/06/10 5:12 PM 224 Jobs and Labor SECTION 2 Sample Application Form FIGURE 7-5 Application for Employment An Equal Opportunity Employer* Today’s Date Please Print or Type PERSONAL INFORMATION Name (Last) Current address (First) (Full middle name) Social Security number State Phone number ( ) E-mail address City What position are you applying for? Zip code Date available for employment? Are you willing Are you willing to Any restrictions on hours, weekends, or overtime? If yes, explain. to relocate? travel if required? Yes No Yes No Have you ever been employed by this Indicate location and dates Company or any of its subsidiaries before? Yes No Can you, after employment, submit verification Have you ever been Convictions will not automatically disqualify of your legal right to work in the United States? convicted of a felony? job candidates. The seriousness of the crime and the date of conviction will be considered. Yes No Yes No PERFORMANCE OF JOB FUNCTIONS Are you able to perform all the functions of the job for which you are applying, with or without accommodation? Yes, without accommodation Yes, with accommodation No If you indicated you can perform all the functions with an accommodation, please explain how you would perform the tasks and with what accommodation. EDUCATION School level School name and address No. of years attended Did you graduate? Course of study High school Vo-tech, business, or trade school College Graduate school PERSONAL DRIVING RECORD This section is to be completed ONLY if the operation of a motor vehicle will be required in the course of the applicant’s employment. How long have you been a licensed driver? Driver’s license number Expiration date Issuing State List any other state(s) in which you have had a driver’s license(s) in the past: Within the past five years, Been convicted of reckless If yes, give dates: have you had a vehicle accident? or drunken driving? Yes No Yes No Has your driver’s license ever been revoked or suspended? Yes No If yes, explain: Been cited for moving violations? If yes, give dates: Yes No Is your driver’s license restricted? Yes If yes, explain: No *We are an Equal Opportunity Employer. We do not discriminate on the basis of race, religion, color, gender, age, national origin, or disability. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 224 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 225 Résumés as Applications Applicants commonly provide background information through résumés. When the situation arises, EEO standards require that an employer treats a résumé as an application form. As such, if an applicant’s résumé voluntarily furnishes some information that cannot be legally obtained, the employer should not use that information during the selection process. Some employers require those who submit résumés to complete an application form as well. Regardless of how the background information is colLOGGING ON lected, companies should be dutiful about checking the UniformGuidelines.com truthfulness of the information presented on résumés and For a free resource on the use of application forms. Various accounts suggest that a noteworselection procedures and tests to thy percentage of applicants knowingly distort their past ensure compliance with federal work experiences. For example, former RadioShack CEO laws, visit this website at www David Edmondson resigned after it was determined that he .uniformguidelines.com. had embellished his educational background.15 Immigration Verification Businesses are required to review and record identity documents, such as Social Security cards, passports, and visas, and to determine if they appear to be genuine. It is illegal to knowingly hire employees who are not in the country legally. The consequences for offending businesses are high; penalties range from $375 to $16,000 per incident and 6 months in prison. If HR personnel know they are working with fraudulent documents, corporate liability exists, and seizure of assets and criminal liability for top management can occur. Immigration and Customs Enforcement (ICE) can audit the records of a business to make certain there has been compliance with employment eligibility laws and rules. Such audits may come from employer filings of government labor documents, disgruntled employees, identity theft complaints, or suspicious patterns of activity.16 Employers must use the revised form I-9 for each employee hired after 1986 and must determine within 72 hours whether an applicant is a U.S. citizen, registered alien, or illegal alien. A government program called E-Verify is run by the Department of Homeland Security to help with this process. The use of E-Verify is mandatory for government contractors or subcontractors.17 An employer should have a policy to comply with immigration requirements and to avoid knowingly hiring or retaining illegal workers. I-9s should be completed, updated, and audited. SELECTION TESTING Many different kinds of tests can be used to help select qualified employees. Literacy tests, skill-based tests, personality tests, and honesty tests are used to assess various individual factors that are important for the work to be performed. These useful employment tests allow companies to predict which applicants will be the most successful before being hired. However, selection tests must be evaluated extensively before being utilized as a recruiting tool. The development of the test items should be linked to a thorough job analysis. Also, initial testing of the items should include an evaluation by knowledge experts, and statistical and validity assessments of the items should be conducted. Furthermore, adequate security of the testing instruments should be coordinated, and the monetary value of these tests to Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 225 26/06/10 5:12 PM 226 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor the firm should be determined. For example, Gerber Products Company was found to be using preemployment selection tests for entry-level positions that did not have sufficient evidence of validity. The tests were negatively impacting minority applicants. Gerber paid 1,912 minority and female applicants $900,000 in back pay and interest.18 Ability Tests Cognitive ability tests Tests that measure an individual’s thinking, memory, reasoning, verbal, and mathematical abilities. Physical ability tests Tests that measure an individual’s abilities such as strength, endurance, and muscular movement. Psychomotor tests Tests that measure dexterity, hand– eye coordination, arm–hand steadiness, and other factors. Work sample tests Tests that require an applicant to perform a simulated task that is a specified part of the target job. Situational judgment tests Tests that measure a person’s judgment in work settings. Tests that assess an individual’s ability to perform in a specific manner are grouped as ability tests. These are sometimes further differentiated into aptitude tests and achievement tests. Cognitive ability tests measure an individual’s thinking, memory, reasoning, verbal, and mathematical abilities. Tests such as these can be used to determine applicants’ basic knowledge of terminology and concepts, word fluency, spatial orientation, comprehension and retention span, general and mental ability, and conceptual reasoning. The Wonderlic Personnel Test and the General Aptitude Test Battery (GATB) are two widely used tests of this type. Managers need to ensure that these tests assess cognitive abilities that are job related.19 Physical ability tests measure an individual’s abilities such as strength, endurance, and muscular movement. At an electric utility, line workers regularly must lift and carry equipment, climb ladders, and perform other physical tasks; therefore, testing of applicants’ mobility, strength, and other physical attributes is job related. Some physical ability tests measure such areas as range of motion, strength and posture, and cardiovascular fitness. As noted later, care should be taken to limit physical ability testing until after a conditional job offer is made, in order to avoid violating the provisions of the Americans with Disabilities Act (ADA). Different skill-based tests can be used, including psychomotor tests, which measure a person’s dexterity, hand–eye coordination, arm–hand steadiness, and other factors. Tests such as the MacQuarie Test for Mechanical Ability can measure manual dexterity for assembly-line workers and others using psychomotor skills regularly. Many organizations use situational tests, or work sample tests, which require an applicant to perform a simulated task that is a specified part of the target job. Requiring an applicant for an administrative assistant’s job to type a business letter as quickly as possible would be one such test. An “in-basket” test is a work sample test in which a job candidate is asked to respond to memos in a hypothetical in-basket that are typical of the problems experienced in that job. Once again, these tests should assess criteria that are embedded in the job that is to be staffed. Situational judgment tests are designed to measure a person’s judgment in work settings. The candidate is given a situation and a list of possible solutions to the problem. The candidate then has to make judgments about how to deal with the situation. Situational judgment tests are a form of job simulation. Assessment Centers An assessment center is not a place but an assessment composed of a series of evaluative exercises and tests used for selection and development. Most often used in the selection process when filling managerial openings, assessment centers consist of multiple exercises and are evaluated by multiple raters. In one assessment center, candidates go through a comprehensive interview, a pencil-and-paper test, individual and group simulations, and work exercises. Individual performance is then evaluated by a panel of trained raters. It is crucial that the tests and exercises in an assessment center reflect the content of the job for which individuals are being screened, and the types Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 226 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 227 Selecting Human Resources of problems faced on that job. For example, a technology communications organization used a series of assessment centers to hire employees who would interact with clients. The company found that these centers improved the selection process and also provided new employees with a good road map for individual development. Personality Tests Personality is a unique blend of individual characteristics that can affect how people interact with their work environment. Many organizations use various personality tests that assess the degree to which candidates’ attributes match specific job criteria. For instance, a sporting goods chain offers job applicants a Web-based test. The test evaluates their personal tendencies, and test scores are used to categorize individuals for the hiring decision. Many types of personality tests are available, including the Minnesota Multiphasic Personality Inventory (MMPI) and the Myers-Briggs test. Although many different personality characteristics exist, some experts believe that there is a relatively small number of underlying major traits. The most widely accepted approach to studying these underlying personality traits (although not the only one) is the “Big Five” personality framework. The Big Five traits are generally considered to be useful predictors of various types of job performance in different occupations. The factors are shown in Figure 7-6. FIGURE 7-6 Big Five Personality Characteristics Conscientiousness Achievement-oriented Careful Hardworking Organized Responsible Agreeableness Cooperative Good-natured Softhearted Tolerant Trusting Extroversion Sociable Gregarious Talkative Openness to Experience Flexible in thought Open to new ideas Broad-minded Curious Original Emotional Stability Neurosis Depression Anger Worry Insecurity Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 227 26/06/10 5:12 PM 228 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Several of the Big Five traits are related to dimensions such as burnout and accident involvement in both work and nonwork contexts. Faking Personality Tests “Faking” is a major concern for employers using personality tests. Many test publishers admit that test profiles can be falsified, and they try to reduce faking by including questions that can be used to compute a social desirability or “lie” score. Researchers also favor the use of “corrections” based on components of the test to account for faking—a preference that also constitutes a strong argument for professional scoring of personality tests.20 Another possibility is use of a “fake warning,” which instructs applicants that faking can be detected and can result in a negative hiring impression. Honesty/Integrity Tests Companies are utilizing different tests to assess the honesty and integrity of applicants and employees. Employers use these tests as a screening mechanism to prevent the hiring of unethical employees, to reduce the frequency of lying and theft on the job, and to communicate to applicants and employees alike that dishonesty will not be tolerated. Honesty/integrity tests can be valid as broad screening devices for organizations if used properly. About 28% of employers use honesty/integrity testing.21 However, these instruments have limitations. For instance, socially desirable responding is a key concern; some questions can be considered overly invasive, insulting, and not job related; sometimes “false positives” are generated (or an honest person is scored as “dishonest”); and test scores might be affected by individual demographic factors such as gender and race. Polygraphs The polygraph, more generally and incorrectly referred to as the “lie detector,” is a mechanical device that measures a person’s galvanic skin response, heart rate, and breathing rate. The theory behind the polygraph is that if a person answers a question incorrectly, the body’s physiological responses will “reveal” the falsification through the recording mechanisms of the polygraph. As a result of concerns about polygraph validity, Congress passed the Employee Polygraph Protection Act, which prohibits the use of polygraphs for preemployment screening purposes by most employers. Federal, state, and local government agencies LOGGING ON are exempt from the act. Also exempted are certain privateVangent Human Capital sector employers such as security companies and pharmaManagement ceutical companies. The act does allow employers to use This consulting firm offers polygraphs as part of internal investigations of thefts or preemployment testing assessments losses. But in those situations, the polygraph test should be and other development tools. Visit their taken voluntarily, and the employee should be allowed to site at www.vangent-hcm.com. end the test at any time. Controversies in Selection Testing Two areas in selection testing generate controversies and disagreements. One is the appropriateness of general mental ability testing, and the other is the validity of personality testing for selection. General mental ability testing is well established as a valid selection tool for many jobs, but since some minority groups tend to score lower on such exams, there is considerable controversy over whether such tests ought to Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 228 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 229 be used.22 When these tests are used, the case for business necessity must be made, and the instrument used should be validated for the organization using it. Personality testing for selection flourished during the 1950s. More than 60% of large companies at one time used it for selection.23 Sears, Standard Oil, and Procter and Gamble used such testing extensively. But in the 1960s researchers concluded that personality is not a good tool for selection, and the use of these tests dropped drastically. In the 1990s, interest in research on personality as a selection tool resurfaced and vendors began selling personalityoriented selection tests. But a seminal research article appearing in Personnel Psychology concluded that personality explains so little about actual job outcomes that we should think very carefully about using it at all for employment decisions.24 The study of personality continues in psychology, and as it evolves, the role of personality in selection will undoubtedly continue to be controversial.25 SELECTION INTERVIEWING Selection interviewing of job applicants is done both to obtain additional information and to clarify information gathered throughout the selection process. Interviews are commonly conducted at two levels: first, as an initial screening interview to determine if the person has met minimum qualifications, and then later, as an in-depth interview with HR staff members and/or operating managers to determine if the person will fit into the designated work area. Before the in-depth interview, information from all available sources is pooled so that the interviewers can reconcile conflicting information that may have emerged from tests, application forms, and references. Interviewing for selection is imperfect and should be focused on gathering valid information that has not been gained in other ways.26 Because selection interviewing is imperfect, the focus must be on techniques that minimize errors and provide the best information.27 Some companies have excessive interview time requirements. For example, one company requires applicants to bring their lunch and spend hours on simulated work tasks, several with tight deadlines.28 However, a court case in California held that temporary employees were owed overtime pay for time spent in job placement interviews.29 Although this case dealt with staffing firm employees, the message is that there may be a limit on how long the employment interviewing process can reasonably go on. Inter-Rater Reliability and Face Validity Interviews must be reliable and allow interviewers, despite their limitations, to pick the same applicant capabilities again and again. High intra-rater reliability (within the same interviewer) can be demonstrated, but only moderateto-low inter-rater reliability (across different interviewers) is generally shown. Inter-rater reliability becomes important when each of several interviewers is selecting employees from a pool of applicants, or if the employer uses team or panel interviews with multiple interviewers. Employers prefer to use interviews over other selection activities because they have high “face validity” (i.e., interviews make sense to employers). It is often assumed that if someone interviews well and the information obtained in Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 229 26/06/10 5:12 PM 230 Jobs and Labor SECTION 2 FIGURE 7-7 Validity and Structure in Selection Interviews Type of Interview Degree of Structure Validity for General Selection Decisions Biographical More More Less Less Behavioral Competency Situational Stress Nondirective the interview is useful, then the individual will be a good hire.30 However, an unstructured interview does not always provide much actual validity, causing a growth in the popularity of structured interviews. As Figure 7-7 shows, various types of selection interviews are used. They range from structured to unstructured, and they vary in terms of appropriateness for selection. Structured Interviews Structured interview Interview that uses a set of standardized questions asked of all applicants. A structured interview uses a set of standardized questions asked of all applicants so that comparisons can be made more easily. This type of interview allows an interviewer to prepare job-related questions in advance and then complete a standardized interviewee evaluation form that provides documentation indicating why one applicant was selected over another.31 The structured interview is useful in the initial screening process because many applicants can be effectively evaluated and compared. However, the structured interview does not have to be rigid. The predetermined questions should be asked in a logical manner but should not be read word for word. The applicants should be allowed adequate opportunity to explain their answers, and interviewers should probe with additional questions until they fully understand the responses. This process can make the structured interview more reliable and valid than other interview approaches. Structured interviews—in any of several forms, including biographical, behavioral, competency, and situational—are useful when making selection decisions. The structured format ensures that a given interviewer has similar information on each candidate. It also ensures that when several interviewers ask the same questions of applicants, there is greater consistency in the subsequent evaluation of those candidates. In fact, it has been recommended that structured interviews be utilized in selection efforts for federal jobs because individual work performance can be better forecasted. However, companies might have to provide additional guidance to enhance interviewers’ implementation of this structure.32 Biographical Interview A biographical interview focuses on a chronological assessment of the candidate’s past experiences. This type of interview is Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 230 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 231 widely used and is often combined with other interview techniques. Overall, the process provides a sketch of past experiences. Behavioral Interview In the behavioral interview technique, applicants are asked to describe how they have performed a certain task or handled a problem in the past, which may predict future actions and show how applicants are best suited for current jobs. A recent study showed that “past behavior” interviews are better at identifying achievement at work than are situational interviews, because they focus on what applicants have actually done in real situations rather than on what they think they might do in hypothetical situations.33 An example of a behavioral interview line of questioning might be: “Tell me about a time when you initiated a project. What was the situation? What did you do? What were the results?” Competency Interview The competency interview is similar to the behavioral interview except the questions are designed to provide the interviewer with something against which to measure the applicant’s response. A competency profile for the position is often utilized, which includes a list of competencies necessary to do that particular job. Using competencies as a benchmark to predict job candidate success is useful because interviewers can identify the factors needed in specific jobs. However, these interviews take time and sometimes benefit articulate or impression management-oriented people. Interviewers must be trained in spotting strong answers for the competencies in question.34 Situational Interview The situational interview contains questions about how applicants might handle specific job situations. Interview questions and possible responses are based on job analysis and checked by job experts to ensure content validity. The interviewer typically codes the suitability of the answer, assigns point values, and adds up the total number of points each interviewee has received. A variation is termed the case study interview, which requires a job candidate to diagnose and correct organizational challenges during the interview. Situational interviews assess what the interviewee would consider to be the best option, not necessarily what they did in a similar situation.35 Less-Structured Interviews Behavioral interview Interview in which applicants give specific examples of how they have performed a certain task or handled a problem in the past. Situational interview Structured interview that contains questions about how applicants might handle specific job situations. Nondirective interview Interview that uses questions developed from the answers to previous questions. Some interviews are done unplanned and are not structured at all. Such interviewing techniques may be appropriate for fact finding, or for counseling interviews. However, they are not best for selection interviewing. These interviews may be conducted by operating managers or supervisors who have had little interview training. An unstructured interview occurs when the interviewer improvises by asking questions that are not predetermined. A semistructured interview is a guided conversation in which broad questions are asked and new questions arise as a result of the discussion. For example: What would you do differently if you could start over again? A nondirective interview uses questions that are developed from the answers to previous questions. The interviewer asks general questions designed to prompt applicants to describe themselves. The interviewer then uses applicants’ responses to shape the next question. With a nondirective interview, as with any less-structured interview, difficulties for selection decisions include keeping the conversation job related and obtaining comparable data on various applicants. Many nondirective interviews are only partly organized; as a result, a combination of general and specific questions is asked in no set order, and different questions are asked of different applicants for the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 231 26/06/10 5:12 PM 232 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor same job. Comparing and ranking candidates is thus more open to subjective judgments and legal challenges, so they are best used for selection sparingly, if at all. Stress Interview A stress interview is designed to create anxiety and put pressure on applicants to see how they respond. In a stress interview, the interviewer assumes an extremely aggressive and insulting posture. Firms using this approach often justify doing so because employees will encounter high degrees of job stress. For example, it might be appropriate in selecting FBI agents or people for high-stress, high-pressure customer complaint positions, but it is not appropriate for most positions. The stress interview can be a high-risk approach for an employer because an applicant is probably already anxious, and the stress interview can easily generate a poor image of the interviewer and the employer. Consequently, an applicant the organization wishes to hire might turn down the job offer. Who Conducts Interviews? Job interviews can be conducted by an individual, by several individuals sequentially, or by panels or teams. For some jobs, such as entry-level jobs requiring lesser skills, applicants might be interviewed solely by a human resource professional. For other jobs, employers screen applicants by using multiple interviews, beginning with a human resource professional and followed by the appropriate supervisors and managers. Then a selection decision is made collectively. Managers need to ensure that multiple interviews are not redundant. Other interview formats are also utilized. In a panel interview, several interviewers meet with the candidate at the same time so that the same responses are heard. Panel interviews may be combined with individual interviews. However, without proper planning, an unstructured interview can result, and applicants are frequently uncomfortable with the group interview format. In a team interview, applicants are interviewed by the team members with whom they will work. This approach can improve team success, but training is required to educate team members about the selection process, and consensus over the hiring decision should be established.36 Effective Interviewing Stress interview Interview designed to create anxiety and put pressure on applicants to see how they respond. Panel interview Interview in which several interviewers meet with candidate at the same time. Team interview Interview in which applicants are interviewed by the team members with whom they will work. Many people think that the ability to interview is an innate talent, but this contention is difficult to support. Just being personable and liking to talk is no guarantee that someone will be an effective interviewer. Figure 7-8 lists questions commonly used in selection interviews. Interviewing skills are developed through training. A number of suggestions for making interviewing more effective are: • • • Plan the interview. Interviewers should review all information before the interview, and then identify specific areas for questioning. Preparation is critical because many interviewers have not done their research.37 Control the interview. This includes knowing in advance what information must be collected, systematically collecting it during the interview, and stopping when that information has been collected. An interviewer should not monopolize the conversation. Use effective questioning techniques. Utilize questions that will produce full and complete answers that can be evaluated based on job relatedness. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 232 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 233 Selecting Human Resources Questions Commonly Asked in Selection Interviews FIGURE 7-8 General Questions What are your strengths and weaknesses? Why did you leave your last job? Why should we hire you? What is most important to you in a job? What questions do you have for me? Problem-Solving Questions What is the most creative work-related idea you have had? Describe a difficult problem you faced and solved. What approach to problem solving works best for you? Describe a sale you did not make, and explain why. Questions About Motivation What have you done that shows initiative? What career objectives have you met? How do you measure success? What rewards mean most to you? What projects make you excited? Selection Interview Questions About Working with Others What kind of people do you like to work with? Tell me about a conflict with a fellow worker. How was it resolved? Describe your management style. When is teamwork more appropriate? Integrity-Indicator Questions Tell me about a time when you were not honest. How would you react if you were asked to do something unethical? If you saw a coworker doing something dishonest, what would you do? When did you last break a rule? When I call your previous employer, what comments will I get? Questions to Avoid The following are kinds of questions that should be avoided in selection interviews: • Yes/no questions: Unless verifying specific information, the interviewer should avoid questions that can be answered “yes” or “no.” For example, “Did you have good attendance on your last job?” will probably be answered simply “yes.” Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 233 26/06/10 5:12 PM 234 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor • • • • • Obvious questions: An obvious question is one for which the interviewer already has the answer and the applicant knows it. Questions that rarely produce a true answer: Avoid questions that prompt a less-than-honest response. An example is “How did you get along with your coworkers?” The likely answer is “Just fine.” Leading questions: A leading question is one to which the answer is obvious from the way the question is asked. For example, “How do you like working with other people?” suggests the answer “I like it.” Illegal questions: Questions that involve information such as race, age, gender, national origin, marital status, and number of children are illegal. They are just as inappropriate in the interview as on the application form. Questions that are not job related: All questions should be directly job related. Listening Responses to Avoid Effective interviewers avoid listening responses such as nodding, pausing, making casual remarks, echoing, and mirroring. The applicant might try to please the interviewers by examining the feedback provided. However, giving no response to an applicant’s answers may imply boredom or inattention. Therefore, interviewers should use friendly but neutral comments when acknowledging the applicant’s comments. Problems in the Interview Operating managers and supervisors are more likely than HR personnel to use poor interviewing techniques because they do not interview often or lack training. Several problems include: • • • • • Snap judgments: Some interviewers decide whether an applicant is suitable within the first two to four minutes of the interview, and spend the rest of the time looking for evidence to support their judgment. Negative emphasis: When evaluating suitability, unfavorable information about an applicant is often emphasized more than favorable information. Halo effect: The halo effect occurs when an interviewer allows a positive characteristic, such as agreeableness, to overshadow other evidence. The phrase devil’s horns describes the reverse of the halo effect; this occurs when a negative characteristic, such as inappropriate dress, overshadows other traits. Biases and stereotyping: “Similarity” bias occurs when interviewers favor or select people that they believe to be like themselves based on a variety of personal factors. Interviewers also should avoid any personal tendencies to stereotype individuals because of demographic characteristics and differences. For instance, age disparities may be a concern as younger executives are interviewing more senior personnel. Additionally, applicants’ ethnic names and accents can negatively impact personal evaluations, and older workers are sometimes less likely to get interviewed and hired than are younger applicants.38 Cultural noise: Interviewers must learn to recognize and handle cultural noise, which stems from what applicants believe is socially acceptable rather than what is factual. Other problems that can occur in the interview are demonstrated in the HR Perspective. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 234 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 235 Selecting Human Resources HR perspective Common Interview Mistakes Bad hiring based on bad interviewing is expensive. It causes poor performance and higher turnover, and results in employing people who are not engaged. Both employers and employees agree that they made the correct hiring decision about half of the time. The other half of the decisions were wrong—they were bad choices. At least some errors are due to silly or useless questions that interviewers seem to favor when they have not been properly trained. For example: • • • • • • If you were a tree (or a fruit, or an animal, or whatever), what kind would you be? Do you like knives? How do you make a peanut butter sandwich? What is your favorite song? What would you do if I gave you an elephant? Do you have a girlfriend for me? There is absolutely no evidence that these and similar questions will help an interviewer pick the best person for the job. Recent surveys show that illegal questions, as well as stupid ones, are a problem. For example, 32% of interviewers did not know that asking a candidate’s age is illegal, 40% did not know it is illegal to ask about marital status, and 44% did not know it is illegal to ask about plans to have children. Good interviewer behavior can create positive feelings toward the job and the organization. Interviewers who are warm, know the job and company, and have a sense of humor are most successful. With that in mind, how well do these comments from interviewees reflect on their interviewers’ behaviors? • • • • • • • • The interviewers were not knowledgeable. The interviewer was unenthusiastic and unfriendly. She was texting while interviewing. The interviewers were arrogant and vague. She asked, “Do you like me as a woman?” He asked, “What is your natural hair color?” He asked, “How strong is your marriage?” The interviewer was not smiling. The interview is the first step in an employment relationship. Questions about trees, songs, or hair color and unfriendly or ignorant remarks from interviewers reduce the chances that the relationship will ever commence.39 BACKGROUND INVESTIGATIONS Failure to check the backgrounds of people who are hired can lead to embarrassment and legal liability. Hiring workers who commit violent acts on the job is one example. While laws vary from state to state, for jobs in certain industries, such as those that provide services to children, vulnerable adults, security, in-home services, and financial services, background checks are mandated in some states. Nationally background checks are required for people with commercial drivers’ licenses who drive tractor-trailer rigs and buses interstate. Negligent Hiring and Retention Lawyers say that an employer’s liability hinges on how well it investigates an applicant’s background. Consequently, details provided on the application form should be investigated extensively, and these efforts should be documented. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 235 26/06/10 5:12 PM 236 SECTION 2 Negligent hiring Occurs when an employer fails to check an employee’s background and the employee injures someone on the job. Negligent retention Occurs when an employer becomes aware that an employee may be unfit for work but continues to employ the person, and the person injures someone. Jobs and Labor Negligent hiring occurs when an employer fails to check an employee’s background and the employee later injures someone on the job. There is a potential negligent hiring problem when an employer hires an unfit employee, a background check is insufficient, or an employer does not research potential risk factors that would prevent the positive hire decision. Similarly, negligent retention occurs when an employer becomes aware that an employee may be unfit for employment but continues to employ the person, and the person injures someone. Many organizations use outside vendors that specialize in conducting background checks because such outside firms can provide these services much more efficiently and effectively. Background checks have some concern that the information reported might be inaccurate or outdated. For instance, a woman was denied employment by a company because a background report provided by an outside firm contained adverse information. However, after getting the report corrected, she was hired by the company. Consequently, the information provided in criminal record checks should be used judiciously and with caution. A number of companies are using personal Web pages and the Internet to perform background checks on employees. Many believe that websites provide a more “in-depth” snapshot of a job candidate’s individual characteristics, regardless of the information that has been submitted to the company through traditional means with the application form or résumé. Online network sites such as MySpace and Facebook are used to obtain personal information, some of which involves sexual activity, drug use, and other questionable behavior.40 Unfortunately, much of the information on personal Web pages appears to be difficult to erase or alter, so some candidates and employees just have to live with less-than-flattering content once it is posted. Also, damaging information can be posted about individuals by anyone on the Internet, further complicating the process of performing fair and legitimate background checks if this information is utilized in job selection. Background information can be obtained from a number of sources. Some of these sources include past job records, credit history, testing records, educational and certification records, drug tests, Social Security numbers, sex offender lists, motor vehicle records, and military records. Running background checks on every applicant is very expensive. Employers sometimes check only the two or three finalists or the candidate who has received a contingent offer.41 The need for background checking can be found in a wide range of positions: pharmacy students, school teachers, janitors, bank tellers, and so on.42 Consider a car salesman who sexually assaults a young woman while on a test drive. If the salesman failed to tell his employer he was a convicted sex offender, does the employer have the responsibility to do a background check to find out? Probably. Nothing will guarantee that an employee will not commit a violent act at work. But employers can reduce the risk by following a lawful process to screen applicants for signs that a person is not appropriate.43 Legal Constraints on Background Investigations Various federal and state laws protect the rights of individuals whose backgrounds may be investigated during preemployment screening. An employer’s most important action when conducting a background investigation is to obtain from the applicant a signed release giving the employer permission to conduct the investigation. Safeguards are appropriate in background checks because although employee screening has become a big business, it is not always an accurate one.44 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 236 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 Selecting Human Resources 237 When a candidate is an internal candidate, blemishes are likely known. But when candidates come from outside the company, problems are more likely to be hidden, at least at first.45 Fair Credit Reporting Act Many employers check applicants’ credit histories. The logic is that poor credit histories may signal, either correctly or incorrectly, a certain level of irresponsibility. Firms that check applicants’ credit records must comply with the federal Fair Credit Reporting Act. This act basically requires disclosing that a credit check is being made, obtaining written consent from the person being checked, and furnishing the applicant with a copy of the report. Some state laws also prohibit employers from getting certain credit information. Credit history should be checked on applicants for jobs in which use of, access to, or management of money is an essential job function. Commonly, financial institutions check credit histories on loan officers and tellers, and retailers conduct credit checks on cashiers and managerial staff. But unnecessary credit checks may be illegal, according to some EEOC cases.46 Medical Examinations and Inquiries Medical information on applicants may be used to determine their physical and mental capabilities for performing jobs. Physical standards for jobs should be realistic, justifiable, and linked to job requirements. Even though workers with disabilities can competently perform many jobs, they sometimes may be rejected because of their physical or mental limitations.47 ADA and Medical Inquiries The ADA prohibits the use of preemployment medical exams, except for drug tests, until a job has been conditionally offered. Also, the ADA prohibits a company from rejecting an individual because of a disability and from asking job applicants any question related to current or past medical history until a conditional job offer has been made. Once a conditional offer of employment has been made, then some organizations ask the applicant to complete a preemployment health checklist or the employer pays for a physical examination of the applicant.48 It should be made clear that the applicant who has been offered the job is not “hired” until successful completion of the physical inquiry. Drug Testing Drug testing may be conducted as part of a medical exam, or it may be done separately. Use of drug testing as part of the selection process has increased in the past few years.49 If drug tests are used, employers should remember that their accuracy varies according to the type of test used, the item tested, and the quality of the laboratory where the test samples are sent. Because of the potential impact of prescription drugs on test results, applicants should complete a detailed questionnaire on this matter before the testing. If an individual tests positive for drug use, then an independent medical laboratory should administer a second, more detailed analysis. Whether urine, blood, saliva, or hair samples are used, the process of obtaining, labeling, and transferring the samples to the testing lab should be outlined clearly and definite policies and procedures should be established.50 References References provided by the candidate are of very limited predictive value. Would someone knowingly pick a reference who would speak poorly of them? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 237 26/06/10 5:12 PM 238 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor Of course not.51 Previous supervisors and employers may provide a better prediction. Good questions to ask previous supervisors or employers include: • • • • • • Dates of employment Position held What were the job duties? What strengths/weaknesses did you observe? Were there any problems? Would you rehire? LOGGING ON VirtualHRScreening.com Through its website, this company offers employers comprehensive risk assessments of applicants including background checks, employment references, drug screening, and criminal histories. Visit the site at www.virtualhrscreening.com. Work-related references from previous employers and supervisors provide a valuable snapshot of a candidate’s background and characteristics. Telephoning references is common. Managers should consider using a form that facilitates the factual verification of information given by the applicant. Some organizations send preprinted reference forms to individuals who are giving references for applicants. These forms often contain a release statement signed by the applicant, so that those providing references can see that they have been released from liability on the information they furnish. Making the Job Offer The final step of the selection process is offering someone employment. Job offers are often extended over the telephone. Many companies then formalize the offer in a letter that is sent to the applicant. It is important that the offer document be reviewed by legal counsel and that the terms and conditions of employment be clearly identified. Care should be taken to avoid vague, general statements and promises about bonuses, work schedules, or other matters that might change later. These documents should also provide for the individual to sign an acceptance of the offer and return it to the employer, who should place it in the individual’s personnel files. GLOBAL STAFFING ISSUES G L O B A L Staffing global assignments involves making selection decisions that impact (or take place in) other countries. When staffing global assignments, cost is a major consideration because establishing a business professional in another country can run as high as $1 million for a 3-year job assignment. Further, if a business professional quits an international assignment prematurely or wants to transfer home, associated costs can be even greater. “Failure” rates for global assignments can run as high as half of those sent overseas in some situations. Types of Global Employees Global organizations can be staffed in a number of different ways, including with expatriates, host-country nationals, and third-country nationals. Each staffing option presents some unique HR management challenges.52 For instance, when staffing with citizens of different countries, different tax laws and other factors apply. HR professionals need to be knowledgeable Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 238 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 239 Selecting Human Resources about the laws and customs of each country represented in their workforce.53 Experienced expatriates can provide a pool of talent that can be utilized as the firm expands operations into other countries. Selection Process for Global Assignments The selection process for an international assignment should provide a realistic picture of the life, work, and culture to which the employee may be sent. HR managers start by preparing a comprehensive description of the job to be done. This description notes responsibilities that would be unusual in the home nation, including negotiating with public officials; interpreting local work codes; and responding to ethical, moral, and personal issues such as religious prohibitions and personal freedoms.54 Figure 7-9 shows the most frequently cited key competencies for successful global employees. The five areas are as follows: • • • FIGURE 7-9 Cultural adjustment: Individuals who accept foreign job assignments need to successfully adjust to cultural differences. Personal characteristics: The experiences of many global firms demonstrate that the best employees in the home country may not be the best employees in a global assignment, primarily because of personal characteristics of individuals. Organizational requirements: Many global employers find that knowledge of the organization and how it operates is important. Selection Factors for Global Employees Cultural Adjustment Cultural awareness Cultural adaptability Diversity acceptance Global experiences Organizational Requirements Organizational knowledge Technical abilities Job-related skills Personal Characteristics Emotional stability Ambiguity tolerance Flexibility and risk taking Physical/stress coping Successful Global Employees Communication Skills Language capabilities Nonverbal awareness Coaching and listening skills Conflict resolution abilities Personal/Family Concerns Personal life demands Family considerations Financial/economic concerns Career development Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 239 26/06/10 5:12 PM 240 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor • • Communication skills: Expatriate employees should be able to communicate in the host-country language both orally and in writing. Personal/family concerns: The preferences and attitudes of spouses and other family members can influence the success of expatriate assignments. A growing issue for U.S. firms that hire individuals to fill jobs in other countries is the need for adequate background checks. Global companies want to ensure that their employees have acceptable work histories and personal characteristics. To satisfy this demand, a number of firms have begun to specialize in preemployment screening of global employees. Some countries have varying government-controlled employment processes that require foreign employers to obtain government approval in order to hire local employees. Many countries such as the United States and Australia require foreign workers to obtain work permits or visas. For U.S.-based firms, the assignment of women and members of racial/ ethnic minorities to international posts involves complying with U.S. EEO regulations and laws. Also, most U.S. EEO regulations and laws apply to foreign-owned firms operating in the United States. LEGAL CONCERNS IN THE SELECTION PROCESS Selection is subject to a number of legalities, especially many of the EEO regulations and laws discussed previously. Throughout the selection process, application forms, interviews, tests, background investigations, and any other selection activities must be conducted in a nondiscriminatory manner. But three areas deserve special mention: defining who is an applicant, applicant flow documentation, and selection for “soft skills.” Defining Who Is an Applicant Employers are required to track applicants who apply for jobs at their companies. It is increasingly important for employers to carefully define exactly who is an applicant and who is not, because many employers are required to track and report applicant information as part of equal employment and affirmative action plans. It is also important because employers may be negatively affected by individuals who claim to have applied for jobs but really just want to file lawsuits. Any person who is interested in a position should be considered an applicant even if no formal posting of the job opening in question has been made, the person has not filed any sort of formal application, and the person does not meet the minimum qualifications for the job. The EEOC and Office of Federal Contract Compliance Programs (OFCCP) have agreed on this definition of “applicant” to be used when an application has been submitted electronically. An applicant is a person who:55 • • • • Has expressed interest through the Internet or electronically and is being considered for a specific position by the employer. Has identified that he or she has the basic position qualifications. Does not remove his or her interest in the position at anytime during the selection process. Has been ranked using “hit features” by employer software or other data techniques that are not linked to assessment qualifications. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 240 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 241 Selecting Human Resources Applicant Flow Documentation Employers must collect applicant data on race, sex, and other demographics to fulfill EEO reporting requirements. Many employers ask applicants to provide EEOC reporting data in a flow form that may be attached to the application form. It is important that employers review this flow form separately and not use it in any selection efforts to avoid claims of impropriety. Because completing the form is voluntary, employers can demonstrate that they tried to obtain the data. Selecting for “Soft Skills” Selection in its “scientific” form is about finding valid predictors of what will be needed on a job and picking people who score high on those predictors. These “hard skills” include cognitive skills, education, and technical skills. But these skills may not predict the difference between adequate and outstanding performance. Some argue that “soft skills” provide an important part of the ability to do a job successfully.56 What are “soft skills”? They are noncognitive abilities that are complementary to outstanding job performance. Examples might include: Empathy Openness Cooperation Interpersonal style Conscientiousness Leadership Integrity Ethical behavior Effort Emotional intelligence But selection for soft skills is haphazard.57 Unlike hard skills, these skills may have to be inferred from past behaviors or from an interview.58 Tests may be available to help with some soft skills, but the basic process presented in this chapter still must apply. First, identify KSAs, competencies, and job functions through job analysis. Next, decide how those will be identified in an applicant (tests, interviews, experience, etc.). Then use structured behavioral interviewing done by trained interviewers incorporating competency-focused questions. Finally, choose those applicants who are strong in the areas necessary to do the job.59 S U M M A R Y • Selection is the process that matches individuals and their qualifications to jobs in an organization. • Placement of people should consider both person/ job fit and person/organization fit. • Mismatches in fit can occur because of skills, geography, time required, earning expectations, and work/family issues. • Predictors linked to criteria are used to identify the applicants who are most likely to perform jobs successfully. • The selection process—from applicant interest through preemployment screening, application, • • • • testing, interviewing, and background investigation—must be handled by trained, knowledgeable individuals. Truth-in-hiring lawsuits may arise from overselling a job. Employers are using electronic preemployment screening to cut down applicant pools. Application forms must meet EEO guidelines and must ask only for job-related information. Selection tests include ability tests, assessment centers, personality tests, and honesty/integrity tests. Some are controversial. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 241 26/06/10 5:12 PM 242 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor • Structured interviews, including behavioral and situational ones, are more effective and face fewer EEO compliance concerns than do unstructured interviews and nondirective interviews. • Interviews can be conducted individually, by multiple individuals, or by technology. Regardless of the method, effective interviewing questioning techniques should be used. • Background investigation can be conducted in a variety of areas. Both when requesting and when giving reference information, employers must take care to avoid potential legal concerns such as negligent hiring and negligent retention. C R I T I C A L • • • • Global organizations can be staffed by individuals who are expatriates, host-country nationals, or third-country nationals. Selection factors for global employees include cultural adjustment, personal characteristics, communication skills, personal/family concerns, and organizational requirements. Selection decisions must be based on job-related criteria in order to comply with various legal requirements. HR professionals must be careful to properly identify, track, and document applicants. Selecting for “soft skills” must follow the model used for more visible skills. T H I N K I N G 1. Develop a set of soft skills necessary for a college professor’s job. 2. Put together a structured interview for hiring assistant managers at a large retail store. 3. How would you do a complete background investigation on applicants to minimize concerns about negligent hiring? H R • E X P E R I E N T I A L Your insurance company recently entered into a business contract with a company in the financial industry that requires extensive background checks for all your existing employees and future applicants who will be doing work associated with the contract. Previously your company conducted only employment verification checks in the hiring process. The management team discussions have raised questions and concerns about issues that need to be considered as the company develops and implements a more extensive background screening A C T I V I T I E S 4. Your Accounting Manager has decided that a behavioral interview to select accountants will solve many hiring problems. What can you tell the manager about this type of interview and whether it is likely to be effective? Check www.job-interview.net and other sources to gather information. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G protocol. Resources to help you identify issues, best practices, and requirements can be found at www .hire-safe.com/Employment_Background_Check_ Guidelines.pdf. 1. What concerns does your company need to consider in following background check guidelines? 2. Discuss with the management team the steps your company needs to take to ensure that it complies with the Fair Credit Reporting Act. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 242 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 243 Selecting Human Resources C A S E Full Disclosure on Sex Offenders? Megan’s Law provides that all states are now required to have all convicted sex offenders register so that residents are aware of their presence in a neighborhood. The law is named for Megan Kanka, a 7-year-old who was raped and murdered by a twice-convicted pedophile who moved to her New Jersey neighborhood. He lured her to his house with the promise of showing her a puppy. Megan’s Law raises issues around the use of criminal registries in hiring and employee management. Several issues are involved for an employer in dealing with Megan’s Law and employees. For example, in Michigan, the Attorney General released the names of 200 registered sex offenders who had been using MySpace (some in violation of the terms of their parole). Some employers found that the list included the names of some of their employees and had to confront the very real problem of what to do about it. The presence of a convicted sex offender presents conflicting obligations and concerns. Employers want (and need) to protect other employees and customers from harm based on negligent hiring and negligent retention issues. But is this person a threat? What if the person has an exemplary work record? In some states, it is illegal for employers to use any information found on the Megan’s Law website for purposes of employment. Perhaps the easiest way to proceed would be to keep from hiring convicts in the first place, but federal law limits an employer’s ability to do that. The EEOC says that the use of conviction records in employment decisions has an adverse impact on African American and Hispanic males. Using a blanket prohibition against convicts in hiring may allow a plaintiff to demonstrate a disproportionate impact on protected categories of applicants. Is an employer required to check the registry? It depends on the job. Generally the answer is “no,” but for certain jobs there is an obligation to check. Those jobs include positions in health care facilities and hospitals (e.g., nurse or aide), day cares and schools (e.g., teacher or aide), security (e.g., guard), social and mental health facilities (e.g., social or mental health worker), taxi and bus services (e.g., drivers), and recreational facilities (e.g., fitness trainer). Virtually any position with access to potential victims is a job with the potential for problems. Two of the names on the Michigan list presented some difficult management decisions. In one office equipment company, a 34-year-old office equipment repair technician was paroled after serving a 7-year sentence for attacking women on jogging paths. His previous employer offered to rehire him as a field technician who would travel to other offices to repair business machines, as he had been an excellent employee with outstanding repair skills. In the other case, a new employee was found to be on the list. He was an African American who had served 10 years for child pornography possession. He is driving a school bus for a church and has thus far been a model employee, although he did not list his conviction on the application form even though the question was asked.60 QUESTIONS 1. Discuss what a manager should do in each of the two Michigan cases. 2. What circumstances might lead you to make different decisions in different cases under Megan’s Law? S U P P L E M E N T A L Strategic Selection: A Review of Two Companies This case shows how Hallmark and United Health Group use selection as part of their strategic approach to HR. (For the case, go to www.cengage .com/management/mathis.) C A S E S Selecting a Programmer This case demonstrates how using a test after a pool of candidates has already been interviewed can present some difficulties. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 243 26/06/10 5:12 PM 244 SECTION 2 Jobs and Labor N O T E S 1. Anjali Anthavaley, “A Job Interview You Have to Show Up For,” The Wall Street Journal, June 20, 2007, D1. 2. Kathy Gurchiek, “Staffing Issues Critical to Business Strategies, SHRM Finds,” HR News, May 28, 2008, 1–3. 3. Alan Krueger and David Schkade, “Sorting in the Labor Market,” Journal of Human Resources, 43 (2008), No. 4, 859–883. 4. Melanie Wanzek, “On Second Thought,” Sunday World Herald, May 10, 2009, CR1. 5. Arne Kalleberg, “The Mismatched Worker: When People Don’t Fit Their Jobs,” Academy of Management Perspectives, February 2008, 24–40. 6. Metin Celik, I. Deha Er, and Y. Ilker Topcu, “Computer-Based Systematic Executive Model of HRM in Maritime Transportation Industry: The Case of Master Selection for Embarking on Board Merchant Ships,” Expect Systems with Applications, 36 (2009), 1048–1060. 7. Robert Grossman, “Hiring to Fit the Culture,” HR Magazine, February 2009, 41–50. 8. Dave Bartram, “The Great Eight Competencies: A Criterion-Centric Approach to Validation,” Journal of Applied Psychology, 90 (2005), 1185–1203. 9. Murray Barrick and Ryan Zimmerman, “Hiring for Retention and Performance,” Human Resource Management, March–April 2009, 183–206. 10. Peter Cappelli, “The Impact of a High School Diploma,” HR Executive Online, August 18, 2008, www.hreonline.com, 1–3. 11. Fay Hanson, “Avoiding Truthin-Hiring Lawsuits,” Workforce Management Online, December 2007, 1–4. 12. V. O’Connell, “Test for Dwindling Retail Jobs Spawns a Culture of Cheating,” The Wall Street Journal, January 7, 2009, A1. 13. Aldo Sualdi, “Job Seekers Put Résumé Responders in a Frazzle,” The Denver Post, November 8, 2009, K1; Gina Ruiz, “Job Candidate Assessment Tests Go Virtual,” Workforce Management Online, January 2008, 1–4. 14. Adrienne Hedger, “3 Ways to Improve Your Employee Screening,” Workforce Management, March 16, 2009, 26–30. 15. Gary McWilliams, “RadioShack CEO Agrees to Resign,” The Wall Street Journal, February 21, 2006, A3. 16. Allison Balvs (ed.), “Employers Beware: ICE Crackdown Target 652 Businesses Nationwide,” Baird Holm Labor and Employment Law Update, August 2009, 1–2. 17. “Federal Contractors Required to Use E-Verify Beginning Sept. 8, 2009,” Ceridian Abstracts, www .hrcompliance.ceridian.com, 1. 18. “Gerber Agrees to Pay $900,000 to Minorities and Females for Hiring Discrimination,” Ceridian Abstracts, August 26, 2009, www .hrcompliance.ceridian.com, 1. 19. Martha Frase, “Smart Selections,” HR Magazine, December 2007, 63–67. 20. Louis Greenstein, “Web of Deceit,” Human Resource Executive, June 16, 2008, 57–60. 21. Chris Piotowski and Terry Armstrong, “Current Recruitment and Selection Practices: A National Survey of Fortune 1000 Firms,” North American Journal of Psychology, 8 (2006), 489–496. 22. Frank Schmidt, et al., “General Mental Ability, Job Performance, and Red Herrings: Responses to Osterman, Hauser, and Schmitt,” Academy of Management Perspectives, November 2007, 64–76. 23. David Autor and David Scarborough, “Does Job Testing Harm Minority Workers? Evidence from Retail Establishments,” Quarterly Journal of Economics, February 2008, 219–277; Peter Cappelli, “Assessing Personality,” Human Resource Executive Online, www.hreonline.com. 24. Frederick Morgeson, et al., “Reconsidering the Use of Personality Tests in Personnel Selection Contexts,” Personnel Psychology, 60, 2007, 683–729. 25. Benjamin Schneider, “Evolution of the Study and Practice of Personality at Work,” Human Resource Management, Winter 46 (2007), 583–610. 26. Scott Highhouse, “Stubborn Reliance on Intuition and Subjectivity in Employee Selection,” Industrial and Organizational Psychology, 1, 2008, 333–341. 27. Jack Welch and Suzy Welch, “Hiring Is Hard Work,” BusinessWeek, July 7, 2008, 80. 28. Joann Lublin, “What Won’t You Do for a Job?” The Wall Street Journal, June 2, 2009, B1. 29. Mark McGraw, “Costly Job Interviews,” Human Resource Executive Online, November 4, 2009, www.hreonline.com, 1–2. 30. Kristen Weirick, “The Perfect Interview,” HR Magazine, April 2008, 85–88. 31. Chad Van Iddekinge, et al., “Antecedents of Impression Management Use and Effectiveness in a Structured Interview,” Journal of Management, October 2007, 752–773. 32. Therese Macan, “The Employment Interview: A Review of Current Studies and Directions for Future Research,” Human Resources Management Review, 19 (2009), 203–218. 33. Henryk T. Krajewski, Richard D. Goffin, Julie M. McCarthy, Mitchell G. Rothstein, and Norman Johnston, “Comparing the Validity of Structured Interviews for Managerial-Level Employees: Should We Look to the Past or Focus on the Future?” Journal of Occupational & Organizational Psychology, 79 (2006), 411–432. 34. Kathy Gurchiek, “Behavioral Interviewing Popular but Training in Use Is Urged,” SHRM HR News, January 28, 2008, www.shrm.org, 1–3. 35. Alexandra Lopez-Pacheco, “How Do I Recruit Great Employees?” National Post (Canada), June 8, 2009, FP8; Laura Quinn, and Maxine Dalton, “Leading for Sustainability Implementing the Tasks of Leadership,” Corporate Governance, 9, 2009, 21–38. 36. Joann Lublin, “For Job Hunters the Big Interview Is Getting Bigger,” The Wall Street Journal, June 3, 2008, D1. 37. “Failing the Interview,” DD1, www .ddiworld.com. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 244 26/06/10 5:12 PM CHAPTER 7 245 Selecting Human Resources 38. Joanna Lahey, “Age, Women, and Hiring,” Journal of Human Resources, XLIII, No. 1, 30–56. 39. Nic Paton, “Half of Hiring Decisions a Mistake, Say Managers,” October 7, 2008, www.management-issues.com; Ann Howard and Jehanna Johnson, “If You Were a Tree What Kind Would You Be?” Development Dimensions International White Paper, 2008, 1–11. 40. Rita Zeidner, “How Deep Can You Probe?” HR Magazine, October 2007, 57–62. 41. Regan Halvorsen, “HR Solutions,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 36. 42. Cheryl Thompson, “Background Checks for Experiential Education Could Get Centralized,” American Journal of Health System Pharmacy, September 2009, 1603–1604. 43. Leonard Schloss and J. Gregory Lahr, “Watch Your Back: Smart Hiring and Proper Background Checks,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008, 46–71. 44. Chad Terhune, “The Trouble with Background Checks,” BusinessWeek, June 9, 2008, 54–57. 45. Lin Grensing-Pophal, “Hiring Inside or Out,” Human Resource Executive Online, November 10, 2009, www .hreonline.com, 1–3. 46. Allen Smith, “EEOC Challenges Unnecessary Credit Checks,” SHRM HR News, February 9, 2007, www .shrm.org, 1–2; “Checking Credit of Job Candidates Drives Concern about Civil Rights,” The Wall Street Journal, January 19, 2007, B2. 47. “Ruling Complicates Return-toWork Tests,” Business Insurance, October 5, 2009, 8. 48. “General Communication Guidelines,” Ceridian Abstracts, April 8, 2009, www.hrcompliance .ceridian.com. 49. Cathy Fyock, “Streamlining the Process,” HR Executive, November 19, 2007, 49. 50. “The Legal Side of Workplace DrugFree Policies,” Safety Compliance Letter 2487, 2008, 7–13; Jo Douglas, “Green Light for Drugs and Alcoholic Testing,” NZ Business, 22, No. 4, 2008, 84. 51. JoAnn Lublin, “Bulletproofing Your References in the Hunt for a New Job,” The Wall Street Journal, April 7, 2009, B9. 52. Mary Siegfried, “A New Approach to Global Staffing,” Inside Supply Management, March 2008, 30–32. 53. Ann Marie Ryan, et al., “Going Global: Cultural Values and 54. 55. 56. 57. 58. 59. 60. Perceptions of Selection Procedures,” Applied Psychology: An International Review, 2008, 1–37. Ashly Pennington, et al. (eds.), Human Resource Management: Ethics and Employment (Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2007), 255. Allen Smith, “OFCCP Updates Guidance on Internet Applicant,” HR News, November 17, 2006, www.shrm.org/news. Lex Borghans, et al., “Interpersonal Styles and Labor Market Outcomes,” Journal of Human Resources, 43 (2008) No. 4, 816–855. Dana Mattioli, “Hard Sell on ‘Soft’ Skills,” The Wall Street Journal, May 15, 2007, B6. Charles Handler, “Dear Workforce . . .,” www.Workforce.com. IRA Blank, “Selecting Employees Based on Emotional Intelligence Competencies: Reap the Rewards and Minimize the Risk,” Employee Relations Law Journal, Winter 2008, 77–85. Diane Cadrain, “Full Disclosure,” HR Magazine, September 2007, 60–64. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_07_ch07_p212-246.indd 245 26/06/10 5:12 PM S E C T I O N 3 Training and Development Chapter 8 Training Human Resources Chapter 9 Talent Management Chapter 10 Performance Management and Appraisal 247 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 247 21/07/10 8:53 PM C H A P T E R 8 Training Human Resources After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Define training and discuss why a strategic approach is important. • Discuss the four phases of the training process. • Identify three types of analyses used to determine training needs. • Explain different means of internal and external training delivery. • Describe the importance of e-learning as part of current training efforts. • Give an example for each of the four levels of training evaluation. 248 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 248 26/06/10 5:14 PM HR Headline China’s Need for Training C (CNImaging/Newscom) hina has enjoyed an economic bonanza, and with that growth has come a shift toward higher-end manufacturing and services. This shift has led to a greater need for experienced and skilled labor. Local managers need not only technical skills, but skills that are business focused as well. As a result, HR in China faces a large challenge in finding, training, and keeping skilled employees who can thrive in Western-style multinational corporations (MNCs). China has a workforce of 800 million, but only a small percentage is considered skilled enough to work in MNCs. The Chinese educational system does not teach the range of needed skills, so companies are training workers. A California biomedical testing instrument manufacturer has 270 employees in sales, marketing, and services in China. Five years ago the focus was on technical skills, but now the company wants employees with experience, expertise, and an understanding of the business and relationships. Chinese culture encourages learning and growing. A Chinese proverb says, “If you want 100 years of prosperity, grow people.” And, Chinese employees want the opportunity to be trained. In fact, if they see companies bring in expatriates or non-Chinese workers, they view those companies as having a short-term investment in China and not as likely to be a good place for career growth. Available training is a retention tool that Chinese employees are demanding. Cisco Systems, which recognized the need to create its own skilled labor pool, now has 220 academies in all provinces in China. The company wants employees to know proposal design, presentation skills, teamwork, products, and sales. A special administrative region (SAR) of China, Macao, is a good example of an area with specific training needs. Macao’s economy is heavily 249 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 249 26/06/10 5:14 PM 250 SECTION 3 Training and Development invested in gaming and the hospitality industry. Hotel and gaming companies have grown their training staffs; at the height of training activities, one hotel resort had 30 full-time training people serving thousands of employees. In the gaming industry, training includes training for dealers, security officers, and supervisors. Training is often done on a 24/7 basis to accommodate various work shifts. Training has become so prominent in many global companies because it is seen as a worthwhile investment. Companies in the United States also have adopted training as a way to retain their talented employees.1 Competition forces business organizations to change and adapt in order to compete successfully. Changes in the way things must be done include training or retraining employees and managers. In this sense, training is an ongoing process for most organizations. Organizations in the United States spend more than $126 billion annually on training and development, or more than $1,000 per employee on average.2 Training is the process whereby people acquire capabilities to perform jobs. Training provides employees with specific, identifiable knowledge and skills for use in their present jobs. Organizational training may include teaching of “hard” skills, such as teaching sales representatives how to use intranet resources, a branch manager how to review an income statement, or a machinist apprentice how to set up a drill press. “Soft” skills are critical in many instances and can be taught as well. These skills may include communicating, mentoring, managing a meeting, and working as part of a team. TRAINING AND HR What kinds of activities usually require training? The most common training topics include, among others, safety, customer service, computer skills, quality initiatives, dealing with sexual harassment, and communication.3 Training has been studied at length in the United States.4 The results of these studies show that training is rated as important or very important by 94% of human resources professionals.5 Further, documented benefits of well-done training include (for both individuals and teams) enhanced skills, greater ability to adapt and innovate, better self-management, and performance improvement. For organizations, research has shown that training brings improvements in effectiveness and productivity, more profitability and reduced costs, improved quality, and increased social capitol. Training Categories Training can be designed to meet a number of objectives and can be classified in various ways. As Figure 8-1 shows, some common groupings include the following: Training Process whereby people acquire capabilities to perform jobs. • Required and regular training: Complies with various mandated legal requirements (e.g., OSHA and EEO) and is given to all employees (e.g., new employee orientation) Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 250 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 251 Training Human Resources Types of Training FIGURE 8-1 Required and Regular Safety compliance Driving provisions Wage and hour rules Employee orientation Benefits enrollment Sexual harassment prevention Job and Technical Customer service Equipment operations Recordkeeping needs Telecommunications IT systems Product details Training Interpersonal and Problem-Solving Communications Writing skills Team relationships Coaching skills Problem analyses Conflict resolution • • • Developmental and Career Business trends Strategic thinking Leadership Change management Career planning Performance management Job/technical training: Enables employees to perform their jobs well (e.g., product knowledge, technical processes and procedures, customer relations) Developmental and career training: Provides longer-term focus to enhance individual and organizational capabilities for the future (e.g., business practices, executive development, organizational change, leadership) Interpersonal and problem-solving training: Addresses both operational and interpersonal problems and seeks to improve organizational working relationships (e.g., interpersonal communication, managerial/supervisory skills, conflict resolution) It is common for a distinction to be drawn between training and development, with development being broader in scope and focusing on individuals’ gaining new capabilities useful for both present and future jobs. Development is discussed in Chapter 9; training is the focus of this chapter. Legal Issues and Training A number of legal issues must be considered when designing and delivering training. One concern centers on the criteria and practices used to select individuals Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 251 26/06/10 5:15 PM 252 SECTION 3 Training and Development for inclusion in training programs. Companies need to make sure those criteria are job related and do not unfairly restrict the participation of protectedcategory members. Also, failure to accommodate the participation of individuals with disabilities in training can expose organizations to EEO lawsuits. Another legal issue is employers’ requiring employees to sign training contracts in order to protect the costs and time invested in specialized employee training. For instance, a telecommunications firm paid $17,000 each to train four network technicians and certify them in specialized equipment. The firm required that each technician sign a training contract whereby one-fourth of the cost would be forgiven each year the employee stayed following the training. A technician who left sooner would be liable to the firm for the unforgiven balance. Health care organizations, IT firms, and other employers often use training contracts, especially for expensive external training. LOGGING ON Finally, the Department of Labor has ruled that employAmerican Society for Training & ees who are training outside normal working hours (e.g., at Development home by completing Web-based classes) must be compensated This website on training and for their time. In one situation, a Web-based class required development contains information on employees to spend about 10 hours at home completing it; research, education, seminars, and once they did, they performed their job duties better. In this conferences. Visit the site at case, the company had to pay the employees for their 10 www.astd.org. hours of training under the Fair Labor Standards Act.6 ORGANIZATIONAL STRATEGY AND TRAINING Training represents a significant expenditure for most employers. But it is too often viewed tactically rather than strategically, which means that training is seen as a short-term activity rather than one that has longer-term effects on organizational success. However, this is changing. For example, during the last recession, unlike previous recessions, some companies chose to maintain training that was necessary for long-term strategic goals.7 Strategic Training Training is used strategically to help the organization accomplish its goals. For example, if sales increases are a critical part of the company’s strategy, appropriate training would identify what is causing lower sales and target training to respond as part of a solution.8 Strategic training can have numerous organizational benefits. It requires HR and training professionals to get intimately involved with the business and to partner with operating managers to help solve their problems, thus making significant contributions to organizational results. Additionally, a strategic training mind-set reduces the likelihood of thinking that training alone can solve most employee or organizational problems. It is not uncommon for operating managers and trainers to react to most important performance problems by saying, “I need a training program on X.” With a strategic focus, the organization is more likely to assess whether training actually can address the most important performance issues and what besides training is needed. Training cannot fix all organizational problems. The value of training can be seen at Walt Disney World where the company has established specific training plans. The implementation of those Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 252 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 253 Training Human Resources training plans results in a distinct competitive advantage for the organization. For example, at the Disney Institute, employees (called “cast members”) get training experience from their guests’ perspectives. As a part of their training, individuals taking hotel reservations stay at a resort as guests in order to gain greater understanding of what they are selling and to experience the services themselves. Organizational Competitiveness and Training General Electric, Dell Computers, Motorola, Marriott, Cisco, FedEx, and Texas Instruments all emphasize the importance of training employees and managers. These companies and others recognize that training efforts can be integral to business success. In a sense, for these companies, training is similar to the “continuous improvement” practiced by some manufacturing firms. The nature of technological innovation and change is such that if employees are not trained all the time, they may fall behind and the company could become less competitive. For example, consider the telecommunications industry today compared with ten years ago, with all the new technologies and the accompanying competitive shifts. Without continual training, organizations may not have staff members with the knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) needed to compete effectively. Training also can affect organizational competitiveness by aiding in the retention of employees. One reason why many individuals stay or leave organizations is career training and development opportunities. Employers that invest in training and developing their employees may enhance retention efforts. Figure 8-2 shows how training may help accomplish certain organizational strategies. Ideally, upper management sees the training function as providing valuable intelligence about the necessary core skills. Knowledge Management For much of history, competitive advantage among organizations was measured in terms of physical capital. However, as FIGURE 8-2 Organizational Strategies Increase sales Expand into overseas market Develop new product line Acquire competitor company Other strategies Linking Strategies and Training Necessary Outcomes to Implement Strategies Identify key sales elements and train sales force Assign key people and provide necessary global training Train production and sales on new products Assimilate employees from new company, and provide orientation and training Other outcomes Training Activities Performance consulting, design training Intercultural competence, language training New product training, production practice, sales simulations Onboarding, corporate culture training Other training activities Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 253 26/06/10 5:15 PM 254 SECTION 3 Training and Development the information age has evolved, “intelligence” has become the raw material that many organizations make and sell through their “knowledge workers.”9 Knowledge management is the way an organization identifies and leverages knowledge in order to be competitive. It is the art of creating value by using organizational intellectual capital, which is what the organization (or, more exactly, the people in the organization) knows. Knowledge management is a conscious effort to get the right knowledge to the right people at the right time so that it can be shared and put into action. Training as a Revenue Source Some organizations have identified that training can be a source of business revenue. For instance, Microsoft, Ceridian, Cisco, Hewlett-Packard, and other technology firms bundle customer training with products and services they sell. Also, manufacturers of industrial equipment offer customers training on machine upgrades and new features. Customers of many of these firms pay for additional training either by course, by participant, or as part of equipment or software purchases. Not only are the costs of the trainers’ salaries, travel, and other expenses covered, but the suppliers also make a profit on the training through the fees paid by customers. As a side benefit, customer satisfaction and loyalty increase if customers know how to use the products and services purchased. Thus, customer training aids customer retention and enhances future sales revenues. Performance Consulting Training should result in improved organizational performance. For some companies, ensuring that it does requires a “performance consulting” approach. Performance consulting is a process in which a trainer (either internal or external to the organization) and an organization work together to decide how to improve organizational and individual results.10 That may or may not include training. Performance consulting takes a broad approach by: • • • Knowledge management The way an organization identifies and leverages knowledge in order to be competitive. Performance consulting Process in which a trainer and an organization work together to decide how to improve organizational and individual results. Focusing on identifying and addressing root causes of performance problems Recognizing that the interaction of individual and organizational factors influences employee performance Documenting the actions and accomplishments of high performers and comparing them with actions and accomplishments of more typical performers Regardless of whether the trainer is an internal employee or an outside consultant, a performance consulting approach recognizes that training alone cannot automatically solve every employer performance problem. Instead, training is one piece of a larger “bundled solution.” For instance, some employee performance issues might be resolved by creating a training program for employees, and others might call for compensation adjustments, job design changes, or reassignment. Integration of Performance with Training Job performance, training, and employee learning must be integrated to be effective, and HR plays a crucial role in this integration.11 Organizations find that training experiences that use real business problems to advance employee learning are better than more traditional approaches. Rather than separating the training experience from the context of actual job performance, trainers incorporate everyday business issues as learning examples, thus increasing the realism of training exercises and scenarios. For example, as part of management training at Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 254 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 255 Training Human Resources Business Education at Work The following is a first-person account from an employee of Graybar Electric Company (an employeeowned company), as she related her experience in a “Mini MBA” set up by Rutgers University. This training program is an excellent example of integrating performance and training. My employer teamed with Rutgers to produce a new management training program to provide a broad base of business knowledge. Graybar has a long history of promoting people from within and needed a program like this. I was a senior attorney on the company’s legal team, and ready for more business education. The training program includes face-to-face meetings as well as online communication. We do most of our work in crossfunctional teams. My team in addition to myself includes Graybar employees from Canada (Vice President), Pittsburgh (Operations Manager), and Alabama (Branch Manager). We learn from each other as well as from the formal instruction. Technology includes e-mail, instant messaging, Webinars, podcasts, conference calls, and the Internet. There are no regularly scheduled classes; we are responsible for reading and finishing HR perspective assignments at our own pace. For example, a recent assignment was to listen to a podcast by a CEO of an international advertising agency on customer loyalty creation. Our team then drafted an article for the company newsletter, discussing the Graybar brand and how to strengthen the value of the brand with the customers. In another assignment, each team completed an assignment on ethics. The team members identified an ethical issue and designed a 10-minute employee training module based on that incident. This required learning the ethical concepts and translating them into an informative program for employees. If you take a class at a local college, perhaps you can apply 20% of what you learn to your job. With this program, I probably apply 80–90% directly to my job. We examine real-world challenges affecting Graybar’s strategy. The work done by the student is actually used to guide the company’s future, as the hands-on learning is presented to senior managers as part of the final exam.12 Note: At this writing, Beverly Propst is Vice President of Human Resources at Graybar Electric. General Electric, managers are given actual business problems to solve, and they must present their solutions to the business leaders in the firm. Using real situations for practice is yet another way of merging the lines between training, learning, and job performance. For another example, see HR Perspective: Business Education at Work. Chief Learning Officers To emphasize the importance of training and to have internal performance consulting expertise, some organizations have created a position entitled chief learning officer (CLO) or chief knowledge officer (CKO). Ideally, the CLO is not just a training director with an inflated new title, but rather a leader who designs knowledge through training for individual employees and the organization. CLOs must demonstrate a high level of comfort in working with boards of directors and the top management team, a track record of success in running some type of business unit, and an understanding of adult learning technologies and processes. If they possess these characteristics, CLOs can take the lead in developing strategic training plans for their organizations. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 255 26/06/10 5:15 PM 256 SECTION 3 Training and Development TRAINING FOR GLOBAL STRATEGIES G L O B A L For a global firm, the most brilliant strategies ever devised will not work unless the company has well-trained employees throughout the world to carry them out. A global look at training is becoming more crucial as firms establish and expand operations worldwide. For U.S. employers, the challenge has increased. According to a report, the number of U.S. job skills certifications declined 18% in one year, while there was a 47% increase in similar certifications in India. The conclusion of the study was that U.S. firms may not remain innovative and strategic leaders much longer, due to the decline in specialized skilled and technical workers.13 Add this problem to the number of global employees with international assignments, and training must be seen as part of global strategic success.14 Global Assignment Training The orientation and training that expatriates and their families receive before departure significantly affect the success of an overseas assignment. When such programs are offered, most expatriates participate in them, and the programs usually produce a positive effect on cross-cultural adjustment. Also, training helps expatriates and their families adjust to and deal with host-country counterparts. A recent survey showed that companies recognize their expatriates often are well trained in skills and technical capabilities but much less well trained in knowledge of the host country culture.15 A related issue is the promotion and transfer of foreign citizens to positions in the United States. For example, many Japanese firms operating in the United States conduct training programs to prepare Japanese people for the food, customs, labor and HR practices, and other facets of working and living in the United States. As more global organizations start or expand U.S. operations, more cross-cultural training will be necessary for international employees relocated to the United States.16 Intercultural Competence Training Global employers are providing intercultural competence training for their global employees. Intercultural competence incorporates a wide range of human social skills and personality characteristics. As noted in Figure 8-3, three components of intercultural competence require attention when training expatriates for global assignments: • • • Cognitive: What does the person know about other cultures? Emotional: How does the person view other cultures, and how sensitive is the person to cultural customs and issues? Behavioral: How does the person act in intercultural situations? Increasingly, global employers are using training methods that allow individuals to behave in international situations and then receive feedback.17 One method is the Culture Assimilator. Used worldwide, especially by Europeanbased firms, the Culture Assimilator is a programmed training and learning method consisting of short case studies and critical incidents. The case studies describe intercultural interactions and potential misunderstandings involving expatriates and host-country nationals. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 256 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 257 Training Human Resources Intercultural Competence Training FIGURE 8-3 COMPONENT POSSIBLE TRAINING Cognitive Culture-specific training (traditions, history, cultural customs, etc.) Language course Emotional Uneasiness: Social skills training focusing on new/unclear and intercultural situations Prejudices: Coaching may be clarifying Sensitivity: Communication skills course (active listening, verbal/nonverbal cues, empathy) Behavioral Culture Assimilator method International projects Social skills training focusing on intercultural situations Source: Developed by Andrea Graf, PhD, and Robert L. Mathis, PhD, SPHR. PLANNING FOR TRAINING Whether global or national in scope, training benefits from careful planning before it is done. Planning includes looking at the “big picture” in which the training takes place as well as specifics for the design of a particular training effort. For example, the needs for skills have changed over time and things like adaptability, problem solving, and professionalism have increased in value in some firms.18 Planning to design training to include changes such as these makes for a more effective training program. Another training planning issue for some companies is knowledge retention for the firm. When retirees leave, they take everything they have learned during a career. Perhaps a retiree is the only one in the company who knows how to operate a piece of machinery or mix a chemical solution. In some areas technology changes so fast that even young people leaving a company may take with them information that cannot easily be replicated. Companies are responding to this knowledge retention need in various ways, including identifying critical employees, having existing critical employees train and mentor others, producing how-to videotapes, and keeping former employees on call for a period of time after their departure.19 Training plans allow organizations to identify what is needed for employee performance before training begins so that a fit between training and strategic issues is made.20 Effective training efforts consider the following questions: • • • • • • Is there really a need for the training? Who needs to be trained? Who will do the training? What form will the training take? How will knowledge be transferred to the job? How will the training be evaluated? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 257 26/06/10 5:15 PM 258 SECTION 3 Training and Development Orientation: Planning for New Employees Orientation Planned introduction of new employees to their jobs, coworkers, and the organization. A good example of one kind of training that requires planning is orientation. Also called “onboarding,” orientation is the most important and widely conducted type of regular training done for new employees. Orientation, which is the planned introduction of new employees to their jobs, coworkers, and the organization, is offered by most employers. It requires cooperation between individuals in the HR unit and operating managers and supervisors. In a small organization without an HR department, the new employee’s supervisor or manager usually assumes most of the responsibility for orientation. In large organizations, managers and supervisors, as well as the HR department, generally work as a team to orient new employees. Unfortunately, without good planning, new employee orientation sessions can come across as boring, irrelevant, and a waste of time to both new employees and their department supervisors and managers. Solid academic research indicates that orientation (institutionalized socialization tactics) can be effective—if done well. Orientation reduces role ambiguity, role conflict, and intention to quit; and it increases perceptions of fit, job satisfaction, commitment, and performance.21 Studies and observations by practicing managers and HR managers confirm this.22 In addition, evidence from the public sector shows how important orientation is if done well.23 Planning for orientation is reviewed in HR On-the-Job. Among the decisions to be made during planning are what to present and also, equally important, when to present it. Too much information on the first HR on-the-job Planning for New Employee Orientation Effective new employee orientation requires planning and preparation. Unfortunately, orientation often is conducted rather haphazardly. To make orientation more effective, the following planning suggestions are useful: • • • • Prepare for new employees. New employees must feel that they belong and are important to the organization. The supervisor, HR unit, and coworkers should be prepared for a new employee’s arrival. Consider using mentors. Some organizations assign coworkers or peers to serve as buddies or mentors as part of the new employees’ orientation. Use an orientation checklist. An orientation checklist can be used to identify what the new employee needs to know now and later. Cover needed information at the proper time. It is important to give employees information • • • on the policies, work rules, and benefits of the company when they need it. What do they need on the first day? What later? Present orientation information effectively. Managers and HR representatives should determine the most appropriate ways to present orientation information both in person and using technological means. Avoid information overload. One common failing of many orientation programs is information overload. New workers presented with too many facts may ignore or inaccurately recall much of the information. Evaluate and follow up. An HR representative or manager can evaluate the effectiveness of the orientation by conducting follow-up interviews with new employees a few weeks or months after the orientation. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 258 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 259 Training Human Resources day leads to perceptions of ineffective onboarding. Several shorter sessions over a longer period of time, bringing in information as it is needed, are more effective. Effective orientation achieves several key purposes: • • • • • Establishes a favorable employee impression of the organization and the job Provides organization and job information Enhances interpersonal acceptance by coworkers Accelerates socialization and integration of the new employee into the organization Ensures that employee performance and productivity begin more quickly Electronic Orientation Resources One way of expanding the efficiency of orientation is to use electronic resources. Estimates are that more than 80% of employers have implemented electronic onboarding activities to improve their employee orientation efforts.24 A number of employers place general employee orientation information on company intranets or corporate websites. New employees log on and go through much of the general material on organizational history, structure, products and services, mission, and other background, instead of sitting in a classroom where the information is delivered in person or by videotape. Specific questions and concerns can be addressed by HR staff and others after employees have reviewed the Web-based information.25 Other companies use electronic resources a bit differently. For example, at Mirage Resorts, when candidates accept an offer, they get an e-mail with a link to a password-protected website that welcomes them, and they fill out their I-9, W-2, and other forms on that website. Before reporting to work, they get e-mails daily explaining where to park, where to get uniforms, and where to drop off their dry cleaning. Assigning a desk, getting a computer and security clearance, and many other orientation tasks are all done before the first day on the job by electronic onboarding.26 Evaluating Orientation and Metrics M E A S U R E Although orientation is important and can provide many advantages for both the organization and the new employee, it is not always done well. To determine the effectiveness of an orientation training program, evaluation using specific metrics is appropriate. Measurement should be made of the success of both the orientation program and the new hires themselves. Suggested metrics include:27 • Tenure turnover rate • New hires failure factor • Employee upgrade rate • Development program participation rate What percentage of new hires of 6 months or less left the organization? What percentage of the total annual turnover was new hires? What percentage of new employees received a higher performance rating than previously? What percentage of new employees have moved on to training for or promotion to higher jobs? Successfully integrating new hires is important, and measuring the degree of success allows the orientation program to be managed. The way in which a firm plans, organizes, and structures its training affects the way employees experience the training, which in turn influences the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 259 26/06/10 5:15 PM 260 SECTION 3 FIGURE 8-4 Training and Development Systematic Training Process Training Needs Assessment Analyze training needs Identify training objectives and criteria Training Design Pretest trainees Select training methods Plan training content Training Delivery Schedule training Conduct training Monitor training Evaluation of training Measure training outcomes Compare outcome to training objectives and criteria effectiveness of the training. Effective training requires the use of a systematic training process. Figure 8-4 shows the four phases of a systematic approach: assessment, design, delivery, and evaluation. Using such a process reduces the likelihood that unplanned, uncoordinated, and haphazard training efforts will occur. A discussion of the training process follows. TRAINING NEEDS ASSESSMENT Assessing organizational training needs is the diagnostic phase of a training plan. This assessment considers issues of employee and organizational performance to determine if training can help. Needs assessment measures the competencies of a company, a group, or an individual as they relate to what is required. It is necessary to find out what is happening and what should be happening before deciding if training will help, and if it will help, what kind is needed. For instance, suppose that in looking at the performance of clerks in a billing department, a manager identifies problems that employees have with their data-entry and keyboarding abilities, and she decides that they would benefit from instruction in these areas. As part of assessing the training needs, the manager has the clerks take a data-entry test to measure their current keyboarding skills. Then the manager establishes an objective of increasing the clerks’ keyboarding speed to 60 words per minute without errors. The number of words per minute without errors is the criterion against which training success can be measured, and it represents the way in which the objective is made specific. Analysis of Training Needs The first step in training needs assessment is analyzing what training might be necessary. Figure 8-5 shows the three sources used to analyze training needs. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 260 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 261 Training Human Resources Sources of Information for Training Needs Assessment FIGURE 8-5 Organization-Wide Sources Grievances Accidents Waste/scrap Training observations Observations Customer complaints Exit interviews Equipment use Attitude surveys Job/Task Sources Employee KSAs Benchmarks Effectiveness Job specifications Efficiency data Employees surveys Individual Employee Sources Tests Records Assessment centers Questionnaires Surveys Job knowledge tools Performance appraisals Organizational Analysis Training needs can be diagnosed by analyzing organizational outcomes and looking at future organizational needs. A part of planning for training is the identification of the KSAs that will be needed now and in the future as both jobs and the organization change. Both internal and external forces will influence training and must be considered when doing organizational analysis. For instance, the problems posed by the technical obsolescence of current employees and an insufficiently educated labor pool from which to draw new workers should be confronted before those issues become critical. Organizational analysis comes from various operational measures of organizational performance. Departments or areas with high turnover, customer complaints, high grievance rates, high absenteeism, low performance, and other deficiencies can be pinpointed. Following identification of such problems, training objectives can be developed if training is a solution. During organizational analysis, focus groups of managers can be used to evaluate changes and performance that might require training. Job/Task Analysis The second way of analyzing training needs is to review the jobs involved and the tasks performed in those jobs. By comparing the requirements of jobs with the KSAs of employees, training needs can be identified. For example, at a manufacturing firm, analysis identified the tasks performed by engineers who served as technical instructors for other employees. By listing the tasks required of a technical instructor, management established a program to teach specific instructional skills; thus, the engineers were able to become more successful instructors. Another way to pinpoint training gaps in the job or the task being done is to survey employees and have them anonymously evaluate the skill levels of their peers and estimate the skill levels necessary to be successful. This not only identifies job needs but also heightens employees’ awareness of their own learning needs.28 A training needs survey can take the form of questionnaires or interviews with supervisors and employees individually or in groups. The growth of the Internet has resulted in firms using Web-based surveys, requests, and other inputs from managers and employees to identify training needs or jobs. A good example of needs assessment for a particular job occurred in the construction industry where there was a rash of accidents among Spanishspeaking construction workers. Construction companies recognized the need for training in English as a second language for many people. Restaurants, hospitals, and hotels have faced the same issue for certain (but not all) jobs.29 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 261 26/06/10 5:15 PM 262 SECTION 3 Training and Development Individual Analysis The third means of diagnosing training needs focuses on individuals and how they perform their jobs. The following sources are examples that are useful for individual analysis: • • • • Performance appraisals Skill tests Individual assessment tests Records of critical incidents • • • • Assessment center exercises Questionnaires and surveys Job knowledge tools Internet input The most common approach for making individual analysis is to use performance appraisal data. In some instances, a good HR information system can be used to identify individuals who require training in specific areas in order to be eligible for promotion. To assess training needs through the performance appraisal process, the organization first determines an employee’s performance strengths and inadequacies in a formal review. Then it can design some type of training to help the employee overcome the weaknesses and enhance the strengths. Another way of assessing individual training needs is to use both managerial and nonmanagerial input about what training is needed. Obtaining this kind of input can be useful in building support for the training from those who will be trained, as they help to identify training needs. Tests can be a good means of individual-level analysis. For example, a police officer might take a qualification test with her service pistol every 6 months to indicate the officer’s skill level. If an officer cannot qualify, training certainly would be necessary. Establishing Training Objectives and Priorities Once training requirements have been identified using needs analyses, training objectives and priorities can be established by a “gap analysis,” which indicates the distance between where an organization is with its employee capabilities and where it needs to be. Training objectives and priorities are then determined to close the gap. Three types of training objectives can be set: • • • Attitude: Creating interest in and awareness of the importance of something (e.g., sexual harassment training) Knowledge: Imparting cognitive information and details to trainees (e.g., understanding how a product works) Skill: Developing behavioral changes in how jobs and various task requirements are performed (e.g., improving speed on an installation) The success of training should be measured in terms of the objectives that were set for it. Useful objectives are measurable. For example, an objective for a new sales clerk might be to “demonstrate the ability to explain the function of each product in the department within two weeks.” This objective checks internalization, that is, whether the person really learned the training content and is able to use the training. Because training seldom is an unlimited budget item and because organizations have multiple training needs, prioritization is necessary. Ideally, management looks at training needs in relation to strategic organizational plans and as part of the organizational change process. Then the training needs can be prioritized based on organizational objectives. Conducting the training most needed to improve the performance of the organization will produce visible results more quickly. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 262 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 263 Training Human Resources TRAINING DESIGN Once training objectives have been determined, training design can start. Whether job-specific or broader in nature, training must be designed to address the specific objectives. Effective training design considers the learners, instructional strategies, and how best to get the training from class to the job. Working in organizations should be a continual learning process. Different approaches are possible because learning is a complex psychological process. Each of the elements shown in Figure 8-6 must be considered for the training design to be effective and produce learning. Learner Characteristics For training to be successful, learners must be ready and able to learn. Learner readiness means that individuals have the ability to learn, which many people certainly have. However, individuals also must have the motivation to learn, have self-efficacy, see value in learning, and have a learning style that fits the training. Ability to Learn Learners must possess basic skills, such as fundamental reading and math proficiency, and sufficient cognitive abilities. Companies may discover that some workers lack the requisite skills to comprehend their training. Some have found that a significant number of job applicants and current employees lack the reading, writing, and math skills needed to learn the jobs. Employers might deal with the lack of basic employee skills in several ways: • • • FIGURE 8-6 Offer remedial training to people in the current workforce who need it. Hire workers who are deficient and then implement specific workplace training.30 Work with local schools to help better educate potential hires for jobs. Training Design Elements Learner Characteristics Ability to learn Motivation to learn Self-efficacy Perceived utility/value Learning styles Training Transfer Strategic link Supervisor support Opportunity Accountability Instructional Strategies Practice/feedback Overlearning Behavioral modeling Error-based examples Reinforcement/ immediate confirmation Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 263 26/06/10 5:15 PM 264 SECTION 3 Training and Development Motivation A person’s desire to learn training content, referred to as “motivation to learn,” is influenced by multiple factors. For example, differences in gender and ethnicity and the resulting experiences may affect the motivation of adult learners. The student’s motivational level also may be influenced by the instructor’s motivation and ability, friends’ encouragement to do well, classmates’ motivational levels, the physical classroom environment, and the training methods used.31 Regardless of what the motivation is, without it, the student will not learn the material. Self-Efficacy Learners must possess self-efficacy, which refers to people’s belief that they can successfully learn the training program content. For learners to be ready for and receptive to the training content, they must feel that it is possible for them to learn it. As an example, some college students’ levels of self-efficacy diminish in math or statistics courses when they do not feel adequately able to grasp the material. These perceptions may have nothing to do with their actual ability to learn, but rather reflect the way they see themselves and their abilities. Instructors and trainers must find appropriate ways to boost the confidence of trainees who are unsure of their learning abilities because people with a high level of belief that they can learn perform better and are more satisfied with the training they receive. Perceived Utility/Value Training that is viewed as useful is more likely to be tried on the job. Perceived utility or value of training is affected by a need to improve, the likelihood that training will lead to improvement, and the practicality of the training for use on the job. Learners must perceive a close relationship between the training and things they want for it to be successful. Self-efficacy People’s belief that they can successfully learn the training program content. Adult learning Ways in which adults learn differently than younger people. Learning Styles People learn in different ways. For example, auditory learners learn best by listening to someone else tell them about the training content. Tactile learners must “get their hands on” the training resources and use them. Visual learners think in pictures and figures and need to see the purpose and process of the training. Trainers who address all these styles by using multiple training methods can design more effective training. Training design also must sometimes address special issues presented by adult learning. Certainly, the training design must consider that all the trainees are adults, but adults come with widely varying learning styles, experiences, and personal goals. For example, training older adults in technology may require greater attention to explaining the need for changes and to enhancing the older trainees’ confidence and abilities when learning new technologies. In contrast, younger adults are more likely to be familiar with new technology because of their earlier exposure to computers and technology. Malcolm Knowles’s classic work on adult learning suggests five principles for designing training for adults.32 According to that work and subsequent work by others, adults: • LOGGING ON Learnativity.com For articles and other resources on adult learning, training, and evaluation, visit this website at www.learnativity.com. • • • • Have the need to know why they are learning something. Have a need to be self-directed. Bring more work-related experiences into the learning process. Enter into a learning experience with a problemcentered approach to learning. Are motivated to learn by both extrinsic and intrinsic factors. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 264 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 Training Human Resources 265 Instructional Strategies An important part of designing training is to select the right mix of strategies to fit the learners’ characteristics. Practice/feedback, overlearning, behavioral modeling, error-based examples, and reinforcement/immediate confirmation are some of the prominent strategies available in designing the training experience. Practice/Feedback For some kinds of training, it is important that learners practice what they have learned and get feedback on how they have done so they can improve. Active practice occurs when trainees perform job-related tasks and duties during training. It is more effective than simply reading or passively listening. For instance, assume a person is being trained as a customer service representative. After being given some basic selling instructions and product details, the trainee calls a customer and uses the knowledge received. Active practice can be structured in two ways. The first, spaced practice, occurs when several practice sessions are spaced over a period of hours or days. The second, massed practice, occurs when a person performs all the practice at once. Spaced practice works better for some types of skills and for physical learning that requires muscle memory, whereas massed practice is usually more effective for other kinds of learning, such as memorizing tasks. Imagine the difficulty of trying to memorize the lists of options for 20 dishwasher models if memorized at a rate of one model a day for 20 days. By the time the appliance distribution salespeople had learned the last option, they likely would have forgotten the first one. Overlearning Overlearning is repeated practice even after a learner has mastered the performance. It may be best used to instill “muscle memory” for a physical activity in order to reduce the amount of thinking necessary and make responses automatic. But overlearning also produces improvement in learner retention. Research suggests that even with overlearning, refreshers are still sometimes necessary to reduce the effect of response delay.33 Active practice Performance of job-related tasks and duties by trainees during training. Spaced practice Practice performed in several sessions spaced over a period of hours or days. Massed practice Practice performed all at once. Behavioral modeling Copying someone else’s behavior. Behavioral Modeling The most elementary way in which people learn—and one of the best—is through behavioral modeling, or copying someone else’s behavior. The use of behavioral modeling is particularly appropriate for skill training in which the trainees must use both knowledge and practice. It can aid in the transfer of skills and the usage of those skills by those who are trained.34 For example, a new supervisor can receive training and mentoring on how to handle disciplinary discussions with employees by observing as the HR director or department manager deals with such problems. Behavioral modeling is used extensively as the primary means for training supervisors and managers in interpersonal skills. Fortunately or unfortunately, many supervisors and managers end up modeling behaviors they see their bosses use. For that reason, supervisor training should include good role models to show how to handle interpersonal interactions with employees. Error-Based Examples The error-based examples method involves sharing with learners what can go wrong when they do not use the training properly. A good example is sharing with pilots what can happen when they are not aware of a situation they and their aircraft are entering. Situational awareness training that includes error-based examples has been shown to improve air crew situational awareness.35 Error-based examples have been incorporated in military, firefighting, and police training as well as aviation training. Case studies that show negative consequences of errors are a good tool for communicating error-based examples. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 265 26/06/10 5:15 PM 266 SECTION 3 Training and Development Reinforcement and Immediate Confirmation The concept of reinforcement is based on the law of effect, which states that people tend to repeat responses that give them some type of positive reward and to avoid actions associated with negative consequences. Positively reinforcing correct learned responses while providing negative consequences at some point for wrong responses can change behavior. Closely related is an instructional strategy called immediate confirmation, which is based on the idea that people learn best if reinforcement and feedback are given as soon as possible after training. Immediate confirmation corrects errors that, if made throughout the training, might establish an undesirable pattern that would need to be unlearned. It also aids with the transfer of training to the actual work done. Transfer of Training Reinforcement Based on the idea that people tend to repeat responses that give them some type of positive reward and to avoid actions associated with negative consequences. Immediate confirmation Based on the idea that people learn best if reinforcement and feedback are given as soon as possible after training. Finally, trainers should design training for the highest possible transfer from the class to the job. Transfer occurs when trainees actually use on the job what knowledge and information they learned in training. The amount of training that effectively gets transferred to the job is estimated to be relatively low, given all the time and money spent on training. It is estimated that about 40% of employees apply training to their jobs immediately after training. Among those who do not use the training immediately, the likelihood of it being used decreases over time.36 Effective transfer of training meets two conditions. First, the trainees can take the material learned in training and apply it to the job context in which they work. Second, employees maintain their use of the learned material over time. A number of things can increase the transfer of training. Offering trainees an overview of the training content and how it links to the strategy of the organization seems to help with both short-term and longer-term training transfer. Another helpful approach is to ensure that the training mirrors the job context as much as possible. For example, training managers to be better selection interviewers should include role-playing with “applicants” who respond in the same way that real applicants would. One of the most consistent factors in training transfer is the support new trainees receive from their supervisors to use their new skills when they return to the job.37 Supervisor support of the training, feedback from the supervisor, and supervisor involvement in training are powerful influences in transfer. Opportunity to use the training also is important. To be trained on something but never to have the opportunity to use it obviously limits transfer. Learners need the opportunity to use new skills on the job if the skills are to remain. Finally, accountability helps transfer training from class to job. Accountability is the extent to which someone expects the learner to use the new skills on the job and holds them responsible for doing so. It may require supervisory praise for doing the task correctly and sanctions for not showing proper trained behavior, but making people accountable for their own trained behavior is effective.38 TRAINING DELIVERY Once training has been designed, the actual delivery of training can begin. Regardless of the type of training done, a number of approaches and methods can be used to deliver it. The growth of training technology continues to expand the available choices, as Figure 8-7 shows. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 266 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 267 Training Human Resources Training Delivery Options FIGURE 8-7 Internal Traditional classes On-the-job training Self-guided training at company portal Mentoring/coaching Job shadowing Developing teachers internally Cross training Training projects Group-based classroom External Third-party delivered training Web conferences Training at outside location Podcasts Educational leave Blended training Teleconferencing Whatever the approach used, a variety of considerations must be balanced when selecting training delivery methods. The common variables considered are: • • • • • • Nature of training Subject matter Number of trainees Individual versus team Self-paced versus guided Training resources/costs • • • • E-learning versus traditional learning Geographic locations Time allotted Completion timeline To illustrate, a large firm with many new hires may be able to conduct employee orientation using the Internet, videotapes, and specific HR staff members, while a small firm with few new hires may have an HR staff member meet individually with the new hires for several hours. A medium-sized company with three locations in a geographic area may bring supervisors together for a two-day training workshop once a quarter. However, a large, global firm may use Web-based courses to reach supervisors throughout the world, with content available in several languages. Frequently training is conducted internally, but some types of training use external or technological training resources. Further, training can be formal or informal. Formal training is very visible, as it consists of planned learning activities. Informal training takes place when learning may not be the primary focus, but it occurs anyway. The informal learning may be the result of some sort of self-initiated effort or simply serendipitous, but it often occurs as needed.39 Internal Training Internal training generally applies very specifically to the organization and its jobs. It is popular because it saves the cost of sending employees away for training and often avoids the cost of outside trainers. Skills-based technical training is usually conducted inside organizations. Training materials are often created internally as well.40 Due to rapid changes in technology, the building and updating of technical skills may become crucial internal training needs. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 267 26/06/10 5:15 PM 268 SECTION 3 Training and Development Basic technical skills training is also being mandated by federal regulations in areas where the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA), the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), and other agencies have jurisdiction. Three types of internal delivery options will be discussed here: informal training, on-the-job training (OJT), and cross training. Informal Training One internal source of training is informal training, which occurs through interactions and feedback among employees. Much of what employees know about their jobs they learn informally from asking questions and getting advice from other employees and their supervisors, rather than from formal training programs. Informal learning tends to occur as a result of a learning need in the context of working.41 It may involve group problem solving, job shadowing, coaching, or mentoring; or it may evolve from employees seeking out other people who have the needed knowledge. Although “informal training” may seem to be a misnomer, a great deal of learning occurs informally in work organizations, and some of it happens by design. Informal training Training that occurs through interactions and feedback among employees. FIGURE 8-8 On-the-Job Training The most common type of training at all levels in an organization is on-the-job training (OJT) because it is flexible and relevant to what employees do.42 Well-planned and well-executed OJT can be very effective.43 Based on a guided form of training known as job instruction training (JIT), OJT is most effective if a logical progression of stages is used, as shown in Figure 8-8. In contrast with informal training, which often occurs spontaneously, OJT should be planned. The supervisor or manager conducting the training must be able to both teach and show the employees what to do. However, OJT has some problems. Often, those doing the training may have no experience in training, no time to do it, or no desire to participate in it. Under such conditions, learners essentially are on their own, and training likely will not be effective. Another problem is that OJT can disrupt regular work. Unfortunately, OJT can amount to no training at all in some circumstances, especially if the trainers simply abandon the trainees to learn the job alone. Also, bad habits or incorrect information from the supervisor or manager can be transferred to the trainees. Stages for On-the-Job Training Prepare the Trainees Present the Information Put them at ease Find out what they know Get them interested Tell, show, question Present one point at a time Make sure the trainees know Provide the Trainees with Practice Have the trainees perform the tasks Ask questions Observe and correct Evaluate mastery Do Follow-Up Put the trainees on their own Check frequently Reduce follow-up as performance improves Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 268 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 269 Training Human Resources Cross Training “Universal Agents” As technology has matured in the banking business, ATMs, debit cards, online banking, and direct deposit have changed the job of the bank teller and reduced the need for teller-processed transactions. Cross training can combine the duties of a teller with the duties of a member service representative (MSR), which helps by retaining jobs, making the jobs more interesting and varied, and saving the bank costs. A “universal agent” is an employee who is crosstrained as both a teller and an MSR. This employee can cover employee absences and lunch breaks for either tellers or MSRs. The universal agent can be scheduled for either position during periods of peak activity, such as Friday afternoons. But to make these advantages become possible, the bank or credit union must provide support with cross training and technology that allows the employee to shift from one job to the other. The universal agent should be able to serve as a transaction processor, financial counselor, and service provider. Universal agents can approach customers and get them to the proper place/person or handle their needs themselves. If customers need checks cashed, the agent can take them to the teller station. If customers need CDs renewed, the agent can do that at a work station. If Cross training Training people to do more than one job. HR perspective customers need loans, the agent can begin the process and call the loan manager for consultation if necessary. Two technological changes are necessary to make this work. First, the traditional teller’s position has to be redesigned to allow the agent to move between the teller’s work station and the sales and service work station. Employees circulate through the bank, and every customer receives a sit-down interaction with an agent for all activities. The second technological change necessary to make the universal agent position work is acquisition of a machine called a “cash recycler.” This machine accepts, stores, and dispenses currency and coins similar to an ATM. It allows the universal agent to get away from the traditional teller’s cash drawer, which must be closed, reconciled, and locked anytime it is left. Teller and MSR skill sets differ, and cross training is critical to teach someone in one position the duties of an employee in the other. Tellers may need sales training to be able to do the MSR job, and MSRs will need teller training. However, when properly done, the universal agent approach can provide a better sales and service experience for the customer and keep transaction costs to a minimum.47 Cross Training Cross training occurs when people are trained to do more than one job—theirs and someone else’s.44 For the employer, the advantages of cross training are flexibility and development.45 However, although cross training is attractive to the employer, it is not always appreciated by employees, who often feel that it requires them to do more work for the same pay. To counteract such responses and to make it more appealing to employees, learning “bonuses” can be awarded for successfully completing cross training. In some organizations, the culture may be such that people seek crosstraining assignments to grow or prepare for a promotion, but that is not the case in all organizations.46 Unions typically are not in favor of cross training because it threatens job jurisdiction and broadens jobs. Cross training may require scheduling work differently during training, and temporarily decreased productivity may result from it as people learn. Overall, an effective crosstraining program can overcome the concerns mentioned and has the potential to be good for both employer and employee, as the HR Perspective: Cross Training Universal Agents illustrates. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 269 26/06/10 5:15 PM 270 SECTION 3 Training and Development External Training External training, or training that takes place outside the employing organization, is used extensively by organizations of all sizes. Large organizations use external training if they lack the capability to train people internally or when many people need to be trained quickly. External training may be the best option for training in smaller firms due to limitations in the size of their training staffs and in the number of employees who need various types of specialized training. Whatever the size of the organization, external training occurs for several reasons: • • • • It may be less expensive for an employer to have an outside trainer conduct training in areas where internal training resources are limited. The organization may have insufficient time to develop internal training materials. The HR staff may not have the necessary level of expertise for the subject matter in which training is needed. There are advantages to having employees interact with managers and peers in other companies in training programs held externally. Outsourcing of Training Many employers of all sizes outsource training to external training firms, consultants, and other entities. Perhaps one-third of training expenditures go to outside training sources. The reasons more outside training is not used may be cost concerns, and a greater emphasis on internal linking of training to organizational strategies. However, outsourcing of training is used more frequently when mergers and acquisition occur.48 A popular route for some employers is to use vendors and suppliers to train employees. Several computer software vendors offer employees technical certifications on their software. For example, being a Microsoft Certified Product Specialist gives employees credentials that show their level of technical expertise. Such certifications provide employees with items to put on their résumés should they decide to change jobs. These certifications also benefit employers, who can use them as job specifications for hiring and promotion. Many suppliers host users’ conferences, where employees from a number of firms receive detailed training on using products, services, and features that are new to the employees. Some vendors will conduct the training inside an organization as well if sufficient numbers of employees are to be trained. Government-Supported Job Training Federal, state, and local governments provide a wide range of external training assistance and funding. The Workforce Investment Act (WIA) provides states with block grant programs that target adult education, disadvantaged youth, and family literacy. Employers hiring and training individuals who meet the WIA criteria receive tax credits and other assistance for 6 months or more, depending on the program regulations. At state and local levels, employers that add to their workforces can take advantage of a number of programs that provide funding assistance to offset training costs. As an example, a number of states offer workforce training assistance for employers. Quick Start (Georgia), Smart Jobs (Texas), and Partnership (Alabama) are three well-known training support efforts. Often such programs are linked to two-year and four-year colleges throughout the state. Educational Assistance Programs Some employers pay for additional education for their employees. Typically, the employee pays for a course that Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 270 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 271 Training Human Resources applies to a college degree and is reimbursed upon successful completion of the course. The amounts paid by the employer are considered nontaxable income for the employee up to amounts set by federal laws. Lifelong Learning Accounts (LiLA) programs can be offered by employers. These accounts are like 401(K) plans—employers and employees contribute to a fund for adult education. The employee owns the plan and keeps it even if the employee leaves the company. It can be LOGGING ON used to further one’s education, perhaps in order to move to Quick Start Technical College a different job in the company.49 System of Georgia One concern about traditional forms of employee educaThe Quick Start system provides tional programs is that they may pose risks for the employer. information on delivering workforce Upon completion of the degree, the employee may choose to training in a broad range of industry take the new skills and go elsewhere. Employers must plan sectors. Visit the website at to use these skills upon employee graduation to improve the www.georgiaquickstart.org. retention of those employees. Combination Training Approaches Whether training is delivered internally or externally, appropriate training must be chosen. The following overview identifies two common training approaches that often integrate internal and external means. Some are used more for job-based training, while others are used more for development. Cooperative Training Cooperative training approaches mix classroom training and on-the-job experiences. This training can take several forms. One form, generally referred to as school-to-work transition, helps individuals move into jobs while still in school or on completion of formal schooling. Such efforts may be arranged with high schools or community colleges. Another form of cooperative training used by employers, trade unions, and government agencies is apprentice training. An apprenticeship program provides an employee with on-the-job experience under the guidance of a skilled and certified worker. Certain requirements for training, equipment, time length, and proficiency levels may be monitored by a unit of the U.S. Department of Labor. Figure 8-9 indicates the most common areas that use apprenticeships to train people for jobs. Apprenticeships usually last 2 to 5 years, depending on the occupation. During this time, the apprentice usually receives lower wages than the certified individual. A form of cooperative training called internship usually combines job training with classroom instruction from schools, colleges, and universities.50 Internships benefit both employers and interns. Interns get real-world exposure, a line on their résumés, and a chance to closely examine a possible FIGURE 8-9 Most Common Apprenticeship Occupations Electrician (construction) Carpenter Plumber Pipe fitter Sheet metal worker Structural-steel worker Elevator constructor Roofer Sprinkler fitter Bricklayer Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 271 26/06/10 5:15 PM 272 SECTION 3 Training and Development employer. Employers get a cost-effective source of labor and a chance to see an intern at work before making a final hiring decision.51 E-Learning: Online Training E-learning is use of the Internet or an organizational intranet to conduct training online. E-learning is popular with employers. The major advantages are cost savings and access to more employees. Estimates are that corporate training conducted through learning technology will increase in the next few years.52 Almost 30% of learning hours today are totally technology based, according to an ASTD report, and e-learning is preferred by workers under the age of 30.53 However, e-learning is advancing gradually, not explosively. It has found favor as part of a “blended” solution that combines it with other forms of learning. By itself, e-learning is not rated among the top effective training practices by training professionals.54 Changes in technology appear to make possible in the future some things that were not possible in the first years of e-learning. For example, Web 2.0 tools such as instant messaging and Web conferencing may allow trainers to expand to “soft skills” electronic training,55 and the ability to have reasonably priced video conferencing may make training via this medium more acceptable.56 LOGGING ON The method is certainly fast and flexible. For example, E Learning Guild after Hurricane Katrina, a Red Cross volunteer was able to This website provides members with design and make an online course to train volunteers availlearning opportunities, networking able in 4 days. When volunteers signed up to help, they were services, resources, and publications immediately directed to the online training course.57 Three on e-learning. Visit the site at areas where online learning has proved to be beneficial are www.elearninguild.com. distance training/learning, simulations, and blended learning. Distance Training/Learning Many college and university classes use some form of Internet-based course support. Blackboard and WebCT are two popular support packages that thousands of college professors use to make their lecture content available to students. These packages enable virtual chat and electronic file exchange among course participants, and also enhance instructor-student contact. Many large employers use interactive two-way television to present classes. The medium allows an instructor in one place to see and respond to a “class” in any number of other locations. With a fully configured system, employees can take courses from anywhere in the world.58 Simulations and Training Computer-based training involves a wide array of multimedia technologies—including sound, motion (video and animation), graphics, and hypertext—to tap multiple learner senses. Computer-supported simulations within e-learning can replicate the psychological and behavioral requirements of a task, often in addition to providing some amount of physical resemblance to the trainee’s work environment. From highly complicated systems that replicate difficult landing scenarios for pilots to programs that help medical trainees learn to sew sutures, simulations allow for safe training when the risks associated with failure are high. For example, sanitation workers can get practice driving on slick roads and down tight alleys without damaging anything. A $450,000 computer simulation uses videos, movement, and sound to simulate driving a dump truck. Accidents from poor truck handling skills include damage to fences, posts, and buildings. The safety training simulation reduces such accidents.59 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 272 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 273 Training Human Resources Simulations and Games A young woman walks into a restaurant in a busy city, sets down a purse, and leaves. Moments later a bomb explodes, and people are screaming and injured as the restaurant goes up in flames. Fire trucks and police go to work to deal with the mess. This did not really happen; it is a training simulation made to teach emergency response initiatives. Such real-time virtual training forces employees to apply their knowledge in the real world, and to make quick decisions in difficult situations. Many people play computer games for fun, but games in various forms also are becoming a very useful part of training. For years military and government workers have used games and simulations to prepare for combat, improve the use of military equipment, and prepare for natural and human-caused disasters. Now many private employers of all types are using gaming situations for both new and existing employees. For example, a company in Pittsburg uses a virtual training environment in which employees learn to operate a forklift to move loads from the loading area HR perspective to another area. They must check their equipment before starting, and a wrong move may result in a forklift crashing into another employee or driving off the dock. The simulation allows learning without tying up the dock for training or hurting anyone. Railroads, trucking companies, banks, retailers, technology firms, hotels, and many others are using gaming simulations. Doing so appears to increase employee interest in training, promises better training transfer, and improves performance. A younger workforce seems to appreciate the training method. Game-based learning (GBL) can present realistic, complete, and captivating experiences for employees. For many, “winning the game” is more motivating than answering questions or taking a test. However, GBL requires the same needs analysis and planning as any other training effort. While the games may be more interesting than some classes, they do not automatically provide good training. The right game must be used to teach the right things.60 Virtual reality is also used to create an artificial environment for trainees so that they can participate in the training. Gaming is a growing e-learning tool, as the HR Perspective describes. The new technologies incorporated into training delivery affect the design, administration, and support of training. Some companies have invested in electronic registration and recordkeeping systems that allow trainers to register participants, record exam results, and monitor learning progress. Generally, technology is moving from center stage to becoming embedded in the learning and training processes. As learning and work merge even closer in the future, technology is likely to integrate seamlessly into the work environment of more employees. This integration will allow employees to spend less time in the future learning how to use technology, and more time on learning the desired content. For example, screening passenger bags in airports has been improved by using a simulation tied to the X-ray machine that is used to screen.61 Blended learning Learning approach that combines methods, such as short, fast-paced, interactive computer-based lessons and teleconferencing with traditional classroom instruction and simulation. Blended Learning E-learning cannot be the sole method of training, according to the findings of a number of employers.62 Therefore, the solution seems to be blended learning, which might combine short, fast-paced, interactive computerbased lessons and teleconferencing with traditional classroom instruction and simulation.63 Deciding which training is best handled by which medium is important. A blended learning approach can use e-learning for building knowledge of certain basics, a Web-based virtual classroom for building skills, and significant Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 273 26/06/10 5:15 PM 274 SECTION 3 FIGURE 8-10 Training and Development Advantages and Disadvantages of E-Learning Advantages Is self-paced; trainees can proceed on their own time Is interactive, tapping multiple trainee senses Enables scoring of exercises/ assessments and the appropriate feedback Incorporates built-in guidance and help for trainees to use when needed Allows trainers to update content relatively easily Can enhance instructor-led training Is good for presenting simple facts and concepts Can be paired with simulation Disadvantages May cause trainee anxiety Some trainees may not be interested in how it is used Requires easy and uninterrupted access to computers Is not appropriate for some training (leadership, cultural change, etc.) Requires significant upfront investment both in time and costs Requires significant support from top management to be successful Some choose not to do it even if it is available in-person traditional instructor-led training sessions and courses. Use of blended learning provides greater flexibility in the use of multiple training means and enhances the appeal of training activities to different types of employees.64 Advantages and Disadvantages of E-Learning The rapid growth of e-learning makes the Internet or an intranet a viable means for delivering training content. But e-learning has both advantages and disadvantages that must be considered.65 In addition to being concerned about employee access to e-learning and desire to use it, some employers worry that trainees will use e-learning to complete courses quickly but will not retain and use much of what they learned. Taking existing training materials, putting them on the Internet, and cutting the training budget is not the way to succeed with e-learning. An important question to ask is: Can this material be learned as well online as through conventional methods? In some cases, the answer is no. E-learning is the latest development in training delivery. Some of the biggest obstacles to using it will be keeping up with the rapid changes in technological innovation and designing e-courses appropriately. E-learning has had a major impact on HR and training, but there are no “ten easy steps” to making e-learning successful. Figure 8-10 presents a listing of the most commonly cited advantages and disadvantages of e-learning. TRAINING EVALUATION Evaluation of training compares the post-training results to the pre-training objectives of managers, trainers, and trainees. Too often, training is conducted with little thought of measuring and evaluating it later to see how well it worked. Because training is both time consuming and costly, it should be evaluated.66 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 274 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 275 Training Human Resources F I G U R E 8 - 11 Levels of Training Evaluation High Value to Organization Results Behavior Learning Reaction Low Easy Difficult Levels of Evaluation It is best to consider how training is to be evaluated before it begins. Donald L. Kirkpatrick identified four levels at which training can be evaluated. As Figure 8-11 shows, the evaluation of training becomes successively more difficult to do as it moves from measuring reaction to measuring learning to measuring behavior and then to measuring results. But the training that affects behavior and results versus reaction and learning provides greater value in viewing training as a strategic performance contributor.67 Reaction Organizations evaluate the reaction levels of trainees by conducting interviews with or administering questionnaires to the trainees. Assume that 30 managers attend a two-day workshop on effective interviewing skills. A reaction-level measure could be gathered by having the managers complete a survey that asked them to rate the value of the training, the style of the instructors, and the usefulness of the training to them. Learning Learning levels can be evaluated by measuring how well trainees have learned facts, ideas, concepts, theories, and attitudes. Tests on the training material are commonly used for evaluating learning, and they can be given both before and after training to provide scores that can be compared. If test scores indicate learning problems, then instructors get feedback and courses can be redesigned so that the content can be delivered more effectively. Of course, learning enough to pass a test does not guarantee that trainees will remember the training content months later or that it will change job behaviors.68 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 275 26/06/10 5:15 PM 276 SECTION 3 Training and Development Behavior Evaluating training at the behavioral level means measuring the effect of training on job performance through observing job performance. For instance, the managers who participated in an interviewing workshop might be observed conducting actual interviews of applicants for jobs in their departments. If the managers asked questions as they had been trained to and used appropriate follow-up questions, then behavioral indicators of the effectiveness of the interviewing training exist. Results Employers evaluate results by measuring the effect of training on the achievement of organizational objectives. Because results such as productivity, turnover, quality, time, sales, and costs are relatively concrete, this type of evaluation can be done by comparing records before and after training. For the managers who attended interviewing training, evaluators could gather records of the number of individuals hired compared with the number of employment offers made before and after the training. The difficulty with measuring results is pinpointing whether changes were actually the result of training or of other major factors. For example, the managers who completed the interviewing training program can be measured on employee turnover before and after the training, but turnover also depends on the current economic situation, the demand for workers, and many other variables. Training Evaluation Metrics M E A S U R E Training is expensive, and it is an HR function that requires measurement and monitoring. Cost–benefit analysis and return-on-investment (ROI) analysis are commonly used to measure training results, as are various benchmarking approaches. Cost–Benefit Analysis Training results can be examined through cost–benefit analysis, which is comparison of costs and benefits associated with training. There are four stages in calculating training costs and benefits:69 1. Determine training costs. Consider direct costs such as design, trainer fees, materials, facilities, and other administration activities. 2. Identify potential savings results. Consider employee retention, better customer service, fewer work errors, quicker equipment production, and other productivity factors. 3. Compute potential savings. Gather data on the performance results and assign dollar costs to each of them. 4. Conduct costs and savings benefits comparisons. Evaluate the costs per participant, the savings per participant, and how the costs and benefits relate to business performance numbers. Cost–benefit analysis Comparison of costs and benefits associated with training. One firm uses HR metrics for many aspects of evaluating how general managers and their stores are performing. Scoring results are produced annually, quarterly, and monthly. Figure 8-12 shows some costs and benefits that may result from training. Even though some benefits (such as attitude changes) are hard to quantify, comparison of costs and benefits associated with training remains a way to determine whether training is cost-effective. For example, one firm evaluated a traditional safety training program and found that the program did not lead to a reduction in accidents. Therefore, the safety training was redesigned, and better safety practices resulted. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 276 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 277 Training Human Resources FIGURE 8-12 Possible Costs and Benefits in Training Typical Costs Trainer’s salary and time Trainees’ salaries and time Materials for training Expenses for trainer and trainees Cost of facilities and equipment Lost productivity (opportunity cost) Typical Benefits Increase in production Reduction in errors and accidents Reduction in turnover Less supervision necessary Ability to use new capabilities Attitude changes Cost–Benefit Analysis Return-on-Investment Analysis and Benchmarking In organizations, training is often expected to produce an ROI. Still, too often, training is justified because someone liked it, rather than on the basis of resource accountability. ROI simply divides the return produced because of the training by the cost (or investment) of the training. In addition to evaluating training internally, some organizations use benchmark measures to compare it with training done in other organizations. To do benchmarking, HR professionals gather data on training in their organization and compare them with data on training at other organizations in the same industry and in companies of a similar size. Comparison data are available through the American Society for Training and Development and its Benchmarking Service. This service has training-related data from more than 1,000 participating employers who complete detailed questionnaires annually. Training also can be benchmarked against data from the American Productivity & Quality Center and the Saratoga Institute. Training Evaluation Designs With or without benchmarking data, internal evaluations of training programs can be designed in a number of ways. The rigor of the three designs discussed next increases with each level. Post-Measure The most obvious way to evaluate training effectiveness is to determine after the training whether the individuals can perform the way management wants them to perform. Assume that a customer service manager has 20 representatives who need to improve their data-entry speeds. After a one-day training session, they take a test to measure their speeds. If the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 277 26/06/10 5:15 PM 278 SECTION 3 Training and Development representatives can all type the required speed after training, was the training beneficial? It is difficult to say; perhaps most of them could have done as well before training. Tests after training do not always clearly indicate whether a performance is a result of the training or could have been achieved without the training. Pre-/Post-Measure By differently designing the evaluation just discussed, the issue of pretest skill levels can be considered. If the data-entry speed is measured before and after training, then it will indicate whether the training made any difference. However, a question would remain: Was any increase in speed a response to the training, or did these employees simply work faster because they knew they were being tested? People often perform better when they know their efforts are being evaluated. Pre-/Post-Measure with a Control Group Another evaluation design can address the preceding problem. In addition to testing the 20 representatives who will be trained, the manager can test another group of representatives who will not be trained, to see if they do as well as those who are to be trained. This second group is called a control group. After training, if the trained representatives work significantly faster than those who were not trained, the manager can be reasonably sure that the training was effective. S U M M A R Y • • • • • • • • Training is the process that provides people with the capabilities they need to do their jobs. Four types of training are regular/required, job/ technical, interpersonal/problem solving, and developmental/career in nature. A strategic approach to training links organizational strategies and HR planning to various training efforts. Training affects factors such as organizational competitiveness, knowledge management, revenue, and performance. Performance consulting compares desired and actual results in order to identify needed training and nontraining actions. Global strategies must consider training as a key component, including intercultural competence training to prepare employees to respond more appropriately to situations encountered during global assignments. The training process consists of four phases: assessment, design, delivery, and evaluation. Training needs can be assessed using organizational, job/task, and individual analyses, and then training objectives can be set to help the organization meet those needs. • Training design must consider learner readiness, learning styles, and learning transfer. • Training can be delivered internally (e.g., OJT training) or through external means, and formally (e.g., through classes) or informally. • Common training approaches include cooperative training and classroom/conference training. • Orientation is a form of onboarding designed to help new employees learn about their jobs. • E-learning is training conducted using the Internet or an intranet, and both its advantages and its disadvantages must be considered in its development. • Various organizations are taking advantage of training that uses technology, such as Web-based multimedia, video streaming, simulation, and virtual reality. • Training can be evaluated at four levels: reaction, learning, behavior, and results. • Training evaluation metrics may include cost– benefit analysis, ROI analysis, and benchmarking. • A pre-/post-measure with a control group is the most rigorous design for training evaluation; other, less rigorous designs can be used as well. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 278 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 279 Training Human Resources C R I T I C A L T H I N K I N G 1. Identify training needs for a group of new salespeople in a high-end jewelry store. 2. Why is evaluating training an important part of strategic training? 3. Develop an orientation checklist based on one first-day session and a second session of 4 hours each to cover 30-days later. H R E X P E R I E N T I A L Due to rapid growth of your technology company, the executive team has asked HR to develop an internal training program. The purpose of the program is to help employees recently promoted to supervisory positions develop the leadership skill sets they need to be successful as supervisors. This will be the first formal training program for your small company. As part of the process, you want to consider the learning styles of the new supervisors. To assist you in developing a successful, A C T I V I T I E S 4. Make a briefing for division managers showing the advantages and disadvantages of e-learning and how to “blend” it with other teaching techniques. Use websites, including www.ASTD.org. P R O B L E M S O L V I N G results-oriented program, review various training websites, including www.agelesslearner.com. 1. To meet the needs of the varied learning styles and maximize the learning potential of the participants, what training techniques should be implemented? 2. Identify the content topics that you will recommend be included in the program to ensure the development of successful leaders. C A S E 21st-Century Onboarding New employees at Sun Microsystems begin their orientation sessions after being hired with a computer game. It is part of an attempt to integrate new people, improve the image of the company, get feedback, and start training. Looking over the shoulder of a new employee, one would see the person playing a computer game called “Dawn of the Shadow Spectors,” battling evil forces that are trying to destroy Sun’s network. Before Sun changed its orientation program, an employee’s first day at work consisted mostly of filling out paperwork, as in most companies. Some new employees waited 2 weeks to get e-mail, and people who worked remotely sometimes waited weeks or months before meeting their managers. The chief learning officer at Sun said, “We wanted to make a better first impression,” unlike that made on an employee’s first day if the company/manager is not ready and the person just sits there. That can make a bad impression that is lasting. Now at Sun the onboarding starts as soon as a person accepts a job. The new employee logs on to the company’s new hire website and learns about the company by playing video games. The person sees a welcome video from the CEO and connects with other employees via social networks. New employees also fill out their W-4s, I-9s, and other paperwork on the website. Sun, which has about 34,000 employees, believes orientation should start the moment a person is hired and continue until the person is productive. A Houston-based company, El Paso Corporation, which employs about 5,000, has a different onboarding process. New hires attend a first-day orientation and then another a month later. During their first week at the company, they get an e-mail with links to everything from ordering business cards to joining the credit union. Before the new system was instituted, employees sometimes waited to even get a computer. One company official noted that new employees “were here but just sitting around because they didn’t have the tools to work.” Now they have a workspace, computer, and network access on their first day. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 279 26/06/10 5:15 PM 280 SECTION 3 Training and Development An advertising agency in Fort Lauderdale, Florida, takes yet a different approach. Zimmerman Advertising, which has about 1,000 employees, wants employees to understand the company, so new hires log on and learn from the new hire website what the company does, its client philosophy, and about its leadership. Then they meet for an hour with the CEO who talks about how he built the company. New hires get a 30-, 60-, and 90-day training checklist that must be completed on time and signed by their supervisor. They also have an opportunity to provide feedback via the website. Modern onboarding systems help new employees understand what the company is all about so they are prepared to integrate into it, says Zimmerman’s Vice President of HR.70 QUESTIONS 1. The case introduces three companies of very different sizes with three different onboarding approaches. What differences do you see in their approaches? What similarities? 2. Are there important ideas missing from all three approaches? If so, what are they? 3. Which approach sounds best to you? Why? S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Training Crucial for Hotels New Payroll Clerk This case illustrates the increased role training is playing in large U.S. hotel chains. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/mathis.) This case shows the frustration that often accompanies the first day at work, and why orientation is important in reducing turnover. (For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/ mathis.) N O T E S 1. Based on Adrienne Fox, “China: Land of Opportunity and Challenge,” HR Magazine, September 2007, 38–44; Z.A.S. Udani, “International Briefing 21: Training and Development in MACAO,” International Journal of Training and Development, 12, No. 4 (2009), 280–296. 2. Herman Aquinis and Kurt Kraiger, “Benefits of Training and Development for Individuals and Teams, Organizations and Society,” Annual Review of Psychology, 60 (2009), 451–474. 3. Julie Bos, “Maximize Every Training Dollar,” Workforce Management, November 17, 2008, 39. 4. Gilad Chan and Richard Klimoski, “Training and Development of Human Resources at Work,” Human Resource Management Review, 17 (2007), 180–190. 5. Michael Felton-O’Brien, “Taking the Pulse,” Human Resource Executive, November 19, 2007, 9. 6. James Hall and Marty Denis, “Compensability of Job Related 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Training,” Workplace Management, April 6, 2009, 10. Charlotte Huff, “Training Adapts to the Downturn,” Workforce Management, March 16, 2009, 22. “Tying Training and Development to Competitive Strategy,” Workforce Management, May 18, 2009, 53. “Strategic Training and Development,” SHRM Research Quarterly, First Quarter 2008, 1–9. Julie Bos, “Top Trends in Training and Leadership Development,” Workforce Management, November 19, 2007, 36. Phyllis Thaenou, et al., “A Review and Critique of Research on Training and Organizational Level Outcomes,” Human Resource Management Review, 17 (2007), 251–273. Based on Beverly Propst, “Business Education á la Carte,” HR Magazine, October 2008, 52–54. J. J. Smith, “U.S. Workers Tech Skills Declined While India, Eastern Europe Grew,” SHRM Global HR News, September 2006, www.shrm.org/global. 14. Paula Caligirvir and Saba Calakoglv, “A Strategic Contingency Approach to Expatriate Assignment Management,” Human Resource Management Journal, 17, 2007, 393–410. 15. Ann Tace, “Training for the Leap Overseas,” T + D, August 2009, 18. 16. Andrea Edmundson, “Culturally Accessible E-Learning,” T + D, April 2009, 41–45. 17. Shedeh Tavakoli, et al., “Effects of Assertiveness Training and Expressive Writing on Acculturative Stress in International Students,” Journal of Counseling Psychology, 56 (2009), 590–596. 18. Stephan Miller, “Skills Critical for a Changing Workforce,” HR Magazine, August 2008, 24. 19. Jean Thilmany, “Passing on KnowHow,” HR Magazine, June 2008, 100–104. 20. Danielle D’Amour, “Knowledge to Action: The Development of Training Strategies,” Healthcare Policy, 3, 2008, 68–79. 21. Alan M. Saks, et al., “Socialization Tactics and Newcomer Adjustment,” Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 280 26/06/10 5:15 PM CHAPTER 8 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. 34. 35. 281 Training Human Resources Journal of Vocational Behavior, 70, 2007, 413–446. Bridget Testa, “Early Engagement Long Relationship?” Workforce Management, September 22, 2008, 27–31; Jerry Newman, “The Undercover Secrets to Successful Onboarding,” Workspan, February 2009, 22–28. Patricia D’Aurizio, “Onboarding: Delivering on the Process,” Nursing Economics, July–August 2007, 228–229; Fay Hansen, “Onboarding for Greater Engagement,” Workforce Management Online, October 2008, www.workforce.com, 1–3. Kathy Gurchiek, “Orientation Programs Help New Hires Find Bearings,” SHRM HR News, May 25, 2007, www.shrm.org, 1–3. D. J. Chhabra, “What Web-Based Onboarding Can Do for Your Company,” Workspan, May 2008, 111–114. Louis Greenstein, “Beyond Day One,” Human Resource Executive, October 2, 2007, 1–26. Bill Gilmyers and Amir Assadi, “What Your New Hires Are Telling You,” Workspan, July 2009, 30–38. Pierre Gudjian and Oliver Triebel, “Identifying Employee Skill Gaps,” The McKinsey Quarterly, May 2009, 1–12. Rita Zeidner, “One Workforce Many Languages,” HR Magazine, January 2009, 33–37. Martha Frase, “An Underestimated Talent Pool,” HR Magazine, April 2009, 55–58. Sara B. Kimmel and Mary N. McNeese, “Barriers to Business Education: Motivating Adult Learners,” Journals of Behavioral and Applied Management, 7 (2006), 292. Malcolm S. Knowles, Elwood F. Holton III, and Richard A. Swanson, The Adult Learner, 6th ed. (New York: Elsevier, 2005). Lisa Burke and Holly Hutchins, “Training Transfer: An Integrative Literature Review,” Human Resource Development Review, 6 (2007), 275. John-Paul Hatala and Pamela Fleming, “Making Transfer Climate Visible: Utilizing Social Network Analysis to Facilitate Transfer of Training,” Human Resource Development Review, 6 (2007), 33–62. Simon Branbury, et al., “FASA: Development and Validation of a Novel Measure to Assess the Effectiveness of Commercial Airline Pilot Situation Awareness Training,” 36. 37. 38. 39. 40. 41. 42. 43. 44. 45. 46. 47. 48. 49. 50. 51. 52. 53. 54. 55. International Journal of Aviation Psychology, 17 (2007), 131–152. Raquel Velada, et al., “The Effect of Training Design, Individual Characteristics and Work Environment on Transfer of Training,” International Journal of Training and Development, 11 (2007), 282–294. Burke and Hutchins, op. cit., 28. Ibid., 281. Ronald Jacobs and Yoonhee Park, “A Proposed Conceptual Framework of Workplace Learning,” Human Resource Development Review, 8 (2009), 133–150. Mark Partridge, “Copyrights and Wrongs,” HR Magazine, November 2008, 101–104. Jacobs and Park, op. cit., 140–141. Kathryn Tyler, “15 Ways to Train on the Job,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 105–108. Maite Blazquez and Wiemer Salverda, “Low Wage Employment and the Role of Education and On-the-Job Training,” EALE Annual Conference (Amsterdam), September 2008, 1–27. Jennifer Arnould, “Kicking Up Cross-Training,” HR Magazine, August 2008, 96–100. Eylem Tekin, et al., “Pooling Strategies for Call Center Agent Cross-Training,” IEEE Transactions, 41, 2009, 546–561. Frada Mozenter, et al., “Perspective on Cross Training Public Service Staff in the Electronic Age: I Have to Learn to Do WHAT?” Journal of Academic Librarianship, 29, 2008, 339–404. “Cross Training Boosts Efficiency,” CU 360, 35, July 27, 2009, 6–7. Marianne Langlois, “Doing Learning Right,” Workforce Management, May 2008, 53. Susan Ladika, “When Learning Lasts a Lifetime,” HR Magazine, May 2008, 57–60. Beth Mirza, “Interns Experience the Real World of HR,” HR Magazine, September 2008, 144–145. Julie Cook Ramirez, “Internal Affairs,” Human Resource Executive, November 19, 2007, 15–17. Jeanne Meister, “Web Based Corporate Learning Takes Off,” Human Resource Executive, November 17, 2007, 15–17. American Society of Training and Development, www.astd.org. Sue Weekes, “May E-Learning Pay and Play,” Training Magazine, May 20, 2008, 1–2. Bill Roberts, “Hard Facts About Soft-Skills E-Learning,” HR Magazine, January 2008, 76–78. 56. Jim Ware and Charlie Granthom, “Is Video Conferencing Finally about to Take Off?” Workspan, December 2008, 18–20; Elizabeth Agnvall, “Meetings Go Virtual,” HR Magazine, January 2009, 74–78. 57. Sarah Fister Gale, “Do It Yourself E-Learning,” Workforce Management Online, May 2008, 1–2. 58. Elisabeth Bennett, “Virtual HRD: The Intersection of Knowledge Management, Culture, and Intranets,” Advances in Developing Human Resources, 11, 2009, 363–372. 59. Casper Star Tribune, October 4, 2009, F1B. 60. Sara Gale, “Virtual Training with Real Results,” Workforce Management, December 2008, 1–3; “Let the Games Begin,” Workforce Management, December 2008, 54. 61. Adrian Schwaninger, “Adaptive Computer Based Training Increases On-the-Job Performance of X-Ray Screeners,” IEEF Xplore, 2007, 117–124. 62. Ed Frauenheim, “Your Coworker, Your Teacher,” Workforce Management, 86, No. 2, 2007, 19–23. 63. Ji-Hye Park, “Factors Associated with Transfer of Training in Workplace E-Learning,” Journal of Workplace Learning, 19 (2007), 311–329. 64. Laura Aionso Diaz and Florentino Entonado, “Are the Functions of E-Learning and Face-to-Face Environments Really Different?” Educational Technology and Society, 12, 2009, 331–343. 65. Kurt Kraiger, “Transforming Our Models of Learning and Development: Web Based Instruction as Enabler of Third Generation Instruction,” Industrial and Organizational Psychology, 1, 2008, 454–467. 66. Joe Ruff, “Helping Firms Measure Worker Training Results,” Omaha World Herald, January 21, 2008. 67. Katharine Shobe and Barbara Curtis, “Training Assessment Challenges in a Military Environment: A U.S. Navy Example,” Performance Improvement, March 2007, 42–46. 68. Yiching Chen, “Learning to Learn: The Impact of Strategy Training,” ELT Journal, January 2007, 20–28. 69. “Calculate the Cost and Benefits of Training,” Workforce Management, 2007, www.workforce.com. 70. Leslie Klaff, “New Emphasis on First Impressions,” Workforce Management Online, March 2008, www.workforce.com, 1–3. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_08_ch08_p247-281.indd 281 26/06/10 5:15 PM C H A P T E R 9 Talent Management After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Identify the importance of talent management and discuss two reasons it may be difficult. • Explain what succession planning is and its steps. • Differentiate between organization-centered and individual-centered career planning. • Discuss three career issues that organizations and employees must address. • List options for development needs analyses. • Identify several management development methods. 282 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 282 26/06/10 5:17 PM HR Headline How Top Companies Develop Stars (© McDonald’s Corporation) T he CEO at American Express says, “Most companies maintain their office copiers better than they build the capabilities of their people.” But the world is changing and many companies are being forced to change as well. An examination of companies reveals that some of the best at managing talent include American Express, General Electric, McDonald’s, and Eli Lily. These so-called “Academy Companies” offer more training to their executives, and their alumni become leaders at other firms. American Express has built a rigorous leadership development program with metrics, incentives, goals, values, and calendars. But the biggest investment in leadership for these businesses is the time spent by the CEO and other executives. McDonald’s CEO personally reviews the development of the company’s top 200 managers. At GE, the CEO reviews the top 600. As the CEO’s subordinates see the importance the boss puts on development, they too spend time developing their subordinates. The result is a cascading emphasis on talent management. Indeed, at American Express 25% of a manager’s bonus is tied to talent development. GE requires new hires to intern at least one summer before hiring, and evaluation of their potential begins then. At Eli Lilly about two-thirds of development comes from job experience, one-third from mentoring and coaching, and a small bit from the classroom. Eli Lilly is also trying to deal with the problems associated with rotational assignments; the company is trying short-term additional work assignments where managers do not leave their jobs, but take on a project outside their field to aid development. The companies on the “Academies” list are also passionate about providing candidate performance feedback along with mentoring and support. Certainly that is not always the case in many organizations, but how can you improve if you don’t know how well you have done? Without feedback, managers stop caring.1 283 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 283 26/06/10 5:17 PM 284 SECTION 3 Training and Development Workforce planning is concerned with having the correct number of employees in the organization as they are needed. Talent management focuses on having the right individuals ready for the jobs when needed, and a pipeline full of talented people who are being developed for future organizational needs. The focus in talent management is on key positions, key job families, skills that will be needed, competency models, talent pools, and assessments for employees. The need for talent management is brought on by a demographic landscape dominated by the impending retirement of experienced baby boomers, a shortage of young people entering the workforce in western Europe and a decline in the 35–44 age group in the United States.2 Issues are further complicated by the number of high school graduates who lack writing and verbal communication skills, as well as a work ethic, and the number of college graduates who are weak in writing, leadership, critical thinking, and creativity skills.3 Where will the successful workforce of the future come from? Additionally, problems with talent management programs seem to be common.4 Research shows that a high percentage of companies are not prepared for a sudden loss of leadership, and most managers and executives are not held accountable for developing their direct reports.5 The levels of an organization most likely to be included in a talent management program are the executive and director levels, followed by CEOs and Vice Presidents.6 TALENT MANAGEMENT IN PERSPECTIVE The idea that human capital can be a source of competitive advantage for some organizations is gaining ground, but most organizations are not designed or managed to optimize talent performance.7 Choices for dealing successfully with talent needs are to: (1) emphasize stability in employment and develop talent internally, (2) develop agility as an organization and buy talent as needed, or (3) use some combination of 1 and 2. So the nature of the business and the environment in which it operates to some extent define appropriate strategies for talent management. Talent management has other characteristics that make it challenging as well. A major one is the nature of “talent” or people. For example, a “deep bench” of talent can be thought of as inventory. But unlike boxes full of empty bottles, talent does not always stay on the shelf until needed—it walks out the door for better opportunities.8 The shelf life of promising managers and specialists is short if they do not have opportunities where they are currently. Further, job candidates indicate that they are most attracted to opportunities to learn and grow. In fact, career development ranks higher than work-life balance and compensation/benefits for most job seekers.9 This makes the need for a successful talent management program even greater. Managing talent in global organizations is complex because movement of managers between countries is limited. Global leadership is especially challenging, as HR processes in different countries are often very different, and employees often expect to be demoted if they return to their home location.10 Global talent management is an even greater challenge than domestic talent management. One way to think of talent management is as a process that moves people from recruiting and selection to meeting the need of the organization for talent. Along the way, all the elements of talent management are encountered: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 284 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 285 Talent Management Talent Management FIGURE 9-1 ACQUISITION STEPS RESULTS Recruiting Training Management talent Selection Career planning Succession planning Key job talent Retention Development Performance management training, succession planning, career planning, development, and performance management. Figure 9-1 shows the idea. Training and performance management are covered in other chapters but succession planning, career planning, and development are covered in this chapter. Talent Management “Systems” Talent management seems to lend itself to the use of various software-based systems that purport to integrate all the pieces of talent management into one manageable whole. For example, one company used a talent management system in: • • • • • Documenting new employee orientations and the onboarding training, regardless of how and where it was done. Tracking classroom training and certifications completed by all store employees. Automating registration of participants for training and development activities. Reporting on completions of training certifications for store employees. Compiling and reporting the training and development history of individuals for use with career planning and development. However, according to one survey, although many companies are planning to use talent management technology, about half still use a manual approach.11 One reason for the demand for automated talent management systems is the situation that arose during the last recession. Many talented people were cut from the workforce, and some companies cut more of them than was necessary. Some employers view information from automation as a way to avoid this problem in the future.12 As an example of the potential in these automated systems, Comcast Corporation can run a search across the entire organization to find people with certain qualifications who are strong in specific skills. If a person is needed for a business development position with strong customer communication and strategic skills, a search of the system will locate a dozen people in the company with excellent performance reviews in those areas during the last year.13 The drive to automate talent management also comes in part from the desire to pull together HR, finance, and operations data to get insights on talent that are otherwise difficult to obtain. Whether current systems do this Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 285 26/06/10 5:17 PM 286 SECTION 3 Training and Development in a way that deals with the key issues is still unclear. A study found that almost half of the companies using automated talent management systems had trouble getting employees and managers to use them. Speculation on why this is so centered on the idea that managers “don’t like to use computers to manage people.”14 However, regardless of the current state of the art, the potential for automated talent management systems in the future is great as a tool to aid decision making, but not the whole solution. Scope of Talent Management As talent management has evolved, a variety of approaches and tools have come along. The HR perspective discusses some groundbreaking talent management programs. Groundbreaking Talent Management Programs How do you develop good managers? Several companies try to grow talent internally by hiring people they view as “high potentials” right out of college and developing them. For example, a program at Lehn and Fink Products (maker of Lysol) is designed to develop general managers from college recruits by using predictors of leadership through extracurricular activities, especially athletics, rather than grades. New recruits begin in low-level jobs and are moved every 6 months. Curtis Lighting in Chicago rotates new college graduates through each of the 10 departments in the company while they take a program of 100 modular classes led by department heads. Public Service Company of Northern Illinois has a high-potential program to identify employees with aptitude for senior management positions. The program is open to every employee; criteria for selection are performance on the job and evidence of leadership behavior. General Electric uses peer feedback. After classroom training and 3-month rotational assignments, newly hired candidates get formal peer feedback in an attempt to grow emotional intelligence skills. Another company uses assessment testing of IQ, vocational interest, aptitude, and vocabulary along with structured interviews to select management trainees. The McCormick Company has created a “junior board of directors.” Young executives consider the same HR perspective problems the board of directors is considering and then make presentations to the real board. The U.S. Army has used forced-ranking systems to identify enlisted personnel who should be promoted to officers. The Navy has used 360-degree feedback systems on performance to identify pilots with the abilities to advance in training. Assessment centers were first used by the CIA and later by industry. Executive coaching, succession planning, rotational development, and assessments of managerial potential all have been widely used. The talent management programs mentioned above are from 60 to 85 years old. They were well established by the 1950s, gone by the 1990s, and are reappearing in the early part of the twenty-first century as “new” and “novel” approaches to talent management. What happened? The 1950s practices of long-term planning, succession planning, and management development were based on the assumptions that companies could predict personnel needs a decade in advance and that the talent in their pipelines would stay there. These pipelines turned out more talent than was needed, and when the 1981 recession hit, the development apparatus was dismantled. When the economy recovered, there was plenty of talent on the market to be hired. That surplus was gone by the end of the 1990s, and most organizations today again want an alternative to simply hiring their talent from outside.15 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 286 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 287 Target Jobs The first issue is to identify the types of jobs that will be the focus of talent management efforts. In some organizations, talent management focuses on the CEO and other executive jobs, rather than more broadly. Other organizations target senior management jobs, mid-level managers, and other key jobs. However, those groups only represent about one-third of the total workforce, which raises the question of whether talent management efforts would be more useful if they were more widely implemented. High-Potential Individuals Some organizations focus talent management efforts primarily on “high-potential” individuals, often referred to as “high-pos.” Attracting, retaining, and developing high-pos have become the emphases for some talent management efforts. Some firms classify individuals as being in the top 10% and then set limits on the number of people who can participate in intensive talent management efforts. Other organizations view talent management more broadly. Targeting primarily high-pos may lead to many other employees seeing their career opportunities as being limited. Thus, talent management may need to include more than the top 10% in some cases. Competency Models What does a person who is ready to be moved up look like? What competencies should the person have? Competency models show knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs) for various jobs. An employer must ask, what talent do we need to achieve this? The answer can be found in a competency model. Competency models help to identify talent gaps. Some companies maintain libraries of competency models. One has more than 900 such models.16 These libraries create a clear path for talent planning. Competency models might be created for executives, managers, supervisors, salespeople, technical professionals, and others. Talent Pools Talent pools are a way to reduce the risk that the company may not need a certain specialty after developing it. The idea is to avoid developing for a narrow specialized job and instead develop a group or pool of talented people with broad general competencies that could fit a wide range of jobs. Once developed, they can be allocated to specific vacancies. Just-in-time training and coaching can make the fit work.17 Career Tracks Career tracks include a series of steps that one follows to become ready to move up. For example, a potential branch manager in a bank might take rotational assignments in customer sales, teller supervisor, credit cards, and other positions before being considered ready to handle the branch manager’s job. Assessment Assessment most often involves tests of one sort or another. Tests for IQ, personality, aptitude, and other factors are used. A portfolio of tests to help predict a person’s potential for a job is called an “assessment center,” which will be discussed in more detail later. Development Risk Sharing The employer always runs the risk in developing talent that an employee who has been developed will leave with the valuable skills gained through development. An alternative to this risk is to have promising employees volunteer for development on their own time. Executive Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 287 26/06/10 5:17 PM 288 SECTION 3 Training and Development LOGGING ON Taleo Corporation For a research library on talent management resources, including articles and interactive tools, visit the Taleo website at www.taleo.com/ resources/research. MBA programs that can be attended on evenings or weekends, extra projects outside a person’s current assignment, volunteer projects with nonprofit organizations, and other paths can be used. The employer might contribute through tuition reimbursement or some selected time away from the job, but the risk is at least partly shared by the employee. The rest of this chapter deals with the major elements of talent management in more detail: succession planning, careers, and development. SUCCESSION PLANNING The basis for dealing successfully with staffing surprises is succession planning. When a sudden loss of a manager occurs, the void is a serious problem.18 At that point it is too late to begin to develop a replacement. “Bench strength” and the leadership “pipeline” are metaphors for ways to prevent the void by having replacements ready. However, succession planning involves more than simply replacement planning. Replacement planning usually develops a list of replacements for given positions. Succession planning must include a well-designed employee development system to reach its potential. Succession planning is the process of identifying a plan for the orderly replacement of key employees. Succession Planning Process Whether in small or large firms, succession planning is linked to strategic planning through the process shown in Figure 9-2. The process consists of first defining positions that are critical to the strategy,19 and then making certain top management is involved personally with mentoring, coaching, and talent identification. It may be appropriate to tie some level of reward to executive success in the process. The next step is to assess the talent available in the organization and determine which have the potential, which are ready now for promotion, and which need additional development. The development practices can vary but should be aimed at specific needs in specific individuals. Finally, evaluating the success of the process is important, and appropriate measures are necessary to do so.20 All the work involved in the succession planning process should result in two products: (1) identification of potential emergency replacements for critical positions and (2) other successors who will be ready with some additional development. The development necessary should be made clear to the people involved, along with a plan for getting the development.21 Role of HR in Succession Planning Often HR has the primary responsibility for succession planning organization-wide. However, for CEO and senior management succession efforts, top executives and board members often have major involvement. In this case, HR commonly performs the following actions: • • • Identifying development needs of the workforce Assisting executives/managers in identifying needed future job skills Participating in identifying employees who might fill future positions Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 288 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 289 Talent Management FIGURE 9-2 Succession Planning Process INTEGRATE WITH STRATEGY What competencies will be needed? Which jobs will be critical? How should critical positions be filled? Will international assignments be needed? INVOLVE TOP MANAGEMENT Is CEO personally involved? Are top executives mentoring/coaching? Are there authority and accountability for succession goals? ASSESS KEY TALENT Does this person have the competencies? What competencies are missing? Are assessments/performance evaluations/etc. valid? Is a results orientation used to identify high positions? Are individuals and career goals/interests compatible? FOLLOW DEVELOPMENT PRACTICES How can missing competencies be developed? Are there opportunities for those in higher positions to interact with executives/board members? Can talent pools be created for job pools? What are the rewards to subordinate development? Are high position/successors to be told? MONITOR/EVALUATE Are multiple metrics used? Are positions filled internally? Is the process viewed favorably? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 289 26/06/10 5:17 PM 290 SECTION 3 Training and Development • • G L O B A L Communicating succession planning process to employees Aiding in tracing and regularly updating succession plan efforts Global Succession Planning Succession planning is not just a U.S. issue. In fact, the percentage of the aging population in the workforce is even higher in countries such as Japan, Germany, Italy, and England. In those countries, as well as the United States, the growth of immigrants has added to the population, which also means that employers are facing both legal and workforce diversity issues. Even in countries with growing native workforces, such as China and India, succession planning is important. Having younger workers who can replace senior managers with international experiences and contacts is a growing concern faced worldwide by employers of different sizes and industries.22 Succession in Small and Closely Held Organizations Succession planning can be especially important in small and medium-sized firms, but few of these firms formalize succession plans. In fact, the lack of succession planning is frequently viewed as the biggest threat facing small businesses. In closely held family firms (those that are not publicly traded on stock exchanges), multiple family members may be involved. But in others, the third- and fourth-generation family members are not employees and many do not want to be involved, other than as owners or as members of the board of directors.23 Even if many CEOs plan to pass the business leadership on to a family member, most of these firms would benefit from planning for orderly succession, particularly if nonfamily members or owners are involved. Addressing the development needs of the successor also helps to avoid a host of potential problems for both the organization and family-member relationships. Succession Planning Decisions A number of decision areas should be considered as part of succession planning. Coming to the answer stage on these decisions takes analysis, as the best answer varies depending on the situation. “Make” or “Buy” Talent? Employers face a “make-or-buy” choice: develop (“make”) competitive human resources, or hire (“buy”) them already developed from somewhere else. Many organizations show an apparent preference for buying rather than making scarce employees in today’s labor market. Current trends indicate that technical and professional people usually are “bought” because of the amount of skill development already achieved, rather than internal individuals being picked because of their ability to learn or their behavioral traits. However, hiring rather than developing internal human resource capabilities may not fit certain environments, and puts the responsibility for development on the employee. Other organizations are focusing on growing their own leaders.24 Like any financial decision, the make-or-buy decision can be quantified and calculated when some assumptions are made about time costs, availability, and quality. Potential versus Performance Another focus of succession planning is shown in Figure 9-3. Note that when developing succession plans for jobs and identifying candidates, focusing only on potential may be too narrow. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 290 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 291 Talent Management Assessing Potential and Current Performance FIGURE 9-3 High Strong Potential Does not meet performance expectations Action: Coaching/ development/job change? P o t e n t i a l High Potential High performance Action: Accelerated stretch assignments? Potential for Lateral Move Meeting performance expectations Action: Additional motivation? w Low Low No Potential to Advance Poor performance Has Reached Potential Exceeds expectations on performance Action: Dismiss? Action: Retain and reward? Performance High The competency model for a job might be much more complex. For example, assume that succession planning for a Vice President of Operations at a hospital is being done. That position needs candidates who have industry contacts, community involvement, leadership and management capabilities, and other competencies. These items are especially important if the current VP has extensive experience and outstanding performance. To combine potential and performance, a two-dimensional graph like the one shown in Figure 9-3 can be used. M E A S U R E Metrics and Succession Planning Some organizations measure the impact of succession planning. A wide range of metrics are used depending on the company plans. The proper metric should be picked early on in the succession decision process. One key measure is identifying the reduced costs of turnover, which is related to employee retention. For instance, in a mid-sized bank, turnover of “high-potential” employees declined significantly after conducting an organization-wide succession plan. Estimates of the turnover savings were done by the HR Director, and the median per key employee “saved” was more than $15,000 per person. Another factor to consider is how succession planning and its follow-up may lead to higher performance and organizational profitability. Organizations such as Apple Computers, General Electric, Merck, Hewlett-Packard, Motorola, Verizon, and other companies use benchmark and quantitative measures to show that succession planning provides significant financial returns. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 291 26/06/10 5:17 PM 292 SECTION 3 Training and Development Other common useful metrics are:25 • • • Percentage of key vacancies filled internally Job performance of promoted successors Bench strength breadth and depth Computerized Succession Planning Models The expansion of information technology capabilities has resulted in employers being able to have succession planning components available electronically to staff members. Skills tracking systems, performance appraisals, and other databases can be linked to succession plans. As employees complete training and development activities, their data can be updated and viewed as career openings occur in the company. Via intranet systems, employees can access and update LOGGING ON their databases, review job and career opportunities, and complete skill and career interest self-surveys and numerBusiness & Decision ous other items. Another aid in leadership development is This website provides an overview of succession planning. Visit the site at 360-degree reviews of managers by others.26 One such system www.businessdecision.com. creates a grid that links employee performance ratings and results to potential career movements. Benefits of Formal Succession Planning Employers are doing succession planning formally and informally. As companies become larger, the benefits of formal succession planning become greater. For larger companies, formal planning is recommended. Even government organizations can benefit from formal succession planning.27 Key benefits include: • • • • Having a supply of talented employees to fill future key openings Providing career paths and plans for employees, which aids in employee retention and performance motivation Continually reviewing the need for individuals as organizational changes occur more frequently Enhancing the organizational “brand” and reputation of the company as a desirable place to work Common Succession Planning Mistakes CEO succession should be a focus of the boards of directors. One reason why boards have increased the priority of CEO succession is the Sarbanes–Oxley Act provisions that have added more demands that boards do CEO succession planning. But focusing only on CEO and top management succession is one of the most common mistakes made. Other mistakes include: • • • • Starting too late, when openings are already occurring Not linking well to strategic plans Allowing the CEO to direct the planning and make all succession decisions Looking only internally for succession candidates All of these mistakes are indicative of poor succession planning.28 An example of the importance of succession planning is seen in the banking industry. Regulatory provisions and auditors are requiring banks to have succession plans identified for top management jobs. Also, law firms are recognizing the importance of succession planning as more senior partners retire. Longer-term succession planning should include mid-level and lower-level managers, as well as other key nonmanagement employees. Some firms target Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 292 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 293 key technical, professional, and sales employees as part of succession planning. Others include customer service representatives, warehouse specialists, and additional hourly employees who may be able to move up into other jobs or departments. Succession planning is an important part of employers doing talent management well. Actions such as career planning and development efforts follow from succession planning efforts. CAREERS AND CAREER PLANNING A career is the series of work-related positions a person occupies throughout life. People pursue careers to satisfy their individual needs. Careers are an important part of talent management, but individuals and organizations view careers in distinctly different ways.29 Changes in employer approaches to planning for replacement managers based upon a less predictable business environment have put much of the responsibility for a career on the shoulders of individual employees. However, companies have found that the lack of a career development plan leaves them vulnerable to turnover, and hiring from outside can have drawbacks.30 When a company attempts to manage careers internally, there may be a typical career path that is identified for employees. Despite major investments by employers over the last decade to improve company-sponsored career planning, a high percentage (41%) of managers surveyed felt the employer’s approach to career development failed to meet their personal needs.31 Changing Nature of Careers The old model of a career in which a person worked up the ladder in one organization is becoming rarer in reality. Indeed, in a few industries, changing jobs and companies every few years is becoming more common. Many U.S. workers in high-demand jobs, such as information technologists and pharmacists, dictate their own circumstances to some extent. For instance, the average 30- to 35-year-old in the United States may have already worked for up to seven different firms. Physicians, teachers, economists, and electricians do not change jobs as frequently. However, as would be expected, even in some of these professions valuable employees who are given offers to switch jobs do so at a higher rate than in the past. Different Views of Careers Various signs indicate that the patterns of individuals’ work lives are changing in many areas: more freelancing, more working at home, more frequent job changes, and more job opportunities but less security. Rather than letting jobs define their lives, more people set goals for the type of lives they want and then use jobs to meet those goals. However, for dual-career couples and working women, balancing work demands with personal and family responsibilities is difficult to do. Labels for different views of careers include the following: • Career Series of work-related positions a person occupies throughout life. • Protean career: assumes individuals will drive their careers and define goals to fit their life Career without boundaries: views a manager as having many possible trajectories for a career, and many are across organizational boundaries Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 293 26/06/10 5:17 PM 294 SECTION 3 Training and Development • • Portfolio career: careers are built around a collection of skills and interests and are self-managed Authentic career: people achieve a high level of personal insight and use this to follow a “true-to-self” career All these different views of careers have merit for different individuals, but they all show that an organization-centered career planning effort will have to consider the unique needs of the individual employee. Organization-Centered Career Planning Organization-centered career planning Career planning that focuses on identifying career paths that provide for the logical progression of people between jobs in an organization. FIGURE 9-4 Careers are different than they were in the past, and managing them puts a premium on career development by both employers and employees. Effective career planning considers both organization-centered and individual-centered perspectives. Figure 9-4 summarizes the perspectives and interaction between the organizational and individual approaches to career planning. Organization-centered career planning frequently focuses on identifying career paths that provide for the logical progression of people between jobs in an organization. Individuals follow these paths as they advance in organizational units. For example, the right person might enter the sales department as a sales representative, then be promoted to account director, to district sales manager, and finally to vice president of sales. A good career planning program includes the elements of talent management, performance appraisal, development activities, opportunities for transfer and promotion, and planning for succession. To communicate with employees about opportunities and to help with planning, employers frequently use career workshops, a career “center” or newsletter, and career counseling. Individual managers often play the role of coach and counselor in their direct contact with individual employees and within an HR-designed career management system. The systems that an employer uses should be planned and managed to guide managers in developing employees’ careers.32 One such system is the career path, or “map,” which is created and shared with the individual employee. Organizational and Individual Career Planning Perspectives INDIVIDUAL PERSPECTIVE ORGANIZATIONAL PERSPECTIVE Identify future organizational staffing needs Plan career ladders Assess individual potential and training needs Match organizational needs to individual abilities Develop and audit a career system for the organization A PERSON’S CAREER Identify personal abilities and interests Plan life and work goals Assess alternative paths inside and outside the organization Note changes in interests and goals as career and life stage change Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 294 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 295 Career Paths Employees need to know their strengths and weakness, and they often discover those through company-sponsored assessments. Then, career paths to develop the weak areas and fine-tune the strengths are developed. For example, Ed Santry, VP of HR in Pittsburgh for Nisource Inc., had three good candidates for a position. The outside candidate had more experience and was hired. But after the decision, Ed had a discussion with the internal candidates. He presented ideas for them to work on over the next few years to improve their chances of getting one of the positions later.33 Career paths represent employees’ movements through opportunities over time. Although most career paths are thought of as leading upward, good opportunities also exist in cross-functional or horizontal directions. Working with employees to develop career paths has aided employers in retaining key employees. At a call center, use of a career path program has led to greater retention of entry-level call center employees. Career progression opportunities are identified to employees who perform well and who see the company as a place to stay and grow a career. Employer Websites and Career Planning Many employers have careers sections on their websites. Such sections can be used to list open jobs for current employees looking to change jobs. An employer’s website is a link to the external world, but should also be seen as a link to existing employee development. Sites also can be used for career assessment, information, and instruction. When designing websites, firms should consider the usefulness of the careers section for development as well as recruitment. Accommodating Individual Career Needs As noted earlier, not everyone views a career the same way. Further, the way people view their careers depends upon the stage of the career. Some research suggests that if employers expect employees to invest more of their personal resources of time and effort in career self-management, they may find it causes conflict with efforts to balance work and life off the job. Most people cannot both invest great amounts of time beyond their job in career management and have a satisfactory work-life balance as well.34 This seems especially true for younger employees. Permitting telecommuting for fast-track employees unwilling to relocate is a way to keep talent in the succession pipeline by accommodating individual needs. Such flexibility is often the difference between continuing a career at a firm and moving on. For example, the CEO of a multimillion dollar business in the Midwest lived primarily in Atlanta. He would live in the Midwestern town for two weeks at a time and return to Atlanta every other weekend, thus telecommuting.35 Career paths Represent employees’ movements through opportunities over time. Individual-centered career planning Career planning that focuses on an individual’s responsibility for a career rather than on organizational needs. Individual-Centered Career Planning Organizational changes have altered career plans for many people. Individuals have had to face “career transitions”— in other words they have had to find new jobs. These transitions have identified the importance of individual-centered career planning, which focuses on an individual’s responsibility for a career rather than on organizational needs. Individual Actions for Career Planning For individuals to successfully manage their own careers, they should be able to perform several activities. Three key ones are as follows: Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 295 26/06/10 5:17 PM 296 SECTION 3 Training and Development • • • Self-assessment: Individuals need to think about what interests them, what they do not like, what they do well, and their strengths and weaknesses. Career advisors use a number of tools to help people understand themselves. Common professional tests include the Strong Interest Inventory to determine preferences among vocational occupations, and the Allport-Vernon-Lindzey Study of Values to identify a person’s dominant values. Feedback on reality: Employees need feedback on how well they are doing, how their bosses see their capabilities, and where they fit in organizational plans for the future. One source of this information is through performance appraisal feedback and career development discussions. Setting of career goals: Deciding on a desired path, setting some timetables, and writing down these items all set the stage for a person to pursue the career of choice. These career goals are supported by shortterm plans for the individual to get the experience or training necessary to move forward toward the goals.36 Individual Career Choices Four general individual characteristics affect how people make career choices: • • • • Interests: People tend to pursue careers that they believe match their interests. But over time, interests change for many people, and career decisions eventually are made based on special skills, abilities, and career paths that are realistic for the individual. Self-image: A career is an extension of a person’s self-image, as well as a molder of it. People follow careers they can “see” themselves in and avoid those that do not fit with their perceptions of their talents, motives, and values. Personality: An employee’s personality includes that individual’s personal orientation (e.g., inclination to be realistic, enterprising, or artistic) and personal needs (including affiliation, power, and achievement needs). Individuals with certain personality types gravitate to different clusters of occupations. Social backgrounds: Socioeconomic status and the educational levels and occupations of a person’s parents are included in an individual’s social background. Children of a physician or a welder know from a parent what that job is like and may either seek or reject it based on how they view the parent’s job. Less is known about how and why people choose specific organizations than about why they choose specific careers. One obvious factor is timing—the availability of a job when the person is LOGGING ON looking for work. The amount of information available Career Planning about alternatives is an important factor as well. Beyond This website is a resource for indivithese issues, people seem to pick an organization on the dual career planning. Visit the site at basis of a “fit” of the climate of the organization as they www.careerplanning.org. view it and their own personal characteristics, interests, and needs. Career Progression Considerations The typical career for individuals today includes more positions, transitions, and organizations—more so than in the past, when employees were less Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 296 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 297 Talent Management mobile and organizations were more stable as long-term employers. But there are general patterns in people’s lives that affect their careers. Theorists in adult development describe the first half of life as the young adult’s quest for competence and for a way to make a mark in the world. According to this view, a person attains happiness during this time primarily through achievement and the acquisition of capabilities. The second half of life is different. Once the adult starts to measure time from the expected end of life rather than from the beginning, the need for competence and acquisition changes to the need for integrity, values, and well-being. For many people, internal values take precedence over external scorecards or accomplishments such as wealth and job title status. In addition, mature adults already possess certain skills, so their focus may shift to interests other than skills acquisition. Career-ending concerns, such as life after retirement, reflect additional shifts. Figure 9-5 shows a model that identifies general career and life periods. Contained within this life pattern is the idea that careers and lives are not predictably linear but cyclical. Individuals experience periods of high stability followed by transition periods of less stability, and by inevitable discoveries, disappointments, and triumphs. These cycles of structure and transition occur throughout individuals’ lives and careers. This cyclical view may be an especially useful perspective for individuals affected by downsizing or early career plateaus in large organizations. Such a perspective argues for the importance of flexibility in an individual’s career. It also emphasizes the importance of individuals’ continuing to acquire more and diverse knowledge, skills, and abilities. Early Career Issues Early career needs include finding interests, developing capabilities, and exploring jobs. Some organizations do a better job than others of providing those opportunities. Work-at-home programs, mentoring, performance bonuses, time with top executives, extensive training, hiring interns, reimbursement for more education, and rich 401(K) plans are some of the things employers are doing to make jobs more attractive for early career employees.37 Early career for many young people is characterized by little individual career planning, which leads to careers that seem to be at the mercy of various sources and out of their control. Proactiveness decreases the likelihood of sitting back and letting someone (or something) else manage a career. Early FIGURE 9-5 General Career Periods CAREER STAGE AGE Characteristics Age group Early Career Mid-Career Late Career Career End 20 years (ⴙ/ⴚ ) 30–40 years 50 years (ⴙ/ⴚ ) 60–70 years Needs Identifying interests, exploring several jobs Advancing in career; lifestyle may limit options, growth, opportunities Updating skills; individual is settled in; individual is a leader whose opinions are valued Planning for retirement, examining nonwork interests Concerns External rewards, acquiring more capabilities Values, contribution, integrity, well-being Mentoring, disengaging, organizational continuance Retirement, part-time employment Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 297 26/06/10 5:17 PM 298 SECTION 3 Training and Development career people want more career planning but are not certain how to do it.38 Planning early in a career may increase employability.39 Career Plateaus Those who do not change jobs may face another problem: career plateaus. Many workers define career success in terms of upward mobility. As the opportunities to move up decrease, some employers try to convince employees they can find job satisfaction in lateral movement. Such moves can be reasonable if employees learn new skills that increase individual marketability in case of future layoffs, termination, or organizational restructurings. One strategy for individuals to get off career plateaus is to take seminars and university courses. This approach may reveal new opportunities for plateaued employees. Rotating workers to other departments is another way to deal with career plateaus. A computer chip manufacturer instituted a formal “poaching” program that encouraged managers to recruit employees from other departments, thereby giving employees greater opportunities to experience new challenges without having to leave the employer. Some plateaued individuals change careers and go into other lines of work altogether. Figure 9-6 shows a “portable” career path that one might encounter under those career situations. In summary, plateaued employees present a particular challenge for employers. They can affect morale if they become negative, but they may also represent valuable resources that are not being well used. Career Transitions Career transitions can be stressful for individuals who change employers and jobs. Three career transitions are of special interest to HR: organizational entry and socialization, job loss, and retirement.40 Entry Career and Job Loss Starting as a new employee can be overwhelming. “Entry shock” is especially difficult for younger new hires who find the work world very different from school.41 Entry shock includes the following concerns: • • FIGURE 9-6 Supervisors: The boss–employee relationship is different from the student–teacher relationship. Feedback: In school, feedback is frequent and measurable, but that is not true of most jobs. Portable Career Path Beginning Expanding Changing Sustaining Concluding Spend several years at large company to learn skills and build network Use networking to develop broader skills and make contacts; establish good reputation Change industries, or go to work for smaller companies; start a company Refresh skills; take a sabbatical; go back to school; gain experience in nonprofit organizations Move to projects as a temporary employee or subcontractor Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 298 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management • • 299 Time: School has short (quarter/semester) time cycles, whereas time horizons are longer at work. The work: Problems are more tightly defined at school; at work, the logistical and political aspects of solving problems are less certain. Job loss as a career transition has been most associated with downsizing, mergers, and acquisitions. Losing a job is a stressful event in one’s career, frequently causing depression, anxiety, and nervousness. The financial implications and the effects on family can be extreme as well. Yet the potential for job loss continues to increase for many individuals, and effectively addressing their concerns should be considered in career transition decision making. Retirement Issues Whether retirement comes at age 50 or age 70, it can require a major adjustment for many people. Some areas of adjustment faced by many retirees include self-direction, a need to belong, sources of achievement, personal space, and goals. To help address concerns over these issues, as well as anxieties about finances, some employers offer preretirement planning seminars for employees. Companies in the United States will face a severe shortage of badly needed skills in the coming decade unless they act now to convince top-performing older employees to delay or phase in their retirement.42 Career development for people toward the ends of their careers may be managed in a number of ways. Phased-in retirement, consulting arrangements, and callback of some retirees as needed all act as means for gradual disengagement between the organization and the individual. However, phased-in retirement (which is widely seen as a good situation for all involved) faces major obstacles in current pension laws. Under many pension plans, employees who are working may not receive pension benefits until they reach a normal retirement age.43 Early retirement often occurs as a result of downsizings and organizational restructurings. These events have required thousands of individuals, including many managers and professionals, to determine what is important to them while still active and healthy. As a result, some of these people begin second careers rather than focusing primarily on leisure activities or travel.44 To be successful with early retirement, management must avoid several legal issues, such as forced early retirement and pressuring older workers to resign. COMMON INDIVIDUAL CAREER ISSUES Four career issues are sufficiently common as to need individual treatment. These are issues with technical and professional workers, women, dual-career couples, and individuals with global careers. Technical and Professional Workers Technical and professional workers, such as engineers, scientists, and IT systems experts, present a special challenge for organizations. Many of these individuals want to stay in their technical areas rather than enter management; yet advancement in many organizations frequently requires a move into management. Most of these people like the idea of the responsibility and opportunity associated with professional advancement, but they do not want to leave the professional and technical puzzles and problems at which they excel. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 299 26/06/10 5:17 PM 300 SECTION 3 Training and Development An attempt to solve this problem, a dual-career ladder, is a system that allows a person to advance up either a management or a technical/professional ladder. Dual-career ladders are now used at many firms, most commonly in technology-driven industries such as pharmaceuticals, chemicals, computers, and electronics. For instance, a telecommunications firm created a dual-career ladder in its IT department to reward talented technical people who do not want to move into management. Different tracks, each with attractive job titles and pay opportunities, are provided. Some health care organizations are using “master” titles for senior experienced specialists such as radiologists and neonatal nurses who do not want to be managers. The masters often are mentors and trainers for younger specialists. Unfortunately, the technical/professional ladder may be viewed as “second-class citizenship” within some organizations. Women and Careers According to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics, the percentage of women in the workforce has more than doubled since 1970, and will reach almost 50% in the decade following 2010. Women are found in all occupations and jobs, but their careers may have a different element than those of men. Women give birth to children, and in most societies they are also primarily responsible for taking care of their children. The effect of this biology and sociology is that women’s careers are often interrupted for childbirth and child rearing.45 Work, Family, and Careers The career approach for women frequently is to work hard before children arrive, plateau or step off the career track when children are younger, and go back to career-focused jobs that allow flexibility when they are older. This approach is referred to as sequencing. But some women who sequence are concerned that the job market will not welcome them when they return, or that the time away will hurt their advancement chances. And indeed, many women’s careers are stifled due to their career interruptions.46 The interaction and conflicts among home, family, and a career affect the average woman differently than they do men. By the time men and women have been out of school for 6 years, on average women have worked much less time than men. These and other career differences provide different circumstances for many females. Employers can tap into the female labor market to a greater extent with child-care assistance, flexible work policies, and a general willingness to be accommodating. Glass Ceiling Another concern specifically affecting women is the “glass ceiling.” This issue describes the situation in which women fail to progress into top and senior management positions. Nationally, women hold about half of managerial/ professional positions but only 10% to 15% of corporate officer positions.47 Some organizations provide leaves of absence, often under FMLA provisions, but take steps to keep women who are away from work involved in their companies. Some have used e-mentoring for women temporarily off their jobs. Other firms use “phased returns” whereby women employees return to work part-time and then gradually return to full-time schedules. Consequently, in the United States, women are making slow but steady strides into senior management and executive positions. Dual-career ladder System that allows a person to advance up either a management or a technical/ professional ladder. Dual-Career Couples As the number of women in the workforce continues to increase, particularly in professional careers, so does the number of dual-career couples. The Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 300 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 301 Talent Management U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics estimates that more than 80% of all couples are dual-career couples. Marriages in which both mates are managers, professionals, or technicians have doubled over the past two decades.48 Problem areas for dual-career couples include family issues and job transfers that require relocations. Family-Career Issues For dual-career couples with children, family issues may conflict with career progression. Thus, one partner’s flexibility may depend on what is “best” for the family.49 Additionally, it is important that the career development problems of dual-career couples be recognized as early as possible. Whenever possible, having both partners involved in planning, even when one is not employed by the company, may enhance the success of such efforts. Relocation of Dual-Career Couples Traditionally, employees accepted transfers as part of upward mobility in organizations. However, for some dual-career couples, the mobility required because of one partner’s transfer often interferes with the other’s career. In addition to having two careers, dualcareer couples often have established support networks of coworkers, friends, and business contacts to cope with both their careers and their personal lives. Relocating one partner in a dual-career couple may mean upsetting this carefully constructed network for the other person or creating a “commuting” relationship. Recruiting a member of a dual-career couple to a new location may mean HR assistance in finding an equally attractive job available for the candidate’s partner at the new location through assistance for the nonemployee partner.50 The HR On-the-Job highlights the common global relocation issues faced by firms with employees having dual-career jobs. HR on-the-job Handling Global Dual-Career Situations Special difficulties exist when individuals transfer to overseas jobs. For example, a spouse who wants to work may not be able to get a work permit, may find that local G L O B A L residents have priority in the job market, or may find incompatible certification/ licensing. In particular, women partners may have difficulty finding employment opportunities in certain countries due to cultural and religious considerations. Only a small percentage of spouses and partners of expatriates are employed during their partners’ international assignments. This disparity is one reason why a number of expatriates do not complete the full term of their overseas jobs. When setting HR policies for global employee relocation assistance, organizations must consider the concerns of dual-career couples. The following approaches can help them reduce the problems faced in such situations: • • • • Pay employment agency fees for the relocating partner. Compensate for a designated number of trips for the partner to look for a job in the proposed new location. Help the partner find a job in the same company or in another division or subsidiary of the company in the new geographic location. Develop computerized job banks to share with other global companies and employers in the new area that list partners available for job openings. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 301 26/06/10 5:17 PM 302 SECTION 3 Training and Development Global Career Concerns G L O B A L Insecurity caused by layoffs and downsizings marks a trend that contrasts with the trend toward personal control over career goals. A number of older male American workers express fear of losing their jobs. But this situation is not just a U.S. phenomenon. Many Japanese workers who have typically worked for the same company their entire lives are experiencing similar job insecurity. In Europe, employers are pressuring governments to dismantle outmoded labor rules that make eliminating employees difficult, while workers are pressuring the same governments to alleviate high unemployment rates. As a result, careers for many individuals worldwide contain both more flexibility and more insecurity.51 Many global employees experience anxiety about their continued career progression. Therefore, the international experiences of expatriates must offer benefits both to the employer and to expatriates in terms of their careers.52 Firms sometimes address this issue by bringing expatriates back to the home country for development programs and interaction with other company managers and professionals. Another potentially useful approach is to establish a mentoring system that matches an expatriate with a corporate executive at the headquarters. Repatriation The issue of repatriation involves planning, training, and reassignment of global employees back to their home countries. For example, after expatriates are brought home, often they no longer receive special compensation packages available to them during their assignments. The result is that they experience a net decrease in total income, even if they receive promotions and pay increases. In addition to dealing with concerns about personal finances, returning expatriates often must reacclimate to U.S. lifestyles, transportation services, and other cultural circumstances, especially if they have been living in less-developed countries. Many expatriates have had a greater degree of flexibility, autonomy, and independent decision making while living overseas than their counterparts in the United States. Back in the home organization, repatriated employees must readjust to closer working and reporting relationships with other corporate employees. Another major concern focuses on the organizational status of expatriates upon return. Many expatriates wonder what jobs they will have, whether their international experiences will be valued, and how they will be accepted back into the organization. Unfortunately, many global employers do a poor job of repatriation. To counter this problem, some companies provide career planning, mentoring programs, and even guarantees of employment on completion of foreign assignments. Repatriation Planning, training, and reassignment of global employees back to their home countries. Global Development Global managers are more expensive than homecountry managers, and more problematic as well.53 Most global firms have learned that it is often a mistake to staff foreign operations with only personnel from headquarters, and they quickly hire nationals to work in a country. For this reason, global management development must focus on developing local managers as well as global executives. Development areas typically include such items as cultural issues, running an international business, leadership/management skills, handling problematic people, and personal qualities. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 302 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 303 Talent Management DEVELOPING HUMAN RESOURCES Development represents efforts to improve employees’ abilities to handle a variety of assignments and to cultivate employees’ capabilities beyond those required by the current job. Development can benefit both organizations and individuals. Employees and managers with appropriate experiences and abilities may enhance organizational competitiveness and the ability to adapt to a changing environment. In the development process, individuals’ careers also may evolve and gain new or different focuses. Development differs from training. It is possible to train people to answer customer service questions, drive a truck, enter data in a computer system, set up a drill press, or assemble a television. However, development in areas such as judgment, responsibility, decision making, and communication presents a bigger challenge. These areas may or may not develop through ordinary life experiences of individuals. A planned system of development experiences for all employees, not just managers, can help expand the overall level of capabilities in an organization. Figure 9-7 profiles development and compares it with training. Possible Development Focuses Development Efforts to improve employees’ abilities to handle a variety of assignments and to cultivate employees’ capabilities beyond those required by the current job. FIGURE 9-7 Some important and common management capabilities that may require development include an action orientation, quality decision-making skills, ethical values, and technical skills. Abilities to build teams, develop subordinates, direct others, and deal with uncertainty are equally important but much less commonly developed capabilities for successful managers. For some tech specialties (tech support, database administration, network design, etc.), certain nontechnical abilities must be developed as well: ability to work under pressure, to work independently, to solve problems quickly, and to use past knowledge in a new situation. Development versus Training Training Focus Time Frame Effectiveness Measures Learn specific behaviors and actions Demonstrate techniques and processes Shorter term Performance appraisals Cost–benefit analysis Passing tests Certification Development Understand information concepts and context Develop judgment Expand capacities for assignments Longer term Availability of qualified people when needed Possibility of promotion from within HR-based competitive advantage Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 303 26/06/10 5:17 PM 304 SECTION 3 Training and Development One point about development is clear: in numerous studies that asked employees what they want out of their jobs, training and development ranked at or near the top. The primary assets that individuals have are their knowledge, skills, and abilities (KSAs), and many people view the development of their KSAs as an important part of their jobs. Lifelong Learning Learning and development are closely linked. For most people, lifelong learning and development are likely and desirable. For many professionals, lifelong learning may mean meeting continuing education requirements to retain certificates. For example, lawyers, CPAs, teachers, dentists, and nurses must complete continuing education requirements in most states to keep their licenses to practice. For other employees, learning and development may involve training to expand existing skills and to prepare for different jobs, for promotions, or even for new jobs after retirement. Assistance from employers for needed lifelong development typically comes through programs at work, including tuition reimbursement programs. However, much of lifelong learning is voluntary, takes place outside work hours, and is not always formal. Although it may have no immediate relevance to a person’s current job, learning often enhances an individual’s confidence, ideas, and enthusiasm. Redevelopment Whether due to a desire for career change or because the employer needs different capabilities, people may shift jobs in midlife or mid-career. Redeveloping people in the capabilities they need is logical and important. In the last decade, the number of college enrollees LOGGING ON over the age of 35 has increased dramatically. But helping employees go back to college is only one way of redevelopThe Community Training & ing them. Some companies offer redevelopment programs to Development Centre recruit experienced workers from other fields. For example, For specialized programs and different firms needing truck drivers, reporters, and IT workservices for learning and lifelong ers have sponsored second-career programs. Public-sector development, visit this website at www.ctdclearningplace.com. employers have used redevelopment opportunities as a recruiting tool. Development Needs Analyses Like employee training, employee development begins with analyses of the needs of both the organization and the individuals. Either the company or the individual can analyze what a given person needs to develop. The goal, of course, is to identify strengths and weaknesses. Methods that organizations use to assess development needs include assessment centers, psychological testing, and performance appraisals. Assessment centers Collections of instruments and exercises designed to diagnose individuals’ development needs. Assessment Centers Collections of instruments and exercises designed to diagnose individuals’ development needs are referred to as assessment centers. Organizational leadership uses assessment centers for both developing and selecting managers. Many types of employers use assessment centers for a wide variety of jobs. In a typical assessment-center experience, an individual spends two or three days away from the job performing many assessment activities. These activities might include role-playing, tests, cases, leaderless-group discussions, computer-based simulations, and peer evaluations. Frequently, they also include in-basket exercises, in which the individual handles typical work and Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 304 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 305 management problems. For the most part, the exercises represent situations that require the use of individual skills and behaviors. During the exercises, several specially trained judges observe the participants. Assessment centers provide an excellent means for determining individual potential.54 Management and participants often praise them because they are likely to overcome many of the biases inherent in interview situations, supervisor ratings, and written tests. Experience shows that key variables such as leadership, initiative, and supervisory skills cannot be measured with tests alone. Assessment centers also offer the advantage of helping to identify employees with potential in large organizations. Supervisors may nominate people for the assessment center, or employees may volunteer. For talented people, the opportunity to volunteer is invaluable because supervisors may not recognize their potential interests and capabilities. Assessment centers also can raise concerns. Some managers may use the assessment center to avoid making difficult promotion decisions. Suppose a plant supervisor has personally decided that an employee is not qualified for promotion. Rather than being straightforward and informing the employee, the supervisor sends the employee to the assessment center, hoping the report will show that the employee is unqualified for promotion. Problems between the employee and the supervisor may worsen if the employee earns a positive report. Using the assessment center for such purposes does not aid in the development of employees, but such uses do occur. Psychological Testing Psychological tests have been used for several years to determine employees’ developmental potential and needs. Intelligence tests, verbal and mathematical reasoning tests, and personality tests are often given. Psychological testing can furnish useful information on individuals about such factors as motivation, reasoning abilities, leadership style, interpersonal response traits, and job preferences. The biggest problem with psychological testing lies in interpretation, because untrained managers, supervisors, and workers usually cannot accurately interpret test results. After a professional scores the tests and reports the scores to someone in the organization, untrained managers may attach their own meanings to the results. Also, some psychological tests are of limited validity, and test takers may fake desirable responses. Thus, psychological testing is appropriate only when the testing and feedback processes are closely handled by a qualified professional. Performance Appraisals Well-done performance appraisals can be a source of development information. Performance data on productivity, employee relations, job knowledge, and other relevant dimensions can be gathered in such assessments. In this context, appraisals designed for development purposes, discussed in more detail in Chapter 10, may be different and more useful in aiding individual employee development than appraisals designed strictly for administrative purposes. HR DEVELOPMENT APPROACHES Common development approaches can be categorized under three major headings, as Figure 9-8 depicts. Investing in human intellectual capital can occur on or off the job and in “learning organizations.” Development becomes imperative as “knowledge work,” such as research skills and specialized technology Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 305 26/06/10 5:17 PM 306 SECTION 3 FIGURE 9-8 Training and Development HR Development Approaches JOB-SITE APPROACHES Coaching Committees Job rotation “Assistant-to” position OFF-SITE APPROACHES Classroom courses Seminars Outdoor training Sabbatical/leaves LEARNING ORGANIZATION Corporate universities Career development centers E-development Effective HR Development expertise, increases for almost all employers. But identifying the right mix of approaches for development needs requires analyses and planning. Job-Site Development Approaches All too often, unplanned and perhaps useless activities pass as development on the job. To ensure that the desired development actually occurs, managers must plan and coordinate their development efforts. Managers can choose from various job-site development methods.55 Coaching The oldest on-the-job development technique is coaching, which is the training and feedback given to employees by immediate supervisors. Coaching involves a continual process of learning by doing. For coaching to be effective, employees and their supervisors or managers must have a healthy and open relationship. Many firms conduct formal courses to improve the coaching skills of their managers and supervisors.56 The success of coaching is being seen in companies throughout the world. One type of coaching that is growing is team coaching. This approach focuses on coaching groups of individual employees on how to work more effectively as parts of workforce teams. Such team efforts may utilize outside consultants and cover many different areas. Group coaching on leadership may help create high-performance teams. Unfortunately, organizations may be tempted to implement coaching without sufficient planning. Even someone who is good at a job or a particular part of a job will not necessarily be able to coach someone else to do it well. “Coaches” can easily fall short in guiding learners systematically, even if they know which experiences are best.57 Often the coach’s job responsibilities take priority over learning and coaching of subordinates. Also, the intellectual component of many capabilities might be better learned from a book or a course before coaching occurs. Outside consultants may be used as coaches at the executive level. Committee Assignments Assigning promising employees to important committees may broaden their experiences and help them understand the Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 306 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 307 personalities, issues, and processes governing the organization. For instance, employees on a safety committee can gain a greater understanding of safety management, which would help them to become supervisors. They also may experience the problems involved in maintaining employee safety awareness. However, managers need to guard against committee assignments that turn into time-wasting activities. Job Rotation The process of moving a person from job to job is called job rotation. It is widely used as a development technique. For example, a promising young manager may spend 3 months in a plant, 3 months in corporate planning, and 3 months in purchasing. When properly handled, such job rotation fosters a greater understanding of the organization and aids with employee retention by making individuals more versatile, strengthening their skills, and reducing boredom. When opportunities for promotion within a smaller or medium-sized organization are scarce, job rotation through lateral transfers may help rekindle enthusiasm and develop employees’ talents. A disadvantage of job rotation is that it can be expensive because a substantial amount of time is required to acquaint trainees with the different people and techniques in each new unit. Assistant Positions Some firms create assistant positions, which are staff positions immediately under a manager (e.g., Assistant to HR Director). Through such jobs, trainees can work with outstanding managers they might not otherwise have met. Some organizations set up “junior boards of directors” or “management cabinets” to which trainees may be appointed. These assignments provide useful experiences if they present challenging or interesting tasks to trainees. Off-Site Development Approaches Off-the-job development techniques give individuals opportunities to get away from their jobs and concentrate solely on what is to be learned. Moreover, contact with others who are concerned with somewhat different problems and come from different organizations may provide employees with new and different perspectives. Various off-site methods can be used. Classroom Courses and Seminars Most off-the-job development programs include some classroom instruction. Most people are familiar with classroom training, which gives it the advantage of being widely accepted. But the lecture system sometimes used in classroom instruction encourages passive listening and reduced learner participation, which is a distinct disadvantage. Sometimes trainees have little opportunity to question, clarify, and discuss the lecture material. The effectiveness of classroom instruction depends on multiple factors: group size, trainees’ abilities, instructors’ capabilities and styles, and subject matter. Organizations often send employees to externally sponsored seminars or professional courses, such as those offered by numerous professional and consulting entities. Many organizations also encourage continuing education by reimbursing employees for the costs of college courses. Tuition reimbursement programs provide incentives for employees to study for advanced degrees through evening and weekend classes that are outside their regular workdays and hours. Job rotation Process of moving a person from job to job. Outdoor Development Experiences Some organizations send executives and managers off to the wilderness, called outdoor training or outdoor Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 307 26/06/10 5:17 PM 308 SECTION 3 Training and Development development. The rationale for using these wilderness excursions, which can last one day or even seven days or longer, is that such experiences can increase self-confidence and help individuals reevaluate personal goals and efforts. For individuals in work groups or teams, shared risks and challenges outside the office environment can create a sense of teamwork. The challenges may include rock climbing in the California desert, whitewater rafting on a river, backpacking in the Rocky Mountains, or handling a longboat off the coast of Maine. Survival-type management development courses may have more impact than many other management seminars. But companies must consider the inherent perils. Some participants have been unable to handle the physical and emotional challenges associated with rappelling down a cliff or climbing a 40-foot tower. The decision to sponsor such programs should depend on the capabilities of the employees involved. Sabbaticals and Leaves of Absence A sabbatical is time off the job to develop and rejuvenate oneself. Some employers provide paid sabbaticals while others allow employees to take unpaid sabbaticals. Popular for many years in the academic world, sabbaticals have been adopted in the business community as well.58 Some firms give employees 3 to 6 months off with pay to work on “socially desirable” projects. Such projects have included leading training programs in urban ghettos, providing technical assistance in foreign countries, and participating in corporate volunteer programs to aid nonprofit organizations.59 Companies that offer sabbaticals speak well of the results. Positive reasons for sabbaticals are to help prevent employee burnout, offer advantages in recruiting and retention, and boost individual employee morale. Women employees have made use of sabbaticals or leaves for family care reasons. The value of this time off to employees is seen in better retention of key women, who also often return more energized and LOGGING ON enthusiastic about their work-life balancing act. One obviThe Training Registry® ous disadvantage of paid sabbaticals is the cost. Also, the Information on more than 200 seminars nature of the learning experience generally falls outside the and video/interactive courses for control of the organization, leaving it somewhat to chance. management and organizational development is available at this website. Visit the site at www.tregistry.com. Sabbatical Time off the job to develop and rejuvenate oneself. Learning Organizations and Development As talent management becomes more important, employers may attempt to become learning organizations. These organizations encourage development efforts through shared information, culture, and leadership that stress the importance of individual learning. This approach focuses on employees who want to develop new capabilities, and they can learn from others in the organization because informal (and formal) teaching and learning is the norm in such organizations.60 A learning mind-set is probably difficult to introduce into an organization where it does not exist. But where it does exist, it represents a significant potential for development. Figure 9-9 depicts some possible means for developing employees in a learning organization. Knowledge-based organizations that deal primarily with ideas and information must have employees who are experts at one or more conceptual tasks. These employees continuously learn and solve problems in their areas of expertise. Developing such employees requires an “organizational learning capacity” based on solving problems and learning new ways not previously used. Encouraging them to pass their knowledge on to others is the basis for a learning organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 308 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 309 Talent Management FIGURE 9-9 Possible Means for Developing Employees in a Learning Organization Means Informal development Formal development Team sharing Coaching or mentoring Observation Individual development plans Job rotation Result Individual learning and development Corporate Universities and Career Development Centers Large organizations may use corporate universities to develop managers and other employees. Corporate universities take various forms.61 Sometimes regarded as little more than fancy packaging for company training, they may not provide a degree, accreditation, or graduation in the traditional sense. A related alternative, partnerships between companies and traditional universities, can occur where the universities design and teach specific courses for employers. Career development centers are often set up to coordinate in-house programs and programs provided by suppliers. They may include assessment data for individuals, career goals and strategies, coaching, seminars, and online approaches. E-Development The rapid growth in technology has led to more use of e-development. Online development can take many forms, such as video conferencing, live chat rooms, document sharing, video and audio streaming, and Web-based courses. HR staff members can facilitate online development by providing a learning portal, which is a centralized website for news, information, course listings, business games, simulations, and other materials. Online development allows participation in courses previously out of reach due to geographic or cost considerations. It allows costs to be spread over a larger number of people, and it can be combined with virtual reality and other technological tools to make presentations more interesting. It can eliminate travel costs as well. When properly used, e-development is a valuable HR development tool. However, the lack of realism can diminish the learning experience. The focus must be learning, not just “using the technology.” MANAGEMENT DEVELOPMENT Although development is important for all employees, it is essential for managers. Without appropriate development, managers may lack the capabilities to best deploy and manage resources (including employees) throughout the organization. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 309 26/06/10 5:17 PM 310 Training and Development SECTION 3 FIGURE 9-10 Management Lessons Learned from Job Experience SOURCES OF MANAGERS’ LEARNING JOB TRANSITIONS New jobs Problems New people Changes in responsibilities CHALLENGES Starting or changing some major organizational feature Having decision-making responsibility Influencing others without formal authority OBSTACLES A bad job situation A difficult boss Demanding clients Unsupportive peers Negative economic circumstances LESSONS MANAGERS NEED TO LEARN Setting agendas: Developing technical/business knowledge, taking responsibility, setting goals Handling relationships: Dealing successfully with people Management values: Understanding successful management behavior Personality qualities: Having the temperament necessary to deal with the chaos and ambiguity of executive life Self-awareness: Understanding oneself and how one affects others Experience plays a central role in management development.62 Indeed, experience often contributes more to the development of senior managers than does classroom training, because much of it occurs in varying circumstances on the job over time. Yet, in many organizations it is difficult to find managers for middle-level jobs. Some individuals refuse to take middle-management jobs, feeling that they are caught between upper management and supervisors. Similarly, not all companies take the time to develop their own senior-level managers. Instead, senior managers and executives often are hired from the outside. Figure 9-10 shows experience-based sources of managers’ learning and lists some lessons important in effectively developing supervisors, middle managers, and senior-level executives. A number of approaches are used to mold and enhance the experiences that managers need to be effective.63 The most widely used methods are supervisor development, leadership development, management modeling, management coaching, management mentoring, and executive education. Supervisor Development At the beginning level for managerial development is the first-line supervisory job. It is often difficult to go from being a member of the work group to being the boss. Therefore, the new supervisors who are used to functioning as individual contributors often require new skills and mind-sets to be successful supervisors. A number of employers conduct presupervisor training. This effort is done to provide realistic job previews of what supervisors will face and to convey to Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 310 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 Talent Management 311 individuals that they cannot just rely on their current job skills and experience in their new positions. Development for supervisors may vary but usually contains common elements. The usual materials for supervisor training and development include several topics: basic management responsibilities, time management, and human relations. Human Relations Training This type of training attempts to prepare supervisors to deal with “people problems” brought to them by their employees. The training focuses on the development of the human relations skills a person needs to work well with others. Most human relations programs are aimed at new or relatively inexperienced first-line supervisors and middle managers. They cover motivation, leadership, employee communication, conflict resolution, team building, and other behavioral topics. The most common reason employees fail after being promoted to management is poor teamwork with subordinates and peers. Other common reasons for management failure include not understanding expectations, failure to meet goals, difficulty adjusting to management responsibilities, and inability to balance work and home lives. Leadership Development Organizations are aware that effective leaders create positive change and are important for organizational success. Firms such as Johnson & Johnson, General Electric, and 3M Company are among the top firms in leadership development. Leadership development is expanding a person’s capacity to be effective in leadership roles. This development occurs in many ways: classroom programs, assessments, modeling, coaching, job assignments, mentoring, and executive education. While it is difficult to develop good leaders in one’s home country, it is even more difficult to do so in another country.64 Also, although universities produce smart, ambitious graduates with good technical skills, many graduates face a very steep learning curve when making the change from school into leadership positions.65 The material that follows examines common ways to help individuals in many different circumstances transition successfully into leadership roles. Modeling A common adage in management development says that managers tend to manage as they were managed. In other words, managers learn by behavior modeling, or copying someone else’s behavior. This tendency is not surprising, because a great deal of human behavior is learned by modeling. Children learn by modeling the behaviors of parents and older children. Management development efforts can take advantage of natural human behavior by matching young or developing managers with appropriate models and then reinforcing the desirable behaviors exhibited by the learners. The modeling process involves more than straightforward imitation or copying. For example, one can learn what not to do by observing a model who does something wrong. Thus, exposure to both positive and negative models can benefit a new manager as part of leadership development efforts. Coaching In the context of management development, coaching involves a relationship between two individuals for a period of time as they perform their jobs. Effective coaching requires patience and good communication skills.66 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 311 26/06/10 5:17 PM 312 SECTION 3 Training and Development Coaching combines observation with suggestions. Like modeling, it complements the natural way humans learn. An outline of good coaching pointers will often include the following: • • • • • Explain appropriate behaviors. Make clear why actions were taken. Accurately state observations. Provide possible alternatives/suggestions. Follow up and reinforce behaviors used. A specific application of coaching is the use of leadership coaching. Companies use outside experts as executive coaches to help managers improve interpersonal skills or decision-making skills. Sometimes these experts are used to help deal with problematic management styles. Consultants serving as executive coaches predominantly come from a psychology or counseling background and can serve many roles for a client by providing key questions and general directions. Sometimes they meet with employees in person, but many do their coaching by phone or electronically. Research on the effectiveness of coaching suggests that coaching can be beneficial in dealing with chronic stress, psychological difficulties, and even physiological problems faced by executives and managers. Management Mentoring A method called management mentoring is a relationship in which experienced managers aid individuals in the earlier stages of their careers.67 Such a relationship provides an environment for conveying technical, interpersonal, and organizational skills from a moreexperienced person to a designated less-experienced person. Not only does the inexperienced employee benefit, but the mentor also may enjoy having the opportunity and challenge of sharing wisdom.68 Fortunately, many individuals have a series of advisors or mentors during their careers and may find advantages in learning from the different mentors. For example, the unique qualities of individual mentors may help less-experienced managers identify key behaviors in management success and failure.69 Additionally, those being mentored may find previous mentors to be useful sources for networking. Figure 9-11 describes the four stages in most successful mentoring relationships. In virtually all countries in the world, the proportion of women holding management jobs is lower than the proportion of men holding such jobs. Similarly, the number of racial and ethnic minorities who fill senior management positions is less than 10%. Unfortunately, younger minority employees and managers may have difficulty finding mentors.70 Company mentoring programs that focus specifically on women and individuals of different racial/ ethnic backgrounds have been successful in a number of larger firms. Based on various narratives of successful women executives, breaking the glass ceiling requires developing political sophistication, building credibility, and refining management styles aided by mentoring. Management mentoring Relationship in which experienced managers aid individuals in the earlier stages of their careers. Executive Education Executives in an organization often face difficult jobs due to changing and unknown circumstances. “Churning” at the top of organizations and the stresses of executive jobs contribute to increased turnover in these positions. In an effort to decrease turnover and increase management development capabilities, organizations are using specialized Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 312 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 313 Talent Management Stages in Management Mentoring Relationships F I G U R E 9 - 11 Less-Experienced Manager STAGE Admires the senior manager’s competence; recognizes him or her as a source of guidance Initiation LENGTH OF TIME More-Experienced Manager 6–12 months Realizes younger manager has potential and “is coachable” Gains self-confidence, values, and styles of operation Cultivation 2–5 years Provides challenging work, coaching, visibility, protection, and sponsorship Experiences independence but at times has feelings of anxiety and loss Separation 6–12 months Knows when to begin to move away Responds with gratitude for the early years; finds that the mentoring relationship becomes a friendship Redefinition Ongoing Continues to be a supporter; takes pride in the younger manager’s accomplishments education for executives. This type of training includes executive education traditionally offered by university business schools and adds strategy formulation, financial models, logistics, alliances, and global issues. Enrollment in Executive Masters of Business Administration (EMBA) degree programs is popular also. Problems with Management Development Efforts Development efforts are subject to certain common mistakes and problems. Many of the management development problems in firms have resulted from inadequate HR planning and a lack of coordination of HR development efforts. Common problems include the following: • • • Failing to conduct adequate needs analysis Trying out fad programs or training methods Substituting training for selecting qualified individuals Another common management problem is encapsulated development, which occurs when an individual learns new methods and ideas, but returns to a work unit that is still bound by old attitudes and methods. The development was “encapsulated” in the classroom and is essentially not used on the job. Consequently, in this situation, it is common for individuals who participate in development programs paid for by their employers to become discouraged and move to new employers that allow them to use their newly developed capabilities more effectively. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 313 26/06/10 5:17 PM 314 SECTION 3 Training and Development S U M M A R Y • • • • • • • • • Talent management is growing in importance because it is concerned with the attraction, development, and retention of human resources. Training, succession planning, career planning, and performance management are crucial parts of talent management. Succession planning is the process that identifies how key employees are to be replaced, including deciding whether to make or buy talent and how to use electronic and Web-based succession planning programs. A number of different mistakes can occur in succession planning, including focusing only on CEO and senior management succession. The nature of careers is changing, as retention of employees and work-life balance have become more important. Career planning may focus on organizational needs, individual needs, or both; and career paths and employer websites are part of career planning. A person chooses a career according to interests, self-image, personality, social background, and other factors. Several special individual career issues must be addressed, including those related to technical and professional workers. Career issues for women may include workfamily balancing and glass ceiling concerns, as well as being part of dual-career couples. C R I T I C A L • • • • • • • • • Global career development has special challenges, including relocations of dual-career couples, global development, and repatriation. Development differs from training because it focuses on less tangible aspects of performance, such as attitudes and values. Developing specific competencies may require lifelong learning and redevelopment of employees. Needs analyses for development may include assessment centers, psychological testing, and performance appraisals. HR development approaches can involve jobsite, off-site, and learning organization activities. On-the-job development methods include coaching, committee assignments, job rotation, and “assistant-to” positions. Off-site development means often include classroom courses, seminars, and degrees; outdoor experiences; and sabbaticals and leaves of absences. Learning organization development efforts reflect knowledge-based means, such as corporate universities and centers and e-development efforts. Management development is a special focus in many organizations, including supervisor development and leadership development. Management modeling, coaching, and mentoring are valuable parts of management development efforts. T H I N K I N G 1. Discuss what talent management is and why it is a consideration addressed by a growing number of employers. 2. Describe the broad range of talent management efforts that use software applications by going to www.learn.com. Then give some examples of firms that have successfully used these applications. H R • E X P E R I E N T I A L You are the HR Director of a large manufacturing company that is approximately 50 years old. The company has reaped the benefits of a mostly tenured workforce, and many of the key workers are now approaching retirement age. It is anticipated that A C T I V I T I E S 3. How has the increase in uncertainty in business affected the “make-or-buy” decision, and is this trend likely to change? 4. Design a management development program for first-level supervisors in an electric utility company. What courses and experiences do they need? P R O B L E M S O L V I N G approximately 20% of the company’s workforce will retire in the next 3 to 5 years. You also are planning to retire within that period of time. To assist the company with the retirement transition process, you want to present a business case to the President Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 314 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 315 Talent Management for a succession plan for several key positions, including the Chief Financial Officer and Director of Operations. To develop an effective succession plan, visit www.score.org/article_succession_plan .html. 2. The successor employee for the replacement of the Director of Operations should have an advanced level of work experience in what key essential functions? 1. Identify the outside company advisors who should be included in the succession planning process. C A S E Leadership Leverage Gunderson Lutheran Health System in La Crosse, Wisconsin, is a health care delivery company that includes a 325-bed hospital, several specialty medical practices, and 41 clinics. In a recent year, they saw 1.4 million outpatient visits. The network has 6,834 employees including physicians, medical staff, managers and supervisors, and senior leaders. The age of their health care managers was a concern when asked whether they had a ready supply of leaders to step in. Upper management felt that growing leaders internally made sense from the standpoint of continuity and cultural fit. The HR staff researched best practices in talent management and development. The result was the establishment of a Talent Development Review Group including the top leaders. This group became accountable for developing leaders, making necessary development happen, and overseeing the growth of high-potential (high-po) talent. The Review Group followed five steps in their process. 1. They spent two years building a tiered leadership competency model that included criteria for executives, directors, and managers to ensure the right mix of KSAs. The tiered model defined behaviors and competencies necessary to demonstrate excellence in each role. The competencies were used for behavioral interview questions and for position descriptions, and they formed the basis for 360-degree feedback. 2. The next step was to identify high-potential talent. The Review Group picked candidates for consideration in each of four pools. Pool members had to demonstrate willingness to: • Advance • Participate in leadership assessment • Receive feedback and coaching • Take on development opportunities • Invest the necessary time In the five years after the program began, 60 high-po employees at all levels of leadership were identified, assessed, and had their career paths discussed. 3. Once high-pos had been identified and invited into a pool, it was time to assess the talent. The high-pos took assessment tools to identify strengths and development needs. Each candidate and the Review Group determined an initial strategy for closing gaps in the candidate’s readiness. 4. A variety of tools were used to develop plans for individual high-pos, including stretch assignments, role expansion, job rotations, coaching, onboarding, continuing education, mentoring, project assignments, and committee assignments. 5. Tracking progress included setting milestones and success metrics to make sure candidates would build the necessary skills. The effect of the development activities on performance was measured as well, with feedback from peers, colleagues, and superiors. The Review Group continues to look at progress annually. While numbers tell a positive story, another big change has been in the culture among the top leaders, who now see talent development as a strategic necessity.71 QUESTIONS 1. The top managers are very busy people. Why was it necessary to involve them in leadership leverage? 2. The program took 5 years to get to the end point. Is that realistic, or did it take too long? Explain why the timing may vary. 3. Would you let the names of the high-pos out to the rest of the organization? Why or why not? Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 315 26/06/10 5:17 PM 316 SECTION 3 Training and Development S U P P L E M E N T A L C A S E S Equipping for the Future Developed Today, Gone Tomorrow This case shows how one company in the oil industry started a succession planning program. For the case, go to www.cengage.com/management/ mathis.) This case illustrates a serious concern some employers have about developing employees only to have them leave. For the case, go to www .cengage.com/management/mathis.) N O T E S 1. Geoff Colvin, “How Top Companies Breed Stars,” CNN Money, September 20, 2007, 1–5. 2. Matthew Guthridge, et al., “Making Talent a Strategic Priority,” The McKinsey Quarterly, January 2008, 2–9; David Semb, “The Upcoming Crisis in Talent Management,” Chief Learning Officer, October 2009, 54–56. 3. Mark Schoeff, Jr., “Skills of Recent High School Graduates Leave Employers Cold,” Workforce Management, April 13, 2007, 1–2. 4. Guthridge, op. cit., 54, 55. 5. “Two-Thirds of Companies Are Not Prepared for Sudden Loss of Leadership,” WorldatWork, August 14, 2008, 1; “Few Companies Can Execute Their Talent Management Plan,” WorldatWork, October 30, 2008, 1. 6. Ibid. 7. Edward Lawler, Talent: Making People Your Competitive Advantage (Jossey-Bass, 2008). 8. Peter Cappelli, “A Supply Chain Model for Talent Management,” People and Strategy, 32 (2009), 5. 9. Helene Cavalli, “Development Opportunities Most Important to Job Seekers,” LinkedIn, December 1, 2009, 1–3. 10. Matthew Guthridge and Asmus Komm, “Why Multi-Nationals Struggle to Manage Talent,” The McKinsey Quarterly, May 2008, 2. 11. “Talent Management Continues to Go High Tech,” HR Focus, October 2009, 8–9. 12. Ed Fravenheim, “Special Report on HR Technology—Talent Planning for the Times,” Workforce Management, October 19, 2009, 37–43. 13. Grae Yohe, “The Talent Solution,” Human Resource Executive, June 2, 2009, 1ff. 14. Ed Fravenheim, “Style Over Substance?” Workforce Management, May 19, 2008, 30. 15. Peter Cappelli, “The Great Circle of Talent Management,” Human Resource Executive Online, August 20, 2007, www.hreonline.com, 1–3; Peter Cappelli, “Talent Management Cycles: Part II,” Human Resource Executive Online, September 17, 2007, www .hreonline.com, 1–3. 16. Adrienne Hedger, “How to Improve Talent Management?” Workforce Management, September 8, 2008, 54; Jon Younger, et al., “Developing Your Organization’s Brand as a Talent Developer,” Human Resource Planning, 30 (2007), 23. 17. P. Cappelli, 2009, 6. 18. B. Behan, “Lesson from VOA: Avoiding a Succession Debate,” BusinessWeek Online, October 7, 2009, 1. 19. Stephan Miles and Theodore Dysart, “Road Map for Successful Succession Planning,” Directors and Boards, First Quarter 2008, 57–59. 20. Dan Dalton and Catherine Dalton, “CEO Succession: Best Practices in a Changing Environment,” Journals of Business Strategy, 28 (2007), 11–13. 21. Charles Greer and Meghna Virick, “Diverse Succession Planning Lessons from the Industry Leaders,” Human Resource Management (2009), 351–367. 22. Jennifer Robison, “Scientific, Systematic Succession Planning,” Gallup Management Journal, June 2, 2009, 1–6. 23. Steve Schumacher, “Passing the Torch,” Rock Products, October 2008, 32–34. 24. Matt Boyle, “The Art of Succession,” BusinessWeek, May 11, 2009, 30–32. 25. Jayson Saba and Kevin Martin, “Succession Management,” Aberdeen Group, 2008, 2–28. 26. “Succession Success,” Human Resource Executive, July 2008, 22–27. 27. Karen Jarrell and Kyle Pewitt, “Succession Planning in Government,” Review of Public Personnel Administration, 27 (2007), 297–309. 28. Paula Ketter, “Sounding Succession Alarms,” T + D, January 2009, 20. 29. Traci McCready and Chris Hatcher, “How to Align Career Development and Succession Planning,” Workspan, March 2009, 61–63. 30. Edward Lawler III, “Choosing the Right Talent,” Workspan, July 2008, 73–75. 31. Kathy Gurchiek, “Career Development Gets Failing Grade from Many Workers,” 2008 HR Trendbook, 49–50. 32. Ronan Carbery and Thomas Garavan, “Conceptualizing the Participation of Managers in CareerFocused Learning and Development,” Human Resource Development Journal, 6 (2007), 396–397. 33. Kathryn Tyler, “Helping Employees Step Up,” HR Magazine, August 2007, 49. 34. Jane Sturges, “All in a Day’s Work?” Human Resource Management Journal, 18 (2008), 132. 35. Kathy Gurchiek, “Telecommuting Becomes Succession Planning Tool,” HR News, July 14, 2008, www.shrm.org, 1–3. 36. Yongho Park and William Rothwell, “The Effects of Organizational Learning Climate, Career Enhancing Strategy, and Work Orientation on the Protean Career,” Human Resource Development International, 8 (2009), 387–405. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 316 26/06/10 5:17 PM CHAPTER 9 317 Talent Management 37. Lindsey Gerdes, “The Best Places to Launch a Career,” BusinessWeek, September 15, 2008, 37–44. 38. Dennis Laker and Ruth Laker, “The Five Year Resume: A Career Planning Exercise,” Journal of Management Education, 31 (2007), 128–141. 39. Johannes Thijssen, et al., “Toward the Employability Link Model,” Human Resource Development Review, 7 (2008), 164–183. 40. Nancy Wendlandt and Aaron Rochler, “Addressing the College to Work Transition,” Journal of Career Development, 35 (2008), 151–165. 41. Thomas Ng and Daniel Feldman, “The School to Work Transition: A Role Identity Perspective,” Journal of Vocational Behavior, 71 (2007), 114–134. 42. Marjorie Armstrong-Stassen, “Organizational Practices and the Post Retirement Employment Experience of Older Workers,” Human Resource Management Journal, 18 (2008), 36–53. 43. Collin Barr, “Pension Tension on the Rise,” Fortune CNN Money, November 30, 2009, 1–3. 44. “Millions Now in ‘Encore’ Careers,” WorldatWork Newsline, June 18, 2008, www.worldatwork.org, 1. 45. Sherry Sullivan and Lisa Mainiero, “Benchmarking Ideas for Fostering Family Friendly Workplaces,” Organizational Dynamics, 36, 2007, 45–62. 46. Cari Tuna, “Initiative Moves Women Up the Corporate Ladder,” The Wall Street Journal, October 20, 2008, B4. 47. Jessica Marquez, “Gender Discrimination Begins Much Earlier than Exec Levels, Report Shows,” Workforce Management, May 12, 2009, 1–3. 48. Cathy Arnst, “Women Want Careers Just as Much as Men,” BusinessWeek, March 27, 2009, 1. 49. Joy Pixley, “Life Course Patterns of Career Prioritizing Decisions and Occupational Attainment in Dual-Earner Couples,” Work and Occupations, 35 (2008), 127–162. 50. Michael Harvey, et al., “Global Dual-Career Exploration and the Role of Hope and Curiosity,” Journal of Management Psychology, 24 (2009), 178–197. 51. Jena McGregor and Steve Hamm, “Managing the Workforce,” BusinessWeek, January 28, 2008, 34–51. 52. Jean-Luc Cerdin and Marie Le Pargneux, “Career and International Assignment Fit,” Human Resource Management, January–February 2009, 5–25. 53. Bill Leisy and N. S. Rajan, “Global Talent Management,” Workspan, March 2009, 39–45. 54. Jayson Saba, et al., “Assessments in Talent Management,” Aberdeen Group, 2009, www.aberdeen.com, 1–23. 55. Alina Dizik, “Training Without a Campus,” The Wall Street Journal, April 15, 2009, D4. 56. “Employees Want to Be Challenged by Coaches,” WorldatWork Newsline, December 12, 2008, 1–2. 57. “What Is a Coaching Culture?” Coaching Conundrum 2009 Global Executive Summary, Blessing White, 2009, 5–23. 58. Frank Giancola, “Making Sense of Sabbaticals,” Workspan, July 2006, 39–41. 59. Beth Mirza, “Build Employee Skills, Help Non Profits,” HR Magazine, October 2008, 30. 60. Jia Wang, “Developing Organizational Learning Capacity in Crises 61. 62. 63. 64. 65. 66. 67. 68. 69. 70. 71. Management,” Advances in Developing Human Resources, 10 (2008), 425–444; Paul Tosey and Jane Mathison, “Do Organizations Learn?” Human Resource Management Review, 7 (2008), 13–31. Desda Moss, “A Lesson in Learning,” HR Magazine, November 2007, 31–52. Donna Owens, “Success Factors,” HR Magazine, August 2008, 87–89. Lisa Dragoni, et al., “Understanding Management Development,” Academy of Management Journal, 52 (2009), 731–743. Mary Siegfried, “Filling the Leadership Void,” Inside Supply Management, April 2007, 22–26. E. Norman, “Develop Leadership Talent During a Recession,” Workspan, May 2009, 35–42. Robert Hooijberg and Nancy Lane, “Using Multisource Feedback Coaching Effectively in Executive Education,” Academy of Management Learning and Education, 8 (2009), 483–493. Lillian Eby, et al., “Does Mentoring Matter?” Journal of Vocational Behavior, 72 (2008), 254–267. Susan Wells, “Tending Talent,” HR Magazine, May 2009, 53–56. Sarah Hazlett and Sharon Gibson, “Linking Mentoring and Social Capitol,” Advances in Developing Human Resources, 9 (2007), 384–411. Mario Gardiner, et al., “Show Me the Money,” Higher Education Research and Development, 27 (2007), 425–442. Based on Nancy Noelke, “Leverage the Present to Build the Future,” HR Magazine, March 2009, 34–36. Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_09_ch09_p282-317.indd 317 26/06/10 5:17 PM C H A P T E R 10 Performance Management and Appraisal After you have read this chapter, you should be able to: • Identify the components of performance management systems. • Distinguish between performance management and performance appraisal. • Explain the differences between administrative and developmental uses of performance appraisal. • Describe the advantages and disadvantages of multisource (360-degree) appraisals. • Discuss the importance of training managers and employees about performance appraisal, and give examples of rater errors. • Identify several concerns about appraisal feedback and ways to make it more effective. 318 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 318 26/06/10 5:19 PM HR Headline Performance Management Does Not Focus Enough on Ethics A (Ryan McVay/Photodisc/Getty Images) recent study determined that many organizations do not focus enough on ethics when managing performance. For instance, only 43% of HR practitioners indicated that their employers included measures of ethics on performance evaluations. Making matters worse, professionals claimed that they were expected to take an active role in managing ethics, but many felt disconnected from the process. Further, many companies do not have a comprehensive program that raises awareness of ethics, and some companies have developed no ethics policies whatsoever. Such findings are troubling considering that problems are common. Organizations need to develop standards governing how employees are expected to behave.1 Given these realities, HR professionals should be involved in the development of those standards. Performance management practices such as evaluation forms should include measures that identify positive behaviors. HR professionals also need to create comprehensive programs that increase the motivation to take appropriate actions. Developing codes of conduct that outline company guidelines, offering training that teaches employees important workplace values, and increasing communication of important job standards can all work together to promote an ethical culture. In additon, reinforcement programs should be developed so that positive behaviors are rewarded and undesirable behaviors are punished. HR managers need to be in the “driver’s seat” when it comes to encouraging ethics. 319 Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 319 26/06/10 5:19 PM 320 SECTION 3 Training and Development Employers want employees who perform their jobs well and contribute to the mission and objectives of the organization, but managers have to provide the proper context for such high productivity. Performance management is the primary tool used to identify, communicate, measure, and reward employees so that they can make these contributions, and the process is one that supports a company’s strategic direction. Properly designing the performance management system is therefore a key method for increasing overall organizational performance. THE NATURE OF PERFORMANCE MANAGEMENT The performance management process starts by identifying the strategic goals an organization needs to accomplish to remain competitive and profitable. After these ideas are crystallized, managers identify how they and their employees can help support organizational objectives by successfully completing work. In a sense, the sum of the work completed in all jobs should advance the strategic plan. By adopting a “big-picture” quantitative approach, managers can successfully combine individual efforts in a manner that provides practical measures of organizational effectiveness. Performance management can also provide a unified approach to dealing with individual career development.2 As Figure 10-1 shows, performance management links organizational strategy to ultimate results. Performance management enables a company to convert overall strategy into results that support the mission and objectives. However, just having a strategic plan does not guarantee that results will be achieved and objectives will be satisfied. When organizational strategies have been defined, they must be translated into department- or unit-level actions. Then these actions must be assigned to individuals who are held accountable for efficient and effective goal accomplishment.3 Often performance management is confused with one of its key components—performance appraisal. Performance management is a series of activities designed to ensure that the organization gets the performance it needs from its employees. Performance appraisal is the process of determining how well employees do their jobs relative to a standard and communicating that information to them. An effective performance management system should do the following: Performance management Series of activities designed to ensure that the organization gets the performance it needs from its employees. Performance appraisal Process of determining how well employees do their jobs relative to a standard and communicating that information to them. • • • • Make clear what the organization expects Provide performance information to employees Identify areas of success and needed development Document performance for personnel records Performance management starts with the development and understanding of organizational strategy, and then dovetails into a series of steps that involves identifying performance expectations, providing performance direction, encouraging employee participation, assessing job performance, and conducting the performance appraisal. As Figure 10-2 suggests, successful performance management is a circular process that requires a system of administrative tools that effectively structures the dialogue between managers and their employees, and the motivation to utilize the system in a productive way.4 A successful performance management system allows managers to better prepare employees to tackle their work responsibilities by focusing on Copyright 2010 Cengage Learning. All Rights Reserved. May not be copied, scanned, or duplicated, in whole or in part. 5315X_10_ch10_p318-356.indd 320 26/06/10 5:19 PM CHAPTER 10 321 Performance Management and Appraisal FIGURE 10-1 Performance Management Linkage Organizational Strategies Performance Management Identify expected performance levels Encourage high levels of performance Measure individual performance; then evaluate Provide feedback on individual performance Provide assistance as needed Reward or discipline depending on performance Employee Performance Performance Management Outcomes Pay increases Incentive rewards Promotions/advancement Training and development Career planning Disciplinary actions Organizational Results Goals met or not met Employee satisfaction or dissatisfaction strong or weak Coordination between performance and pay these activities. For example, the software company CA recently revised its performance review procedures so that the process would better facilitate individual motivation and growth. Employees are rated on standardized job criteria, complete self-evaluations, and are given completed evaluation forms several days ahead of appraisal meetings to consider ratings. “Performance agreements” explicitly connect individual actions to corporate goals, and the whole process of performance management is strengthened through positive communication.5 Even well-intentioned employees do not always know what is expected or how to improve their performance, which also makes performance management necessary. A